Skip to main content

Full text of "Objects for the microscope, being a popular description of the most instructive and beautiful subjects for exhibition"

See other formats


THE  LIBRARY 

OF 

THE  UNIVERSITY 
OF  CALIFORNIA 

PRESENTED  BY 

PROF.  CHARLES  A.  KOFOID  AND 
MRS.  PRUDENCE  W.  KOFOID 


Scales  of  Beetles  and  Fishes. 


"Frontispiece. 


1.  Weevil,  natural  size.        2.  Scales  of  Weevil,  magnified  100  diameters. 

3.  Scales  of  Green  Weevil,  magnified  150  diameters.       4.  Scale  of  Perch,  magnified  4  diameters. 

5.  Lines  on  Perch's  scale,  magnified  100  diameters.    6.  Scale  of  Sole,  magnified  9  diameters. 

7.   Piece  of  Eel's  Skin,  magnified  4  diameters. 
8.  Upper  and  under  layers  of  Eel-skin,  and  Eel  scales.     9.  Scale  of  Eel,  magnified  50  diameters. 


OBJECTS 


FOR 


THE    MICROSCOPE 

BEING  A 

POPULAK  DESCRIPTION 

OF  THE  MOST 

INSTRUCTIVE    AND    BEAUTIFUL    SUBJECTS 

FOE  EXHIBITION. 


BY 

L.     LANE     CLARKE. 


1  The  eye  sees  no  more  than  it  brings  with  it  the  power  of  seeing." 


FOUBTH  EDITION. 

Illustrated  with  Eight  Coloured  Plates. 

LONDON: 
GROOMBRIDGE     AND     SONS, 

5,  PATERNOSTER  ROW. 

MDCCCLXXL 


I  LONDON:    | 

I  BARRETTS  SONs7| 

|    MARK   LANE.  | 


CONTENTS. 


ON  THE  USE  OF  THE  MICROSCOPE. 

fAGE 

Directions  for  Mounting  Objects       ...         ...         ...         ...       ....         6 

„  „    Mounting  in  Balsam  ...          ...          ...          ...          ...         7 

PART  I. 

OBJECTS   PROM   THE   VEGETABLE    KINGDOM. 

CHAPTER  I. 

Shapes  of  Cells— Cell-contents — Oil  Cells— Hairs  of  plants — 
Cuticle  and  Stomata — Cuticle  of  Yucca,  of  Aloe,  of  Deutzia 
Scabra,  of  Amaryllis,  of  Indian  Corn,  of  Saccalobium, 
of  Elaeagnus,  of  Tillandsia,  of  Onosma,  of  Opuntia  ...  ...  9 

Raphides. — Cuticle  of  Hyacinth — Raphides  from  Rhubarb — 
Anagallis — Spiral  fibre — Spiral  Cells  of  Oncidium — Spiral 
Vessels  of  Collomia — Spiral  Cells  of  Balsam— Spiral  Cells  of 
Sphagnum — Scalariform  Vessels  ...  ...  ...  ...  19 

Pollen.—  Pollen  of  Mallow,  of  Hollyhock,  of  Passion-flower,  of 
(Enothera — A  few  words  more  on  the  Pollen— Pollen-tubes 
— Stamens  ...  ...  ...  ...  ...  ...  ...  23 

Seeds.—  Poppy— Sweet-William— Silene,     or     Stellaria— Orchis— 

Eccremocarpus  or  Calampelis    ...          ...          ...          ...          ...        28 

CHAPTER  II. 

SECTIONS    OF   WOOD. 

Ruscus— Whanghae  Cane— Asparagus — Section  of  Hazel,  of  Pine, 
of  Yew — Cedar  of  Lebanon — Vegetable  Ivory — Fossil  Coni- 
ferous Wood — Pine  Wood— Section  of  Cocoa-nut,  of  Cob-nut, 
of  Snake-wood  ...  ...  ...  ...  ...  ...  ...  29 

Moss. — Slides  ofDicranum,  Funaria,  &c.  &c. — Spore-cases  of  Fern 
— Elaters  of  Equisetum — Elaters  of  Jungermannia — Junger- 
mannia  Bidentata  °...  32 

Fungi. — Slide    of  Puccinia,    or   Phragmidium— Blight   of  Wheat 

(Smut) — Uredo  Fcetida,  or  Bunt — Uredo,  or  ^cidium         ...       39 


IV  CONTENTS. 

CHAPTER  III. 

INFUSORIAL   EARTHS. 

PAGE 

Diatoms  of  Guano — Naviculae — Navicula  Hippocampa — Pleuro- 
sigma — Meloseira — Meloseira  Borreri — Achnanthes  Longipes, 
— Synedra  Ulna  —  Bacillariae — Gomphonema — Licmophora — 
Rhabdonema  —  Grammatophora  Marina — Biddulphia — Am- 
phitetras — Isthmia  Obliqua — Arachnoidiscus  —  Heliopelta — 
Actinocyclus — Asteromphalus  Asterolampra — Coscinodiscus  42 

Desmidiacece — Volvox    Globator — Closterium  —  Confervae  —  Zyg- 

nema — Achy  la  Prolif era  ...         ...         ...       50 


PART  II. 

OBJECTS    FROM    THE    ANIMAL    KINGDOM. 

CHAPTER  I. 

OBJECTS    FROM    THE    ARACHNIDA. 

Spider's   Foot — Spider's    Legs — Spider's    Spinnarets — Spider's 

Eyes — Spider's  Jaws — Spider's  Palpi — Epidermis   of  Spider       57 

CHAPTER  II. 

INSECT      PARTS. 

Tongues  of  Insects. — Tongue  or  Proboscis  of  Hive  Bee — Tongue  of 
Wasp — Butterfly's  Tongue  or  Proboscis — Proboscis  or  Tongue 
of  Blow-fly — Proboscis  of  Tabanus,  of  Gnat,  of  Empis-fly,  of 
Dioctria  —  Head  of  Conops,  of  Rhingia,  or  Syrphus, 
of  Drone-fly,  or  Helophilus,  of  Eristalis,  of  Tipula,  of  Lim- 
nobia,  of  Hemerobius,  of  Panorpa — Tongue  of  Cricket — 
Gizzard  of  Cricket — Mouth  of  Soldier-beetle,  Calathus  Castel- 
loides,  of  Brachinus,  of  Onthophagus,  of  Anchomenus,  of 
Crioceris,  of  Ladybird,  of  Stenopterus  Rufus...  ...  ...  64 

Antennce. — Antennae  of  Cockchafer,  of  Nitidularia,  of  Hydrophilus, 
of  Elater,  of  Syrphus,  of  Blow-fly,  of  Bee,  of  Ichneumon,  of 
Argynnis — Palpi  of  Argynnis — Antennae  of  Dragon-fly,  of  Silk- 
worm-moth ...  ...  ...  ...  ...  ...  ...  79 

Spriacles  and  Trachece. — Spiracles  of  Dytiscus — Tracheae  of  Dy- 
tiscus — Spiracles  of  Cockchafer,  of  Fly,  of  Tipula,  of  Water 
Larvee — Aerating  Leaflet  of  Libellula — Abdomen  of  Ephe- 
mera, or  Spiracles  ...  ...  ...  ...  ...  ...  83 


CONTEXTS.  7 

PAGE 
Circulation  of  Blood  85 

Spiracles  of  Larva  of  Bot-fly  86 

Wings  of  Insects. — "Wing  of  Scatophaga,  of  House-fly,  of  Blue- 
bottle-fly, of  Syrphus,  of  Midge,  of  Gnat,  of  Beetle,  of 
Cricket 86 

Scales  of  Insects. — Scales  of  Morphq  Menelaus,  of  Polyommatus 
Argus,  of  Hipparchia  Janira,  of  Pontia  Brassica,  of  Silkworm- 
moth,  of  Clothes-moth,  of  Podura,  of  Lepisma  Saccharina  ...  91 

Elytra  of  Diamond  Beetle      94 

Feet  of  Insects. — Foot  of  Syrphus — Leg  of  Dytiscus,  or  Dyticus 
— Foot  of  Wasp,  of  Ophion — Leg  of  Bee,  of  Gyrinus,  of  Bra- 
chinus,  of  Anchomenus,  of  Calathus  Castelloides — Sting  of 
Wasp  and  Bee,  of  Gnat,  of  Tabanus 94 

Egg  of  Bot-fly,  or  (Estrus 98 

CHAPTER  III. 

INSECTS   MOU>*TED   "WHOLE. 

The    Telephorns,    or    Soldier-beetle — Helophorua     Granularis — 

Catheretes  Urticae — Coccinella,  or  Lady-bird  ...          ...      100 

Hemiptera. — Yelia  Rivulorum — Notonecta,  or  the  Water  Boatman 
— Reduvius,  or  Bed-bug — Cimex,  or  Field-bug — Aphis — 
Aphrophora,  or  Cuckoo-spit — Thrips  ...  ...  ...  106 

Hymenoptera. — Tenthredo,  or  Saw-fly — Cypheus  Pygmseus — Ich- 
neumon-fly— Microgaster  Glomeratus  —  Aphidius  Avenae — 
Ephedrus  Plagiator — Ceraphron  Carpenterii — Chelymorpha 
Phyllophora,  or  the  Turtle- shaped  Leaf-bearer  ...  ...  110 

CHAPTER  IV. 

DIPTERA. 

Culex  Pipiena 120 

Ptychoptera : 124 

JScatopha/ja. — The  Family  of  the  Brachycera — the  Scatophaga — 
Lonchoptera — Bibeo —  Dolichopus — The  Opomyza — Chlorops 
— Phoro  —  Leptis  —  Asilus  —  Empis  —  Empis  Stercorea — 
Hilara — Syrphus  Pyrastri — Borborus  Equinus — Sepedon — 
Sepsis 125 

The  Halteres,  Poisers,  of  Diptera. — Halteres  of  Blow-fly — Hal- 

teres  of  Tabanus  142 


VI  CONTENTS. 

CHAPTER  V. 

•  PARASITES. 

PAGE 

The  Flea,— The  Pygidium  of  a  Flea  ' 144 

Pediculus,  or  Louse     .,.         ...         ...         146 

The  Acari,  or  Tics,  Mites. — Acarus  Domesticus,  or  Common 
Cheese-mites  —  Acarus  Passularum  —  Acarus  Passerinus — 
Ixodes,  or  Dog-tick — Melophagus — Stenopteryx  —  Ornitho- 
myia — Nycteribia — Chelifer — Acarus  Gamasus — Trombidium 
Phalangii — Trombidium  Autumnale — Water-mites — Entozoa  147 

CHAPTER  VI. 

MICROSCOPIC   MOTHS. 

Nepticula  Aurella —  Nepticula  Malvelli  —  Nepticula  Prunatori — 
Nepticula  .Trimaaulella — Ceriastoma — Scitella — Lithocolletis 
Sylvella— Lithocolletis  Schreberella— Lithocolletis  Trifas- 
ciella — Lithocolletis  Hortella  — Gracilaria  Swederella — Gra- 
cilaria  Syringella  —  Coleophora  Gryphipennella  —  Ornix 
Guttea — Lithocolletis  Scabiosella — Glyphipteryx  Thrasonella 
— Head  of  Ochsenheimeria,  &c.  ...  ...  ...  ...  153 

CHAPTER  VII. 

PALATES. 

Palate  of  Helix  Pomatia — Helix  Aspersa — Limax — Helix  Hor- 
tensis — Helix  Nemoralis — Helix  Rufescens — Helix  Virgata 
— Zonites,  or  Helix  Nitida — Palate  of  Whelk,  of  Purpurea, 
of  Nasa,  of  Trochus  Ziziphinus,  of  Trochus  Crassus,  of 
Trochus  Umbilicatus,  of  Periwinkle,  of  Haliotis,  or  Aumer, 
of  Pleurobranch,  of  Aplysia,  of  Doris,  of  Limpet,  of  Chiton, 
of  Yellow  Nerite,  of  Neritina  Fluviatilis,  of  Lymneus  Stag- 
nalis,  of  Planorbis  Cornea,  of  Paludina,  of  Cyclastoma  ...  158 

CHAPTER  VIII. 

SLIDES    OF    ZOOPHYTES. 

Anthozoa. — Sertularia  Pumila — Sertularia  Polyzonias — Sertularia 
Operculata  —  Sertularia  Rosacea — Laomedea  Geniculata — 
Laomedea  Dichotoma  —  Plumularia  Cristata  —  Plumularia 
Falcata 1C? 

Polyzoa. — Gemicellaria —  Gemmellaria  Loriculata  —  Gemecelaria, 
or  Notomia  Bursaria — Cellularia  Avicularia — Flustra  Trun- 
cata  —  Pustulipora  Fossil  —  Flustra  Chartacese  —  Cellularia 
Reptans — Cellularia  Ciliata — Crisea  Eburnea — Crisea  Cornuta 
— Serialaria  Lendigera — Fresh-water  Zoophytes  ...  ...  171 


COK  TENTS.  VU 

CHAPTER  IX. 

SEA-WEEDS — MARINE   ALG.E. 

PAGE 

Marine  Algae — Callithamnion  —  Ceramium  —  Ptilota  Plumosa — 
Plocamium  Vulgare,  Coccineum  —  Polysiphonia  —  Sphero- 
coccus — Griffitlisia —  Gracillaria —  Lanrentia —  Odonthalia — 
JBonnemaisonnia — Delesseria  —  Rhodomela  —  Spyridia  Fila- 
mentosa — Chaetospora  Wiggii — Halymenia  —  Dasya — Dasya 
Arbuscula — Dasya  Occellata  —  Dasya  Yenusta — Goadby's 
Solution  for  Marine  Algae  ...  ...  ...  181 

CHAPTER  X. 

FORAM1NATED    SHELLS. 

The  Operculina — Fossil  Foraminated   Shells   from   Barbadoes — 

Orbitolites— Nummulites  ,194 

CHAPTER  XL 

SPICULES   OF   SPONGES. 

Spicules   of  Sponge — Gemmules   of  Pachymatisma — Spicules  of 

GrantiaNivea     198 

CHAPTER  XII. 

SECTIONS    OF   BONE. 

Man's   Metacarpal — Fin-bone  of  Lepidosteos — Femur  of  Tetrao 

Urogallus 201 

Sections  of  Teeth. — Sections  of  Human  Tooth        204 

CHAPTER  XIII. 

HAIRS. 

Human  Hair — Hairs  of  Dormouse  and  Common  Mouse,  of  Mole, 
of  Bat,  of  Elephant,  of  Camel,  of  Reindeer,  of  Ornitho- 
rhynchus,  of  Larva  of  Dermestes  ...  206 

CHAPTER  XIV. 

SPICULES   OF   HOLOTHURI^E. 

Spicules  of  Synapta — Spicules  of  Chirodota — Calcareous  Spicules 
of  Doris— Calcareous  Skeleton  of  Doris — Spicules  of  Gorgonia 
— Spicules  of  Alcyonium  Digitatum — Section  of  Echinus 
Spine  208 


Vlll  .  CONTENTS. 


OBJECTS   FOR   POLARISCOPE. 

PAGE 

Polarized  Light — Selenite  —  Rhinoceros  Horn  —  Whalebone — 
Elytra  of  Dytiscms — Cuticle  of  Deutzia  Leaf — Section,  of 
Quartz— List  of  Objects  212 

CHAPTER  XV. 

ANATOMICAL    INJECTED   PREPARATIONS. 

Liver:  Human,  Eabbit,  Pig,  Monkey— Yilli,  Small  Intestines  of 
Man,  of  Monkey,  of  Pig,  of  Dog,  of  Cat,  of  Rabbit— Duode- 
num of  Mouse — Lung  :  Human,  Monkey,  Bear,  Puppy,  Pig, 
Cat,  Sheep,  Fowl,  Goose,  Turtle,  Rattlesnake,  Frog,  Tortoise 
—Gill  of  Eel— Fin  of  Turtle— Stomach  of  Mouse— Skin- 
Palm  of  Hand— Foot  of  Cat— Skin  of  Toad— Ciliary  Pro- 
cesses— Eye  of  Ox — Ear  of  Mouse— Toe  of  White  Mouse — 
Kidney — Tongue  :  Human,  Dog,  Cat,  Mouse — Brain :  Human, 
Cat,  Rabbit,  Mouse  216 

CHAPTER  XVI. 

SLIDES    OF   CRYSTALLIZATION. 

Selenite — Acetate  of  Copper — Sulphate  of  Copper — Alum — Oxa- 
lurate  of  Ammonia — Murexide,  or  Purpurute  of  Ammonia — 
Hydrochlorate,  or  Muriate  of  Ammonia — Oxalate  of  Am- 
monia— Salt  of  Brucia— lodo-disulphate  of  Quinine — Borax, 
or  Bi-borate  of  Soda— Boracic  Acid— Sulphate  of  Magnesia — 
Ammonio-Phosphate  or  Magnesia — Uric  Acid,  or  Lithic  Acid 
— Nitrate  of  Potash,  or  Nitre  — Saltpetre — Salicine — Nitrate 
of  Silver ...  224 


OBJECTS   FOR   THE    MICROSCOPE. 


ON  THE  USE  OF  THE  MICROSCOPE. 

ALTHOUGH  a  minute  description  of  the  construction  of  the 
microscope  would  be  out  of  place  in  this  small  work,  and 
involve  more  of  the  science  of  optics  than  could  be  under- 
stood without  diagrams  and  much  knowledge  of  the  laws 
of  light,  yet  it  will  be  useful  to  give  a  few  hints  on  the 
practical  management  of  a  newly-purchased  instrument. 

Assuming  the  student  to  be  desirous  of  obtaining  an 
efficient  instrument  at  a  mode- 
rate cost,  he  cannot  do  better 
than  procure  what  is  ordinarily 
termed  a  student's  microscope, 
which  may  be  obtained  from 
£3  3s.  to  £5  5s. 

It  had  long  been  a  desiderata 
with  microscopists  to  obtain  the 
advantage  of  binocular  vision 
with  stereoscopic  effect.  Mr.  F. 
H.  Wenham  was  the  successful 
adapter  of  the  stereoscopic  prin- 
ciple to  the  microscope,  which 
the  following  extract  from  '  Re- 
creative Science/  will  clearly 
explain  : — 

The  result  is  obtained  by  the 
introduction  of  a  small,  but  very 
accurately  formed,  double  reflect- 
ing prism,  immediately  above  the 
object  glass,  so  as  to  intercept 
half  the  rays  of  light  which  pass 
through  it.  Fig.  1  will  explain 
the  principle  : — A  is  the  body  of 
an  ordinary  microscope ;  at  B  a  FIG.  1. 


2  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

square  hole  is  cut,  through  which  the  prism  c  is  made 
to  slide  so  far  that  its  edge  will  just  reach  the  central 
line  of  the  objective,  and  should  be  made  to  draw  back  t 
so  as  to  clear  the  aperture  altogether,  when  the  tube ' 
A  acts  as  a  single  microscope.  When  the  prism  is  thrust 
in,  it  collects  a  portion  of  the  rays,  and  reflects  them  to 
the  opposite  side  of  the  tube,  where  an  opening  is  made 
large  enough  to  allow  them  to  pass  through,  into  the  sup- 
plementary body,  E,  which  in  size  corresponds  to  the  main 
tube  ;  the  remainder  of  the  rays  pass  uninterruptedly  up 
the  principal  body. 

Fig.  2  is  an  enlarged  outline  of 
the  prism.  Let  E  E  be  a  ray  of  light 
having  passed  through  the  object 
•f  glass,  and  entering  the  prism  at 
right  angles  at  the  point  F  ;  passing 
on,  it  is  intercepted  by  the  surface 
A  B,  which  being  inclined  within  the 
angle  of  total  reflection,  the  ray  is 
towards  H,  from  which  point  it  is 
again  reflected  in  the  direction  re- 
quired. If  the  prism  be  correctly 
made,  and  of  the  smallest  size  pos- 
sible for  admitting  the  pencil,  the 
difference  between  the  direct  and 
reflected  image  is  scarcely  observable; 
FIG.  2.  a  faulty  prism  can  therefore  be  easily 

detected. 

The  adjustment  for  difference  of  distance  between  the 
eyes  is  effected  by  means  of  the  draw  tubes  ;  if  they  are  at 
the  utmost  limit  of  proximity  when  close  in,  by  drawing 
them  out  they  can  be  made  to  suit  every  position  of  eye- 
sight. This  is  very  conveniently  done  by  means  of  a  rack 
and  pinion  movement,  as  shown  in  Fig.  3. 

The  opaque  principle  of  illumination  should  be  used  in 
all  cases  where  possible,  as  this  gives  to  objects  a  more 
natural  appearance.  The  effect  upon  looking  through  a 
binocular  microscope  for  the  first  time  is  very  striking ; 
many  peculiarities  are  instantly  presented  to  the  eye,  which, 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  3 

with  a  single  body,  would  be  observed  with  difficulty.  The 
instrument  figured  is  one  of  those  exhibited  by  Messrs. 
Crouch  at  the  Manchester  Exhibition  of  Science  and  Art. 


FIG.  3. 

The  advantage  of  the  binocular  is  chiefly  in  the  rest  it 
gives  the  eyes,  which  have  no  unequal  and  unnatural  strain. 

The  field  of  vision  is  extended,  and  objects  are  seen  in 
relief,  round,  life-like,  and  distinct.  The  joints  of  insects 
are  seen  in  a  wonderful  manner,  the  ball  and  socket  joints 
and  hinge  joints,  if  well  prepared,  are  now  perfectly  realised; 
the  hairs  of  plants  and  animals  are  seen  in  their  true  posi- 
tion ;  suckers,  especially  those  on  the  foot  of  Dyticus, 
present  themselves  in  the  erect  attitude  of  life,  and  Diatoms 


4  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

mounted  dry  on  a  black  disc  exhibit  their  form  and  mark- 
ings, as  if  the  more  elaborate  parabolic  reflector  was  beneath. 
To  test  this,  obtain  a  slide  of  Heliopelta,  or  of  Isthmia  enervis, 
or  of  Arachnoidiscus,  which  will  show  the  advantage  of  the 
binocular  with  a  very  moderate  power. 

Fossil  foraminated  Shells  (Barbadoes). 

Spicules  of  Gorgonia. 

Section  of  Rush. 

Capsules  of  Moss. 

Any  of  these  will  answer  the  same  purpose. 

Whilst  adding  a  few  thoughts  to  this  introductory  chap- 
ter, let  me  answer  one  or  two  questions  not  unfrequently 
put  to  me. 

How  much  does  this  microscope  magnify  ? 

That  is,  a  small  binocular  with  simple  eye-piece,  and 
three  object  glasses  of  two-inch,  one-inch,  and  half-inch 
focus.  The  scale  of  magnifying  power  varies  with  different 
makers ;  but  if  I  give  my  own  microscope  as  an  example, 
it  will  help  to  make  others  understood. 

The  two-inch  object  glass,  which  has  an  angular  aperture 
of  15°,  will  magnify  twenty-five  diameters,  or  400  times 
superficial  measurement. 

The  one-inch  object  glass  has  usually  about  33°  angular 
aperture,  magnifies  fifty  to  sixty  diameters,  or  960  times 
superficial  measurement. 

The  half-inch  object  glass  has  an  angular  aperture  of  60° 
or  65°,  and  consequently  magnifies  120  diameters,  or  1,920 
times  superficial  measurement. 

Again  I  am  asked,  What  is  the  angle  of  aperture  ? 

This  cannot  here  be  explained  beyond  the  brief  state- 
ment, that  it  is  the  angle  made  by  two  lines  from  opposite 
sides  of  the  aperture  of  the  object  glass  with  the  point  of  the 
focus  of  the  lens.  A  diagram  is  necessary  to  make  this 
quite  clear. 

The  two-inch  object  glass  requires  a  certain  distance,  as 
at  A,  to  briug  the  object  under  examination  into  distinct- 
ness or  focus. 

The  inch,  half-inch,  quarter-inch  glasses,  require  nearer 
and  nearer  approach  to  the  object  for  the  same  purpose. 


Objects  JOT  the  Microscope.  5 

The  angles  so  made  by  the  dotted  lines  are  measured  by 
a  graduated  semicircle  of  180°,  under  peculiar  manage- 
ment of  light  well  known  by  opticians,  but  beyond  our 
present  inquiry ;  and  denote  the  number  of  extreme  lateral 
rays  which  the  object  glass  admits. 


The  larger  the  angle  the  greater  is  the  number  of  rays 
admitted,  and  the  more  brilliantly  the  object  is  illuminated 
the  greater,  consequently,  is  the  defining  power.  Experi- 
ment has  shown  that  obliquity  of  light  is  needful  for  the 
perception  of  the  most  delicate  markings,  and  that  an  out- 
line visible  with  an  object  glass  of  small  angular  aperture 
admitting  but  few  oblique  rays,  as  in  Fig.  1,  would  be  filled 
up  with  lines  of  beauty,  and  stria?  of  inconceivable  delicacy 
under  an  object  glass  of  large  aperture,  as  Fig.  3,  which 
gives  it  an  oblique  illumination. 

The  markings  on  butterfly  scales  and  the  valves  of  Dia- 
tom acea?  will  illustrate  this. 

Again  it  is  asked,  What  is  that  particular  fault  which 
object  glasses  by  inferior  makers  are  liable  to,  called 
spherical  aberration  ?  It  is  when  objects  at  the  circum- 
ference of  the  field  are  not  in  focus  at  the  same  time  as  those 
in  the  centre,  or  when  part  of  a  single  object  fades  away 
towards  the  circumference. 

Another  fault  is  chromatic  aberration,  when  coloured 
fringes  surround  the  object  under  examination,  whereas  an 
achromatic  lens  shows  a  clear  colourless  field  and  a  purely 
bright  object. 


ti  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

Defining  power,  not  the  magnifying  power,  is  the  thing 
to  care  for ;  we  want  to  see  the  real  structure  of  an  object, 
not  an  exaggerated  representation  ;  and  those  are  the  best 
glasses  which  transmit  clear  light,  give  a  perfectly  flat  field, 
and  by  which  we  see  sharp  distinct  lines  in  the  object  we 
are  investigating. 

I  will  but  add  a  few  practical  hints  on  the  management 
of  the  microscope  : — 

Do  not  imagine  that  an  expensive  apparatus  is  necessary. 
The  greatest  discoveries  have  been  made  with  the  simplest 
instruments. 

Have  good  object  glasses,  and  do  not  waste  money  on 
an  elaborate  stage. 

Use  low  powers  in  preference  to  high  ones,  unless  abso- 
lutely necessary ;  and,  remember,  we  do  not  want  objects 
magnified  so  much  as  we  want  them  defined.  A  clearly- 
defining  low  power  is  the  best  working  glass. 

A  few  simple  tools  will  be  sufficient  for  all  purposes  of 
dissection  and  examination,  viz. — 

Slides  of  glass. 

Circles  and  squares  of  thin  glass. 

A  pair  of  forceps. 

A  lancet. 

A  few  needles,  fixed  in  handles.  Split  one  end  of  a 
match,  and  tie  the  needle  in  with  some  waxed  silk. 

Two  or  three  camel-hair  pencils. 

Six  watch  glasses. 

These  are  all  that  are  absolutely  necessary  for  daily 
study. 

FOR   MOUNTING   OBJECTS. 

This  need  not  be  a  difficult  or  expensive  process ;  but  to 
succeed  with  insect  preparations  time  and  experience  are 
essential.  The  easiest  beginning  is  with  vegetable  speci- 
mens— cuticles,  pollen,  &c. — and  with  palates  which  are 
mounted  in  fluid. 

You  must  have  a  turn-table,  price  6s.  to  8s.,  and  make 
a  cell  on  each  glass  slide  you  mean  to  use,  with  gold  size 
or  Brunswick  black.  It  is  better  to  see  this  done  than  to 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  7 

read  the  best  description  of  "  how  to  do  it."  A  small 
bottle  of  gold  size  or  Brunswick  black  costs  6d. 

Make  a  solution  of  salt  and  water  ;  be  careful  that  it  is 
very  clean,  and  better  use  distilled  or  filtered  water — five 
grains  of  salt  to  one  ounce  of  water.  This  is  the  best 
preservative  for  palates. 

Pure  glycerine — a  small  bottle,  Is.  This  is  excellent  for 
leaves  of  moss  and  cuticles  ;  but  they  also  mount  very  well 
and  more  easily  in  Mr.  Topping's  liquid:  one  part  of 
acetate  of  alumina  to  four  parts  of  distilled  water. 

Let  your  cells  be  quite  dry ;  it  is  better  to  make  a  dozen 
or  more  at  once  and  keep  them  by  you.  When  required, 
fix  the  slide  upon  the  turn-table,  put  a  drop  of  the  liquid  in 
the  cell  with  a  camel-hair  pencil,  then  lay  the  object  in  it. 
Have  a  thin  glass  cover  ready,  and  let  it  gently  fall  over 
the  cell.  Remove  the  superfluous  moisture  with  a  little 
sponge  or  blotting  paper ;  and  then,  with  a  steady  hand, 
take  a  brushful  of  Brunswick  black,  make  the  revolving 
table  run  round  quickly,  and,  touching  the  edge  of  the 
cell,  a  circle  of  the  varnish  will  safely  fix  it.  Let  the 
varnish  be  thin,  and  the  circle  also  ;  for  it  dries  better, 
and  there  is  less  danger  of  its  running  into  the  cell-contents. 
The  next  day  go  over  it  again,  making  the  circle  thicker 
and  wider. 

FOR   MOUNTING   IN   BALSAM. 

Have  a  bottle  of  clear,  pure  Canada  balsam — it  costs  Is. 

A  little  spirit  of  turpentine,  3d. 

Spirits  of  wine,  one  ounce,  Is, 

A  brass  table,  or  tripod. 

A  spirit  lamp. 

Solution  of  caustic  potash. 

The  use  of  balsam  in  preparing  insect  parts  is  not  only 
to  preserve,  but  to  show  the  structure  of  the  object.  When 
properly  applied,  it  enters  into  the  minutest  parts,  dis- 
placing the  air,  and  rendering  the  external  tegument — 
hairs,  spines,  or  suckers— perfectly  transparent. 

For  instance,  many  young  students,  anxious  to  see  the 
leg  of  a  fly,  or  of  a  beetle,  clip  it  off,  and  put  it  under  the 


8  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

microscope.  They  are  somewhat  disappointed  at  seeing 
indistinctly  a  row  of  black  joints,  and  nothing  more. 

Let  that  leg  be  first  soaked  for  a  few  days  in  a  little 
potash  and  water,  to  soften  it  and  dissolve  the  internal 
substance  ;  then  washed  in  clean  water  and  dried  ;  then 
soaked  for  a  few  minutes  in  turpentine,  and  finally  mounted 
in  balsam  ;  every  joint  will  be  clear,  every  hair  visible, 
the  pulvillus  transparent,  and  the  structure  admirably 
displayed. 

The  same  results  are  obtained  with  the  eyes,  tongues,  and 
wings  of  all  insects. 

The  actual  mounting  is  a  matter  of  experience  :  to  keep 
out  air-bubbles  is  the  great  and  only  difficulty. 

Place  a  slide  on  the  brass  table,  over  the  spirit  lamp,  and 
when  heated  moderately  put  a  drop  of  balsam  in  the  centre 
of  it ;  let  this  alsop become  warm,  but  not  very  hot,  and  then 
lay  the  prepared  object  in  it.  As  bubbles  arise,  skim  them 
off  with  a  needle,  and  take  care  that  the  balsam  does  not 
boil,  or  your  specimen  is  lost ; — it  will  be  full  of  obstinate 
air-bubbles,  irrevocably  fixed  in  the  tissue.  When  it  looks 
clear,  examine  under  the  microscope,  and  if  all  right  replace 
it  on  the  table,  and  having  previously  warmed  a  thin  glass 
cover,  let  it  drop  gently  over  the  object. 

Dry  it  on  the  mantelpiece,  or  a  stone  slab,  and  then  clean 
the  slide  by  scraping  off  the  balsam  and  washing  it  with  a 
little  turpentine  ;  or  soda  and  water  will  clean  it  nicely  ; 
only  if  it  is  left  in  the  solution  it  will  unsettle  the  balsam. 

Try  experiments  for  yourself,  and  do  not  be  discouraged 
by  a  great  many  failures  ;  neither  be  satisfied  with  bad 
mounting,  half-prepared  objects,  and  untidy  slides. 


PART  L 

OBJECTS  FKOM  THE  VEGETABLE  KINGDOM. 


•'  Search  out  the  wisdom  of  Nature, — there  is  depth  in  all  her  doings. 
She  hath  on  a  mighty  scale  a  general  use  for  all  things ; 
Yet  hath  she  specially  for  each  its  microscopic  purpose. 
There  is  use  in  the  prisoned  air  that  swelleth  the  pods  of  the  laburnum, 
Design  in  the  venomed  thorns  that  sentinel  the  leaves  of  a  nettle, 
A  final  cause  for  the  aromatic  gum  that  congealeth  the  moss  around  a 

rose, 
A  reason  for  each  blade  of  grass  that  raiseth  its  small  spine." 

Proverbial  Philosophy. 

"  On  every  herb  on  which  you  tread 
Are  written  words  which,  rightly  read, 
Will  lead  you  from  earth's  fragrant  sod 
To  hope  and  holiness  and  God."  Anon. 


CHAPTER  I. 

IN  every  collection  of  objects  for  the  microscope  we  find 
many  preparations  from  the  vegetable  world — slides  of 
cuticles,  fibro-cells,  pollen-grains,  raphides,  &c.  &c. ;  and 
few  lose  more  in  being  hastily  looked  at,  as  merely  pretty 
objects,  without  that  knowledge  of  flower-life  which  alone 
can  enable  us  rightly  to  appreciate  them. 

If  we  are  wholly  ignorant  of  the  structure  of  plants,  their 
uses,  their  variety,  and  the  secret  mechanism  by  which 
their  life  is  renewed  day  by  day,  we  are  apt  to  look  at  these 
slides  for  mere  amusement,  for  the  lust  of  the  eye,  pleased 
as  a  child  or  as  a  savage  with  strange  forms  or  brilliant 
colours.  Therefore,  before  we  take  them  up,  it  will  not  be 
unprofitable  to  learn  if  we  do  not  know,  and  refresh  our 
memory  if  we  have  once  known,  something  of  the  mysteries 
of  creation  in  vegetable  life. 


10  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

Thousands  of  years  have  passed  away  since  angel  voices 
sang  the  praises  of  God  when  He  had  finished  the  fair  work 
of  creation,  and — looking  upon  the  lowliest  herb  of  the  field 
as  upon  the  birds  of  the  air,  the  living  creatures  of  the 
deep,  wide  sea,  the  beasts  of  the  earth,  and  man,  the  lord 
of  all — "  behold  it  was  very  good."  Thousands  of  years 
have  passed  away :  man  has  changed,  it  may  be  that  the 
lower  creatures  have  partaken  of  his  fall ;  but  of  the  beau- 
tiful flowers  and  the  stately  trees  we  have  no  reason  to 
believe  that  there  is  aught  in  them  that  offends  their 
Maker;  we  fearlessly  search  into  the  recesses  of  their 
being,  and  behold  they  are  wondrously  beautiful  and  still 
"very  good." 

A  flower-plant  has  been  likened  by  linger,*  a  German 
botanist,  to  "  a  most  skilfully-planned  chemical  laboratory, 
a  most  ingenious  mechanism  for  the  display  of  physical 
forces,  and  one  of  the  simplest,  and  consequently  one  of  the 
most  sublime,  structures  ever  designed  or  executed." 

He  also  likens  the  growth  of  a  plant  to  the  building  of 
a  glorious  edifice ;  he  compares  the  cells  of  vegetable  life, 
in  their  varied  forms  and  sizes,  to  the  stones  of  a  building 
forming  a  kind  of  masonry.  In  some  parts  of  a  plant  the 
cells  are  long,  and  form  pipes  or  cylinders,  or  they  are 
condensed  and  thickened  into  fibre.  In  the  cuticle  of  leaf 
and  flower  we  have  flattened,  oblong,  or  crenellated  cells, 
which,  as  a  tesselated  pavement,  protect  the  more  delicate 
machinery  within. 

We  find,  by  the  help  of  a  microscope,  not  only  this,  but 
also  the  store  chambers  of  cell-contents  where  the  materials 
for  the  plant  edifice  are  collected  and  preserved. 

Again,  in  the  building  of  a  plant  there  are  air-passages 
resembling  regularly-shaped  rooms,  or  romantic  caves,  or 
microscopic  grottos,  terminating  in  what  are  called  stomata; 
which  stornata  have  folding  doors  or  valves  to  open  or  shut 
at  pleasure,  so  that  the  air  circulates  freely  through  the 
plant  organism.  These  are  mostly  on  the  under  side  of  a 
leaf,  so  the  under  cuticle  is  the  one  we  mount  for  observa- 

*  '  Unger's  Letters.' 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  1 1 

tion,  and  we  shall  notice  these  stomata  more  particularly 
when  the  slides  are  described. 

The  origin  of  every  plant  is  a  single  cell.  The  perfection 
of  a  plant,  from  the  tiniest  moss  to  the  loftiest  oak,  is  in  a 
countless  multitude  of  simple  cells  containing  various  sub- 
stances needful  for  its  growth,  and  of  an  infinite  variety  of 
shape  and  substance  :  for  some  cells  are  very  thick  ;  some 
are  dotted,  to  allow  of  the  circulation  of  air  in  the  deep 
recesses  of  the  stem  ;  some  have  variegated  walls  produced 
by  its  secondary  deposits,  like  fibre  coiled  around,  and 
these  fibro-cells  are  abundant  in  some  plants.  We  have 
them  from  the  Oncidium  and  Opuntia.  Some  cells  of 
spiral  fibre  act  as  trachea  for  breathing  organs,  or  give 
lightness  and  elasticity  to  a  stem.  They  are  abundant  in 
strawberry  leaves,  vine  leaves,  rhubarb  stems,  spinach,  and 
there  are  beautiful  examples  in  the  slide  of  spiral  cells  from 
the  balsam.  Much  more  can  be  learnt  from  the  examina- 
tion of  the  fresh  plant,  because  of  the  difficulty  of  preserving 
cells  and  their  contents.  Is  it  not  wonderful  to  think  of  a 
little  plant  having  its  store  chambers  secreting  starch,  sugar, 
gum,  oils,  raphides,  colouring  matter— aye,  and  beautiful 
crystals  floating  in  the  cell-fluid,  or  suspended,  as  are  the 
cystolithes,  in  the  cell-chambers  of  the  nettle  tribe  ? 

The  very  knowledge  that  such  things  are,  and  that  they 
may  be  seen  in  an  infinite  variety,  will  lead  us  first  to  look 
at  these  slides  understandingly,  then  to  seek  further  by 
examination  of  living  plants.  This  will  induce  us  to  study 
such  books  as  Quekett's  *  Histiology,'  '  Carpenter  on  the 
Microscope,'  'Mohl  on  the  Vegetable  Cell/  '  Schacht  on 
the  Microscope,'  '  Unger's  Letters,'  &c.  &c.  Then  we 
shall  see  our  microscope  worthily,  and  our  cabinet  of  objects 
will  cease  to  be  a  mere  toy. 

SHAPES    OF    CELLS. 

As  the  object  of  this  little  book  is  to  excite  and  not  to 
satisfy  the  desire  of  an  inquiring  mind,  let  me  here  suggest 
that  it  is  well  to  prove  all  things  ;  and  before  you  quite 
believe  that  every  flower  and  plant  is  made  up  of  single 
cells  of  varied  form,  examine  for  yourself  thus  : — Take  a 


12  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

flower,  a  few  bits  of  stalk,  a  lily  leaf,  or  small  piece  of 
rhubarb  stalk,  another  of  cucumber,  a  thin  slice  of  raw 
potato,  a  wallflower,  or  a  primrose — any  flower  :  macerate 
it  in  water  for  a  day  or  two,  until  it  begins  to  decompose, 
and  the  smallest  portion  placed  under  the  microscope  with 
a  drop  of  water  will  show  you  the  now  separating  cells  of 
various  shape  :  those  in  stalks  oblong  or  cylindrical ;  those 
in  the  surface  of  petals  and  leaves  square,  or  round,  or 
hexagonal,  or  irregular,  with  zigzag  boundaries,  or  papilli- 
form,  as  in  the  Geranium,  Sweetwilliam,  &c.  ;  those  of  the 
parenchyma  or  pulp  of  the  leaf  generally  oval.  In  looking 
at  these,  you  will  certainly  find  a  variety  of  contents  which 
are  seldom  preserved  for  any  length  of  time,  and  which  you 
must  therefore  observe  in  the  fresh  and  living  plant. 

CELL-CONTENTS. 

In  the  slice  of  potato  you  will  find  every  cell  crowded 
with  starch-granules,  that  is,  if  it  is  a  good  potato  ;  for  starch 
is  to  the  potato  what  fat  is  to  an  animal,  and  if  it  is  in 
"  good  condition  "  tne  cells  should  be  "full  of  it.  The  test 
of  this  is  a  drop  of  tincture  of  iodine,  which  turns  the  starch- 
granules  to  a  beautiful  blue  or  violet  colour  ;  and  a  diseased 
potato  with  empty  cells  will  therefore  be  detected  by  a  drop 
of  that  same  iodine. 

In  the  stem  of  a  lily  you  will  find  starch-grains,  mixed 
with  green  granules  of  chlorophylle,  a  kind  of  vegetable 
wax,  which  gives  the  green  colour  to  leaves. 

All  our  farinaceous  plants  contain  abundance  of  starch, 
especially  wheat,  barley,  oats,  maize,  rice,  arrow-root ;  and 
the  granules  differ  from  each  other  in  size  and  form  so 
decidedly,  that  they  cannot  well  be  mistaken  by  a  careful 
observer.  They  are  prepared  for  the  microscope,  and  sold 
as  polariscope  objects,  because  the  examination  of  a  starch 
granule  with  polarized  light  shows  it  with  a  beautiful  black 
cross,  revolving  with  the  polarizer ;  or,  if  over  a  selenite 
stage,  a  brilliant  play  of  colours  is  obtained. 

Besides  starch-grains  and  chlorophylle,  you  will  find 
something  else  in  the  cells  of  that  lily  stem,  which  I  select 
as  an  easy  one  to  obtain  in  any  garden.  In  some  cells,  not 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  13 

in  all,  you  will  probably  observe  a  larger  granule,  with  a 
lesser  one  within,  or  perhaps  several  lesser  ones  ;  the  large 
granule  is  the  nucleus,  the  minute  inner  ones  the  nucleoli ; 
they  are  the  supposed  origin  of  new  cells,  and  much  that  is 
exceedingly  interesting  has  been  written  in  the  works  before 
referred  to  :  '  Mohl  on  the  Vegetable  Cell ; '  '  Hofmeister's 
Die  Enstehung  des  Embryo.'  These  nuclei  are  to  be 
observed  in  pollen-grains,  in  the  hairs  of  Tradescantia?,  or 
Spidervvort,  especially  in  the  pollen  of  the  fir-tree  tribe. 

OIL  CELLS. 

Cells  containing  oil  are  beautiful  objects  when  found  as 
on  rose-trees,  on  the  stem  of  Saxifrage,  Geraniums,  Col- 
lomia,  Drasena,  raised  upon  delicate  stalks,  often  brightly 
coloured,  or  glittering  diamond-like  in  the  sunshine.*  Some- 
times the  oil  cells  are  sessile,  in  golden  spots  upon  the  back 
of  a  black-currant  leaf ;  or  white  and  silvery  in  the  recesses 
of  a  Sage  leaf,  a  leaf  of  Rue,  or  Hop,  or  Mulberry. 

Sometimes  these  oil  cells  are  internal,  as  in  the  rind  of 
an  orange,  where  they  are  very  large  and  most  easily  ob- 
served; also  in  the  leaves  of  Myrtle  and  Magnolia,  of 
Hypericum,  St.  John's  wort,  so  common  in  woods  and 
hedges :  those  little  dark  dots  are  the  oil  cells,  and  trans- 
parent, if  you  hold  the  leaf  up  against  the  light,  and 
examine  it  with  a  pocket  lens. 

HAIES    OF    PLANTS. 

The  hairs  of  plants  will  furnish  you  with  abundant  ma- 
terial for  study  and  delight  throughout  the  summer  long, 
and  the  variety  in  their  form  will  astonish  you.  Look  at 
the  beautiful  bead-like  hairs  of  the  Spiderwort  —  a  rich 
purple  chain  of  cells  fringing  each  stamen.  White,  trans- 
parent, glittering  rows  of  cells  from  the  flocculent  mass  of 
hairs  we  see  on  the  leaves  and  stem  of  the  common 
Groundsel.  The  common  garden  Verbena  has  the  mouth 
of  its  corolla  closed  by  a  dense  row  of  beaded  hairs  pro- 
tecting its  pistil.  I  cannot  describe  more,  but  look  at  these. 

*  These  are  called  glandular  hairs. 


14  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

Some   are   simple ;    some   are   branched,    or   star-like,  or 
tufted,  and  contain  simply  water  :— 


Alyssum  leaf 
Draba  verna  leaf. 
Antirrhinum  calyx. 
Tradescantia  stamen. 
Verbena. 
Campanula. 
Nettle. 
Borage. 


Chrysophyllum. 


Yerbascum. 

Ivy. 

Hibiscus. 

Deutzia  scabra. 

Elseagnus. 

Dolichos  (cowage). 

Groundsel. 


Take  the  hair  of  a  Borage  stem  or  flower  off  at  the  base, 
and  lay  it  on  a  slide  with  a  drop  of  water  covered  with  a 
bit  of  thin  glass,  and  you  will  be  delighted.  The  hair  of 
the  Nettle,  with  its  poison  gland  at  the  base,  must  be  ex- 
amined in  the  same  way.  The  pain  is  caused  by  the 
breaking  off  of  its  point,  and  the  acrid  irritating  liquid 
springing  up  into  the  wound. 

The  reason  why  these  hairs  are  mentioned  immediately 
after  the  cells  and  cell-contents  is,  because  they  are  only 
prolonged  and  varied  cells  rising  from  the  cuticle,  and  when 
the  cell-walls  thicken  into  fibre  these  hairs  become  thorns. 
Sometimes  they  expand  and  form  scales,  as  we  see  on  the 
beautiful  leaves  of  Hippophse  and  Elseagnus,  which  are 
mounted  as  detached  scales  for  the  polariscope,  or  in  situ  as 
opaque  objects. 

CUTICLE    AND    STOMATA. 

The  cuticle  of  plants  is  that  transparent  skin  which  we 
can  easily  peel  off  from  various  leaves,  but  especially  from 
the  Lily,  the  Candytuft,  Iris,  and  the  petals  of  flowers ;  and 
prove  by  examination  under  a  piece  of  thin  glass  and  with 
a  drop  of  water  that  it  is  really  composed  of  a  single  layer 
of  cells,  having  pores,  called  stomata,  thickly  scattered 
over  it. 

These  slides  are  very  useful  to  those  persons  who  live 
in  cities,  or  who  have  not  yet  studied  plant-life  for  them- 
selves ;  and  I  doubt  not  that  they  will  lead  many  a  careless 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  15 

eye  to  look  for  other  examples,  and  to  find  an  endless 
variety  in  the  garden  and  the  field. 

These  pores,  called  stomata,  are  absolutely  necessary  to 
vegetable  life.  Leaves  are  the  organs  of  respiration — the 
lungs  of  a  tree,  and  the  stomach  also  ;  for  they  send  back 
nutrition  to  the  trunk  and  stem,  take  up  the  sap  which 
rises  from  the  root,  give  it  the  needful  quantity  of  carbon, 
expose  it  to  the  action  of  the  air,  and  cause  the  super- 
abundant moisture  to  evaporate.  All  this  is  done  by  the 
agency  of  the  little  dots  we  call  stomata.  And  this  is  the 
way  in  which  they  act : — We  see  that  the  cuticle  is  formed 
of  a  single  layer  of  cells  ;  these  contain  air  and  not  fluid, 
as  do  the  cells  of  the  pulp  or  parenchyma ;  also  they  are 
so  closely  fitted  to  each  other  as  to  confine  that  moisture 
which  otherwise  would  be  too  quickly  evaporated  by  a  hot 
sun,  and  the  leaf  soon  dried  up  and  withered  ;  but  at  the 
same  time,  as  air  is  necessary  to  the  inner  cells  of  a  leaf 
or  flower,  these  stomata,  or  openings,  are  placed  in  great 
numbers  in  the  cuticle,  acting  like  valves,  which  admit  air 
freely,  give  out  surplus  fluid,  and  take  in  atmospheric 
moisture  when  required.  They  are  bordered  by  cells  of 
peculiar  form,  usually  kidney-shaped,  with  an  oval  aperture 
in  the  centre ;  and  these  "  guard  cells  "  dilate  and  con- 
tract, closing  or  opening  the  passage  according  to  the  ne- 
cessities of  the  plant.  On  a  hot  day  they  will  close,  to 
defend  the  inner  cells  from  exhausting  heat :  in  dry 
weather,  when  the  stem  does  not  give  enough  fluid  for  the 
nourishment  of  the  leaves,  then  the  stomata  open  at  night 
and  drink  in  the  night-dew,  but  close  again  as  soon  as  the 
cavities  of  the  leaf  are  full.  The  number  of  pores  in  a 
square  inch  of  surface  is  amazing;  e.g.  we  find  that  a 
square  inch  of  the  leaf  of 

Hydrangea  contains  .  .  160,000  under  surface 

Iris  „  .  .     12,000  both  surfaces 

Houseleek         „  .  .     10,710  upper  surface 

Tradescantia      ,,  .  .       2,000  upper  surface 

Lilac  „       '  r  .   160,000  under  surface 

Vine  „  .  .     13,000  under  surface 


Iti  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

The  stomata  are  generally  largest  upon  succulent  plants, 
and  abound  on  the  under  side  of  all  leaves  except  grasses 
and  upright  leaves,  such  as  the  Iris  and  Tradescantia,  where 
they  are  found  equally  on  both  sides. 

CUTICLE    OF   YUCCA. 

In  the  cuticle  of  Yucca  the  stomata  are  bounded  by  four 
cells,  and  are  themselves  somewhat  quadrangular  :  there  are 
about  40,000  of  them  in  one  square  inch.  The  plant  is  a 
native  of  Peru  ;  called  also  common  Adam's  needle,  bearing 
a  handsome  flower  in  panicles  on  a  stem  eight  or  ten  feet 
high  when  in  its  native  soil ;  but  in  British  gardens  it 
scarcely  reaches  three  feet  high. 

CUTICLE    OF    ALOE. 

The  cells  are  somewhat  different  in  shape,  though  the 
stomata  are  also  bordered  by  four  cells :  they  are  more 
oblong,  very  prettily  disposed,  but  require  a  power  of  200 
diameters  to  observe  properly.  First  use  the  J-inch,  and 
then  the  J-inch. 

CUTICLE    OF    DEUTZIA    SCABEA. 

This  is  a  polariscope  object. 

The  cuticle  is  siliceous  (see  Indian  Corn),  and  the  wavy 
outlines  of  the  cells  and  the  starry  clusters  of  siliceous 
hairs  are  very  beautiful.  When  gathered  from  the  tree, 
these  stars  are  white  upon  the  green  cuticle,  and  those  of 
the  upper  surface  are  many-rayed,  whereas  those  of  the 
lower  surface  have  usually  but  four  or  five  rays. 

This  leads  us  to  consider  the  use  of  those  abundant  hairs 
which  clothe  the  living  plant.  They  serve  two  purposes — 
for  warmth  to  the  tender  bud,  or  for  attracting  moisture. 
On  many  plants  they  rise  up  towards  evening  and  catch 
the  falling  dew  ;  then  bending  downwards  at  noontide  they 
form  a  close  layer  over  the  cuticle,  and  give  it  a  protecting 
shade,  at  the  same  time  preventing  a  too  rapid  evaporation 
of  the  moisture  they  had  attracted.  There  are  many 
kinds  of  hairs  on  plants ;  most  beautiful  are  some  of  them, 
especially  those  which  secrete  oils  or  saccharine  matter. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  17 

These  are  called  glandular  hairs ;  they  rise  up  on  a  slender 
stem,  and  expand  into  a  globular  head,  filled  with  coloured 
or  white  special  secretions,  such  as  we  find  on  Sweet-briar 
and  Moss-rose  buds,  or  on  the  leaves  and  flowers  of 
Collomia. 

CUTICLE    OF   AMARYLLIS. 

This  example  will  show  the  two-lobed  stomata,  one 
kidney-shaped  cell  on  each  side  ;  it  is  from  any  part  of  leaf 
or  stem  of  the  common  white  Lily ;  also  compare  the  cells 
with  those  of  the 

CUTICLE    OF    INDIAN   CORN. 

This  is  what  is  called  a  siliceous  cuticle.  All  the  grass 
tribe  and  the  plants  called  Equisetacese,  or  horse-tails,  have 
the  property  of  attracting  silex  or  flint  from  the  soil  in 
which  they  grow  :  the  cell  walls  and  stomata  become  so 
impregnated  with  it,  that  even  soaking  in  nitric  acid,  which 
destroys  the  vegetable  part,  leaves  the  skeleton,  or  frame- 
work, perfect,  as  in  this  slide,  which  has  been  thus  pre- 
pared. Observe  the  finely-toothed  edge  of  each  cell,  as 
well  as  the  peculiar  shape  of  the  four  cells  bordering  the 
pores.  The  stomata  are  very  abundant  in  grasses ;  they 
cover  every  part  of  the  stem,  and  both  sides  of  the  leaves. 

CUTICLE    OF    SACCALOBIUM. 

The  Saccalobium  is  one  of  the  orchis  tribe,  a  native  of 
Asia,  found  in  the  Indian  Archipelago,  and  is  cultivated 
in  hot-houses  in  England.  The  spiral  fibre  in  some  of  its 
cells  forms  a  regular  network  on  the  inner  surface. 

CUTICLE   OF   EL^AGNUS. 

This  is  an  opaque  object ;  the  scales  are  very  beautiful, 
and  when  detached  from  the  leaf  and  mounted  in  balsam 
they  polarize. 

The  Elseagnus  is  a  native  of  all  parts  of  the  world,  from 
the  northern  hemisphere  down  to  the  equator,  which  it 
rarely  passes.  The  flowers  of  this  species  are  highly 
fragrant,  and  abound  in  honey. 


18  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

CUTICLE    OF   TILLANDSIA. 

The  under  side  of  the  leaves  and  the  stem  of  this  plant 
are  adorned  with  delicate  scales,  as  of  the  finest  network. 

The  plant  itself  is  a  native  of  South  America  and  the 
West  Indies.  The  whole  tribe  dislike  water ;  and  Lin- 
nseus  named  the  genus  from  a  professor  in  Sweden,  who, 
having  once  experienced  a  very  rough  passage  from 
Stockholm  to  Abo,  determined  never  again  to  cross  the 
water ;  he  even  changed  his  own  name  to  that  of  "  Til- 
lands,"  which  means  on  or  by  land  ;  and  actually,  when 
obliged  to  return  to  Stockholm,  preferred  travelling  ^00 
miles  round  by  Lapland  to  going  a  direct  road  of  eight 
miles  by  sea. 

One  species  of  Tillandsia  (utriculata)  which  grows  upon 
old  and  decaying  trees  in  the  forest  of  Jamaica,  has  leaves 
a  yard  long,  inflated  at  the  base,  which  form  a  reservoir  for 
water.  Each  leaf  holds  about  a  quart  of  fluid,  and  wild 
cattle  seek  refreshment  there.  Travellers  also,  under  the 
hottest  sun,  may  turn  aside  and  find  a  sweet  pool  of  water 
in  dry  seasons,  when  all  other  supplies  have  failed. 

CUTICLE    OF  ONOSMA. 

The  Onosma  is  a  native  of  Tauria,  near  the  Bosphorus. 
The  plant  is  small,  with  handsome  flowers,  flourishing  in 
sandy  soil ;  and  this  cuticle  is  very  beautiful  under  polarized 
light, 

CUTICLE    OF    OPUNTIA. 

This  beautiful  cuticle  is  from  the  leaf  of  the  Opuntia,  a 
kind  of  Cactus  or  Indian  fig,  and  on  one  of  them  the 
cochineal  insect  is  found :  this  is  from  the  Opuntia  vulgaris, 
which  bears  a  large  purple  juicy  fruit,  and  is  a  spiny 
shrub,  growing  abundantly  on  Mount  Etna  amidst  its 
lava.  It  is,  however,  a  native  of  South  America,  and  the 
way  in  which  it  has  been  naturalised  and  made  most  useful 
in  Sicily  is  remarkable.  As  soon  as  a  little  fissure  is  per- 
ceived in  the  lava,  a  small  branch  or  joint  of  Opuntia  is 
stuck  in ;  the  latter  pushes  out  roots,  which  are  nourished 
by  the  rain  which  collects  round  them,  or  by  whatever  dust 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  19 

or  remains  of  organic  matter  may  have  made  a  little  soil. 
These  roots  spread  out  and  ramify  into  the  most  minute 
crevices,  breaking  up  the  lava  into  small  fragments,  and 
finally  rendering  it  fit  for  culture. 

LITHOSPERMUM. 

From  lithos,  a  stone,  sperma,  a  seed. 

The  hardy  stony  seeds  have  given  it  this  name,  as  well 
as  the  old  English  appellative  Gromwell,  from  the  Celtic 
grom,  a  seed,  and  mil,  a  stone. 

The  leaf  of  this  common  plant  is  extremely  beautiful ; 
the  hairs  are  not  only  bulbous  as  in  borage,  but  cells  are 

frouped  around  the  base  of  each  like  a  circlet  of  crystals, 
here  are  three  species  worth  seeking : 

The  common  white  L.  arvense,  in  cornfields. 

L.  officinalis,  pale  yellow. 

L.  purpurea,  large  blue  flowers  in  chalky  soil. 

RAPHIDES. 

These  are  crystals  found  in  the  cells  of  various  plants. 
No  better  example  can  we  have  than  the 

CUTICLE    OF    HYACINTH, 

in  every  cell  of  which  we  see  a  cylindrical  crystal.  Exa- 
mined with  polarized  light  they  are  most  distinctly  seen, 
and  enable  us  to  understand  the  position  of  raphides  in 
other  plants.  The  Cactus,  the  common  Dock,  and  various 
other  vegetables,  have  bundles  of  needle7shaped  crystals 
in  their  cells.  Turkey  Rhubarb  and  the  garden  Rhubarb 
have  rectangular  prisms  of  carbonate  of  lime  grouped  in  a 
stellate  form.  See  the  slide  of 

RAPHIDES    FROM    RHUBARB. 

What  their  use  is  we  do  not  know.  Another  kind  called 
cystolithes,  are  stalked  and  suspended  in  the  cells  of  the 
nettle  tribe.  Their  formation  has  been  watched  :  first  a 
little  papilla  or  swelling  is  perceived  at  the  upper  part  of  a 
cell,  which  increases  at  the  end  into  a  clubbed  form,  from 
which  crystals  of  oxalate  of  lime  sprout  forth. 


20  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

This  is  one  of  the  mysteries  of  creation,  how  the  cells  of 
a  plant  so  regularly  secrete  each  its  appointed  store  of  need- 
ful substance  for  the  plant-life — how  from  the  earth  in 
which  it  grows,  from  the  air  in  which  it  lives,  from  the  light 
which  quickens  it,  each  tiny  chamber  receives  exactly  that 
portion  of  nourishment,  and  that  kind  of  nourishment 
which  enables  it  to  produce  either  the  green  wax  which 
colours  the  leaf,  or  the  white  starch-grains,  or  the  gum,  the 
sugar,  the  oil,  or  the  shining  crystals,  or  that  nucleus  which 
is  the  reproductive  cell — all  this  going  on  invisibly  around 
us  in  every  living  plant,  and  having  been  thus  going  on  for 
five  thousand  years  at  least,  unseen,  unknown  by  us,  until 
the  revelations  of  the  microscope.  Is  there  no  deep  thought 
stirred  in  our  hearts  by  the  manifest  order  and  minute 
care  of  Him  who  built  up  this  living  temple  for  His  own 
pleasure  and  for  ours  ?  Do  we  think  of  all  that  is  contained 
in  the  flower  we  gather  by  the  way-side,  in  the  herb  that 
bends  beneath  our  feet  ?  Is  no  desire  kindled  to  see  these 
things  as  they  are,  and  pass  on  from  these  slides  to  the 
examination  of  the  plant  itself?  There  are  a  thousand 
things  more  beautiful  than  raphides  that  cannot  thus  be 
mounted  or  preserved.  Shall  I  give  one  example  only  for 
a  summer  hour's  delight  ? 

ANAGALLIS. 

In  the  garden  or  the  cornfield  gather  a  little  scarlet 
Pimpernel,  the  Anagallis,  or  the  Poor  Man's  Weather- 
glass, that  lowly  and  bright  little  flower  which  opens  every 
morning  at  eight  minutes  past  seven,  and  closes  about  three 
minutes  past  two  in  the  afternoon.  Examine  it  with  a 
pocket-lens,  and  you  will  see  that  it  belongs  to  the  Primrose 
tribe,  with  its  single-leaved  calyx  and  corolla,  wheel-shaped, 
deeply  cleft  into  fine  segments,  fine  slender  filaments  and 
heart-shaped  anthers,  one-thread-shaped  and  clubbed 
stigma.  With  the  same  lens  you  can  examine  the  seed- 
vessel,  a  little  globular  capsule  opening  all  round,  and, 
raising  the  lid,  observe  the  most  beautiful  dotted  seeds 
lying  closely  pressed  to  the  pitted  receptacle  ;  and  this,  if 
once  seen,  will  not  be  forgotten.  Take  it  now  to  the  mi- 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  21 

croscope,  and,  with  a  low  power,  first  look  at  one  of  the 
coloured  segments  of  the  corolla.  Press  it  lightly  in  a 
drop  of  water  under'  a  bit  of  glass,  and  you  will  then  see 
that  the  edge  of  the  petal  is  fringed  with  little  bell-like 
glands,  purple  and  white,  and  that  hues  of  deeper  colour 
radiate  from  the  base  of  the  petal.  Put  on  a  higher  power, 
and  you  will  find  these  are  exquisite  spiral  vessels  ;  not  one 
only,  but  many  in  each  line,  short,  and  joined  to  each  other 
by  a  delicate  dove-tailing  process.  Think  of  the  mechanism 
in  that  one  small  leaf,  and  those  little  oil  cells  fringing  it 
so  prettily,  doubtless  for  use  as  well  as  beauty.  Then  take 
off  one  stamen  and  look  at  it  in  the  same  way.  Half  way 
up  the  slender  white  stem  are  purple  hairs,  each  jointed 
and  like  a  row  of  tiny  amethysts  :  above  is  the  heart- 
shaped  anther,  with  its  golden  store  of  pollen  grains,  out 
of  each  of  which  will  flow  the  life-giving  germ  to  the  future 
seed.  Take  the  style  and  stigma,  and  examine  them  next ; 
you  will  not  soon  be  weary  of  the  sight.  Most  likely  you 
will  find  some  pollen  grains  upon  the  stigma  throwing 
down  their  tubes  invisibly  ;  for  this  is  only  seen  with  a 
high  power,  and  by  making  a  very  thin  section  of  a  short 
style,  such  as  that  of  a  Cistus,  or  a  Chickweed. 

After  such  an  examination,  that  little  flower  will  never 
be  seen  with  the  same  careless  eye  which  for  years  had 
passed  it  by  unheeded,  because  unconscious  of  its  beauty. 

SPIKAL    FIBRE. 

Many  specimens  of  these  are  sold  prepared  for  the 
microscope,  especially  the  following  : — 


Spiral  cells  of  Oncidium. 
Spiral  vessels  of  Collomia. 
Spiral  fibre  from  Balsam. 


Spiral  cells  of  Sphagnum. 
Scalariform  vessels. 


They  require  some  little  explanation.  We  have  already 
seen,  in  the  examination  of  cuticles  and  flower-stems,  that 
plants  are  made  up  of  cells  containing  various  substances, 
as  starch,  crystals,  oil,  or  wax.  These  were  for  the  nourish- 
ment of  the  plant ;  but  here  are  cells  which  are  supposed 


22  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

to  assist  in  the  circulation  of  air  and  moisture  throughout 
the  system.  Some  of  them  strikingly  resemble  the  trachea 
of  insects,  and  seem  to  communicate  with  the  stomata  as 
the  trachea  do  with  the  spiracles. 

SPIEAL    CELLS    OF    ONCIDIUM. 

These  beautiful  little  cells  are  obtained  by  macerating  the 
pulp  of  those  leaves  which  contain  them,  separating  them 
with  a  fine  sable  brush,  or  mounted  needle.  The  Oncidium 
is  an  orchis,  a  native  of  Peru,  Mexico,  and  the  West  In- 
dian Islands  ;  cultivated  in  hot-houses  in  England.  They 
are  curious  and  beautiful  plants,  with  spotted  yellow  or 
purple  and  white  flowers,  one  species  much  resembling  a 
gorgeous  butterfly.  In  all  these  plants  the  spiral  cells 
abound  immediately  under  the  cuticle,  and,  viewed  with 
polarized  light,  they  resemble  coils  of  coloured  wire. 

SPIRAL   VESSELS   OF   COLLOMIA. 

These  fibre-cells  are  in  the  cuticle  of  the  seed,  and  the 
examination  of  them  is  so  easily  made,  that  it  is  well  worth 
doing.  The  cells  which  contain  the  fibre  are  in  this  in- 
stance so  delicate,  that  a  drop  of  water  causes  them  to 
break,  and  the  coil  unrolls,  shooting  forth  in  long  tubes, 
with  an  appearance  of  life  as  they  spring  across  the  field  of 
sight.  To  see  this,  take  a  seed  of  Collomia,  and  cutting  off 
a  very  small  piece  of  its  skin,  place  it  with  a  drop  of  water 
on  a  slide  under  the  thin  glass,  when  you  will  perceive  the 
fibre  uncoiling  in  all  directions.  The  Collomia  is  a  native 
of  America,  but  naturalised  in  our  gardens,  where  it  grows 
like  a  weed,  having  pretty  buff  or  pink-coloured  flowers, 
covered  with  glandular  hairs. 

SPIRAL   CELLS   OF   BALSAM. 

These  are  from  the  common  Balsam  of  our  garden,  and 
show  the  bundles  of  long  cells  made  up  of  spiral  fibre, 
which  often  break  and  pass  into  annular  fibre :  you  may 
perceive  some  of  these  in  detached  rings.  These  cells  con- 
tain air,  and  are  those  which  most  resemble  the  trachea  of 
insects.  Those  of  the  Leek  are  also  very  remarkable,  and 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  23 

the  common  garden  Rhubarb  will  furnish  you  with  abun- 
dant specimens.  Take  a  little  boiled  Rhubarb,  and  pick  it 
to  pieces  with  a  mounted  needle  in  a  little  water,  when 
bundles  of  spiral  vessels  will  be  easily  found. 

SPIRAL   CELLS   OF   SPHAGNUM. 

Sphagnum  is  a  moss  growing  in  marshy  places,  and  its 
leaf  shows  a  beautiful  arrangement  of  spiral  fibres  in  its 
large  oval  cells,  whilst  in  the  smaller  ones  you  will  see  the 
granules  of  chlorophylle  which  colour  the  leaf. 

SCALARIFORM   VESSELS, 

so  called  because  they  resemble  the  steps  of  a  ladder,  are 
peculiar  to  ferns  and  to  asparagus.  They  are  secondary 
deposits  on  the  cell  wall,  and  somewhat  of  the  nature  of 
spiral  fibre.  Under  polarized  light  they  are  very  beautiful. 
When  you  pull  up  a  common  Bracken  or  Fern,  and  cut 
the  root  across,  the  brown  figure  you  see,  called  King 
Charles  in  the  Oak,  is  made  up  of  these  scalariform  vessels. 
They  are  very  troublesome  to  prepare,  but  this  is  the  easiest 
way  tnat  I  know  of:— Cut  up  the  root  and  boil  it  until 
tender  enough  to  peel ;  put  the  centre  part  into  a  jam- 
pot with  water  and  a  little  nitric  acid;  let  it  stand  in 
boiling  water  for  some  hours,  then  pick  the  long  white 
fibres  carefully  out,  wash  them  in  boiling  water  over  and 
over  again  until  perfectly  clean  arid  clear,  which  is  only 
ascertained  by  examination  under  the  microscope,  then 
mount  them  in  fluid  or  balsam.  If  in  balsam,  dry  them 
well  first. 


POLLEN. 

POLLEN  OF  MALLOW. 

A  beautiful  object  viewed  as  an  opaque — more  lovely  far 
when  taken  fresh  from  the  flower,  and  looked  at  upon  one 


24  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

of  its  own  crimson  leaves,  or  the  petal  of  a  Geranium.  It 
cannot  be  worthily  described :  rest  not  until  you  have  seen 
it ;  and  also  the 

POLLEN    OF    HOLLYHOCK, 

which  is  like  it,  only  the  golden  grains  are  larger,  and  per- 
haps more  easily  preserved.  I  usually  take  a  portion  of 
the  stamen,  studded  with  the  spiked  globular  grains,  and 
dry  them  on  a  scarlet  petal  of  the  flower  ;  but  they  are 
well  seen  on  a  black  ground,  simply  mounted,  when  dry, 
between  two  pieces  of  glass. 

POLLEN    OF    PASSION-FLOWER. 

-  These  are  not  spiked,  but  have  three  plain  valves  and  a 
reticulated  cuticle. 

POLLEN    OF   (ENOTHERA 

is  curiously  triangular,  with  pores  at  each  corner,  from  one 
or  more  of  which  the  pollen  tubes  spring  forth. 

Pollen  is  always  better  observed  fresh  from  the  plant. 
The  variety  in  shape  and  structure  is  very  great ;  the  in- 
terest will  be  unfailing  in  the  examination  of  it,  the  deeper 
we  go  into  the  mysteries  of  plant-life.  % 

This  golden  dust,  which,  to  the  unassisted  eye,  is  all 
alike  in  every  flower,  is  fashioned  with  the  most  elaborate 
care  for  its  great  purpose,  and  sculptured  with  that  exqui- 
site finish  which  all  creation  bears  as  the  signature  of  the 
gracious  God  who  made  all  things  well. 

This  golden  dust,  contained  by  every  flower  in  the  few 
or  many  stamens  which  are  the  caskets  of  its  wealth,  is  the 
fructifying  principle  which  causes  the  seed  to  become 
fruitful,  and  without  which  no  reproduction  of  a  plant 
could  continue,  as  it  does,  from  age  to  age. 

The  purpose  of  this  book  being  chiefly  to  explain  the 
objects  before  us,  I  will  not  say  more  of  the  pollen-grain 
than  that  it  must  be  examined  both  as  a  transparent  object, 
with  a  drop  of  water  or  oil  of  lemon,  and  dry,  as  an  opaque. 
Particularly  observe  the  blue  pollen  of  Epilobium  ;  the  red 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  25 

pollen  of  Verbaseum ;  the  black  pollen  of  the  Tulip  ;  the 
varied  forms  in  the  following  flowers  :— 


Cucumber 

Crocus 

Cactus 

Cruciferse  (order) 

Collomia 

Campanula 

Cobsea  Scaudens 

Composite  (order) 

Geranium 

Heath 


Daisy    (one    of   the    Com- 

positse) 
London  Pride 
Saxifrage 
Violet 
(Enothera 
Passion-flower 
Lupin 
Acacia 


A   FEW   WORDS   MORE   OX    THE   POLLEN. 

As  I  lay  aside  these  slides,  and  desire  you  to  seek  for 
varieties  of  pollen  in  the  fresh  sweet  flowers  around,  the 
thought  arises  that  some  who  read  thus  far  may  wish  to 
know  a  little  more  of  the  structure  of  the  flower  they 
gather,  and  the  pollen  they  examine ;  else  the  microscope 
lesson  loses  half  its  value,  and  the  student  more  than  half 
his  pleasure.  If  it  is  possible,  read  some  better  book — 
Lindley's  works,  or  Balfour's  '  Botany/  where  all  is  told, 
and  illustrated  by  plates ;  but  if  you  cannot  do  this,  then 
gather  a  flower  and  examine  it  thus  :  a  Chickweed  will  be 
easily  obtained,  and  is  the  best  for  a  microscope  lesson. 

The  organs  of  generation  in  flowers  are  the  stamens  and 
the  pistil :  the  stamens  varying  in  number  from  two  to 
upwards  of  twenty;  and  the  pistil,  which  occupies  the 
centre  of  the  flower,  having  from  one  to  many  styles,  the 
upper  part  of  which  is  called  the  stigma.  The  base  of 
the  pistil,  which  is  swollen  and  round,  is  the  ovary.  Cut  it 
open  with  a  penknife  or  lancet,  and  you  will  see  tiny  white 
cells  on  either  side,  which  are  the  rudiments  or  beginning 
of  the  future  seed.  The  pollen  fructifies  each  seed  whilst 
growing  in  the  ovary,  and  the  way  in  which  it  is  accom- 
plished has  only  of  late  years  been  discovered. 

The  stamens  are  filaments  bearing  at  the  top  single  or 
double  caskets,  called  anthers,  full  of  pollen-grains.  When 

2 


26  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

a  flower  first  opens  the  anthers  are  closed  all  round ;  but  as 
soon  as  the  air  and  the  light  have  perfected  the  pistil  and 
caused  it  to  secrete  a  kind  of  gum,  or  viscid  liquid,  on  the 
surface  of  its  stigma,  intended  to  hold  fast  the  pollen-grain, 
the  anthers  open  and  the  golden  dust  appears,  falling  on 
the  ready  channel,  which  conveys  it  to  the  ovary  beneath. 
The  pollen-grain  itself  is  not  a  simple  cell,  as  we  might  at 
first  suppose  :  minute  as  it  is  there  are  many  cells  therein, 
and  a  subtle  fluid,  called  fovilla,  which  is  in  reality  the  life- 
giving  principle  to  the  ovule.  When  a  pollen-grain  falls 
upon  the  stigma  it  presently  opens  one  of  its  pores,  and 
sends  forth  a  tube  more  or  less  long,  which  descends 
through  the  tissues  of  the  style,  enters  the  ovary,  reaches 
a  tiny  ovule,  and  pours  it  into  the  fovilla,  which  fovilla 
forms  the  embryo  or  future  plant  that  is  preserved  and 
nourished  in  the  seed. 

Take  a  little  pollen  from  a  Cucumber  plant  or  Passion- 
flower, and  when  it  is  fairly  under  the  microscope,  covered 
with  thin  glass,  let  a  drop  of  water  run  in.  The  moisture 
is  absorbed  by  the  pollen-grain,  and  it  throws  out  a  tube 
and  discharges  the  fovilla.  It  goes  off  like  a  little  cannon, 
a  cloud  of  fovilla  waving  on  the  slide. 

The  quantity  of  pollen  in  a  flower  is  astonishing.  A 
flower  of  the  Peony,  for  instance,  has  about  174  stamina, 
each  containing  21,000  granules,— total,  3,654,000  pollen- 
grains.  A  single  Dandelion  has  243,000  pollen-grains. 
The  contents  of  one  anther  are  quite  sufficient  for  the  fruc- 
tification of  all  the  ovules  ;  but  the  superabundance  is  not 
wasted,  for  thousands  of  insects  live  on  the  golden  store, 
and  the  busy  bee  fills  her  baskets  hourly  with  these  pretty 
cakes  for  her  nurslings. 

POLLEN-TUBES. 

To  see  the  actual  pollen-tubes  in  their  passage  down  the 
style  is  a  more  difficult  matter ;  nevertheless,  with  care  and 
a  good  glass  it  may  be  managed.  Put  on  the  J-inch  and 
choose  a  flower  with  a  very  stout  style, — a  Cistus  or  this 
Chickweed  ;  the  flower  must  have  just  faded,  then  you  may 
be  sure  .the  ovules  are  fructified.  With  a  sharp  razor  make 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  27 

a  very  thin  section  of  the  pistil,  and  lift  it  with  a  fine  sable 
brush  on  to  a  slide  in  a  drop  of  water,  and  cover  as  usual 
with  thin  glass ;  focus  carefully,  have  good  light,  and  you 
will  see  the  pollen-tubes  actually  descending  the  tissue  of 
the  style. 

Now  we  are  considering  a  great  mystery.  We  see  how 
varied  are  the  lengths  of  styles  and  pistils,  yet  shorter  or 
longer  the  pollen-tube  stops  not  until  it  reaches  the  ovary, 
and  when  there,  amidst  the  many  rows  of  ovules,  in  many 
positions,  it  has  to  seek  the  one  spot  in  each  ovule  by 
which  alone  it  can  enter,  and  there,  and  there  only,  it  rests. 
Perhaps  all  but  one  have  been  fertilised,  and  are  closed — it 
seeks  that  one  and  perfects  the  work.  Thus  we  see  the 
all-directing,  all-sustaining,  life-giving  power  of  the  Omni- 
present one  ;  we  see  His  presence  in  the  tiniest  flower.  He 
alone  knoweth  how  this  may  be, — we  only  see  that  it  is  so  ; 
and  reverently  let  us  ever  search  into  the  mysteries  of  crea- 
tion, and  find  new  and  deep  delight  in  these  revelations  of 
His  secret  order,  wisdom,  and  care  for  the  preservation 
even  of  the  flower  of  the  field. 

STAMENS. 

The  shapes  of  stamens  are  also  to  be  noticed.  Some 
open  lengthwise,  some  across ;  some  have  valves  like  fold- 
ing doors,  flying  upward,  as  in  the  laurel  tribe.  The 
anthers  of  the  barberry  are  on  jointed  filaments,  which  are 
exceedingly  irritable,  and,  if  touched  by  the  smallest  insect, 
spring  up  and  scatter  the  pollen  on  the  pistil. 

Euphorbia,  or  spurge, — a  common  weed  in  every  garden, 
—has  a  pistil  which  hangs  outward  and  downward,  appa- 
rently out  of  reach  of  the  pollen.  The  anthers  rise  up  and 
shoot  it  out  like  little  guns,  one  after  the  other,  at  the 
stigma  of  the  flower. 

Nettles  also  have  beautiful  elastic  filaments  for  scattering 
the  pollen  on  the  pistil,  which  is  in  a  separate  flower. 
Many  plants  have  these  organs  thus  separated,  but  pro- 
vision is  ever  made  for  their  union,  as  in  the  case  of  our 
cucumbers,  where  bees  and  flies  carry  the  pollen  from  one 
flower  to  the  other. 


28  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

SEEDS. 

Having  said  a  little  on  the  beginning  of  the  seed  in  the 
ovary,  we  shall  be  prepared  to  look  at  the  seeds  themselves 
with  greater  interest.  Here  also  we  have  an  endless  variety 
of  beautiful  microscopic  objects  : — 

POPPY  SEEDS, 
viewed  as  opaque  objects,  show  a  reticulated  surface  ; 

SWEET-WILLIAM  SEEDS, 

oblong  and  dotted ; 

SILEKE,  OR  STELLARIA, 

beautifully  fretted  and  sculptured — 


Foxglove 

St.  John's  Wort 

Saxifrage 

Geranium 

Anagallis 


Portulaca 

Passion-flower 

Begonia 

Scropularia 

Hyoscyamus. 


Look  at  all  these  ;  and,  above  all,  get  a  prepared  slide 
of  the  exquisite 

ORCHIS  SEEDS. 

They  are  like  little  net-purses,  with  the  seed  in  them  :  the 
loose  net  is  the  skin  or  cuticle  of  the  seed. 

ECCREMOCARPUS   OR   CALAMPELIS   SEED. 

This  winged  seed  is  a  splendid  object  for  the  polariscope. 
The  Eccremocarpus,  a  beautiful  creeper,  with  large  bright- 
coloured,  trumpet-shaped  flowers,  is  a  native  of  the  tropics. 

SEED  OF  CENTAUREA  CYANUS. 

The  section  of  the  seed  of  this  plant  is  an  excellent  object 
for  the  binocular.  It  is  common  in  corn-fields,  with  small 
purple  florets  of  the  disk,  and  large  bright-blue  florets  of 
the  ray.  Named  from  the  centaur  Chiron,  who  was  said 
to  have  cured  himself  of  a  wound  in  the  foot  with  the  leaves 
of  this  plant. 


Seed-vessels  of  Ferns,  and  Section  of  Limestone. 


Plate  3. 


10 


I.  Seed-vessel  ot  Fern  when  unripe,  magnified  60  diameters.         2.  Seed-vessel  of  Fern,  at  the 
moment  when  the  ring  straightens  itself.      *.  Leaflet  of  black  Maidenhair  Spleenwort  Fern. 

4.  Two  sori,  or  collections  of  seed-vessels,  of  Spleenwort  Fern,  magd.  12  diams.        5.  Sorus  of 

Huit's-tongue  Fern,  magd.  6  diams.        6.  Part  of  a  leaflet  of  Shield  Fern. 

7.  Sorns,  magd.  10  diams.        8.  Sori  of  Polypody  Fern,  magd.  7  diams.        9.  Sori  and  part  of 

leaflet  of  Hare's-foot  Fern,  magd.  5  diams.'     10"  Thin  section  of  Limestone,  magd.  20  diams. 

II.  Group  of  twenty  seed-vessels,  natural  size.     1:'.  Group  of  twenty  seed-vessels,  magd.  6  diams. 

13.  Leaflet  of  Polypody.  14.  Part  ol  a  leaflet  ol  Haie's-foot  Fern. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  29 


CHAPTER  II. 

SECTIONS  OF  WOOD. 

THE  use  of  these  sections  is  to  show  the  structure  of  the 
stem  of  plants,  and  the  difference  between  the  two  great 
divisions  of  the  vegetable  world  into  endogens  and  exogens. 
An  endogen  is  a  plant  which  has  long  straight-veined  leaves 
like  a  Palm,  a  Cane,  a  Lily,  Iris,  Daffodil,  and  all  the 
grasses.  The  flowers  are  usually  divided  into  three,  or  a 
multiple  of  three ;  the  embryo  has  only  one  seed-lobe,  or 
cotyledon,  and  the  stem  is  like  the  section  of 

RUSCUS, 

or  Butcher's-broom,  a  common  shrub  in  waste  and  watery 
places,  with  very  rigid  dark-green  leaves,  tipped  by  a  sharp 
spine  :  it  blossoms  in  April,  but  is  chiefly  admired  for  its 
large  scarlet  autumn  berries,  one  in  the  axil  of  each  leaf. 
This  pretty  section — apparently  a  fine  lace-pattern — shows 
the  structure  of  an  endogenous  tree;  it  grows  from  within, 
and  is  composed  of  a  dense  mass  of  simple  cells,  in  the 
midst  of  which,  in  varied  patterns,  run  upwards  bundles  of 
denser  cells  called  "  fibro-vascular"  ;  and  each  bundle  has 
one  or  more  ducts,  best  seen  perhaps  in  a  section  of 

WANGHAE  CASE. 

Sometimes  the  centre  cells  disappear  and  leave  the  stem 
hollow,  as  in  the  grasses  and  many  of  the  water  plants. 
Compare  now  this  slide,  and  also  a  section  of 

ASPARAGUS, 

with  that  of  the  Hazel  or  Apple. 

SECTION    OF    HAZEL. 

Here  we  see  very  distinct  organization  on  quite  a  different 
plan.  The  exogen  has  veined  and  reticulated  leaves  ;  the 


30  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

seeds  have  two  lobes,  or  cotyledons ;  the  flowers  are 
arranged  in  four  or  five.  The  wood  grows  by  the  addition 
of  cells,  in  circles,  to  the  exterior  of  that  last  formed,  and 
we  see  distinctly  the  open  cells  of  the  pith  in  the  centre  ; 
the  medullary  rays  running  from  the  centre  to  the  bark  at 
intervals,  with  sap-vessels  and  cellular  tissue  in  circles,  as 
they  were  added  on. 

CEDAK   OF   LEBANON, 

a  firm,  dense  wood  ;  the  cells  are  very  minute,  the  circles 
very  distinct ;  each  circle  is  a  year's  growth,  and  the  medul- 
lary rays  are  very  fine  and  numerous,  radiating  from  the 
centre.  Those  dark  bands  forming  the  circles  are  made  up 
of  vascular  tissue,  or  woody  fibre,  composed  of  long  pointed 
cells,  which  overlap  one  another,  and  deposit  internally  a 
strengthening  wall  of  a  substance  called  scleragen,  which  is 
most  abundant  where  not  only  density  but  great  power  of 
resistance  is  required.  When  young  these  woody  fibres 
conduct  the  sap  with  facility  through  both  stem  and 
branches,  especially  of  the  fir  tribe ;  but  after  they  are 
thickened  they  only  afford  support,  and  become  what  car- 
penters call  "heart-wood."  The  sap-vessels  of  trees  are 
those  nearest  to  the  bark,  which  makes  the  barking  of  trees 
so  dangerous  to  their  life. 

SECTION    OF   PINE. 

Look  next  at  this  section,  because  it  shows  some  pecu- 
liar dots  on  that  same  woody  fibre,  called  glandular  dots, 
and  which  are  remarkable  as  belonging  to  that  tribe,  and 
also  at  one  of  the  yew  tree  (Taxtis). 

SECTION    OF   YEW. 

In  this  section,  if  vertical,  there  is  a  beautiful  com- 
bination of  spinal  fibre  with  coniferous  pits. 

These  pitted  structures  require  explanation,  especially  as 
those  of  the  pine  or  common  deal  are  used  as  tests  of  the 
defining  power  of  the  object-glass.  The  pits  in  coniferous 
wood  are  surrounded  by  a  broad  rim. 

The  origin  of  the  pitted  cell  is  in  the  unequal  deposit  of 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  31 

secondary  matter  inside  the  cell- wall.  Always  remembering 
that  a  young  cell  is  a  simple  sac  of  a  single  membrane, 
which,  containing  a  certain  fluid,  is  capable  of  secreting 
various  substances,  curiously  separated  from,  or  combined 
with,  the  various, gases  and  inorganic  matter  which  form 
the  soil  in  which  it  grows.  These  secretions  are  used  for 
strengthening  the  cell-walls,  as  the  young  plant  springs 
upward  ;  therefore,  if  the  deposit  inside  the  cell  is  uneven, 
it  causes  marks  on  the  cell- wall ;  if  the  cell  grows  faster 
than  the  supply  of  deposit,  the  markings  are  spiral  or 
arched,  or  waved,  or  dotted  ;  and  these  are  best  observed 
by  comparing  different  cells  from  fresh  plants.  The  anther 
of  the  vegetable  marrow,  if  peeled  and  then  examined  with 
a  drop  of  water,  will  give  beautiful  cells  of  arched  fibre. 
But,  to  continue  with  this  slide, — these  pits  are  at  first  only 
dots  in  the  secondary  deposit ;  then  as  the  cell  thickens 
these  pits  deepen,  the  primary  membrane  breaks,  and  they 
become  channels  from  cell  to  cell,  as  you  may  see  in  a  sec- 
tion of  vegetable  ivory,  where  you  perceive  radiations  from 
each  cell,  which  are,  in  fact,  these  deep  pits,  and  in  a  vertical 
section  would  look  like  the  pitted  cells  of  Fir,  or  Clematis, 
or  Lime-wood,  or  Laurus  sassafras,  and  many  others. 

VEGETABLE   IVORY. 

Vegetable  ivory  is  the  seed  of  a  palm  called  Phytelephas 
macrocarpa,  and  is  composed  of  a  large  round  mass  of  bony 
albumen,  in  which  a  small  embryo  is  imbedded.  Slices  of 
this  ivory-like  albumen,  placed  under  the  microscope, 
afford  very  beautiful  examples  of  these  thickened  cells. 

FOSSIL   CONIFEROUS   WOOD. 

Fossil  coniferous  wood,  which  is  wood  converted  into 
lignite,  or  a  kind  of  coal,  when  the  vegetable  matter  is 
almost  entirely  removed  and  replaced  by  silex  (flint),  pre- 
serving all  the  peculiarities  of  structure.  This  fossil  wood, 
from  Tasmania,  will  show  the  pitted  ducts,  which  prove  it 
to  be  one  of  the  Conifers,  or  family  of  firs. 


32  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

Always  add  to  your  collection  sections  of 

FOSSIL   PINE   WOOD, 

vertical,  horizontal,  and  tangential. 

SECTION   OF   COCOA   NUT. 

This  gives  an  example  of  cells  thickened  into  very  con- 
solidated woody  tissue. 

SECTION   OF   COB   NUT. 

The  cob  nut,  or  hog  nut,  is  the  seed  of  a  plant  (Omphalea), 
belonging  to  the  natural  order  of  Euphorbiacese,  native  of 
Jamaica. 

SECTION   OF  SNAKE   WOOD. 

This  is  the  wood  of  a  plant  called  Ophioxylon,*  from  its 
twisted  root  and  stem,  resembling  a  serpent.  It  is  found 
in  the  East  Indies,  sometimes  as  a  climbing  plant,  bearing 
bright  red  and  white  flowers ;  sometimes  as  a  small  shrub, 
the  root  of  which  is  a  famous  nostrum  with  the  native 
physicians. 


MOSS. 
SLIDES  OF  DICEANUM,  FUNARIA,  ETC.  ETC. 

There  is  no  season  without  its  beautiful  symbols  of 
God's  power  and  love,  His  wisdom  and  forethought.  Spring 
flowers  fade  away  ;  the  summer  foliage  withers  and  falls 
from  the  trees  ;  the  autumn  soon  loses  its  crown  and  the 
last  of  its  flowers ;  but  hardly  have  the  lingering  Dandelion 
and  little  Daisy  left  us  than  on  every  old  wall  and  knotted 
trunk  we  find,  in  rich  profusion  and  variety,  the  capsules  or 
seed-vessels  of  the  pretty  mosses. 

They  are  our  little  way-side  friends, — we  often  gather 
their  trailing  stems  and  leafy  sprigs  ;  but  few  persons,  com- 
paratively speaking,  pause  to  examine  their  exquisite  seed- 
vessels;  therefore  a  few  mounted  specimens  will  be  of  great 
value  in  the  collection  for  our  microscope. 

*  Ophioxylon,  from  tQis,  a  serpent,  and  II/AO^  wood ;  because  it  lias  a 
twisted  root  and  stem. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  33 

Before  I  describe  the  growth  of  a  moss  or  the  slides 
before  us,  it  is  necessary  to  learn  the  several  parts  of  its 
fructification,  and,  if  possible,  to  procure  specimens  of  each 
of  them. 

A  moss  is  a  flowerless  plant ;  the  fruit  or  seed-vessel  is 
the  only  visible  organ  of  reproduction,  and  consists  of — 

The  capsule,  or  urn-like  body,  which  contains  the  spores. 

The  operculum,  or  lid  of  the  capsule,  which  shuts  in  the 
spores  until  they  require  light  and  air. 

The  calyptra,  or  veil,  which  protects  the  young  capsule. 

The  peristome  of  the  capsule,  which  in  most  of  the  mosses 
is  set  round  with  a  single  or  double  row  of  teeth,  such  as 
you  see  in  Dicranum  or  Bryum,  and  which  are  curiously 
regular  in  their  number,  varying  from  four  to  sixty-four, 
but  always  a  multiple  of  four.  Remark  this  in  any  you 
may  examine  ;  there  will  be  four  or  eight,  sixteen  or  thirty- 
two,  and  one  variety  (Polytrichum)  has  sixty-four;  but 
there  will  be  no  odd  number. 

The  inner  peristome,  or  cilia,  a  fringe  of  delicate  inner 
teeth,  often  rising  like  a  cone  in  the  centre  of  the  capsule, 
pale  yellovr,  or  pure  white,  whereas  the  outer  row  is  usually 
crimson  or  brown. 

The  columella  is  a  column  in  the  middle  of  the  capsule, 
round  which  the  spores  cluster,  and  which  you  will  only  see 
by  carefully  dividing  an  unripe  capsule  lengthwise,  making 
a  thin  section,  and  looking  at  it  with  a  drop  of  water  under 
a  low  power,  when  it  will  delight  you. 

The  growth  of  a  little  moss  is  so  interesting  that  we  shall 
do  well  to  watch  it  in  our  winter  walks,  from  November  to 
April. 

Botanists  are  not  yet  quite  agreed  about  the  green 
filaments,  which  are  the  first  appearance  of  fructification, 
and  whose  different  cells  contain  the  germs  of  the  future 
moss.  They  are  called  antheridia  and  pistillidia,  analogous 
to  the  stamens  and  pistils  of  a  flower,  but  very  different 
in  their  structure  and  action.  Read  the  chapter  on  the 
structure  and  reproduction  of  moss  in  '  Carpenter  on  the 
Microscope '  ;  or,  better  still,  read  Hooker  and  Taylor's 
t  Muscologia  Britannica.' 


34  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

The  part  that  we  can  daily  observe  with  a  simple  pocket 
lens  is  this: — The  little  capsule  rises  from  its  mossy  stem 
wrapped  in  a  delicate  leaf,  which  breaks  from  its  stalk, 
and  is  carried  upwards  in  the  growth  of  the  tender  bud  it 
is  to  protect  from  the  winter  cold.  This  leaf  forms  the 
calyptra  before  described,  and  varies  in  colour,  form,  and 
substance  :  on  some  species  of  moss  it  is  quite  transparent, 
of  bright  green  or  pale  yellow ;  on  some  it  is  hairy  and 
thick.  By-and-by  the  calyptra  falls  off, — splits  up  the 
side,  or  comes  off  whole, — and  then  the  capsule  is  seen, 
wholly  formed,  but  closed  by  its  lid  or  operculum.  This 
also  varies  much  in  form  and  colour;  sometimes,  as  in 
the  tiny  Weissia  on  stone  walls,  it  is  bright  apple-green, 
tipped  with  scarlet  or  crimson,  very  beautiful  to  look  upon 
even  thus  ;  but  none  could  guess  at  the  exceeding  loveliness 
concealed  beneath  this  pretty  lid,  nor  without  a  microscope 
could  we  see  further  into  its  mysteries. 

If  we  take  an  unripe  moss  and  divide  it,  we  perceive  the 
spores  clustering  round  the  columella,  and  growing  in 
warmth  and  security  within  the  closecl  capsule.  But  an 
appointed  time  comes,  and  then  the  operculum  opens,  falls 
back,  and  we  see  the  peristome  surrounded  with  a  double 
or  single  row  of  teeth, — four,  sixteen,  thirty-two,  or  sixty- 
four,  always  an  even  number  and  multiple  of  four,  as  I 
have  before  observed, — the  outer  row  rich  crimson  or  brown, 
and  the  inner  cilia  pure  white  or  pale  yellow,  forming  an 
exquisite  network  as  they  bend  protectingly  over  the 
mouth  of  the  capsule,  allowing  the  imprisoned  spores  both 
light  and  air,  yet  saving  them  from  cold  and  wet  and  tiny 
insects,  until  they  are  perfected  and  ripe  for  dispersion. 
When  their  work  is  accomplished  the  cilia  open,  the  little 
teeth  unclose,  and  the  spores  fall  to  the  ground,  or  are 
borne  upon  the  winds  hither  and  thither,  to  vegetate 
wheresoever  it  pleaseth  God  that  they  shall  grow.  All 
this  care  hath  He  taken  of  the  spores  of  a  tiny  moss ! 
Yes ;  and  these  mosses  occupy  no  unimportant  position 
in  the  economy  of  nature.  They  are,  with  lichens  and 
fungi,  called  servi,  or  servants,  because  they  are  the  earliest 
forms  of  vegetable  life,  and  prepare  the  soil  for  higher 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  35 

plants.  In  the  most  desolate  regions,  in  the  coldest 
climate,  the  little  moss  is  found.  This  very  Dicranum,  at 
least  its  species  Dicranum  bryoides,  was  once  the  friend  of 
the  great  traveller,  Mungo  Park.  He  was  bewildered  in 
a  desert,  and,  over-weary  even  unto  death,  had  laid 
himself  down  despairingly  to  die.  As  he  did  so,  a  little 
Dicranum  caught  his  eye  ;  the  sight  of  its  beauty  touched 
him,  the  thought  of  God's  care  for  it  awakened  the  better 
thought  of — "  If  God  so  cares  for  the  grass  of  the  field, 
which  to-day  is  and  to-morrow  is  not,  does  He  not  much 
more  care  for  me  ?  "  He  rose  up,  tried  once  more  to  find 
his  way,  and  was  saved. 

Mosses  abound  everywhere;  they  fill  even  the  rank  bogs, 
and  form  rich  mould  for  the  aristocrats  of  creation  ;  they 
cluster  round  the  wild  flowers,  and  protect  them  in  their 
earliest  state  from  cold  and  injury.  Servants  of  creation, 
servants  of  God,  they  fill  their  appointed  place,  and  do 
their  Maker's  will,  beautiful  in  their  lowliness  as  the  state- 
liest oak  of  the  forest. 

THE   DICRANUM 

is  found  from  November  to  April,  in  hedges  or  clay  banks. 

FUNARIA   HTGROMETRICA 

is  to  be  viewed  as  an  opaque  object.  The  crimson  peri- 
stome  of  twisted  teeth  and  the  white  cilia  gathered  into  a 
silvery  knob  in  the  centre  is  one  of  the  loveliest  objects  we 
can  look  at.  They  are  best  gathered  fresh,  and  all  the 
winter  long  we  find  them  on  walls  and  in  hedges,  or  waste 
places,  especially  wherever  wood  has  been  burnt,  or  near 
railway  stations. 

The  leaves  of  mosses  are  made  up  of  cellular  tissue,  and 
in  a  young  leaf  of  Fun  aria  we  see  the  chlorophyll-grains 
very  distinctly.  They  want  no  preparation  beyond  placing 
under  thin  glass  with  a  drop  of  water. 

The  capsules  of  Dicranum  and  Weissia  are  better 
mounted  in  balsam  ;  and  Funaria  is  best  seen  when  simply 
gummed  on  a  circle  of  black  paper,  and  protected  by  a 
cell  of  cardboard  and  thin  glass. 


36  -Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

There  are  upwards  of  forty  genera  and  a  thousand 
species  of  moss,  of  which  39  genera  and  400  species  are 
found  in  Great  Britain. 

SPORE-CASES   OF   FERN. 

The  fructification  of  ferns  affords  a  great  variety  of 
microscopic  objects,  though  we  rarely  find  any  but  the 
spore-cases  of  the  common  Polypodium  mounted  in  this 
way;  therefore,  after  looking  at  the  slide,  we  should  by 
all  means  collect  and  examine  as  many  varieties  of  fern  as 
we  can,  not  only  for  the  shape  of  the  thecfe,  as  these  little 
cases  are  called,  but  for  their  position  on  the  frond. 

This  Polypodium  is  a  most  common  fern,  growing  upon 
old  walls  and  hedgerows,  and  the  round  yellow  spots  on 
the  underside  of  the  frond  are  masses  of  these  spore-cases 
called  sori. 

Observe  that  each  theca  is  clasped  by  an  elastic  ring  or 
band,  called  the  annulus,  and  the  spores  are  kept  safely 
during  their  growth,  as  in  a  golden  casket ;  but,  as  soon  as 
they  are  fit  for  dispersion,  the  membrane  which  encloses 
them  breaks,  and  the  elastic  band  is  seen  with  an  empty 
little  cup  at  each  end.  The  spores  themselves  resemble 
pollen-grains,  and  are  very  prettily  marked  ;  but  will 
require  a  higher  power,  and  had  better  be  examined  from 
a  fresh  frond,  with  a  drop  of  water,  or  a  drop  of  oil  of 
lemon,  which  is  an  excellent  assistant  in  the  observation  of 
pollen  and  spores  of  all  kinds. 

The  great  profusion  of  these  organs  of  reproduction  is 
astonishing.  If  we  take  a  leaf  or  frond  of  the  common 
Hart's-tongue  (Scolopendriuin),  and  count  those  brown 
lines  on  the  underside,  which  are  the  sori,  we  find  at  least 
fifty  in  a  good-sized  frond ;  in  each  sorus  4,000  of  these 
tiny  thecse,  sometimes  6,000 ;  and  the  theca?  themselves 
enclose  about  fifty  spores  :  thus  we  shall  find  that  a  single 
leaf  of  the  plant  may  give  rise  to  no  fewer  than  ten 
millions  of  young  ferns. 

An  interesting  experiment  may  be  made  to  learn  the 
growth  of  a  fern,  by  simply  shaking  some  ripe  spores  on 
a  saucerful  of  fine  mould,  covering  it  with  a  bell-glass  or 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  37 

tumbler,  and  keeping  it  moist,  warm,  and  shaded.  In  a 
short  time  a  thin  green  film  will  spread  over  the  soil,  which 
take  up  carefully  on  the  point  of  a  lancet,  and  examine 
under  the  microscope.  The  little  spore  first  becomes 
swollen,  angular,  and  bursts,  throwing  out  a  fine  rootlet, 
which  fixes  in  the  soil  and  draws  in  nourishment.  Then  a 
number  of  delicate  transparent  cells  are  formed  from  the 
mother-cell  in  the  spore,  making  a  little  green  scale,  which 
as  it  expands  throws  out  many  fibres  or  rootlets  on  the 
underside.  The  wonderful  part  is  that  this  tiny  green 
scale  produces  two  kinds  of  cells,  which  fructify  each  other, 
as  do  the  stamens  and  pistil  of  flowering  plants. 

One  set  of  cells,  called  antheridia,  contain  most  curious 
spiral  filaments,  which  move  spontaneously,  and  wheel 
round  and  round  until  the  cell  breaks,  and  they  escape 
to  enter  into  the  other  kind  of  cells,  called  archegonia,  or 
germ-cells,  from  which  the  real  stem  of  the  future  fern  is 
produced.  This  is  difficult  to  watch,  and  it  requires  a 
power  of  300  diameters  to  see  these  moving  filaments, 
called  antherozoides ;  but  the  development  of  the  little  fern 
is  in  itself  worth  seeing  and  mounting  for  the  microscope 
in  its  several  stages. 

Ferns  are  amongst  the  flowerless  plants, — very  numerous, 
very  useful ;  not  fewer  than  2,000  species  inhabit  various 
parts  of  the  world,  from  the  tall  Tree-fern  of  the  tropics, 
more  than  fifty  feet  high,  to  the  humble  Spleenwort 
(Asplenium  ruta-muraria)  which  haunts  our  ruined  walls. 
Their  claim  to  usefulness  rests  on  their  medicinal  pro- 
perties ;  the  thick  mucilage  from  Adiantum  capillus  Veneris 
being  a  famous  cough  nostrum  ;  a  decoction  of  Polypo- 
dium  is  taken  as  an  anti-rheumatic  and  sudorific  beverage  ; 
Osmunda  regalis  is  given  to  rickety  children  as  a  tonic  ; 
and  others  are  used  as  styptics  and  purgatives.  The  roots, 
when  roasted  and  peeled,  are  eaten  by  the  natives  of  New 
Zealand  as  we  eat  bread. 

Shirley  Hibberd's  '  The  Fern  Garden  '  is  a  most  useful 
companion  in  a  country  walk,  to  assist  us  in  recognising 
the  different  species. 


38  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

ELATERS    OF    EQUISETUM. 

This  slide  is  useful  chiefly  in  directing  attention  to  the 
plant  from  which  the  elaters  are  taken,  and  as  leading  the 
student  to  an  interesting  experiment. 

The  Equisetaceae,  or  Horsetails,  are  leafless  plants  found 
on  moist  ground,  in  ditches  and  rivers,  with  whorls  of  long 
slender  branches,  and  a  hollow  stem  which  gives  the  micro- 
scopist  a  very  beautiful  siliceous  cuticle  with  stomata.  The 
fructification  is  found  in  the  spring :  a  fertile  scaly  head 
rises  from  the  earth,  having  circles  round  it  of  shield-like 
discs,  beneath  which  the  spore-cases  and  these  spores,  which 
then  appear  only  as  a  fine  green  dust,  lie  concealed. 

Shake  a  little  of  the  dust  on  a  slide  of  glass,  and  innu- 
merable small  bodies  will  be  seen,  each  with  four  elastic 
filaments  clasping  and  unclasping  them  in  quick  motion  for 
several  minutes.  If  dry  and  motionless,  by  lightly  breathing 
on  them  the  action  will  be  repeated.  These  are  the  elaters 
of  the  Equisetum,  and  the  mechanism  by  which  the  spores 
are  dispersed. 

ELATERS    OF   JUNGERMANNIA. 

Jungermannia,  or  Scale-moss,  is  a  plant  of  lower  rank  in 
the  vegetable  world  than  the  true  moss,  such  as  Dicranum 
or  Eunaria.  The  elaters  which  are  here  mounted  belong 
to  that  species  called  Jungermannia  dilatata,  which  creeps 
over  the  bark  of  trees,  and  tints  the  trunk  of  an  old  elm  or 
oak  with  a  rich  brown  or  crimson  ;  here  and  there  a  patch 
of  this  scaly  plant  encrusting  the  rugged  surface,  and 
requiring  the  aid  of  a  pocket  lens  to  see  its  fructification. 

Any  time  from  November  to  March  look  closely  at  one 
of  these  dark  masses,  and  you  will  see  dotted  over  it  tiny 
globes,  white  as  of  frosted  silver,  rising  on  a  slender  stem, 
and  perhaps  great  numbers  of  exceedingly  minute  fawn- 
coloured  flowers.  If  you  gather  one  and  examine  it  with 
a  good  glass,  small  tufts  of  spiral  fibre  will  be  seen  on  each 
segment  of  what  seems  to  be  a  flower — these  are  the  elaters. 
Now  this  is  not  a  flower,  but  a  simple  spore-case.  The 
little  white  globe  before  noticed  splits  into  four  valves,  and 
these  elaters  of  spiral  fibre  uncoil  with  a  spring  and  scatter 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  39 

the  ripe  spores.  There  are  seventy  species  of  British 
Jungermannia,  which  have  been  admirably  described  and 
delineated  by  Sir  William  Hooker.  We  can  find  several 
of  them  in  our  country  walks  anywhere,  and  the  leaves  of 
cellular  tissue  are  particularly  worthy  of  observation  under 
the  microscope. 

JUNGERMANNIA    BIDENTATA. 

This  is  an  example  of  the  delicate  toothed  leaves  of  one 
species.  We  find  another,  Jungermannia  furcata,  very 
commonly  on  the  same  tree  as  J.  dilatata ;  it  has  a  narrow 
green  frond,  forked  at  the  extremity,  and  on  the  underside 
we  may  see  the  anthers,  or  antheridia,  the  male  organs  of 
the  plant.  They  are  small  green  globules,  which  cannot 
be  properly  observed  without  a  microscope. 

The  elaters  are  best  seen  when  mounted  in  balsam ;  the 
leaves  either  dry  or  in  glycerine. 


FUNGI. 
SLIDE  OF  PUCCINIA,  OR  PHRAGMIDIUM. 

Before  we  appreciate  this  apparently  simple  object,  it  is 
needful  to  learn  something  of  the  vast  extent  and  variety 
of  the  family  to  which  it  belongs  ;  but  the  limits  of  this 
catalogue  will  not  allow  of  more  than  a  very  brief  state- 
ment of  necessary  information. 

The  Fungi  are  plants  of  low  organization,  of  which  the 
highest  in  rank  is  the  common  Mushroom,  the  lowest  that 
fine  mould  or  tiny  spot  which  we  find  on  dead  leaves  or 
decaying  wood,  or  as  a  film  upon  our  preserves,  or  a  tiny 
forest  on  our  stale  paste.  Everywhere,  in  short,  we  may 
gather  specimens  of  Fungi,  and  find  beautiful  life  in  death 
under  the  revealing  power  of  our  microscope. 

Few  of  them  are  at  present  mounted  for  the  student, 
but  this  species  may  always  be  obtained ;  it  is  a  fungus 
parasitic  on  the  Rose-tree. 

The  Puccinia  is  a  mildew  which  infests  the  straw  of 
Wheat,  the  leaves  of  Roses,  Blackberry,  Potentilla,  Box, 
and  Ground-ivy.  We  merely  see  small  black  spots,  usually 


40  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

surrounded  by  a  circle  of  orange-coloured  cells,  which  if  we 
scrape  off  and  soak  for  a  minute  either  in  turpentine  or 
diluted  nitric  acid,  each  particle  of  black  dust  (for  it  appears 
nothing  more  to  the  naked  eye)  is  found  to  be  a  pear- 
shaped  seed-vessel,  divided  into  compartments  containing 
spores.  This  Puccinia  of  the  Rose  or  Blackberry  has  from 
five  to  seven  compartments,  or  spore-chambers,  and  is  the 
best  specimen  to  collect  for  observation.  Some  botanists 
call  it  Phragmidium,  and  Aregma. 

If  you  wish  to  see  the  actual  escape  of  the  spore,  scrape 
the  fungus  from  the  leaf,  and  let  it  soak  in  a  little  alcohol 
on  the  slide  to  disperse  the  air.  Before  the  spirit  has  quite 
evaporated,  add  a  drop  of  nitric  acid  under  the  thin  glass 
cover,  and  warm  it  over  a  spirit-lamp,  press  the  glass  gently, 
and  in  all  probability  the  inner  cell  of  the  spore-case  will 
come  out,  enclosing  the  spore  itself. 

To  see  the  germination  of  Puccinia,  you  have  only  to 
scatter  some  of  these  spore-cases  in  the  spring  on  some 
moist  flannel,  or  on  a  floating  piece  of  cork,  when  they  will 
presently  throw  out  long  colourless  filaments,  at  the  end  of 
which  three  or  four  septa  will  be  seen  filled  with  orange- 
coloured  endochrome  or  pulp  of  granular  matter ;  then  a 
spicule  will  rise  on  each  septum,  and  expand  into  a  globular 
head,  into  which  the  orange-coloured  matter  will  pass,  and 
these  eventually  fall  off  and  begin  to  germinate  on  their 
own  account. 

The  spores  of  fungi,  being  light  and  excessively  minute, 
float  in  the  air,  enter  plants  through  the  stomata,  and  ger- 
minate in  the  cell  beneath. 

BLIGHT   OF   WHEAT   (SMUT). 

This  is  a  fungus  of  globular  form,  black  and  powdery, 
covering  the  young  ears  of  corn  like  a  coating  of  soot.  It 
is  called  Uredo  segetum.  The  spores  are  so  exceedingly 
minute,  that  upwards  of  seven  millions  eight  hundred  and 
forty  thousand  of  them  would  be  required  to  cover  a  square 
inch  of  surface. 

UREDO    F(ETIDA,    OR   BUNT, 

is  another  species,  also  blighting  the  wheat,  but  found  in 
the  grain,  which  looks  dark,  though  otherwise  like  the  sound 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  41 

wheat,  until  it  is  crushed,  when  a  fetid  black  powder  is 
seen,  the  spores  of  which  are  larger  than  those  of  the  smut. 
Nevertheless,  each  grain  contains  four  millions  of  them. 
They  are  of  an  oily  nature,  so  that  they  stick  to  the 
healthy  grains,  and,  if  sown  with  them,  infect  the  next 
crop  ;  therefore  farmers  dress  their  wheat  with  potash  to 
destroy  this  fungus. 


UREDO,    OR 

I  mention  this,  although  few  specimens  are  mounted, 
because  it  is  met  with  abundantly  throughout  the  autumn 
and  winter  on  the  underside  of  the  Coltsfoot  leaf,  on  Spurge 
in  our  gardens,  on  the  twigs  of  Fir-trees,  and  on  almost 
every  garden  vegetable.  These  yellow  spots  on  leaf  or  stem 
are  beautiful  microscopic  objects.  The  orange-coloured 
spores  form  under  the  cuticle,  which  breaks  sometimes  like 
a  cup,  or  coronet,  full  of  golden  dust,  that  is  most  interest- 
ing to  the  observer. 

I  will  only  add  that  there  are  4,000  species  of  fungi,  most 
of  which  are  parasitic  on  plants  and  animals.  The  human 
body  is  also  subject  to  their  growth  —  the  internal  parts,  as 
well  as  the  bulb  of  the  hair,  the  tongue  and  palate.  The 
tartar  of  our  teeth  is  partly  a  fungus,  and  so  is  the  thrush 
in  infants. 

We  can  find  a  rich  store  of  curious  and  beautiful  forms 
on  every  dying  leaf  or  decaying  stem.  Examine  the  mould 
on  paste  or  jam  ;  the  Puccinia  on  Rose-trees,  Beans,  Black- 
berries ;  the  ^Ecidium,  growing  in  bright-red  spots,  on 
Gooseberry  and  Barberry  leaves  in  June  and  July  ;  also  on 
the  white  film  on  leaves  of  the  garden  pea.  ^Ecidium  is 
called  ery&iplie,  and  has  little  spore-cases  dotted  over  it. 
So  also  on  the  leaves  of  the  willow,  a  lovely  little  erysiphe, 
each  black  dot  fringed  with  hooked  filaments.  These  will 
give  some  idea  of  the  variety  of  fungi,  and  their  invisible 
and  unknown  beauty.  Look  over  Greville's  work  on  the 
Cryptogamia,  and  Mrs.  Hussey  on  the  Fungi;  or  get  at 
Bulliard's  fine  old  book  on  Microscopic  Fungi,  when  your 
winter  walks  will  abound  with  hitherto  undreamt-of  objects 
of  delight. 

3 


42  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 


CHAPTER  III. 

INFUSORIAL   EARTHS. 

THESE  slides,  which  require  high  power  and  a  good 
microscope  to  examine,  consist  of  specimens  of  Diatomacese 
from  different  parts  of  the  world.  Their  value  is  in  pro- 
portion to  the  knowledge  of  their  possessor  concerning  the 
Diatomacese  generally  and  particularly.  The  Diatom aceaB 
are  minute  vegetable  forms,  called  also  "  brittleworts," 
from  the  almost  unavoidable  separation  of  their  cells  or 
frustules  in  handling  them.  Long  have  they  caused  dis- 
putes as  to  their  animal  or  vegetable  nature.  Very  eminent 
naturalists,  such  as  Ehrenberg,  seeing  them  gifted  with 
spontaneous  motion, — the  little  golden  Naviculse  sailing 
slowly  across  the  field  of  vision,  apparently  turning  back 
when  meeting  with  an  obstacle,  or  whirling  gently  round 
as  if  by  their  own  will, — decided  that  they  were  surely 
animal,  and  classed  them  with  the  Infusoria,  which  are 
microscopic  animals,  found  in  salt  and  fresh  water.  But 
later  researches  and  patient  investigation  have  placed 
beyond  doubt  the  vegetable  nature  of  these  beautiful  crea- 
tions, to  whose  variety  there  appears  no  limit. 

As  the  wondering  astronomer  discovers  the  infinite 
worlds  revealed  in  unfathomed  space,  and  sees  star  after 
star  arise  in  countless  myriads  within  the  dim  and  distant 
nebulae, — as  his  mind  bows  down  overwhelmed  by  the  sense 
of  the  omnipotent  Creator's  dominion  and  guidance  of  all 
those  glorious  orbs, — even  so  the  microscopist  bends  in 
astonished  awe  before  the  infinitude  of  God's  works  in  the 
uncountable  varieties  and  exquisite  beauty  of  the  minute 
Diatoms. 

BILIN  SLATE. — Wherefore  are  they  thus  highly  wrought, 
and  why  in  such  abundance  ?  Take  up  that  slide  of  Bilin 
slate,  and  know  that  in  one  single  cubic  inch  40,000  millions 
of  these  delicate  forms  are  found  ! 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  43 

RICHMOND. — Look  at  the  earth  from  Richmond — it  is 
a  very  small  quantity  of  a  marine  deposit — eighteen  feet 
deep,  underlying  the  whole  city  of  Richmond,  U.S.,  and 
extending  over  an  area  whose  limits  are  not  known. 

ALGIERS,  ORAN. — Observe  the  beautiful  discs  in  that 
slide  of  earth  from  Algiers.  Use  the  highest  power  that 
the  art  of  man  has  yet  constructed,  and  hardly  will  you  see 
all  the  beauty  which  the  finger  of  our  God  has  traced  on  the 
circular  valves  of  these  little  Diatoms,  called  Coscinodiscus, 
Actinocyclus,  Arachnoidiscus,  or  Heliopelta.  These  names 
sound  hard  and  perplexing  to  beginners,  but  they  are  full 
of  meaning  to  any  one  acquainted  with  Greek  ;  and  there  is 
this  great  advantage  in  such  nomenclature — that  it  is  un- 
derstood alike  by  scholars  of  all  nations.  The  difficulty  of 
scientific  names  lies  not  in  the  names  themselves,  so  much  as 
in  our  deficient  education,  which  wastes  the  time  and  the 
intellect  of  young  ladies  in  acquiring  accomplishments  and 
modern  languages  without  the  solid  foundation  of  Latin 
and  Greek,  which  is  acknowledged  to  be  essential  for  men. 
These  discs,  and  some  others  most  commonly  mounted  as 
objects  for  the  microscope,  will  be  explained  presently ; 
it  is  necessary  previously  to  say  somewhat  more  of  the 
Diatomacea?  generally. 

And,  first:  They  are  now  decidedly  placed  in  the  vege- 
table kingdom.  They  are  found  to  consist  of  simple  cells, 
whose  membrane  is  so  thoroughly  impregnated  with  silex 
(flint)  that  it  is  indestructible  by  those  powerful  acids  or  by 
such  heat  as  would  totally  destroy  a  simple  cell-membrane. 
They  consist  always  of  two  valves  united  at  the  edges,  like 
a  bivalve  shell,  and  containing  endochrome,  like  the  plant- 
cell  ;  sometimes  oil-globules,  and  a  granular  substance 
which  has  been  seen  to  circulate  within.  For  a  proper 
understanding  of  this  read  l  Carpenter  on  the  Microscope ' ; 
i  Smith  on  British  Diatomacese ' ;  '  Pritchard's  Infusoria ' ; 
<  Annals  of  Natural  History,'  1843  and  1848  ;  '  Microscopic 
Journal,'  1854. 

The  markings  upon  the  valves,  and  their  shape  and 
position,  are  the  distinguishing  characters  which  decide  the 
species. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope. 


They  are  found  in  the  living  state  abundantly  in  every 
pond  and  ditch,  ocean  and  rock-pool.  They  are  in  immense 
deposits  in  every  part  of  the  world.  A  mud-bank,  400 
miles  long  and  120  broad,  has  been  found  on  the  flanks  of 
Victoria  Land,  wholly  composed  of  these  siliceous  valves,  or 
loricse.  In  Sweden  and  Norway  they  are  used  under  the 
name  of  bergh-mehl,  and  mixed  with  the  flour  for  bread.  In 
the  masses  of  guano  these  imperishable  Diatoms  are  found  in 
profusion,  having  been  eaten  by  shell-fish,  re-swallowed  by 
the  sea-bird,  and  passed  through  its  digestive  organs,  to 
reappear  unharmed,  in  all  their  beauty,  as  you  may  see 
them  on  the  slides  sold  as  "  discs  from  guano." 

DIATOMS   OF    GUANO. 

It  is  not  possible  to  catalogue  the  contents  of  the  slides 
sold  as  infusorial  earths  from  various  parts,  because  every 
slide  has  a  different  collection,  and  the  student  should  care- 
fully study  each  slide,  and  learn  its  contents,  with  the  help 
of  such  a  book  as  '  Pritchard's  Infusoria,' 

The  earths  from  the  following  places  -contain  some  of  the 
most  beautiful  forms  :— 


Algiers 

Mull 

Bilin 

Italy 

Barbadoes 

Auvergne 

Richmond  (discs) 

Bangor,  U.S. 

New  Durham 


Kieselguhr 

Lapland 

Gossa 

Obero 

Habitchtswald 

Tullamore 

Lock  Mourne 

Premnay 

Wreatham,  U.S. 

NAVICUL^E. 


Virginia  (discs) 

Piscataway 

Manchester,  U.S. 

Rappanhanna 

Schockhoe 

Rugen 

Slieve  Mor  Hills 

'Bermuda  (discs) 


Some  Diatomaceee,  however,  are  mounted  separately, 
either  as  test-objects,  for  their  delicate  striae,  or  for  their 
peculiar  markings ;  and  none  more  frequently  so  than  the 
Naviculse,  of  which  Navicula  hippocampa,  or  Pleurosigma 
angidatum,  are  favourite  examples. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  45 


NAVICULA    HIPPOCAMPA. 

The  Naviculse  comprise  the  largest  section  of  the  whole 
body  of  diatoms,  and  vary  very  much  in  form  and  markings, 
but  the  genus  Naviculse  itself  is  so  called  from  its  resem- 
blance to  a  boat  or  little  ship  (Nays,  &  ship).  They  are 
found,  both  in  the  living  and  fossil  state,  of  a  bright  golden 
colour,  the  valves  delicately  striated,  with  or  without  a 
central  aperture.  Some  are  striped  longitudinally ;  some 
transversely ;  some  waved  or  shaped  like  the  letter  S,  as 

PLEUEOSIG3IA, 

in  which  the  apparent  stria?  are  resolvable  into  hexagonal 
dots  under  a  high  power.  These  Naviculse  all  multiply  by 
division  and  conjugation,  as  do  the  diatoms  generally, 
which  cannot  be  explained  without  plates,  and  the  student 
must  refer  to  the  works  already  mentioned. 

3IELOSEIRA, 
From  melos  (a  member),  and  seira  (a  chain), 

is  found  on  marine  algee,  a  composite  plant  of  many 
frustules,  joined  together  by  siliceous  hoops. 

MELOSEIRA   BORRERI. 

No  student  should  be  without  a  slide  of  Meloseira, 
because  it  is  a  diatom  very  likely  to  be  mistaken  under  a 
low  power  for  a  mass  of  conferva?.  In  fact,  it  has  been 
misunderstood  even  by  eminent  naturalists.  Agardh,  the 
Swedish  botanist,  found  and  classed  it  with  the  fresh-water 
algse  ;  Ehrenberg  examined  and  removed  it  into  the  animal 
kingdom  under  the  name  of  Gallionella ;  and  now  it  is 
replaced  in  the  vegetable  world  as  a  diatom,  its  siliceous 
lorica  being  quite  ascertained,  and  many  beautiful  species 
found  both  in  salt  and  fresh  water.  If  possible,  obtain  a 
specimen  of  Meloseira  sub-flexilis,  which  is  found  off 
1'riburg  ;  or  Meloseira  nummulites,  found  in  the  Baltic  Sea  ; 
but  meanwhile  observe  this  M.  Borreri,  which  is  abundant 
on  marine  algse.  You  see  a  mass  of  bead-like  filaments, 
which  towards  the  edge  is  better  seen  and  with  a  high 


46  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

power.  The  frustules,  or  valves,  are  quite  apparent—  cylin- 
drical, round  at  the  edges,  and  with  a  strongly-marked 
central  line.  Some  of  the  frustules  are  larger  than  others ; 
in  these  most  likely  the  process  of  self-conjugation  has 
begun. 

ACHNANTHES   LONGIPES, 

From  achne  (chaff  or  down) ,  and  anthos  (a  flower) . 

These  now  scattered  frustules  were  connected  in  life  by  a 
stem,  and  the  upper  and  lower  frustules  had  different 
markings.  You  may  observe  that  some  have  a  transverse 
line,  forming  a  cross  upon  the  valve ;  this  is  one  of  the 
lower  frustules.  Achnanthes  are  common  in  sea-water, 
attached  to  algse.  There  are  several  species, — some  fossil, 
others  found  in  fresh  water  ;  but  this  is  the  most  beautiful. 


STNEDRA   ULNA, 

From  sunedra  (a  sitting  together), 

are  common  in  fresh  water,  sitting  together  in  groups  of 
golden  wands,  striated  and  open  at  the  ends,  which  in  age 
dilate,  and  three  obtuse  teeth  are  visible,  with  openings 
between  them.  These  often  occur  in  such  numbers  as 
quite  to  encrust  the  conferva?,  or  the  stones  in  ponds  and 
rivers. 

We  need  but  to  take  a  very  little  of  the  brown-looking 
vegetation  which  we  find  on  the  walls  of  wells  or  horse- 
troughs,  or  quiet  ponds,  and  placing  it  on  a  slip  of  glass, 
with  a  drop  of  water,  cover  with  another  piece  of  thin 
glass,  to  see  many  of  these  living  microscopic  plants. 

BACILLARLE, 
From  baculus  (a  staff). 

These  are  much  shorter  than  Synedra,  and  are  found 
adhering  together  by  one  corner,  in  a  zigzag  manner,  or 
free,  like  naviculse,  gliding  about  in  a  drop  of  water.  They 
are  so  abundant  as  to  cover  the  conferva?  like  felt. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  47 


GOMPHONEMA, 
From  gomphus  (a  wooden  peg), 

is  shaped  like  a  wooden  peg  or  wedge,  and  grows  like  a 
tree,  on  long  filaments,  attached  to  confervse  or  stones  in 
fresh  water,  varying  in  shape,  being  sometimes  round  at 
the  tip,  or  notched,  or  with  a  plain  edge. 

LICMOPHORA, 

From  liTcmos  (a  fan),  andpftora  (bearing), 

grows  likewise  on  a  stalk,  but  in  dense  masses,  and  is  a 
marine  diatom,  parasitic  on  seaweeds.  Its  growth  is  dif- 
ferent from  that  of  the  Gomphonema.  The  stalk  widens 
in  the  process  of  multiplication,  and  so  spreads  out  the 
frustules  like  a  fan. 

RHABDONEMA, 
From  rhabdos  (a  staff). 

These  are  marine  also,  and  used  as  test  objects,  because, 
besides  the  striations,  each  frustule  has  two  or  four  rows  of 
marks  called  vittse.  They  were  joined  together  when 
alive,  forming  a  long  tube ;  but  usually  we  only  see  the 
separated  frustules  here. 

GRAMMATOPHORA   MARINA, 
From  gramma  (a  letter). 

This  is  used  as  a  test  object  to  discover  some  very  delicate 
striae  on  the  borders  of  each  valve,  and  is  also  remarkable 
for  its  vittse,  which  resemble  letters ;  especially  this  G. 
marina,  which  has  four  Greek  gammas  (y)  on  each  frustule. 
The  vittas  are  internal  siliceous  folds,  and  distinguish  a  large 
section  of  the  Diatomacese.  There  are  fifteen  species  of 
Grammatophora.  This  one  is  found  on  seaweed  in  the 
Atlantic  and  Pacific  oceans. 

BIDDULPHIA, — AMPHITETRAS, 

Biddulphia  is  one  of  the  chain-like  diatoms  which  adhere 
to  one  another  by  projecting  angles,  or  horns.  A  band  of 


48  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

minute  cells  forms  a  hoop  round  the  valves,  and  when  they 
multiply  the  young  cells  slip  out  from  between  the  valves, 
and  the  hoop  often  becomes  detached. 

Amphitetras  is  a  square  cellular  diatom,  which  frequently 
has  its  frustules  piled  up  one  over  the  other,  with  a  large 
cell  in  each  corner  of  the  frustules.  They  are  found  alive 
in  the  sea  off  Cuba  and  the  Canary  Islands,  fossil  in 
Bermuda  earth  and  Barbadoes  deposit. 

ISTHMIA   ENERYIS. 

A  lovely  diatom,  found  on  seaweed  on  the  English  coast 
and  in  the  Channel  Islands.  Its  exquisite  areolated  struc- 
ture is  very  remarkable,  and  will  repay  careful  examination. 
Its  mode  of  increase  is  unlike  all  others.  Two  cells  form 
within  the  valves,  and  as  they  enlarge  break  forth  ;  but  still 
the  siliceous  hoop  which  once  joined  the  new  frustules  to 
the  old  one  remains  attached  for  a  time  round  one  of  them 
and  alters  its  shape,  causing  some  to  appear  truncated 
instead  of  round.  The  areolse  of  Isthmia  are  never  well 
seen  except  with  the  parabolic  illuminator,  or  mounted  dry 
and  viewed  with  a  binocular  microscope. 

AEACHNOIDISCUS, 

From  arachne  (a  spider),  and  discus. 

This  beautiful  disc  is  one  from  the  guano,  and  is  also  found 
attached  to  seaweed  ;  especially  one  species,  which  is  much 
used  by  the  Japanese  in  making  soup.  It  does,  indeed, 
somewhat  resemble  a  spider's  web.  But  how  can  we 
describe  the  wonderful  delicacy  of  its  tracery,  or  cease  to 
wonder  at  the  perfection  of  its  form,  when  we  learn  that 
this  double  disc  has  two  inner  valves ;  the  outer  one 
horny,  upon  which  are  the  web-like  marks,  is  indestructible 
in  nitric  acid  ;  and  the  inner  valve  siliceous,  supports  the 
upper  one  upon  fretwork  like  a  gothic  window.  This 
should  always  be  looked  at  with  a  Lieberkuhn,  or  a 
parabolic  illuminator. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  49 


HELIOPELTA, 

From  helios  (the  sun),  andpeZfa  (a  shield). 

This  diatom  is  found  in  Bermuda  infusorial  earth.  We 
sometimes  find  two  or  three  species  on  the  same  slide,  and 
few  mounted  diatoms  are  as  beautiful  as  the  Heliopelta 
viewed  as  an  opaque  with  the  binocular.  We  then  see  the 
really  raised  compartments  in  relief,  forming  a  five  or  six- 
rayed  star  of  exquisite  workmanship,  with  a  striated  margin 
and  lateral  spines,  which  are  thought  to  connect  the  frustules 
together  when  in  a  young  state.  The  number  of  rays  de- 
termine the  species.  If  the  heliopelta  has  a  five-rayed  star 
in  the  centre  and  ten  compartments,  it  is  H.  Leuwenlwekii. . 
If  there  is  a  six-rayed  star  and  twelve  compartments,  it  is 
H.  euleri.  If  there  is  a  perfect  Maltese  cross  and  eight 
compartments,  this  is  H.  metii.  But  is  quite  necessary, 
in  order  fully  to  observe  the  structure,  to  have  two  slides  of 
this  diatom,  the  one  for  transmitted  the  other  for  reflected 
light,  and  the  latter  must  have  the  Heliopelta  mounted 
without  balsam. 

OMPHALOPELTA    (CELLULOSA   VEKSICOLOR). 

This  diatom  so  nearly  resembles  Heliopelta,  that  a  little 
close  observation  is  necessary  in  order  to  detect  the  differ- 
ence between  them.  The  rays,  though  distinct,  are  less 
raised,  and  the  margin  has  fewer  spines,  the  rim  is  broader, 
and  one  species,  0.  versicolor,  has,  with  transmitted  light,  a 
play  of  colour  from  tawny  to  red,  also  a  bright,  clear,  six- 
rayed  star  in  the  centre,  and  the  rim,  though  narrower  than 
0.  cellulosa,  is  very  radiant.  This  is  also  found  in  Bermuda 
fossil  earth,  and  other  species  in  guano. 

ACTINOCTCLUS, 
From  actin  (a  ray  of  light),  and  cyclus  (a  circle), 

has  no  marginal  spines,  and  from  eight  to  ten  divisions ;  is 
found  alive  at  Cuxhaven ;  fossil  in  Virginian  earth. 


50  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

ASTEKOMPHALUS   ASTEROLAMPRA, 

From  aster  (a  star),  omphalos  (the  navel),  and  lampra  (shining). 

Look  for  these  in  the  slides  of  fossil  guano,  Bermuda 
earth,  Virginia  deposit,  and  Piscataway  earth.  They  present 
beautiful  umbilical  rays,  reaching  only  halfway  towards  the 
margin,  and  alternate  rays  proceeding  from  the  margin, 
forming  a  bright  star  in  the  centre,  having  five  areolae  in 
each  marginal  division. 

COSCINODISCUS, 

From,  coscinon  (a  sieve), 

has  no  rays  or  divisions,  but  resembles  the  Indian  turn  of  a 
fairy  watch.  The  structure  is  wholly  cellular,  and  the 
species,  of  which  there  are  forty,  are  known  one  from 
another  by  minute  yet  regular  markings,  tubercles,  and 
variations  in  the  size  of  the  cells.  They  are  found  alive  in 
the  sea  off  Cuxhaven  ;  fossil  in  the  Richmond,  Virginia,  and 
Bermuda  earths,  also  in  the  chalk  marl  of  Oran. 

These  are  the  specimens  most  commonly  sold  by  opti- 
cians, and  they  show  us  what  DiatomaceaB  are ;  but  to 
pursue  the  study,  and  learn  the  myriads  which  a  little 
bog-water  or  a  spray  of  seaweed  would  reveal,  we  must 
read  Pritchard's  work  on  Infusoria  ;  or,  if  further  interested 
in  the  manner  of  their  propagation, — which  is  really  won- 
derful— read  the  article  "Diatomacea"  in  the  works  on 
the  Microscope  by  Carpenter  or  Hogg. 


DESMIDIACE^E. 


These  are  minute  plants,  of  green  colour,  found  in  fresh 
water,  shallow  pools,  and  ditches. 


YOLVOX   GLOBATOR. 


This  is  one  of  them,  which,  from  its  animalcule-like 
movement  and  extreme  beauty,  has  long  been  considered 
as  one  of  the  Infusoria.  If  mounted,  it  maybe  beautiful, 
but  is  much  more  so  in  its  living,  moving  state,  in  a  drop 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  51 

of  water ;  revolving  round  and  round,  sometimes  gliding 
along,  sometimes  rolling  through  the  water,  aotransparent 
globe,  enclosing  from  one  to  seven,  or  even  twenty,  lesser 
and  darker  green  globules,  of  various  sizes.  Each  of  those 
globules  in  time  breaks  from  its  parent  cell,  and  becomes 
likewise  a  mother  plant,  producing  young  volvoces  with 
such  rapidity  that  ponds  are  often  thronged  with  them, 
and  the  water  is  coloured  to  a  deep  green.  There  is  a 
pond  at  Blackheath  which,  in  the  months  of  July  and 
August,  abounds  with  Volvox  globator. 

CLOSTEKIUM 

is  a  favourite  specimen  of  Desmidiacea?.  Its  little  half- 
moons,  or  ovals,  sometimes  joined  together,  are  frequently 
found  in  all  pools,  especially  on  moors  and  in  exposed  places. 

Lately  the  Closterium  has  been  closely  examined  with 
high  powers,  and  a  circulation  of  fluid  was  seen  throughout 
the  cell.  This  requires  a  power  of  300  diameters  and  care- 
ful management  of  light.  Then  a  peculiar  whirling  move- 
ment may  be  distinguished  in  the  large  round  space  at  the 
end  of  the  cell,  as  well  as  along  both  the  concave  and  con- 
vex edges  of  the  Closterium.  It  is  like  the  circulation  in 
Vallisneria,  Chara,  and  Anacharis,  which  I  do  not  describe, 
because  I  am  only  noticing  those  objects  which  are  mounted 
for  students,  in  the  hope  of  leading  them  to  examine  the 
living  plants  for  themselves,  with  other  books  of  a  higher 
order.  (Read  '  Carpenter's  Microscope/  chap,  vi.,  on  the 
Desmidiacese.) 

To  find  the  Desmidiaceae,  try  small  shallow  pools,  and 
not  stagnant  water. 

The  Closterium,  Euastrum,  Micrasterias,  &c.,  will  be 
found  as  a  gelatinous  stratum  at  the  bottom,  on  stones,  or 
stems  of  water-plants.  The  Staurastrum,  Pediastrum,  and 
all  the  smaller  species,  float  as  a  thin  film  on  the  water,  or 
form  a  dirty-looking  cloud  round  the  aquatic  plants. 

Raise  the  film  with  a  small  muslin  net,  or  pour  the  water 
through  your  handkerchief,  scrape  off  the  deposit,  and  trans- 
ier  it  into  bottles  of  fresh  water  for  examination  at  home. 


52  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

If  on  plants,  strip  the  stem  with  your  fingers,  and  in  the 
same  way  drop  the  gelatinous  mass  in  water.  Let  it  settle, 
and  the  little  plants  will  flourish  and  remain  long  enough 
for  you  to  study,  not  only  their  lovely  forms,  but  also  their 
manner  of  propagation,  which  is  threefold.  They  multiply 
by  self-division,  by  conjugation,  or  by  zoospores. 

The  most  common  way  is  this :  when  a  simple  cell  has 
come  to  its  full  growth,  a  partition  forms  in  the  middle, 
the  cell  gradually  separates  into  two  halves,  each  of  which 
speedily  becomes  a  perfect  species  of  Desmidiacea. 

The  increase  by  conjugation,  observed  particularly  in 
Closterium  and  Cosmarium,  takes  place  thus :  two  fronds 
approach  each  other,  and  the  outer  cell-wall  of  each  splits 
and  throws  out  a  connecting-tube  which  joins  them  together. 
Through  this  tube  the  contents  of  one  cell  is  poured  into 
the  other,  and  mixing  with  the  endochrome  of  the  receiving- 
cell,  forms  a  body  called  sporangium,  which  is  afterwards 
set  free  by  the  breaking  up  of  the  parent  cell. 

Multiplication  by  zoospores  has  been  observed  in  Cosma- 
rium, Pediastrum,  and  many  othersf  The  endochrome 
divides  into  a  number  of  granular  particles  called  gonidia, 
which  escape  through  the  cell-wall,  and  develop  into  per- 
fect cells. 

Or  they  are  ciliated  and  have  a  spontaneous  movement, 
both  in  the  parent  cell  and  out  of  it,  when  they  are  called 
zoospores. 

CONFERVA. — ZYGNEMA. 

This  is  mounted  for  the  microscope,  as  an  example  of 
conjugation  amongst  the  Confer vacese. 

Confervacea3  are  those  plants  which  form  the  green  or 
brown  scum  on  ponds  and  ditches,  and  the  long  green, 
silky  threads,  that  float  in  running  water.  Most  beautiful 
are  their  ribbon-like  filaments  of  varied  pattern,  and  most 
useful  their  life  on  the  stagnant  water,  which  they  purify 
by  absorbing  the  noxious  gases,  and  giving  out  the  life- 
sustaining  oxygen. 

Looking  at  this  scum  for  the  first  time  will  probably 
surprise  us  as  much  as  anything.  It  does  seem  so  won- 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  53 

derful  that  what  we  have  passed  by  unheeded  for  so  many 
years,  or  even  turned  from  in  disgust,  should  be  so  very 
beautiful.  The  filaments  are  worked  by  the  hand  of  God 
in  such  varied  pattern,  that  every  pool  may  furnish  us  with 
a  new  specimen,  and  read  us  a  lesson  of  the  infinite  care 
that  has  been  bestowed  on  the  lowest  orders  of  creation. 

The  conjugation  of  Zygnema  resembles  that  of  Closterium, 
only  as  the  filament  is  long  and  divided  into  many  cells, 
every  cell  throws  out  a  connecting  tube,  and  one  filament 
completely  empties  itself  into  the  other,  remaining  colourless, 
whilst '  the  recipient  has  a  dark-green  star  of  condensed 
endochrome  in  every  division. 

ACHTLA   PROLIFERA. 

I  have  come  reluctantly  to  the  end  of  the  vegetable  slides, 
and  upon  each  have  said  so  little  of  all  that  there  was  to  say 
that  I  can  only  hope  my  few  words  may  prove  very  unsatis- 
factory, and  so  send  the  reader  to  better  works  and  to  the 
study  of  that  open  volume  which  lies  around  us,  the 
hieroglyphics  of  which  our  microscope  deciphers  for  us. 
Only  one  more  little  plant  I  will  mention :  it  cannot  be 
mounted,  but  you  may  raise  it  for  yourself  in  a  glass  of 
water  at  any  time.  It  is  a  parasitic  plant  on  dead  animal 
substances  in  water,  and  produces  the  zoospores  of  which  we 
have  been  speaking.  Throw  two  or  three  dead  flies  in  a 
glass  of  water,  and  in  a  few  days  they  will  be  covered  with 
a  cloudy  film  of  minute  colourless  filaments ;  that  is  the 
plant  A  clujla  prolifera. 

I  will  describe  what  I  saw  the  first  time  I  examined  it. 
I  found  one  day  in  a  small  glass  tank  a  dead  larva  of  some 
aquatic  insect,  covered  with  a  transparent  mould,  and  on 
examining  it  with  a  half-inch  object-glass,  saw  a  mass  of 
delicate  white  filaments.  Some  of  these  were  filled  with 
green  granules  in  constant  motion,  and  as  I  watched  them 
the  filament  under  observation  began  to  expand  into  a  club- 
shaped  head,  and  the  granules  to  form  into  small  angular 
bodies,  moving  slowly  round  and  round.  The  progress 
seemed  so  rapid,  that  I  took  out  my  watch  to  time  the 


54  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

changes,    which   astonished  me.      It   was   a  bright  July 
evening. 

20  min.  to  7.     The  angular  bodies  were  forming. 

15  min.  past  7.  The  gonidia,  or  zoospores,  as  I  should  call 
them,  were  becoming  oval. 

20  min.  past  7.  The  gonidia  were  in  violent  motion, 
revolving  and  bounding  against  the  end  of  the  cell. 

25  min.  past  7.  The  end  of  the  cell  contracted  and  elon- 
gated, then  suddenly  opened  like  a  beak,  and  out  rushed 
the  whole  multitude  of  little  zoospores,  merrily  swim- 
ming hither  and  thither,  evidently  ciliated,  and  always 
moving  the  small  end  foremost.  The  empty  cell  col- 
lapsed, and  I  forgot  it  in  watching  the  other  filaments, 
all  progressing  in  the  same  way.  The  spores  continued 
to  move  about  rather  more  slowly  for  nearly  half  an 
hour,  when  the  quasi  animal  life  seemed  to  cease,  and 
they  floated  away  to  germinate  upon  the  nearest 
decaying  substance. 

I  hope  you  will  prove  the  truth  of  what  I  write ;  it  will 
afford  much  pleasure  and  a  most  useful  lesson. 


PART    II. 

OBJECTS   FROM   THE   ANIMAL   KINGDOM. 


"  The  desire  which  tends  to  know 
The  works  of  God,  thereby  to  glorify 
The  great  Work -master,  leads  to  no  excess 
That  reaches  blame,  but  rather  merits  praise 
The  more  it  seems  excess ; 
For  wonderful  indeed  are  all  His  works, 
Pleasant  to  know,  and  worthiest  to  be  all 
Had  in  remembrance  alway  with  delight." — Milton. 


THE  slides  usually  prepared  from  the  animal  kingdom 
consist  of  insect  parts,  palates  of  Molluscs,  Zoophytes,  and 
miscellaneous  objects,  rather  difficult  to  classify,  since 
they  seem  to  be  mounted  chiefly  to  please  the  eye  of  the 
purchaser. 

The  demand  for  "  pretty  objects  "  has  been  caused  by  the 
absence  of  any  plan  for  the  proper,  use  of  the  microscope  ; 
but  now  that  we  begin  to  find  its  real  use,  and  appreciate 
its  value  as  an  educational  instrument,  the  optician  will 
have  a  better  selection  of  slides  on  sale,  and  each  object 
will  be  chosen  as  much  for  its  usefulness  as  for  its  beauty. 

There  is  a  class  of  slides  now  sold  by  several  opticians, 
which  deserves  especial  recommendation.  They  are  insects 
mounted  whole;  one  single  preparation  affording  material 
for  a  day's  study  at  least.  Instead  of  isolated  parts  be- 
longing to  unknown  insects,  we  have  the  perfect  body  of 
Fly  or  Beetle,  displaying  its  external  anatomy,  and  giving 
us  such  an  insight  into  its  structure  as  we  should  hardly 
acquire  with  much  reading  and  the  best-drawn  illustration. 

Take,  for  instance,  the  slide  of  Scatophaga,  or  common 
Dung-fly,  and  read  the  description  in  this  catalogue ;  or 
the  Telephorus  Beetle ;  and  compare  the  two  carefully  in  all 


56  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

their  parts ;  reading  at  the  same  time,  from  Cuvier,  or 
Westwood's  '  Introduction  to  Entomology/  the  generic 
characters  of  the  Coleoptera  and  Diptera,  and  the  young 
entomologist  will  have  received  a  lesson  never  to  be  forgotten. 

For  those  who  have  not  begun  the  study  of  natural 
history,  a  few  words  are  added  on  the  classification  of 
insects  generally,  without  which  some  descriptions  may  be 
unintelligible. 

Insects  are  so  called  from  the  word  in-secta,  their  bodies 
being  divided  into  many  distinct  segments.  They  are  a 
class  of  invertebrate  articulated  animals.  The  head  is 
always  distinct  and  furnished  with  antennae ;  the  body 
usually  consists  of  thirteen  segments ;  they  breathe  by 
means  of  trachea? ;  possess  a  nervous  system,  a  circulation 
of  blood,  and  a  digestive  apparatus  varying  with  the 
necessities  and  habits  of  the  species. 

According  to  Cuvier's  arrangement,  insects  are  divided 
into  twelve  orders.  The  first  four  orders  have  no  wings. 

1    -,»-.,  ,  Julus   or  Centipedes,  and 

1.  Mynopoda,      example  Woodlice 

2.  Thysanura  „  Lepisma,  or  Sugar-louse 

3.  Parasita  „  Pediculus  (Louse) 

4.  Suctoria  „  Pulex  (Flea) 

5.  Coleoptera  „  Beetles 

6.  Orthoptera  „  Grasshoppers,  Crickets 

7.  Hemiptera  „  Bugs,  Aphides 

8.  Neuroptera  „  Dragon-flies 

9.  Hymenoptera  „  Bees,  Wasps,  Ichneumons 

10.  Lepidoptera  „  Butterflies,  Moths 

11.  Strepsiptera  „  Stylops 

12.  Diptera  „  Flies 

The  objects  themselves  will  be  the  best  illustrations  of 
these  orders. 

Preparations  of  animal  tissues,  blood,  injected  respiratory 
and  digestive  organs,  and  other  objects  relative  to  the 
physiology  of  the  human  body,  are  reserved  for  a  separate 
pamphlet. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  57 

CHAPTER   I. 

OBJECTS    FROM   THE   ARACHNIDA. 
SPIDER'S  FOOT,  JAWS,  SPIXNARETS,  EYES,  EPIDERMIS. 


THIS  favourite  object  should  always  have  three  companions 
in  its  box — a  preparation  of  Spider's  eyes,  Spider's  jaws, 
and  Spider's  spinnarets, — therefore  I  shall  say  something 
of  each  of  these,  and  also  a  little  of  Spiders  themselves. 
We  are  so  familiar  with  them,  so  apt  to  dislike  them  in  the 
house  and  overlook  them  in  the  garden,  that  it  will  be  well 
to  learn  somewhat  of  their  history. 

Few  persons  realize  the  dignified  position  they  hold  in 
the  order  of  creation.  They  are  called  insects;  and  are 
certainly  not  considered  so  aristocratic- as  Butterflies,  or  so 
grand  as  the  great  Beetles  ;  perhaps  a  little  higher  than  the 
Fly  they  so  cunningly  ensnare.  Therefore  let  us  consider 
the  Spider  as  a  whole  before  we  examine  his  foot. 

TJie  Spider  is  not  an  insect.  It  ranks  higher  than  any 
insect,  no  matter  how  large  or  how  beautiful ;  and  this  on 
good  grounds.  In  all  God's  works  a  perfect  plan  and 
regular  order  are  established,  and  the  organization  of 
living  creatures  is  gradually  perfected,  from  the  lowest 
form  of  animal  life  in  the  simple  ciliated  monad,  up  to 
the  elaborate  anatomy  of  man.  Now  the  Spider  might  be 
an  insect  if  we  strictly  adhered  to  the  meaning  of  the  term 
in-secta  (divided  into  parts) ;  but  as  its  internal  anatomy  is 
more  perfect,  its  respiratory  apparatus,  its  circulation,  and 
mode  of  reproduction,  superior  to  those  in  any  of  the 
twelve  orders  of  insects,  the  Spiders  are  called 

ARACHNIDA, 

and  placed  above  them  in  natural  order. 

The  Arachnida  have  oval  or  round  bodies;  the  head, 
which  is  joined  to  the  thorax,  has  simple  eyes,  which  in 

4 


58  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

structure  more  nearly  resemble  the  animal  than  the  insect 
eye.  Sometimes  there  are  eight,  sometimes  six,  or  only 
two.  They  have  a  mouth  with  jaws  (maxillce),  a  tongue 
(Ugida),  remarkable  palpi,  and  frontal  claws  often  of  great 
magnitude.  But  the  nervous  system  is  the  great  distinction. 
The  organ  of  sensation,  which  is  the  brain  in  man  and 
animals,  is  a  series  of  knotted  nerves  called  ganglia  in  insects, 
from  which  proceed  nerves  to  all  parts  of  the  body.  The 
imperfect  insect,  such  as  a  Caterpillar,  has  more  ganglia 
than  the  perfect  butterfly.  And  whereas  the  insect  has 
generally  from  six  to  eight  or  ten  ganglia,  or  little  brains, 
in  diiferent  parts  of  its  body,  the  Spider  has  but  two,  and 
they  more  brain-like,  more  concentrated,  and  consequently 
of  a  higher  order. 

Then  again  as  to  the  circulation  :  we  know  that  in  all 
creatures  the  blood  is  the  life ;  it  is  the  fluid  which  nourishes 
all  parts  of  the  body.  Not  always  red;  it  may  be  white, 
or  yellow,  or  green  ;  but  it  is  blood,  and  constituted  more 
or  less  like  our  human  blood,  as  the  microscope  reveals. 
All  insects  have  a  heart  or  dorsal  vessel  which  pumps  out 
the  blood  (as  we  shall  see  explained  when  examining  the 
larvae  of  ephemera)  that  circulates  loosely  in  the  body, 
bathing  the  air  vessels  which  supply  it  with  oxygen ;  but  the 
Arachnida  have  a  true  heart ;  long,  indeed,  like  the  insect 
heart,  but  furnished  with  arteries  and  veins  which  give  it 
perfect  circulation.  This  raises  it  another  step  higher. 

The  respiratory  system  is  different  in  various  species  ; 
but  the  Spider  whose  foot  we  are  looking  at  had  lungs  or 
pulmonary  sacs,  with  two  or  four  breathing  orifices,  situated 
just  near  the  base  of  the  abdomen,  and  inside  those  sacs  a 
number  of  delicate  white  triangular  plates  which  aerated 
the  blood.  This  is  more  like  animal  respiration  than  the 
trachea  of  insects.  (See  Spiracles.) 

The  Arachnida  do  not  undergo  metamorphosis.  The 
female  lays  eggs,  making  very  pretty  cocoons  or  nests  for 
them,  and  the  young  Spiders  come  forth  perfect  from  the 
shell,  with  the  exception  of  the  two  fore  legs,  which  are 
not  always  developed  until  a  few  days  after  their  birth. 

And  if  we  read  any  good  work  on  the  Arachnida  we 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  59 

shall  not  fail  to  be  struck  with  the  intelligence  of  their 
habits  and  the  amount  of  their  instinct.  For  instance,  in 
the  structure  of  their  habitations,  one  species  (Clotho*) 
found  in  the  south  of  Europe  makes  a  beautiful  tent  in  the 
shape  of  a  cup,  festooned  at  the  edges,  with  the  outer  cover- 
ing of  the  finest  texture,  like  taffeta,  and  weaves  a  second 
apartment,  of  still  softer  material,  for  her  young.  In  this 
inner  room,  kept  scrupulously  clean,  she  hangs  five  or  six 
little  bags,  wherein  her  eggs  are  laid  enveloped  in  fine 
down.  When  she  goes  in  and  out  of  her  tent  she  lifts  the 
edge  of  a  festoon  and  drops  it  again.  The  Mygale  Spider, 
whose  nest  you  may  see  in  the  British  Museum,  brought 
from  Jamaica,  is  made  of  the  hardest  clay,  having  a  trap- 
door fitting  most  exactly,  and  hinged  with  stout  layers  of 
silk  ;  the  use  of  which  she  knows  so  well,  that  if  it  is  half- 
opened  by  an  intruder,  she  will  pull  it  strongly  inwards  to 
defend  herself. 

The  cunning  and  amusing  way  in  which  the  Hunting 
Spiders  catch  their  prey — creeping  under  a  twig  or  window- 
ledge  as  gently  as  a  deer-stalker,  lying  motionless  for  a 
while,  moving  as  the  Fly  moves,  turning  with  incredible 
swiftness  round  and  round,  ever  keeping  the  prey  in  sight, 
until,  quite  certain  of  its  being  within  reach,  they  spring 
like  a  Tiger,  as  fierce  and  as  unerring  in  their  leap. 

We  may  watch  these  ourselves  in  our  garden  on  a  warm 
spring  day,  e.g.  a  little  black  and  white  striped  Spider, 
called  Salticus,  which,  before  it  leaps,  cautiously  fixes  a 
good  strong  thread  to  the  wall  in  case  of  a  fall. 

Again,  we  may  see  high  instinct  and  deep  affection  in 
those  vagrant  Spiders  of  the  wood,  Lycosse,  which  hunt 
with  their  cocoon  of  eggs  so  firmly  clasped  to  the  body 
that  they  will  die  rather  than  part  with  it. 

A  wise  little  Spider  of  our  neighbourhood — its  name  I 
do  not  know — lives  on  the  ponds  and  ditches  of  Otmoor, 
and  spins  a  web  round  a  kind  of  raft  of  Lemna,  with  a  stem, 
of  grass  or  a  little  twig — to  make  it  stronger,  I  suppose — 
and  floats  about  on  this,  pouncing  on  any  half-drowned  or 
newly-hatched  Fly  which  may  come  within  its  reach. 

*  Uroctea. 


60  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

Last  of  all  that  I  shall  mention, — as  paper  would  fail  me 
if  I  noticed  all  our  spider  friends, — is  the  Diving  Spider  of 
our  aquariums  (Argyroneta),  common  near  London,  rare  in 
many  parts  of  England :  which  has  been  taught  to  make  a 
diving-bell  for  the  work  which  God  has  appointed  her.  The 
water-world  requires  its  avengers  to  keep  down  the  fast- 
multiplying  creatures  therein,  and  the  Argyroneta  aquatica 
is  one  of  them.  True  her  gill-like  lungs  enable  her  to 
breathe  under  water;  but  still  she  requires  more  oxygen  than 
it  affords,  and  comes  up  about  four  times  an  hour  for  a 
supply  of  air.  This  she  conveys  to  a  silken  house  she  has 
previously  spun  amidst  the  weeds  in  still  water,  and  which 
we  see  shining  like  a  little  globe  of  silver ;  the  Spider  half 
inside,  her  breathing  organs  immersed  in  the  air,  and  her 
head  outside,  watching  for  a  tiny  Beetle  or  a  little  Cyclops. 
For  a  more  detailed  account  of  the  Water  Spider,  see 
'  Kirby  and  Spence's  Entomology/  or  the  smaller  work  called 
'  Insect  Architecture.'  I  only  mention  these  facts  to  prove 
the  reasonableness  of  the  high  position  the  Arachnida  hold, 
and  the  unreasonableness  of  the  neglect  and  dislike  they 
often  meet  with.  I  bring  them  forward  because  the  whole 
Spider  is  to  be  purchased  beautifully  prepared,  and  its 
external  parts  may  thus  be  studied ;  also  because  the  comb 
of  the  foot  is  in  every  collection,  and  it  is  more  interesting 
when  we  have  some  further  knowledge  of  the  body  to 
which  it  once  belonged. 


The  Spider's  legs  have  a  different  formation  from  those 
of  insects.  Each  has  seven  joints ;  the  two  upper  ones 
form  a  kind  of  haunch ;  the  next  is  the  femur ;  the  fourth 
and  the  fifth  are  tibiae ;  the  first  or  second  according  to 
the  species,  much  the  longest ;  the  last  two  are  the  tarsi, 
less  distinct  than  those  of  insects,  but  remarkably  furnished 
with  toothed  claws  called  the  combs.  In  our  Garden 
Spider,  the  Epeira,  there  are  no  less  than  five  of  these 
combs,  besides  three  upper  and  untoothed  claws,  to  each 
foot ;  also  a  strong  moveable  spine  or  hook  at  the  joint  of 
each  tarsus. 


Feet  of  Insects,  Petal  of  Geranium,  etc. 


Plate  3. 


1.  Foot  of  Spider,  magnified  18  diameters.  2.  Claws  of  Spider,  magd.  K'-O  cliams. 

3    Foot  of  Fly,  magd.  20  diams.        4.  Foot  of  Boatfly,  magd.  4  cliams. 

5.  Boatfly.        6.  Boatfly  floating.         7.  Boatfly  on  the  wing.        8.  Petal  of  Geranium. 

Piece  of  Geranium  Petal,  magd.  8  diam<.         10.  Minute  portion  of  Petal,  magd.  150  diams. 

'ollen  of  clarkia  pulchella,  mag.  100  diameters.     12.  Pollen  of  Crown-imperial,  mug.  100  diams. 

13.  Grain  of  the  above,  magd.  300  diams.          14.   Pollen  of  Salvia  paten?,  magd.  ICO  diams. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  61 

The  use  of  these  combs  is  for  cleaning  itself  and  its  web, 
the  Spider  being  a  most  tidy  creature.  It  has  been  seen 
to  spend  an  hour  or  more  in  scraping  the  delicate  threads 
of  its  web,  when  dust  or  soot  had  collected  on  them ;  and 
if  they  were  too  thoroughly  in  crusted  with  dirt,  these  little 
claws  broke  the  thread,  rolled  it  up,  and  threw  it  away. 

The  combs  have  from  fifteen  to  seventeen  teeth,  necessary 
for  the  swiftly  running  Spider  when  crossing  the  fragile 
web  or  twisting  the  silken  bands  that  form  its  dwelling  or 
its  snare. 

Whoever  has  patiently  watched  a  Garden  or  a  House 
Spider  spinning  its  web,  will  have  noticed  how  with  these 
claws  it  shakes  and  tries  the  strength  of  each  supporting 
line,  and  is  able  to  cling  to  it  or  roll  it  up  by  means  of  these 
handy  little  combs,  as  well  as  to  regulate  the  issue  of  the 
threads  from  the  spinnarets, — as  it  were  reeling  it  off. 

SPIDER'S  SPINNARETS. 

These  are  not  always  well  prepared.  They  are  difficult 
to  keep  in  position,  but  you  could  see  them  well  by  catching 
a  good-sized  Spider,  and  examining  it  as  an  opaque  object. 
At  the  end  of  the  abdomen  you  will  find  four  or  five  teats 
or  spinnarets,  pierced  with  an  immense  number  of  minute 
holes,  from  which  a  viscid  fluid,  a  kind  of  glue,  exudes  at 
the  will  of  the  animal,  and  is  drawn  out  as  a  fine  thread.  In 
reality,  each  of  those  fine  lines  which  we  can  scarcely  see  is 
composed  of  thousands  of  threadlets,  for  there  are  often 
1,000  orifices  in  each  teat.  The  fluid,  first  uniting  from  all 
these  in  one  twist,  descends  about  the  tenth  of  an  inch,  and 
then  twining  with  the  three  or  four  others,  it  becomes  a 
cable  in  structure  and  in  strength. 

The  formation  of  the  web  would  be  too  long  a  process  to 
describe  here.  Only  one  fact  I  add ;  which  is,  that  the 
Spider  makes  two  different  kinds  of  thread,  and  every  web 
is  fashioned  of  these  different  materials. 

Take  one  of  those  common  garden  geometric  webs,  and 
throw  a  little  fine  dust  against  it.  Look  closely ;  you  will 
see  that  the  dust  adheres  to  the  cross  lines  which  form  the 
circles,  but  not  to  the  radii  or  supporting  lines.  This  is 


62  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

because  the  Spider  secretes  a  viscid  matter,  which  she 
deposits  in  little  globules  all  along  each  circle,  and  which 
acts  as  bird-lime  in  securing  the  prey.  In  one  web  of 
moderate  size  not  less  than  87,360  of  these  globules  have 
been  counted ;  and  yet  the  time  occupied  in  its  whole 
construction  was  only  about  forty  minutes. 

I  often  think  that  invalids,  or  mechanics,  or  town-people, 
who  cannot  enjoy  many  of  our  country  pleasures,  or  learn 
God's  wonderful  ways  in  the  instinct  He  has  bestowed  upon 
our  humble  fellow-creatures,  might  find  much  profit,  much 
amusement,  if  they  only  knew  a  little  more  about  the  flies 
on  their  window-pane,  and  the  spiders  on  the  wall.  And 
those  careful  housewives  who  so  diligently  sweep  away  this 
beautiful  work,  might  leave  just  one  sometimes,  as  a  little 
page  from  God's  Book  of  Creation,  which,  if  rightly  studied, 
would  lead  to  happier  thoughts  than  come  with  the  over- 
carefulness  about  household  matters. 


I  have  said  already  that  the  eye  of  a  Spider  is  of  a  higher 
type  than  the  compound  eye  of  insects.  It  has  a  single 
arched  cornea,  a  spherical  lens,  and  a  concave  vitreous  body, 
with  a  cup-shaped  retina  and  a  layer  of  pigment  cor- 
responding to  the  choroid  membrane  of  the  animal  eye.  It 
shines  in  the  dark  like  a  cat's  eye,  and  evidently  can  see  in 
the  night  as  in  the  day.  This  is  very  remarkable,  and  de- 
notes higher  organization  .than  we  find  even  in  the  aggregate 
lens  of  a  Butterfly's  eye. 

The  position  of  these  eyes — for  the  Spider  has  six  or 
eight — is  admirably  varied  for  their  different  habits  and 
pursuits. 

The  Garden  Spider,  Epeira,  has  two  very  large  red  ones  in 
front  and  two  behind,  forming  a  square ;  two  on  each  side 
almost  confluent. 

The  House  Spider  has  a  double  row  of  four  each  arching 
the  forehead. 

The  Hunters  have  two  fierce  large  eyes  in  front,  four 
little  ones  just  beneath,  and  two  some  distance  behind,  like 
watchmen  or  an  "  arriere-garde."  Whilst  the  common 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  63 

Phalangia,  or  Harvestmen,  which  run  always  on  the  ground 
amongst  moss  and  leaves,  and  are  of  the  lowest  rank  in  the 
society  of  Spiders,  have  but  two  eyes,  seated  on  a  tubercle 
or  watch-tower  on  their  back. 

There  are  seventeen  different  positions  at  least  in  the 
eyes  of  those  Spiders  most  common  to  us. 


The  jaws  or  chelifers  of  the  Spider — properly  speaking, 
the  mandibles — are  various  in  form,  but  always  tremendous 
weapons,  not  only  from  their  size  and  sharpness  and  the 
serrated  edges  and  spines  with  which  they  are  beset,  but 
also  because  the  upper  joint  contains  a  little  sac  of  intense 
poison,  which  is  emitted  through  a  minute  orifice  in  the 
next  joint,  and  effectually  kills  whatever  insect  is  bitten. 

SPIDER'S  PALPI. 

The  palpi,  or  feelers,  serve  as  organs  of  taste  and  touch, 
and  also  as  distinguishing  marks  of  the  sex.  The  male 
Spider  has  very  large  knobbed  palpi,  by  which  it  is  easily 
recognised. 

EPIDERMIS    OF.  SPIDER. 

The  skin  of  the  Garden  Spider  (Epeira)  is  frequently 
mounted,  and  displays  very  beautiful  undulating  lines, 
surrounding  the  roots  of  the  hairs.  These  concentric 
markings  arise  from  the  existence  of  folds  in  the  inner 
membrane,  beneath  which  lies  a  layer  of  pigment  cells,  to 
which  the  variegated  appearance  and  beautiful  colours  of 
the  Arachnida  are  owing. 

The  skin  is  merely  washed,  dried,  and  mounted  in 
balsam. 


64  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 


CHAPTER   II. 

INSECT      PARTS. 

TONGUES     OF      INSECTS. 
TONGUE     OR     PROBOSCIS     OF     HIVE     BEE. 

THIS  is  a  common  and  favourite  object  in  all  collections, 
and  very  beautiful ;  but  it  should  always  be  one  of  at  least 
five  others  in  the  insect  division,  in  order  rightly  to  appre- 
ciate and  enjoy  the  exhibition  it  affords  of  adaptation  for  a 
particular  purpose. 

A  moderate  power  gives  a  view  of  the  whole  tongue,  so 
called,  which  in  truth  consists  of  several  parts.  The  habits 
of  the  Hive  Bee  are  well  known,  and  need  not  here  be 
described ;  but  it  is  worth  observing  how  beautifully  this 
organ  is  adapted  for  gathering  the  honey  which  lurks  in 
the  deep  nectaries  of  such  flowers  as  the  Columbine  or 
Honeysuckle. 

Those  strong-looking  maxillae  are  chiefly  used  as  pro- 
tecting sheaths  for  the  delicately  fringed  and  jointed  ligula 
or  tongue,  which  is  stretched  forth,  having  two  feelers, 
called  labial  palpi,  one  on  each  side.  These  palpi  are  jointed 
at  the  tips,  and  used  for  steadying  the  proboscis  in  the 
flower-cup  as  it  laps  up  the  sweetness  there.  The  ligula 
has  forty  joints,  or  more ;  the  number  varies  with  the 
species  ;  you  will  easily  see  them  with  an  inch  lens.  They 
render  it  perfectly  flexible,  as  it  sweeps  round  both  concave 
and  convex  surfaces ;  and  with  a  tremulous  lapping  motion 
the  fluid  is  drawn  up  along  the  hairy  channel  into  the 
opening  valve  which  protects  its  throat.  There  is  a  knob 
or  kind  of  button  at  the  tip,  which  has  been  falsely  supposed 
to  be  a  perforated  sucker.  The  tip  of  the  tongue  is  simply 
cartilaginous,  but  the  base  is  hollow  and  capable  of  inflation 
to  a  considerable  size.  In  this  hollow  part  the  nectar  drawn 
from  the  flowers  is  collected  previous  to  its  passing  into  the 
honey  stomach. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  65 

If  possible,  the  jaws  or  mandibles  of  the  Bee  should  be 
mounted  with  the  tongue,  to  show  the  instruments  with 
which  they  fashion  their  waxen  cells,  seize  their  enemies, 
destroy  the  drones,  &c.  The  mandibles  vary  in  form  and 
power  with  the  different  necessities  of  the  species.  The 
Hive  Bee  has  simple  spathulate  jaws;  the  wild  Humble 
Bee  has  toothed  and  stronger  ones ;  as  also  the  Carder  Bee, 
Mason  Bee,  and  Carpenter  Bee. 

A  comparative  view  of  the  tongues  of  these  Bees  would 
be  most  interesting,  and  for  those  who  like  to  make  a 
collection  I  will  give  the  easiest  way  of  preparing  them  for 
observation. 

Soak  the  heads  for  about  a  fortnight  in  liq.  potassaB, 
to  soften  the  skin  and  dissolve  the  fatty  substance  within, 
which  prevents  the  parts  from  being  distinctly  seen.  Then 
wash  them  in  water,  and  press  them  flat  between  two  pieces 
of  glass  until  quite  dry ;  drop  a  little  turpentine  upon  them 
and  let  them  soak  in  it  for  a  few  days,  when  they  will 
mount  beautifully  in  Canada  balsam.  If  bubbles  of  air 
remain  in  the  tissue,  lay  the  tongue  on  a  glass  slide,  and 
cover  it  with  a  piece  of  thin  glass;  take  a  camel-hair 
pencil  and  drop  turpentine  between  the  glasses,  which 
must  now  be  suffered  to  boil  over  the  spirit  lamp,  and  the 
air  will  rush  out  in  bubbles ;  keep  supplying  turpentine 
until  the  object  is  perfectly  transparent,  then  quickly  and 
gently  apply  the  balsam. 

TONGUE    OF    WASP. 

How  very  different  this  is  from  the  tongue  of  the  Bee ! 
Instead  of  the  long  and  slender  ligula,  here  is  a  short 
broad  two-lobed  membrane,  far  more  useful  to  the  Wasp, 
who  does  not  trouble  himself  to  collect  the  honey  he  wrill 
eat  ready-made  out  of  the  comb,  but,  who  prefers  rasping 
rapidly  away  the  soft  ripeness  of  the  Peach,  the  Apricot,  or 
the  Plum  ;  or  gnawing  the  juicy  meat  at  the  shambles,  or 
sucking  out  the  life  of  a  fat  Fly.  This  broad  flat  membrane 
— how  handy  it  must  be  in  making  those  curious  paper  nests 
wherein  they  rear  their  young ;  a  trowel  and  a  smoothing 
iron,  a  spoon  and  shovel,  as  may  be  required ;  and  with 


66  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

those  two  brushes  on  either  side  ever  keeping  it  clean  and 
unclogged  for  its  work ;  whilst  those  four  feelers,  the  labial 
palpi  and  maxillary  palpi,  ceaselessly  vibrate  over  all,  to 
ascertain  the  fitness  of  food  or  material. 

There  are  many  species  of  Wasps ;  and  some  of  them, 
especially  foreign  ones,  feed  more  upon  honey  than  do  our 
common  Wasps,  and  their  lingulse  are  therefore  modified 
for  their  wants,  being  longer  and  sometimes  three-lobed, 
with  a  variation  also  on  the  mandibles  or  outer  jaws. 

These  would  make  a  very  interesting  collection  prepared 
like  the  Bee's  head. 

BUTTERFLY'S  TONGUE  OR  PROBOSCIS. 

This  is  a  beautiful  piece  of  mechanism ;  a  long  elastic 
coil  which  the  hovering  Butterfly  throws  lightly  into  the 
recesses  of  the  deepest  corolla.  It  cannot,  like  the  Bee, 
dive  down  into  the  Honeysuckle  or  Campanula,  or  passion- 
ately tear  open  the  nectary  of  a  Foxglove.  Its  beautiful 
wings  cannot  fold  so  closely  as  to  let.  it  creep  into  the 
Salvia-cup  or  Lily-bell.  Therefore  its  Creator  gave  it  this 
excellent  instrument  adapted  exactly  to  its  wants.  In  the 
living  insect  it  is  coiled  closely  to  its  head,  so  as  to  be 
scarcely  visible,  and  not  at  all  to  impede  its  movements. 
When  unfolded,  we  perceive  that  it  consists  of  two  long 
tubes  hooked  together  most  curiously  by  minute  teeth, 
which  on  either  side  are  inserted  into  little  pits  between 
each  row  of  teeth.  Moreover  each  of  these  tiny  teeth  has 
a  second  tooth,  which  forms  a  deep  notch,  and  prevents  the 
accidental  unhooking  of  this  double  tube.  Then  at  the 
edge  of  each  tube  there  are  seventy-four  little  barrel- 
shaped  bodies,  or  papillae,  considered  to  be  the  organs  of 
taste,  and  inside  each  tube,  which  you  may  observe  is 
delicately  striated,  there  are  spiral  vessels  or  tracheae  con- 
nected with  the  larger  tracheae  in  the  head.  Now  the 
fluid  does  not  pass  up  the  interior  of  this  antlia,  which 
is  its  proper  name,  but  is  drawn  upwards  along  that 
channel  which  is  formed  by  the  union  of  the  two  tubes. 
The  papillae  are  best  observed  near  the  tip,  and  with  a  high 
power. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  67 

PROBOSCIS   OR   TONGUE   OF   BLOW-FLY. 

This  is  a  true  proboscis,  but  not  so  well  seen  alone  if  all 
its  parts  and  uses  are  to  be  considered ;  you  should  have 
the  proboscis  of  a  Gnat  and  of  a  Tabanus  or  House-fly 
rightly  to  understand  the  whole. 

We  see  the  little  House-fly  busy  in  our  sugar-basin,  or 
the  Blow- fly,  unwelcome  in  our  larder.  We  feel  the  tire- 
some tickling  on  a  hot  summer's  day  when  they  gambol 
over  our  hands  and  face ;  but  we  know  not  how  beautiful 
is  that  little  mischievous  tongue.  Here  it  is  spread  out, 
the  simplest  form  having  a  broad  fleshy  lobe  which  is 
striated  with  spiral  fibres,  by  which  it  obtains  a  sucking 
movement  and  draws  up  the  juices  it  feeds  on.  Little  short 
stiff  hairs  are  set  around  it,  and  these  are  what  do  us 
mischief  in  rasping  off  the  polish  of  our  book-covers,  and 
causing  the  irritation  to  our  skin. 

PROBOSCIS    OF    TABANUS. 

This  is  the  more  complicated  proboscis  of  the  Tabanus, 
or  Horse-fly.  Who  does  not  know  how  it  torments  our 
cattle,  and  the  carriage  horse  in  particular,  in  a  dusty  drive 
through  the  country  ?  A  large  brown  Fly,  with  variegated 
wings,  and  such  magnificent  eyes  !  She  is  easily  caught ; 
for  when  she  fixes  on  the  horse  and  tastes  the  warm  blood, 
her  whole  attention  is  given  to  the  feast.  I  say  she,  be- 
cause the  male  Tabanus  is  found  harmlessly  hovering  over 
flowers,  and  loves  the  haunts  of  the  Honey  Bee :  his  mouth 
has  no  lancets,  whereas  the  female  is  supplied  with  very 
powerful  instruments  of  assault. 

The  head  should  always  be  mounted  with  the  proboscis, 
which  greatly  increases  the  interest  of  the  slide ;  because, 
although  the  eyes  lose  in  preparation  their  gorgeous  colour- 
ing of  green,  purple  and  gold,  in  zigzag  bands  across  the 
facets,  yet  the  delicate  network  remains,  and  shows  the  4,000 
meshes,  which  in  life  each  contained  an  eye.  As  is  the 
case  with  many  of  the  Diptera,  the  eyes  of  the  female  are 
parted  by  a  narrow  band.  Beneath  the  eyes,  near  the 
mouth,  are  the  antennse,  which  are  supposed  to  be  organs 
of  hearing,  as  they  certainly  are  of  feeling.  Six-jointed 


68  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

these  are ;  the  first  and  second  bristly,  the  third  is  very 
long,  and  the  last  three  very  short.  It  is  important  to 
observe  these  things,  as  the  shape  of  one  joint  in  the  an- 
tennse  will  determine  the  species.  In  this  very  case,  if  we 
were  examining  the  large  and  true  Tabanus  bovinus,  we 
should  see  a  very  different  third  joint. 

Next  let  us  examine  the  mouth. 

That  long  and  broad  membrane  is  called  the  labium. 
Those  lines  at  the  inner  edge  of  the  two  lobes  are  spiral 
muscular  fibre,  which  enable  it  to  lap  or  draw  up  the  fluid 
it  feeds  on  ;  and  those  lancets  are  instead  of  jaws,  or  rather 
are  modifications  of  the  mandibles  and  maxillse,  which  are 
the  inner  and  outer  jaws  of  insects.  These  lancets  pierce 
the  skin,  and  the  labium  sucks  the  blood  of  the  horse.  If 
the  slide  has  the  head  of  Tabanus  bovinus,  and  not  the  com- 
mon Tabanus  pluviatilis,  also  called  Hsemotopota,  or  "  blood- 
drinking,"  the  head  will  be  armed  with  a  strong  pair  of 
mandibles  besides  the  lancets.  The  larvae  of  these  flies 
live  in  the  earth — long  grey  footless  .grubs,  feeding  on 
decayed  vegetables. 

PROBOSCIS   OF    GNAT. 

Here  is  another  of  our  little  tormentors,  and  a  female 
Diptera  also ;  for  the  male  Gnat  dances  gaily  in  the  sun- 
shine with  his  beautiful  plumed  head,  and  has  not  by  any 
means  so  well-developed  a  mouth.  He  does  not  suck  blood, 
and  probably  sips  a  little  nectar  from  flowers  or  the  dew 
upon  the  leaves  in  the  short  time  he  has  to  live :  the  busi- 
ness of  his  life  is  to  choose  a  mate  and  die.  The  female 
Gnat  lives  longer,  and  is  very  bloodthirsty.  Here  observe 
a  long  fleshy  lip,  or  labium,  which  is  the  sheath  containing 
two  mandibles,  two  maxillae,  one  labium,  one  ligula  or 
tongue.  They  may  not  all  be  visible  on  the  slide,  as  some 
may  remain  inside  the  sheath,  and  some  may  be  broken  off, 
they  are  so  very  delicate ;  but  if  perfect  it  would  show  all 
these.  The  mandibles  are  finely  toothed  like  a  saw,-  but 
you  require  a  quarter-inch  glass  to  see  this  well.  The 
ligula  is  shaped  like  a  spear-head.  The  stiff  horny  labium  is 
pointed  like  a  needle.  When  the  Gnat  pierces  the  skin, 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  69 

the  two  serrated  mandibles  work  rapidly  up  and  down,  the 
sheath  folds  backward,  the  pressure  of  the  lancets  causes  a 
little  poison-bag,  situated  at  the  base  of  the  proboscis,  to 
emit  one  drop  of  acrid  matter,  and  when  the  little  creature 
has  sucked  our  life-blood,  and  her  small  body  is  distended 
and  crimsoned  with  her  draught,  she  flies  off  like  a  winged 
ruby  in  the  sunlight,  that  little  poison-drop  rankling  in  the 
wound  and  causing  our  after  uneasiness  and  irritation.  It 
is  worth  the  slight  annoyance,  however,  to  watch  the  process 
of  her  feast.  With  a  pocket  lens  we  can  see  the  working 
down  of  the  lancets,  and  the  up-flowing  of  the  blood  into 
her  stomach. 

The  shrill  buzz  of  the  Gnat,  like  a  fairy  clarion,  is  peculiar 
to  the  female,  and  only  heard  when  she  is  bloodthirsty. 
Her  delicate  wings  then  vibrate  3,000  times  in  a  second, 
and  are  supposed  to  cause  this  sound  by  the  friction  of  their 
bases  against  her  body.  Her  eyes,  which  quite  cover  her 
head,  and  the  long  fourteen-jointed  antenna  weaving  to  and 
fro,  make  her  a  beautiful  object,  in  spite  of  her  unpleasant 
propensities. 

PKOBOSCIS    OF    ASILTTS. 

The  Asilus  is  one  of  the  Diptera  (Flies) — the  largest  and 
fiercest  of  them — most  frequent  in  sandy  situations.  They 
flit  about  in  the  hot  sunshine,  pouncing  upon  all  smaller 
flies — Beetles  and  Hymenoptera,  Ichneumon  flies,  &c.— 
holding  them  between  their  fore  legs,  and  plunging  their 
sharp  lancets  and  fleshy  tongue  into  the  softest  part  of  their 
prey.  The  colour  of  these  flies  is  mostly  tawny,  gold- 
coloured,  or  reddish-yellow ;  the  wings  finely-veined  and 
clouded  at  the  edge ;  the  body  long  and  narrow.  The 
larva  lives  in  the  earth :  it  has  twelve  segments,  and 
changes  to  a  spiny  pupa,  from  whence  the  Fly  emerges  in 
June. 

PROBOSCIS   OF    EMPIS-FLT. 

The  Empis  is  often  called  the  Snipe-fly,  from  its  remark- 
able labrum,  which  really  resembles  a  Snipe's  beak.  When 
at  rest  it  is  folded  close  to  the  breast,  but  very  frequently 


70  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

is  seen  transfixing  the  body  of  some  poor  smaller  fly  which 
the  Empis  is  greedily  sucking.  The  Empidae  are  generally 
small  black  flies,  and  there  are  many  species  of  them. 
They  are  more  fully  described  with  the  slide  of  Empis 
stercorea ;  also  the  peculiar  veining  of  their  wings. 

PEOBOSCIS   OF   DIOCTEIA, 

one  of  the  Asilidse,  flies  which  inhabit  meadows,  trees  and 
bushes,  feeding  on  lesser  flies,  and  more  common  than  the 
true  Asilus.  They  are  usually  black  and  shining,  and  carry 
their  antennae  very  fiercely  erect.  The  head  should  be 
mounted  in  profile  to  show  the  tubercle  upon  which  the 
antennae  are  seated,  five-jointed  and  porrect,  close  to  each 
other  at  the  base  and  diverging  outward.  The  proboscis 
stands  out  almost  horizontally. 

HEAD    OF    CONOPS. 

This  is  a  pretty  black  and  yellow  Fly,  frequenting  flowers, 
having  a  bright  triangular  spot  on  the  top  of  the  head. 
The  thorax  with  two  yellow  scapulae,  and  the  abdomen  is 
banded  black  and  yellow.  The  remarkable  part  of  the  head 
is  a  singular  proboscis  curved  suddenly  upwards  ;  a  labrum 
notched  at  the  tip,  arched  above  and  hollow  beneath  ; 
labium  bilobed  and  slightly  hairy,  with  three  shallow 
transverse  furrows  at  the  tip.  The  antennae  should  be  well 
displayed,  for  their  structure  alone  would  determine  the 
species,  and  therefore  furnish  a  useful  lesson  on  the  absolute 
necessity  of  minute  observation,  if  we  wish  truly  to  learn 
and  enjoy  the  insect  world. 

The  antennae  of  Conops  are  about  as  long  as  the  head, 
fiercely  seated  on  a  tubercle,  and  have  seven  joints  ;  the  first, 
short  and  slightly  hairy,  forming  an  angle  with  the  second, 
which  is  much  longer  and  rather  club-shaped  :  the  third 
is  seated  on  the  second  like  a  cone,  and  the  fourth  is  very 
small ;  so  is  the  fifth,  and  the  others  are  like  little  spines  ; 
nevertheless  they  are  seven  in  all.  The  eyes  are  prominent 
and  oblong  ;  but  the  eye  of  the  Fly  is  particularly  described 
in  the  head  of  Rhingia. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  71 

HEAD    OF    RHINGIA,    OR    SYRPHUS. 

This  beautiful  preparation  is  the  one  I  have  chosen  for 
drawing  particular  attention  to  the  eye  of  the  Fly.  That 
fine  delicate  lace,  now  perfectly  transparent,  is  the  skeleton 
or  framework  in  which  were  set  four  thousand  perfect  organs 
of  sight,  which  we  call  the  eye  of  a  Fly.  That  outer  mem- 
brane, which  is  all  that  is  now  left,  is  the  cornea ;  it  was 
lined  with  an  intense  black  pigment,  excepting  one  tiny 
spot  in  the  centre  of  each  facet,  through  which  the  light 
was  admitted.  Behind  the  pigment  was  a  broad  zone, 
orange-coloured  and  black ;  then  a  second  zone,  deep  blue 
or  black ;  then  the  optic  ganglion,  gathering  all  the  fila- 
ments of  each  eye  into  one  knot — the  brain. 

The  brain  of  insects  is  not  a  solid  mass,  or  great  ganglion, 
like  the  brain  of  animals ;  but  the  medium  of  communica- 
tion between  insects  and  the  external  world,  is  a  nervous 
system  consisting  of  two  medullary  threads  or  cords,  and  a 
series  of  knots  or  ganglia  placed  at  intervals  throughout 
the  body. 

Larva3  have  usually  two  of  these  ganglia  to  each  segment 
of  the  body.  The  perfect  insect  has  fewer ;  but  the  first 
ganglion,  as  in  the  Fly,  always  sends  out  the  nerves  of  the 
eyes,  tongue,  maxillse,  mandibles,  and  antenna?.  Therefore 
we  understand  how  the  organs  of  sight  are  united  in  the 
head  of  a  Fly  upon  the  first  ganglion  or  brain.  And  whilst 
each  eye  receives  a  perfect  image  of  the  object  before  it,  one 
single  impression  may  be  conveyed  to  its  possessor. 

This  head  of  Rhingia  has  also  a  very  beautiful  tongue, 
long  and  slender,  lobed  and  edged  with  spiral  fibre,  capable 
of  great  extension  to  accommodate  the  habits  of  the  Fly. 

The  Rhingia  campestris,  or  Rostrata,  is  so  called  from 
its  projecting  horny  beak.  It  is  a  very  pretty  Fly  com- 
mon in  woods  and  gardens  during  the  summer ;  remarkable 
from  its  hovering  like  a  Humming-bird  over  the  flowers, 
and  darting  suddenly  into  them,  sucking  the  honey-drop 
with  this  long  and  slender  ligula,  and  then  out  again  with 
a  swift  jerking  flight  not  very  easily  followed.  Its  body 
is  a  dull  red ;  the  wings  finely  veined,  like  all  its  family, 
the  Syrphidse. 


72  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

HEAD  OF  DRONE-FLY,  OR  HELOPHILUS. 

This  so  nearly  resembles  the  Rhingia  that  little  need  be 
added  in  explanation,  except  of  the  fly  itself,  which  is  one 
of  the  Syrphidee,  nearly  related  to  the  Rhingia.  The  Helo- 
philus  is  that  large  black  and  yellow  fly  so  common  in  the 
autumn  on  Michaelmas  Daisies,  often  mistaken  for  a  Wasp, 
as  it  makes  a  loud  humming  noise  and  is  very  intent  upon 
its  feast.  It  passes  through  a  greater  change  than  most  of 
the  fly  tribe ;  for  it  lived  and  fed  in  the  foulest  sewer  as  a 
rat- tailed  larva  which  is  yery  curious  in  its  manner  of 
breathing.  This  larva  has  a  long  retractile  tail,  with  the 
action  of  a  telescope,  capable  of  immense  extension  to  reach 
the  surface  of  the  water  or  mud  for  air.  The  body  being 
very  transparent,  the  tracheal  vessel  is  distinctly  seen  in  a 
wavy  line  the  whole  length  of  the  tail. 

HEAD    OF    ERISTALIS, 

differs  only  from  Helophilus  in  having  a  black  hairy  body, 
more  like  a  Bee.     The  antennae  are  very  beautiful. 

HEAD    OF    TIPULA. 

This  favourite  and  beautiful  preparation  is  the  head  of 
our  familiarly  called  Daddy-long-legs.  The  colour  adds  to 
the  beauty  of  the  lacework  eye,  and  the  fine  antennae,  simple 
yet  varied  in  the  length  of  the  joints,  which  are  each 
slightly  hairy.  The  palpi  have  four  joints,  and  bend  over 
the  broad  fleshy  proboscis,  in  which  large  trachea  are 
distinctly  seen.  These  Tipula?  are  very  destructive  in  the 
grub  state.  The  female  deposits  her  eggs  in  deep  burrows 
by  means  of  a  long  ovipositor,  consisting  of  four  pieces  ; 
two  of  them  bore  like  an  auger  the  required  hole  in  the 
earth,  and  the  other  two  join  and  conduct  the  egg  to  its 
appointed  place.  When  the  larva  hatches  it  has  two  short 
horns  on  its  head,  several  fleshy  conical  appendages  on  the 
abdomen,  and  two  very  strong  mandibles  working  against 
two  horny  convex  dentated  plates.  Very  destructive  are 
they  to  the  farmer's  grass  land,  often  destroying  hundreds 
of  acres  in  England  and  France.  The  more,  therefore,  of 
these  beautiful  heads  that  are  thus  prepared  the  better. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  73 


HEAD    OF    LIHNOBIA. 

This  is  essentially  like  the  head  of  Tipula.  I  need  only 
say  that  Limnobia  is  one  of  the  same  family,  only  of  a 
different  genus,  and  the  larvae  are  much  less  destructive, 
living  mostly  in  fungi. 

HEAD    OF    HEMEROBIUS. 

This  is  usually  mounted  as  an  opaque  object,  to  show 
the  metallic  lustre  of  the  eyes.  The  Hemerobius  belongs 
to  the  order  Neuroptera.  Is  has  four  exquisite  light  green 
wings  resembling  delicate  lace,  and  lays  its  eggs  on  the 
twigs  of  lilac  trees ;  these  eggs  are  stalked  and  placed  in 
rows  along  the  twig,  from  which  a  very  useful  little  larva 
emerges — a  destroyer  of  the  Aphides. 

HEAD   OF   PANORPA. 

The  Panorpa  is  called  the  Scorpion-fly,  and  is  very 
common  on  nettles  in  the  middle  and  end  of  summer. 
They  are  not  difficult  either  to  distinguish  or  to  catch  ;  for 
the  male  fly  is  very  conspicuous  with  his  long  turned-up 
tail,  at  the  end  of  which  he  brandishes  an  unpleasant- 
looking  pair  of  forceps.  The  wings,  four  of  them,  are 
highly  reticulated,  which  denote  it  to  be  of  the  order  Neu- 
roptera, and  first  cousin  to  the  beautiful  Dragon-fly  and 
brilliant  Hemerobius ;  they  are  prettily  spotted,  and  of 
equal  size.  If  we  look  at  the  head  we  shall  see  a  pair  of 
long  antenna?  inserted  between  the  eyes,  three  ocelli,  or  little 
eyes  on  the  crown  of  the  head,  and  this  long  snout-like 
proboscis,  with  mandibles,  maxilla?  and  lower  lip  nearly 
linear,  and  four  or  six  short  palpi.  Upon  this  beak  we 
often  see  a  little  insect  spitted,  whilst  the  tongue  is  rapidly 
sucking  out  its  life's-blood.  The  Panorpa  is  a  carnivorous 
fly,  and  hunts  in  the  hot  sunshine,  not  only  on  the  wing, 
but  running  swiftly  under  and  over  the  nettle-leaves,  intent 
on  his  pursuit,  and  easily  captured  himself  whilst  thus 
engaged. 

5 


74  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 


TONGUE    OF   CRICKET. 

(Achetce.) 

This  is  an  example  of  a  true  insect  tongue,  and  must 
be  examined  with  several  powers  if  we  wish  to  see  all  its 
beauty.  For  a  general  view  use  an  inch  lens,  and  observe 
the  two  strong  muscles  which  move  it,  from  whence  nume- 
rous fine  spiral  fibres  arch  over  the  transparent  membrane. 
Afterwards  use  the  half-inch  and  the  quarter-inch,  when 
these  fibres  appear  to  be  furrowed  or  fretted,  like  little  files, 
and  must  form  a  most  useful  tongue  for  the  voracious 
Cricket.  We  all  know  how  destructive  it  is  in  the  house ; 
gnawing  linen  or  books,  or  feeding  on  flour,  meat — in 
short,  anything  it  can  find.  After  this  tongue  has  performed 
its  office,  there  is  a  complicated  gizzard,  which  will  be 
explained  in  its  proper  place  ;  though  it  ought  to  be  looked 
at  after  the  tongue,  and  with  the  wing-case  of  the  male 
Cricket,  whose  drum  and  file  is  a  very  interesting  micro- 
scopic object. 

The  House  Cricket  belongs  to  the  order  Orthoptera,  or 
straight-winged  insects.  The  female  does  not  chirp  ;  she 
is  known  by  a  long  pointed  ovipositor,  with  which  she 
deposits  about  300  eggs  in  a  season. 

GIZZARD    OF    CRICKET. 

This  is  a  most  interesting  object  in  connection  with  the 
tongue  of  the  Cricket,  as  illustrative  of  the  digestive  organs 
of  the  Orthoptera.  It  is  usually  mounted  in  Canada  balsam 
and  viewed  with  transmitted  light ;  but  the  effect  is  more 
beautiful,  and  the  structure  better  displayed,  by  examina- 
tion with  the  parabolic  reflector,  or  a  simple  Lieberkuhn, 
when  the  scale-like  plates  are  thrown  into  relief,  and  the 
formidable  apparatus  for  digestion  is  manifest. 

The  Cricket  has  a  long  and  dilatable  oesophagus,  which 
ends  in  a  crop  or  sac  for  the  reception  of  food  in  a  rough 
state,  and  this  is  followed  by  a  gizzard,  consisting  of  two 
skins,  the  inner  one  plaited  into  six  folds  having  longitu- 
dinal rows  of  teeth  resembling  toothed  scales,  the  outer 
row  much  smaller  than  those  in  the  centre,  and  each 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  75 

capable  of  elevation  and  depression.  The  whole  grinding 
machine  is  moved  by  thousands  of  muscles,  which  enable  it 
to  reduce  the  food  to  a  pulp,  and  it  is  then  passed  on  to  the 
intestinal  canal  or  lower  stomach,  where  biliary  vessels, 
analogous  to  the  liver  in  the  higher  animals,  pour  in  the 
bile,  which  finally  prepares  the  food  for  the  general  nourish- 
ment of  the  body. 

A  most  interesting  collection  of  gizzards  may  easily 
be  made,  and  the  variation  and  adaptation  of  structure 
observed,  by  preparing  the  stomach  of  Dytiscus,  of  the 
large  Grasshopper  or  Locust,  the  Cockroach  (Blaps),  Tene- 
brio  (Beetle)  and  most  of  the  predaceous  Beetles.  One 
small  Beetle,  a  wood-borer,  Cryptorhynchus  lapatld,  has  a 
gizzard  so  minute  as  hardly  to  exceed  a  large  pin's  head  in 
size,  and  yet  it  is  said  to  be  armed  with  no  less  than  400 
pairs  of  teeth,  moved  by  a  far  greater  number  of  muscles. 

MOUTH    OJF   BEETLE. 
(Telephora,  or  Soldier-beetle.) 

This  is  a  common  and  favourite  object,  and  should  be 
considered  carefully,  for  it  belongs  to  that  large  and  useful 
tribe  of  insects  which  we  could  no  more  spare  from  their 
place  in  creation  than  we  could  the  flowers  of  the  field,  or 
the  birds  of  the  air. 

A  Beetle's  mouth  will  be  more  interesting  if  we  say  a  few 
words  about  the  Beetles  themselves. 

Coleoptera  they  are  called,  from  two  Greek  words,  signi- 
fying "  wings  in  a  sheath."  No  less  than  30,000  species 
are  known,  of  which  3,600  are  found  in  Britain  ;  exceeding 
the  amount  of  all  our  other  native  animals,  and  forming 
a  third  part  of  our  insect  population.  They  vary  in  size 
from  the  great  Prionus,  which  measures  six  inches  long,  and 
has  nine  inches  expanse  of  wing,  to  the  minute  Trichopteryx 
and  Atomaria,  hardly  one-eighth  of  a  line — quite  micro- 
scopic ;  and  yet  every  external  joint,  every  internal  organ, 
is  as  perfect  in  the  small  as  in  the  large. 

The  usefulness  of  the  Beetle  tribe  is  far  greater  than  is 
imagined.  Not  only  in  the  perfect  state  do  they  remove 
dead  animal  substances,  excrements,  &c.,  but  in  their  larval 


76  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

state  feed  on  decayed  vegetable  matter,  which  else  would 
render  the  air  unwholesome  for  our  existence,  and  more 
offensive  to  our  senses  than  can  well  be  imagined.  Let  us 
examine,  therefore,  the  mouth  of  our  little  scavenger. 

It  has  six  parts.  An  upper  lip,  called  labrum,  which  covers 
the  mouth,  and  is  horny  or  leathery,  but  simple  in  form. 

Two  upper  jaws,  called  mandibles,  varying  in  shape,  but 
strong  and  toothed,  or  hooked,  for  seizing  their  prey  and 
tearing  it  to  pieces  before  it  is  passed  on  to  the  more  deli- 
cate under  jaws  or 

Maxillae,  which  are  fringed  with  delicate  hairs,  and  to 
Avhich  are  attached  jointed  palpi,  or  feelers.  The  tips  of 
these  are  often  triangular,  or  hatchet-shaped,  which  will 
distinguish  them  for  your  observation.  These  palpi  move 
very  rapidly,  apparently  examining  the  food,  and  two  others 
are  attached  to  the  under  lip  or 

Labium,  for  the  same  purpose.  Part  of  the  labium  is 
called  the  chin  or  mentum,  usually  having  a  notch  in  the 
centre.  Some  of  the  Beetles  have  a  distinct  tongue  inside 
all  this — the  Dung-beetle  for  instance— lying  between  the 
labium  and  labrum.  It  is  a  simple  membrane,  sometimes 
fleshy,  sometimes  horny. 

The  mouth  of  a  Beetle  would  be  much  better  examined 
by  taking  a  large  Beetle,  and  soaking  the  head  for  a  few 
days  in  liquor  potassse  ;  then  washing  it  in  a  watchglassful 
of  water,  when  the  parts  are  easily  separated  and  studied. 
Do  this,  because  from  one  mouth  we  cannot  learn  all  that  is 
useful  or  interesting.  For  instance,  in  the  mandibles  are 
found  different  kinds  of  teeth ;  molar  teeth  for  grinding 
food,  or  incisive  teeth  for  tearing  it.  The  maxilla  also 
vary  extremely  in  their  form*  and  appendages.  The  lobes 
are  often  furnished  with  spines  or  teeth,  and  are  single  or 
double,  fringed  or  plain ;  but  the  predaceous  Beetles  have 
always  fringed  lobes  like  stiff  brushes,  as  if  for  cleansing 
the  food  or  the  other  appendages  of  the  mouth.  Also,  I 
may  mention  that  the  palpi  of  those  Beetles  which  feed 
on  the  pollen  of  flowers,  such  as  the  tribe  of  the  Nitidu- 
sidce,  are  used  by  them  to  open  the  anthers  in  a  very 
curious  way. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  77 

The  antennae  of  the  Beetle  are  not  described  here  but  in 
connection  with  those  of  the  Blow-fly  and  Bee,  concerning 

which  some  interesting  discoveries  have  been  lately  made. 

• 

MOUTH   OF   BEETLE. 

(Bouche  et  palpes  de  Calathus  Castelloides.) 

This  is  a  black  Beetle  about  half  an  inch  long,  very 
common  in  the  neighbourhood  of  London ;  found  under 
stones. 

The  object  is  good  as  showing  beautifully  fringed 
maxillae  with  two  pair  of  labial  palpi ;  the  outer  pair  have 
four  joints,  the  lower  pair  only  three.  Some  species  of 
Coleoptera  have  one  pair  of  labial  palpi,  and  one  pair  of 
maxillary  palpi. 

Observe,  the  little  tonguelet  in  the  centre  has  two  ear- 
like  appendages,  called  paraglossse.  That  broad  curved  plate 
above  it  is  the  mentum,  with  a  notch  in  the  centre,  which 
distinguishes  the  section  of  the  Carabici  to  which  it  belongs. 

MOUTH    OF   BRACHINUS. 

(Bouche  et  palpes  de  Brachinus.) 

The  mouth  of  the  Bombadier  Beetle  (see  leg  of  Brachinus), 
one  of  the  Carabici,  which  has  the  maxSlse  terminated 
simply  in  a  point ;  the  tonguelet  exposed,  and  labial  palpi 
distinctly  three-jointed  ;  the  mentum  not  toothed ;  the  last 
joint  of  both  maxillary  and  labial  palpi  evidently  dilated. 

MOUTH   OF   ONTHOPHAGUS. 

(Bouche  et  palpes.) 

One  of  the  Dung-beetles  or  Scaraboeides,  the  earliest 
species  of  the  spring.  It  belongs  to  the  large  family  of  the 
Lamellicornes,  having  the  antennae  clubbed  and  composed 
of  leaflets  arranged  like  a  fan,  opening  and  shutting  in  the 
same  manner.  The  first  pair  of  legs  are  remarkably  strong, 
the  tibise  toothed  for  burrowing  in  the  earth  and  manure 
upon  which  they  feed.  Many  of  the  species  are  very  large 
and  beautiful,  with  metallic  bodies  and  sculptured  Elytra. 
The  Onthophagus  is  small,  but  of  a  brassy  black  colour ; 


78  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

the  elytra  dull  grayish-yellow  thickly  clouded  with  black, 
and  it  has  a  curious  pair  of  horns  on  its  head.  The  mouth 
shows  a  pair  of  broad  curved  and  delicately  fringed  maxilla?, 
which  deserve  examination  with  a  high  power.  The  last 
joint  of  the  maxillary  palpi  is  the  largest,  and  the  labial 
palpi  are  very  hairy. 

MOUTH    OF   ANCHOMENUS, 

a  species  nearly  allied  to  Brachinus,  a  small  green  Beetle 
found  under  stones.  We  observe  the  maxilla?  terminate 
in  a  single  hook,  with  two  pair  of  palpi,  and  the  tongue- 
let  having  the  paraglossa?  mentioned  in  the  mouth  of 
Brachinus. 

MOUTH   OF   CRIOCERIS. 

(Asparagus  Beetle.) 

This  abundant  and  pretty  Beetle  is  found  in  the  hot  sunny 
days  of  July  laying  eggs  upon  the  asparagus  plants.  It  is 
blue  and  red,  with  the  elytra  marked  in  the  form  of  a  double 
cross,  yellow  and  blue.  It  belongs  to  the  order  Tetrameray 
having  four  joints  in  the  tarsi. 

The  mouth  displays  a  membranous  two-lobed  tonguelet, 
the  maxilla?  whitish  and  membranous,  delicately  fringed ; 
the  terminal  lobe  straight,  the  palpi  filiform. 

MOUTH    OF  LADYBIRD, 

(Coccinella,) 

too  well  known  to  need  description  ;  but  it  may  be  noticed 
that  it  belongs  to  the  last  order  of  Coleoptera,  the  Trimera, 
having  only  three  joints  in  the  tarsi. 

The  mouth  is  very  remarkable  from  the  hatchet-shape  of 
the  last  joint  of  the  maxillary  palpi.  The  maxilla?  are 
armed  on  the  inner  edge  with  a  horny  tooth. 

When  the  Coccinella  is  alive  and  in  its  youth,  the  circu- 
lation of  blood  may  be  seen  in  the  veins  of  the  wing. 

MOUTH  OF  STENOPTERUS  RUFUS. 

A  black  Beetle  with  red  antennse<  not'common  in  Eng- 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  79 

land ;  found  in  June  near  Darenth  Wood  and  Coombe 
Wood.  It  is  one  of  the  Cerambycidae,  a  section  of  the 
Longicornes.  These  have  only  four  joints  in  the  tarsi,  the 
last  three  furnished  with  short  brushes,  and  the  first  and 
second  joints  heart-shaped.  The  mouth  is  very  differently 
constructed  from  those  before  described.  The  two  maxillary 
lobes  are  remarkably  distinct  and  prolonged  beyond  the 
palpi :  the  last  joint  of  the  palpi  thick,  conical,  and  dark- 
coloured.  I  may  mention  here,  as  Stenopterus  is  rare  in 
England,  that  a  very  pretty  species  of  the  same  family  may 
be  readily  found  on  willows,  and  the  mouth  will  show  the 
same  kind  of  maxillae,  with  this  one  difference  in  the  palpi 
— that  the  maxillary  palpi  are  very  much  smaller  than  the 
labial,  or  even  the  maxillary  lobes. 

The  beetle  to  which  I  refer  is  Cerambyx  moschatus,  or 
Musk-beetle,  about  an  inch  long,  green,  shaded  with  blue, 
or  a  more  golden  colour,  emitting  a  scent  of  musk  or  of 
otto  of  roses  on  being  handled.  It  has  long  antennae,  and 
kidney-shaped  eyes  surrounding  the  base  of  the  antennae. 
The  larva  is  a  soft  white  maggot,  burrowing  under  the 
bark  of  trees. 


A  IN  T  E  N  N  M. 

The  antennae,  or  feelers,  are  very  important  organs  in 
all  insects ;  but  especially  in  the  flies  and  beetles.  In  both 
these  orders  the  shape,  position,  and  number  of  joints  in 
the  antenna?,  form  distinguishing  characters  in  the  genera 
and  species  of  insects. 

They  are  situated  on  the  head,  near  the  eyes.  They 
deserve  particular  attention  and  study ;  for  no  organs  are 
more  wonderful  or  more  useful,  and,  until  lately,  none  so 
little  understood.  The  order  Coleoptera  is  divided  by 
them  into  the  families,  Lamellicornes,  Clavicornes,  Serri- 
cornes,  and  Palpicornes.  For  examples  of  these,  which 
are  very  beautiful,  look  at  the  head  of  the  common  Dung- 
beetle,  which  has  a  clubbed  antenna,  formed  of  leaflets, 
capable  of  being  shut  up. 


80  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

ANTENNAE   OF    COCKCHAFER, 

another  Lamellicorne  beetle,  every  leaflet  of  whose  beautiful 
antennae  shows  a  cellular  tissue  of  oval  cells,  with  nucleus 
and  nucleolus,  according  to  Quekett ;  but  with  an  external 
cuticle  of  hexagonal  cells,  according  to  Carpenter.  The 
organs  of  sensation,  sacs  and  sacculi,  are  found  in  them, 
and  occupy  the  place  of  the  nucleoli  of  Quekett.  (See 
antennae  of  Syrphus.)  The  leaflets  of  the  male  are  much 
longer  than  those  of  the  female. 

ANTENNA    OF   NITIDULARIA. 

An  example  of  Clavicorne  antennae.  These  Nitidularia 
are  small  beetles  which  haunt  our  flowers  and  swarm  upon 
nettles  all  the  summer  long,  and  may  be  recognised  by  their 
antennae  having  eleven  joints,  the  last  three  clubbed. 

ANTENNAE   OF   HYDROPHILTJS, 

is  an  example  of  Palpicorne  antennae ;  clubbed  also,  but 
differently  shaped,  and  having  only  nine  joints— never 
more. 

ANTENN/E   OF   ELATER. 

Here  is  a  common  little  beetle,  often  called  Skip-jack, 
from  its  springing  up  with  a  jerk  when  laid  on  its  back ; 
easily  recognised  on  plants  by  its  depressed  head,  and 
long  dark  body;  also  by  its  habit  of  falling  down  as  if 
dead  when  alarmed.  The  antennae  are  an  example  of  the 
Serricornes,  toothed  or  serrated,  especially  those  of  the  male 
insect. 

.For  examples  of  variety  of  antennas  in  the  Diptera,  look 
at  the  heads  of  Dolichopus,  Empis,  Sepedon,  and  Syrphus, 
Phora,  Tabanus,  &c.  Compare  these  with  the  antennae  of 
Bee,  Saw-fly,  Ichneumon-fly,  and  Dragon-fly.  The  antennee 
not  only  vary  in  the  species,  but  in  the  sexes,  and  are 
always  most  beautiful  in  the  male ;  as  in  the  head  of  a 
Gnat,  which  is  plumed,  whilst  that  of  the  female  is  quite 
plain. 

The  wild  Bees,  Saw-flies,  and  Beetles,  present  many 
examples  where  the  different  shape  and  length  of  the 


Objects  for  the  Microscope. 


81 


antennae  enable  us  at  first  sight  to  recognise  the  sex. 
Therefore  we  should  study  them,  especially  in  the  following 
insects  : — 


WILD    BEES. 

Chelostoma 
Specodes 
Halictus 
Andrena 
Eticera 

BEETLES. 

Cerambyx 
Anthrenus 
Colymbetes 
Scolia 
Anthrophila 

Rhipicera 
Chelonus 
Elater 

ICHNEUMONS. 

Pteronus 

MOTHS. 

Bombyces 
Saturnia 

It  has  been  supposed  that  they  were  chiefly  the  organ 
of  touch,  probably  of  smell  also,  and  of  hearing.  Certain 
it  is  that  they  are  most  important  to  the  insect,  and  that 
special  contrivance  for  their  preservation  and  use  may  be 
observed  in  many  tribes.  I  will  but  mention  a  few  exam- 
ples. The  common  Water-scorpions,  Nepa  and  Belastoma, 
have  very  deep  kidney-shaped  boxes  between  the  eye  and 
the  throat  to  defend  their  singular  antennae.  Cryptocerus, 
a  remarkable  ant,  has  a  square  plate,  the  sides  of  which 
form  a  longitudinal  cavity  in  which  the  antennae  lie  quite 
concealed  and  safe.  Many  of  the  Diptera  have  furrows  in 
their  foreheads,  which  receive  and  protect  the  antennae  in 
repose.  Many  beetles,  Anthrenus  and  Byrrhus,  have  cavi- 
ties under  the  prothorax  or  breast,  where,  when  alarmed, 
their  antennae  are  secreted. 

But  in  proof  that  they  are  certainly  organs  of  sensation 
in  a  high  degree,  it  has  lately  been  discovered  that  the 
antennae  of  Bees,  Wasps,  Flies,  Dragon-flies  and  Ichneu- 
mons have  peculiar  structures  wrhich  had  never  been 
described  before.  Dr.  Hicks  published  his  papers  on  the 
subject  in  the  l  Transactions  of  the  Linnaean  Society, 
1857.' 

ANTENNAE    OF   SYRPHUS,    OR   OF   BLOW-FLY. 
(Musca  Vomitoria.) 

Either  of  these  may  be  taken  to  illustrate  what  is  stated 
by  Dr.  Hicks.  If  properly  mounted  they  will  be  trans- 
parent ;  and  on  the  third  joint  of  each  example  will  be  seen 
a  multitude  of  transparent  dots.  These  dots  are  perfora- 


82  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

tions  of  the  inner  coat  of  the  wall  of  the  antenna,  closed 
externally  by  a  very  thin  membrane.  Behind  this  perfora- 
tion is  a  sac  which,  when  the  antenna  is  crushed  or  broken 
up,  may  be  found  floating  about  in  the  fluid.  There  are 
about  17,000  of  these  sacs  in  each  antenna.  Besides  these 
simple  sacs  there  are  large  spores,  which  lead  into  chambers 
from  which  numerous  little  sacs  or  sacculi  radiate.  These 
apertures  are  fringed  with  very  minute  hairs.  There  are 
about  eighty  of  these  cavities  on  each  side  of  the  antennae. 
They  are  filled  with  fluid,  closed  in  from  the  outer  air  by  a 
very  thin  membrane,  and  to  each  little  sac  a  nerve  proceeds 
from  the  large  antenna!  nerve. 
This  will  be  seen  better  in 

ANTENNAS    OF    BEE. 

On  the  last  three  joints  of  these  antennae,  but  only  on  one 
side,  we  find  these  vesicles  or  sacs  ;  and  if  properly  pre- 
pared the  great  nerve  may  be  distinctly  seen,  giving  off 
three  bundles  of  finer  nerves,  each  of  these  dots  receiving 
one. 

ANTENNAE   OF    ICHNEUMON. 

One  species  of  Ichneumon  will  give  singularly-shaped 
perforations,  in  which  the  transparent  membrane  over-arches 
and  extends  beyond  the  aperture,  and  gives  it  the  appearance 
of  an  inverted  canoe. 

ANTENNAE   OF   ARGTNNIS. 

Argynnis,  or  Fritillary  Butterfly,  tawny  coloured,  with 
black  lines  and  spots  on  the  upper  wing,  and  silvery  streaks 
and  spots  on  the  under  side  of  the  hind  wing.  The  antennae 
possess  small  transparent  dots  and  chambered  cavities. 

PALPI    OF   ARGYNNIS, 

a  very  pretty  object,  showing  the  scales  or  feathers  of  the 
Butterfly  in  situ. 

ANTENNA   OF   DRAGON-FLY 

furnish  the  most  beautiful  examples  of  these  acoustic  cham- 
bers, and  display  the  nerve  well. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  83 


OF   SILKWORM!   MOTH. 

These  will  form  an  example  of  the  variation  of  the  An- 
tennae in  the  sexes,  those  of  the  male  Moth  being  pecti- 
nated throughout  equally,  while  those  of  the  female  have 
shorter  branches,  and  alternately  one  long,  and  one  short. 

To  prepare  the  antennae  of  Bees,  Wasps,  and  Flies,  for 
these  observations,  it  is  necessary  to  soak  them  in  chlorate 
of  potash,  with  a  few  drops  of  hydrochloric  acid,  until  they 
are  colourless  ;  then  dry  them  and  mount  in  balsam. 


SPIRACLES     AND     TRACHEAE. 
SPIRACLES   OF   DYTISCUS. 

The  Dytiscus  is  a  large  Water-beetle,  very  common  in 
ditches  and  ponds,  belonging  to  the  pentamerous  Coleop- 
tera.  It  passes  its  first  stage  of  existence  wholly  in  the 
water  as  a  most  voracious  larva,  with  long  narrow  body 
and  strong  head,  armed  with  mandibles,  breathing  by  the 
anus,  and  rising  frequently  to  the  surface,  when  it  hangs 
head  downwards  and  the  body  curved  like  an  S.  When 
full-grown  as  larva  it  buries  itself  in  the  earth,  changes  to 
a  pupa,  and  afterwards  to  the  perfect  insect.  It  is  from 
the  Beetle  that  these  spiracles  or  breathing  organs  are 
taken. 

Few  objects  are  more  beautiful  than  those  prepared  from 
the  respiratory  apparatus  of  insects.  The  blood  of  insects 
is  aerated,  not  by  its  passing  through  particular  organs,  as 
the  lungs  in  some  land  animals,  or  the  gills  of  fish ;  but  the 
air  is  circulated  in  every  part  of  their  body  by  means  of 
delicate  spiral  vessels,  called  trachea?,  or  air-tubes,  which 
ramify  into  the  minutest  organs.  As  you  observe  these 
spiracles,  look  also  at  these  slides,  which  are  very  commonly 
found  in  all  collections. 

TRACHEAE   OF   DTTISCUS. 

You  see  they  greatly  resemble  the  spiral  vessels  of  plants  ; 
within  the  outer  membrane  an  elastic  fibre  winds  round  and 


84  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

round  in  close  and  regular  coils,  and  then  comes  another 
thin  transparent  membrane,  closing  it  in  and  securing  it 
from  disturbance.  When  these  tubes  are  pressed  flat  and 
are  large,  as  the  tracheae  of  Dytiscus,  then  the  double  wall 
of  fibre  crossing  each  other  gives  an  appearance  of  watered 
silk.  Vessels  such  as  these  in  the  tongues,  wings,  and 
throughout  the  body,  are  easily  dissected  for  examination, 
by  opening  the  abdomen  and  floating  off  the  fine  white 
threads  which  branch  off  on  either  side  from  every  spiracle. 
This  brings  us  back  to  the  spiracle  itself,  which  is  on  every 
segment  of  the  abdomen,  an  oval  opening  defended  by  those 
beautiful  arborescent  hairs,  preventing  dust  or  particles  of 
harmful  substance  from  entering  in  and  lacerating  the 
delicate  tracheal  vessels. 

SPIRACLES   OF   COCKCHAFER. 

(Melolontha.) 

Here  is  a  difference  of  structure  in  the  spiracles  of  the 
larva  of  Cockchafer,  which  burrows  in  the  earth  to  a  great 
depth,  and  whose  naked  body  has  no  defence  for  its  tracheal 
aperture  ;  therefore  the  spiracle,  though  very  small,  is  doubly 
protected  by  a  framework  of  bars,  stretched  from  side  to 
side  of  the  thickened  margin,  and  a  membrane  dotted  with 
minute  holes  covers  these  again,  effectually  protecting  the 
trachea?,  whilst  it  freely  admits  the  air. 

SPIRACLE   OF   FLY,- 

is  a  modification  of  the  spiracle  of  Dytiscus.  It  is  inter- 
laced with  branching  fibre. 

SPIRACLE    OF   TIPULA. 

This  has  a  solid  disc  in  the  centre,  and  radii  proceed 
from  thence  to  the  margin. 

SPIRACLES   OF   WATER   LARY^E. 

These  are  best  examined  in  the  living  larvae  of  the  Gnat, 
where  the  last  segment  of  the  abdomen  is  prolonged  into  a 
tube,  the  mouth  of  which  remains  at  the  surface  of  the 
water  whilst  the  animal  breathes. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  85 

There  are,  however,  other  and  quite  different  modes  of 
respiration  in  aquatic  larvae,  which  form  beautiful  micro- 
scopic objects. 

AERATING   LEAFLET    OF   LIBELLULA, 

the  larva  of  one  of  the  Dragon-flies,  those  slender,  beau- 
tiful blue  and  scarlet  flies,  which  glance  like  living  sun- 
beams across  our  path  on  a  summer's  day,  and  may  be 
found  in  thousands  resting  on  the  reeds  and  bushes  at  the 
river's  side.  When  these  are  in  the  larval  state,  they  have 
three  leaflike  plates  at  the  extremity  of  the  abdomen,  over 
which  innumerable  tracheae  ramify  and  draw  from  the 
water  that  supply  of  air  which  is  needful  for  their  life. 

ABDOMEN    OF   EPHEMERA,    OR   SPIRACLES. 

The  larva  of  the  pretty  May-fly,  or  Ephemera,  has  on 
either  side  of  its  body  a  row  of  little  leaflets,  each  of  which 
is  an  external  spiracle,  and  when  alive  it  is  most  interesting 
to  watch  its  palpitations,  the  play  of  those  tiny  organs 
drawing  oxygen  from  the  water  to  aerate  the  blood.  It  is 
best  thus  to  see  it,  because  we  are  able  to  observe  the 
circulation  of  the  blood  through  the  transparent  skin. 


CIRCULATION    OF   BLOOD. 

All  creatures  that  have  life  have  blood :  it  is  the  nourish- 
ing fluid  which  is  needful  for  existence.  In  insects,  it  is 
colourless,  but  composed  of  minute  corpuscles,  which  are 
propelled  through  the  body,  not  by  arteries  and  veins,  but 
by  one  great  dorsal  vessel,  constricted  at  intervals,  and  one 
end  of  which  is  closed,  the  other  open  and  acting  as  the 
aorta  of  the  heart.  We  see  it  here  constricting  and  dilating, 
pumping  out  the  blood  which  bathes  the  whole  interior  of 
the  body,  flowing  into  the  antennae,  the  legs,  the  wings — 
taking  all  directions.  Here  also  we  see  a  regular  current 
through  each  appendage  of  the  tail,  and  backward  it  is  drawn 
into  the  long  dorsal  vessel  through  some  lateral  fissures  in 
it,  which  are  closed  by  valves,  preventing  its  return.  More- 
over, we  can  see  in  this  larva  the  constrictions  of  the  heart, 


86  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

its  divisions  into  parts  or  chambers,  called  cardiac  chambers, 
each  of  which  is  closed  by  a  little  door  or  valve,  only 
opening  upwards,  so  that  the  onward  flow  of  the  blood  is 
secured,  and  out  it  is  forced  from  the  aorta  again  to  con- 
tinue its  circulation.  We  understand  better  when  we  have 
watched  this  in  the  living  creature,  how  the  delicate  tracheal 
vessels  receiving  air  through  the  spiracles  give  it  out  to  the 
blood  in  which  they  are  immersed.  Although  there  are  no 
distinct  membranous  veins  in  insects,  yet  the  blood  flows 
in  regular  channels  formed  by  the  interstices  of  the  flakes  of 
fat,  air-cells,  muscles,  &c.  The  pulsations  vary  in  different 
insects.  Hunter  counted  thirty-four  pulsations  in  a  minute 
in  the  heart  of  a  silkworm  ;  which  we  can  do,  as  the  great 
dorsal  vessel  is  very  distinctly  seen  constricting  and  dilating 
in  the  full-grown  larva.  When  excited  by  fear  or  muscular 
exertion,  the  action  of  the  heart  is  accelerated  to  as  many 
as  100  and  140  pulsations  in  a  minute. 

In  examining  the  larva  of  Ephemerse,  which  are  abundant 
in  most  ponds,  simply  confine  it  in  a  live  box  with  a  drop 
of  water,  and  just  press  it  sufficiently  to  keep  it  still,  yet 
unhurt.  If  you  cannot  easily  find  a  larva  of  Ephemerae, 
any  waterbutt  in  summer  will  abound  with  larvae  of  Gnat, 
and  they  will  do  nearly  as  well.  So  also  will  a  newly- 
hatched  Fly,  or  a  young  Bee,  just  before  it  emerges  from 
the  pupa  case  ;  in  these  the  circulation  will  be  observed  in 
the  wings. 

SPIRACLES   OF   LARYA   OF   BOT-FLY. 

(CEstrus.) 

See  egg  of  (Estrus  for  an  account  of  the  Bot. 

WINGS   OF   INSECTS. 

There  is  much  to  learn  in  the  wings  of  Coleoptera, 
Hemiptera,  Hymenoptera,  and  Diptera.  The  scales  or 
feathers  which  clothe  the  wings  of  Lepidoptera  are  noticed 
under  Scales  of  Moth.  The  Diptera  are  classed  by  the 
veining  of  the  wings,  and  therefore  it  is  absolutely  necessary 
to  have  a  few  specimens  mounted  as  lessons  for  the  names 
of  the  nerves  or  veins  of  the  wing. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  87 

The  wing  itself  may  be  described  as  a  transparent  mem- 
branous organ,  consisting  of  two  laminae,  or  plates,  which 
are  united  by  canals  called  veins  or  nerves.  These  veins 
are  hollow  channels  through  which  the  circulating  fluid 
flows,  and  a  tracheal  vessel  runs  in  communication  with  the 
tracheae  in  the  thorax. 

In  the  Ladybird's  (Coccinella)  wing,  the  blood  is  not  con- 
fined to  these  canals  or  veins,  but  circulates  freely  through  a 
large  part  of  the  wing.  The  circulation  may  be  seen  in  the 
wing  of  any  newly-hatched  fly,  but  especially  in  that  of  the 
beautiful  lace-winged  fly,  Hemerobius,  where  it  was  first 
noticed  by  Dr.  Bowerbank. 

WING   OF   SCATOPHAGA. 

Although  this  is  fully  described  for  the  slide  of  Scato- 
phaga,  mounted  whole,  it  is  mentioned  here  as  the  best 
lesson  on  the  veins,  and  very  easily  put  up  separately.  If 
merely  mounted  dry,  the  veins  are  sufficiently  seen,  but  when 
soaked  for  a  few  days  in  turpentine  and  mounted  in  balsam, 
they  become  transparent  from  the  expulsion  of  the  air  ;  and 
then  not  only  the  canals,  but  the  tracheae,  may  be  visible, 
especially  in  the  costal  vein. 

Observe  that  strong  vein  bordered  with  hairs  on  the 
fore-margin  of  the  wing— that  is  the  Costal  vein ;  and  in 
the  Coleoptera  there  is  inside  a  little  bag  of  fluid  called 
the  Phialum,  by  which  the  fly  can,  at  its  pleasure,  increase 
the  weight  of  its  wing,  and  sink  or  fly  slowly. 

The  short  vein  next  to  the  Costal,  ending  at  about  one- 
third  of  the  length  of  the  wing,  is  called  the  Sub-Costal. 

The  next  to  that  is  the  Mediastinal. 

The  next  is  the  Radial,  which  forks  off  at  its  base ;  and 
the  farthest  branch  is  the  Cubital,  always  an  important  vein. 

After  the  Cubital  comes  the  Prcebrachial,  joined  to  it  by  a 
transverse  vein,  called  the  Discal  transverse. 

WING   OF   HOUSE-FLY. 
(Musca.) 

This  is  an  example  of  the  true  fly's  wing.  The  Muscidae 
are  very  numerous,  and  divided  into  many  groups  and 


88  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

families  ;  the  third  joint  of  the  antennae,  always  the  largest 
in  this  family,  enables  us  to  recognise  a  true  Musca  at  once. 
After  that  we  must  look  at  the  wing,  which  varies  very 
much  in  the  number  and  position  of  its  veins. 

There  are  many  house-flies.  The  Musca  domestica  will 
show  the  prsebrachial  vein,  forming  a  rounded  obtuse  angle 
at  its  flexure,  nearly  straight  from  thence  to  the  tip ;  the 
discal  transverse  vein  nearly  straight,  parted  from  the  border 
by  more  than  half  its  length. 

This  little  wing  makes  600  strokes  a  second,  carrying  it 
five  yards ;  if  alarmed,  can  increase  its  velocity  to  thirty- 
five  feet  in  a  second. 

WING  OF   BLUE-BOTTLE   FLY, 
'    (Muscat,  Vomitoria,) 

will  show  the  Discal  transverse  vein  with  two  distinct 
curves,  parted  from  the  border  and  from  the  flexure  of  the 
pnebrachial  by  hardly  one-third  of  its  length.  The  an- 
tennae of  this  fly  have  the  third  joint  remarkably  long,  and 
furnished  with  peculiar  organs  of  smell.  (See  Antennae  of 
Blow-fly.) 

WING   OF   STKPHUS, 

not  one  of  the  Muscida?,  or  true  flies,  and  therefore  a  good 
example  of  a  beautiful  variety.  The  Syrphidae  are  a  nu- 
merous family,  comprising  thirty-one  genera;  they  are 
mostly  seen  hovering  over  flowers,  vibrating  their  wings  as 
they  pause  awhile,  then  darting  with  rapid  flight  a  short 
distance  only,  and  becoming  stationary  again.  Many  of 
the  species  make  a  humming  noise  like  a  Bee,  and  are 
mistaken  for  either  Bees  or  Wasps. 

The  veining  of  this  wing  is  an  excellent  lesson.  The 
Costal  vein  ends  just  before  the  tip  of  the  wing,  and 
receives  the  Radial,  or  Cubital ;  for  both  these  veins  are 
not  always  present  in  the  Syrphus  wing. 

The  Mediastinal  is  very  distinct ;  a  transverse  vein  con- 
nects the  Cubital  with  the  Prwbrachial  near  the  margin. 
But  the  chief  distinction  lies  in  one  or  two  spurious  veins, 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  89 

one  of  which  crosses  a  small  transverse  vein  between  the 
Prabrachial  and  Cubital,  and  the  second,  when  present, 
runs  behind  the  Pobrachial  vein. 

These  examples  of  wings  are  most  useful  in  awakening 
attention  to  the  importance  of  minute  observation,  to  the 
perfect  order  of  Creation  in  all  its  parts,  to  the  distinct 
individuality  of  each  tiny  fly  in  the  presence  of  Him  who 
made  it.  How  little  we  think  of  this ;  how  carelessly  we 
glance  at  the  flies  on  our  window-panes ;  they  are  nearly 
all  alike  to  our  unseeing  eyes.  We  complain  of  them,  lay 
traps  for  them,  kill  them,  but  it  seldom  occurs  to  us  that 
we  had  better  study  them. 

WING   OF   MIDGE. 

(Psychoda.} 

Only  two  examples  more  will  I  give — the  wing  of  a 
Midge  and  the  wing  of  a  Gnat.  These  both  belong  to  the 
first  order  of  Diptera,  the  Tipulidae,  which  comprises  all  the 
Gnats,  Midges,  and  Daddy-long-legs,  or  Tipulae.  There  are 
many  more  veins  in  this  tiny  wing  than  in  any  yet  noticed, 
and  the  number  of  areolets  or  enclosed  spaces  in  the  wing 
is  thirteen,  every  vein  thickly  covered  with  fine  hairs ; 
these  are  supposed  to  assist  the  insect  in  its  downward 
flight,  by  fixing  the  atmospheric  fluid,  which  glides  over  it 
as  they  rise. 

The  motion  of  a  little  Midge  on  the  window-pane  is 
always  zigzag,  from  right  to  left,  and  left  to  right.  Some 
wings  have  six  or  seven  spots  upon  them,  and  are  called 
Psychoda  sexpunctata. 

WING   OF   GNAT. 

This  wing  differs  in  the  various  species  of  Gnats  which 
haunt  our  waterbutts,  and  tanks,  and  stagnant  ponds. 
Some  have  more  beautiful  scales  than  others,  but  this  wing 
of  the  common  Gnat  (Culex  pipiens)  is  a  good  study  and  a 
most  pleasing  object.  Look  at  it  with  the  lowest  power 
for  the  veining,  and  then  with  the  highest  for  the  scales. 

The  Gnats  belong  to  that  division  of  flies  called  Tipu- 
lidae, and  also  Nemocera,  which  means  having  the  head 


90  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

branched.  They  all  have  long  and  beautiful  antennae, 
which,  in  the  males,  are  plumed  and  whorled  like  the  stems 
of  Equisetum. 

The  wings  are  narrow  and  lanceolate. 

Sub-costal  vein  ends  a  little  before  the  tip  of  the  wing. 

Radial,  branched  from  the  Sub-costal,  and  is  forked. 

Cubital  vein  begins  from  the  Prcebracliial  small  transvese. 

Mediastinal  is  between  the  Radial  and  Costal. 

Prccbrachial  is  also  forked.     There  are  fourteen  areolets. 

The  scales  of  a  Gnat  form  test  objects  of  the  defining 
power  of  an  object  glass.  Scales  are  composed  of  two  or 
three  layers  of  membrane,  and  probably  the  longitudinal 
ridges  in  these  scales  may  represent  folds  of  the  outer 
membrane.  We  should  not  only  see  these  striaj,  but  the 
delicate  transverse  markings  and  projections  of  the  lines 
beyond  the  top  of  the  scale. 

Gnats  fly  silently  in  winter  and  early  spring,  before  the 
thirst  for  blood  is  awakened,  and  then  the  female  only  sounds 
the  shrill  clarion  of  war  in  her  eager  flight  to  and  fro.  See 
the  Gnat  (Culex),  mounted  whole,  and  for  the  complete 
knowledge  of  Flies,  consult  '  Walker's  British  Diptera,' 
vol.  iii. ;  '  The  Insecta  Britannica.' 

WING   OF   COLEOPTERA. 

Beetles  have  four  wings ;  but  the  upper  pair,  being  crusta- 
ceous  and  used  only  as  a  protection  for  the  under  pair,  are 
called  Elytra.  Their  use  is  obvious  from  the  habits  of  the 
Coleoptera ;  they  burrow  in  the  ground  and  reside  under 
the  bark  of  trees,  or  beneath  stones,  when  the  undefended 
membranous  wing  would  receive  the  greatest  injury.  The 
under  wing  is  particularly  described  when  examining  the 
slide  of  Telephorus. 

Both  of  these  should  be  mounted  and  observed.  The 
upper  pair,  or  Elytra,  if  properly  prepared,  are  very  beau- 
tiful polariscope  objects,  especially  those  of  Dytiscus  and 
Cockchafer  (Melolontha). 

But  there  is  a  more  important  notice  to  be  taken  of  the 
internal  structure  of  the  Elytron.  Dr.  Hicks  discovered 
the  same  vesicles  here  as  he  did  in  the  antennae  of  Flies 


Wings  of  Insecta. 


Plate  4. 


*  £^s^  ,v^  -s^^wi?  v<  .>  ^  ^v^  v 


1.  Wing  of  Earwig,  shewing  its  method  of  folding  up. 

2.  Wing  of  Earwig,  magnified  4  diameters.     3.  Earwig  flying,  natural  size. 

4.  Wing  of  Whirligig-beetle,  magnified  fi  diameters.  5.  The  same,  natural  size. 

.  Minute  portion  of  Beetle's  wing,  magnified  420  diameters.       7.  Wasp's  wing,  folded. 

8.   Wasp's  wings,  hooked  together,  magnified  3  diameters. 

U.   Hooks  on  Wasp's  wing,  magnified  60  diameters. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  91 

and  Bees.  (See  Antennae.)  The  wing-nerve  branches 
over  the  Elytron,  and  those  dots  which  exhibit  the  black 
cross  with  polarized  light,  are  vesicles  or  organs  of  sensa- 
tion, to  which  a  distinct  branch  of  the  nerve  may  be  traced. 

Soak  the  Elytron  in  potash  for  a  week  or  more,  and  when 
perfectly  transparent  mount  in  balsarn. 

The  under  wings  exhibit  groups  of  these  vesicles  on  the 
under  side  of  the  sub-costal  nerve,  as  many  as  200  and  300 
in  each  wing.  Observe  the  wing  of  Strangalia,  a  Longi- 
corne  Beetle.  (See  l  Journal  of  Linnsean  Society/  vol.  i. 
p.  136,  Nov.  1,  1856).  See  also  Elytra  of  Diamond  Beetle. 

WING   OF   CRICKET. 

(Acheta,  domestica.) 

This  is  mounted  to  show  the  organ  of  sound,  the  drum 
and  file  by  which  the  male  Cricket  chirps.  Each  of  the 
upper  wings,  or  Elytra,  has  a  round  transparent  space  called 
the  drum,  or  tympanum ;  at  the  base  of  each  Elytron  is  a 
transverse  horny  ridge,  furnished  with  numerous  short 
transverse  ridges  or  teeth,  and  forming  a  kind  of  bow  or 
file.  The  insect  rubs  the  Elytra  across  one  another,  and 
the  grating  of  the  files,  together  with  the  action  of  the 
drum  as  a  sounding-board,  causes  the  loud  chirp.  Some 
naturalists  think  that  the  legs  work  against  this  file  and 
produce  the  sound,  particularly  in  the  Grasshopper,  whose 
thighs  are  armed  with  rough  ridges  and  short  spines,  and 
act  as  the  bow  against  the  files  and  drum  of  the  Elytra. 

The  male  Cricket  only  chirps.  The  female,  silently  at 
home,  occupies  herself  in  laying  about  300  eggs  and  in 
rearing  her  brood.  The  tongue  of  a  cricket  is  a  beautiful 
object. 


SCALES    OF   INSECTS. 


The  feathers  of  a  Moth,  a  Butterfly,  a  Gnat,  the  scales 
of  a  Beetle,  of  a  Weevil,  of  the  Podura,  are  all  both  favourite 
and  useful  objects  for  the  microscope.  It  is  well  known  to 
every  one  that  the  dust  which  remains  on  our  fingers  after 
touching  a  butterfly's  wing  is  a  mass  of  beautiful  feathersr 


92  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

or  scales,  varying  in  shape  and  colour  with  the  species ; 
and  that  some  are  so  delicately  ornamented  with  a  tracery 
that  no  unassisted  eye  can  see  that  they  form  test  objects 
for  the  denning  power  of  the  microscope. 

Besides  that  use,  we  learn  much  from  viewing  a  part  of 
a  butterfly's  wing  as  an  opaque,  and  observing  how  the 
scales  are  arranged  on  the  membrane  of  the  wing  exactly 
like  the  tiles  on  the  roof  of  a  house  ; — this  is  called  being 
"  imbricated ";  each  scale  furnished  with  a  point  at  one 
end  which  fits  into  a  cup -like  socket,  attached  to  the  skin 
of  the  body  or  the  membrane  of  the  wing.  When  the  scales 
are  rubbed  off  and  transparent,  we  can  better  observe  their 
structure,  and  we  have  some  excellent  examples  in  the 
slides  numbered  here. 

SCALES   OF   MORPHO    MENELAUS. 

Each  scale  or  feather  consists  of  three  distinct  laminae, 
two  external  and  coloured,  the  inner  one  a  highly  polished 
colourless  membrane,  which  reflects  the  light  and  increases 
the  brilliancy  of  the  scale.  The  Morpho  menelaus,  a  large 
foreign  butterfly  of  gorgeous  blue,  has  striated  scales,  and 
with  very  high  power,  each  line  is  slightly  beaded,  giving 
the  appearance  of  transverse  scorise ;  but  to  see  this  the 
achromatic  condenser  must  be  used. 

SCALES   OF   POLYOMMATTJS  ARGUS, 

a  British  Butterfly  common  as  the  pretty  blue  butterfly  of 
the  cornfield,  or  the  seaside  Downs ;  has  peculiar  scales 
shaped  like  a  battledore  with  long  handle,  ajid  the  longi- 
tudinal lines  are  swollen  at  intervals  into  rounded  eleva- 
tions, which  give  it  a  dotted  appearance,  except  towards 
the  base,  where  a  crescent-shaped  cloud  of  minute  pigment- 
cells  crosses  the  scale,  and  forms  a  distinguishing  mark  of 
the  species. 

SCALES   OF   HIPPARCHIA   JANIRA, 

our  little  meadow  brown  Butterfly,  which  flits  so  merrily 
about  the  long  grass  in  June  to  October,  laying  its  exqui- 
site eggs  upon  the  stems,  from  which  a  green  striped 
caterpillar  emerges  in  due  time.  These  are  the  scales  of 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  93 

its  brown  wings,  most  excellent  test  objects,  and  giving 
different  markings.  When  dry,  or  in  balsam,  or  when 
viewed  by  oblique  or  direct  light,  we  see  that  the  rounded 
end  is  toothed,  and  bears  a  brush-shaped  appendage. 

SCALES   OF   PONTIA   BRASSICA. 

The  common  Cabbage  Butterfly,  whose  history  is  too 
well  known  to  need  remark  ;  the  earliest  and  latest  of  our 
summer  friends  and  garden  enemies.  There  are  several 
shapes  in  the  scales  of  its  wing,  a  very  long  and  slender  one, 
and  some  more  of  the  battledore  shape,  and  heart-shaped, 
with  beautiful  striae.  Observe  also  a  portion  of  the  mem- 
brane, where  the  scales  or  feathers  are  rubbed  oif.  The 
apertures  into  which  they  are  fixed  are  little  cups  or  tubes, 
the  orifices  of  which  are  set  backward ;  and  around  each 
are  radiating  folds  of  the  upper  membrane,  giving  them  a 
star-like  appearance. 

SCALES   OF   THE   SILKWORM   MOTH. 

The  Silkworm  Moth  (Bombyx  mori)  has  a  variety  of 
scales,  toothed,  and  broad  or  narrow,  and  Leuwenhoeck 
reckoned  no  less  than  400,000  of  these  delicate  scales  on 
the  wings  of  one  moth. 

SCALES   OF   CLOTHES   MOTH. 

From  the  under  side  of  that  troublesome  little  Tinea  we 
obtain  a  beautiful  test  object  of  very  fine  striae.  Also  from 
the  Podura. 

SCALES   OF   PODURA. 

The  Podura  is  a  small  gray  wingless  insect  with  six  legs, 
and  a  long  forked  tail,  bent  inwards,  and  by  means  of 
which  it  leaps  and  springs  about  in  the  sawdust  of  our 
cellars,  and  under  stones,  and  in  moss  in  damp  places. 

SCALES   OF   LEPISMA   SACCHARINA. 

A  first  cousin  of  Podura,  haunting  our  sugar  stores,  and 
originally  a  native  of  America.  It  does  not  leap  so  well  as 
Podura,  if  at  all ;  for  its  body  does  not  terminate  in  a  forked 
tail,  but  in  several  long  thread-like  styles,  and  it  runs 
swiftly  along,  the  little  silvery  gray  body  closely  covered 


94  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

with  these  beautiful  scales  which  require  high  and  good 
powers  to  see  distinctly. 

A  few  words  may  be  added  on  the  appearance  which 
Podura  scales  should  present  as  a  test  object.  Under  a 
medium  power  they  resemble  watered  silk  ;  light  and  dark 
lines  wave  across  the  scale  in  irregular  bands ;  but  with 
better  definition  every  dark  band  should  be  resolved  into 
rows  of  short  lines,  thick  at  one  end,  and  very  fine  at  the 
other.  Yet  these  apparent  lines  are  not  lines.  We  must 
have  a  higher  power,  a  good  quarter-inch  lens,  and  then 
with  careful  management  of  light — always  a  most  impor- 
tant thing — we  shall  see  that  the  apparent  lines  are  really 
spaces  between  the  wedge-like  particles  which  make  up 
the  layer  or  upper  surface  of  the  scale.  As  a  test  object  it 
is  out  of  fashion  ;  the  dots  of  the  Pleurosigma  and  the  striae 
of  Grammatophora  and  Pygidium  of  a  flea  being  preferred 
by  many  scientific  observers. 

ELYTRON    OF    DIAMOND    BEETLE. 

A  most  beautiful  object,  to  be  looked  at  with  reflected 
light — that  is  as  an  opaque.  These  brilliant  spots  are 
groups  of  scales,  fashioned  precisely  like  those  of  a  butterfly's 
wing,  but  owing  to  their  iridescence,  to  the  peculiar  thinness 
of  the  upper  layer  and  the  reflecting  power  of  the  secon- 
dary layer,  the  colour  changes  like  that  on  a  soap-bubble 
by  the  varied  position  of  the  light,  the  dark  cell  in  which 
the  scales  are  set  adding  to  their  brilliancy.  The  Diamond 
Beetle  is  one  of  the  weevil  tribe,  and  a  native  of  South 
America;  but  we  have  smaller  Diamond  Beetles  in  our 
own  country,  and  the  Curculio  of  the  oak  and  of  the  beech, 
a  little  green  and  gold  weevil,  by  no  means  rare  on  nettle- 
plants,  is  quite  as  beautiful  under  the  microscope,  having 
the  same  kind  of  scales,  set  in  dark  cup-like  recesses  on 
its  elytra. 


FEET  AND  LEGS  OF  INSECTS. 
FOOT  OF  SYEPHUS. 


Although  the  feet  are  better  studied  with  the  leg  and 
upon  the  whole  insect,  yet  as  those  specimens  are  not  so 


Wings,  etc.,  of  Insects. 


Plate  5. 


1 .  Small  Dragon-fly.        2.  Fart  of  small  Dragon-fly's  wing,  magnified  7  diameters. 
3.  Wing  of  another  species  of  Dragon-fly.        4.  Part  of  wing,  magnified  7  diameters. 

5.  Minute  Beetle,  common  in  Spring         6.  Beetle,  magnified  30  diameters. 
Hairs  of  Beetles,  magnified  420  diameters.      8.  Wing-case  of  Beetle,  magnified  50  diameters. 
9.  Teeth  at  the  base  ol  Ming-case,  magnified  900  diameters. 


Objects  for  t/ie  Microscope.  95 

easily  obtained  as  the  foot  of  Syrphus,  it  should  by  all 
means  form  part  of  an  educational  box. 

The  Syrphus  is  one  of  those  flies  which  vibrate  over  our 
flowers  in  the  summer,  and  haunt  the  Michaelmas  Daisy 
in  the  autumn.  They  are  called  Drone-flies  and  Wasp- 
flies,  and  are  mistaken  sometimes  for  one  of  the  Hyme- 
noptera. 

This  foot  displays  that  pair  of  membranous  expansions 
called  pulvilli  which  enable  the  fly  to  walk  up  and  down 
smooth  surfaces,  on  glass  and  on  ceilings,  in  opposition  to 
the  laws  of  gravity.  They  are  fringed  with  minute  hairs, 
each  of  which  is  tubular,  and  secretes  a  viscid  fluid  which 
attaches  the  foot  to  the  surface  of  the  glass  or  wall,  and  the 
hooks  on  either  side  act  as  fulcra  or  props,  with  which  the 
fly  pushes  against  the  substance  when  it  desires  to  detach 
itself.  The  joints  above  the  pulvilli  are  called  tarsi. 

LEG   OF   DYTISCUS,    OR   DTTICUS. 

A  most  splendid  object  for  the  polariscope.  The  Dytiscus 
is  a  large  water-beetle,  common  in  ditches  and  ponds,  and 
this  is  the  fore-leg  of  the  male.  That  large  round  disc  is 
composed  of  three  joints  of  the  tarsi,  which  are  studded 
with  suckers ;  one  is  extremely  large,  furnished  with  radi- 
ating fibres,  and  another  is  somewhat  smaller,  with  single 
cup-like  suckers  raised  on  stalks,  altogether  giving  it  an 
immense  power  of  adhesion. 

FOOT   OF   WASP, 

another  favourite  object  for  the  polariscope:  the  tarsal 
joints  are  well  seen,  as  also  the  hooks  on  each  side  of  the 
pulvillus. 

FOOT   OF   OPHION. 

These  toothed  claws  belong  to  an  Ichneumon-fly  (Ophion), 
which  deposits  its  eggs  in  the  larva  or  caterpillar  of  a  moth 
(Bombyx  Vinula,  Puss  Moth).  The  fly  is  yellow  and  has  a 
sickle-shaped  body,  the  ovipositor  slightly  exserted. —  (See 
Hymenoptera  Microgaster.) 


96  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

HIND-LEG   OF   BEE. 

This  is  to  show  the  peculiar  structure  of  the  hind-leg  of 
the  Hive-bee.  The  worker-bee — not  the  queen,  nor  yet 
the  drone — has  this  beautiful  contrivance  for  gathering  the 
bee-bread,  and  carrying  it  home  to  the  hive.  The  Bee 
collects  the  pollen  of  flowers,  and  rolls  it  into  little  pellets, 
which  she  places  in  two  hollows  on  the  outside  of  her  hind- 
legs,  called  the  baskets.  -This  is  done  by  her  mouth  and 
these  hairy  legs,  which  help  to  collect  the  pollen,  and  work 
it  into  shape  and  consistence. 

Every  leg  has  ten  rows  of  these  hairs,  and  sixteen  hairs 
in  a  row.  Count  them,  and  observe  how  short  and  stiff 
they  are,  exactly  what  the  Bee  wants  for  her  work. 

FOBE-LEG    OF   BEE. 

The  fore-legs  of  the  Hive-bee,  or  Carder,  or  Humble-bee, 
exhibit  a  peculiar  notch  and  spur  on  the  tibia,  which  the 
insect  uses  for  clinging  each  to  the  other  in  the  festoons 
of  wax-secreting  labourers,  or  for  nipping  the  legs  of  an 
enemy.  There  is  a  deep  notch  edged  with  stiff  short 
bristles,  and  above  it  a  spur,  fashioned  somewhat  like  the 
blade  of  a  pocket-knife,  which  closes  over  it,  and  must  be  a, 
most  useful  appendage  to  the  busy  Carder-bee  in  hackling 
its  moss.  It  must  not  be  soaked  long  in  potash  or  the 
spur  falls  off.  Mounted  dry  for  the  binocular  it  is  well 
seen,  and  the  modifications  adapted  to  each  species  are 
very  interesting. 

LEG   OF    GYBINUS. 

The  Gyrinus  is  a  small  Water-beetle,  that  merry  little 
fellow  who  assembles  with  a  host  of  comrades,  whirls  round 
in  ceaseless  play  on  the  surface  of  the  quiet  pond,  or  sunny 
margin  of  the  river.  Boys  call  it  the  Whirligig  Beetle. 
These  curious  hind-legs,  of  which  he  has  four,  are  the  oars 
and  helm  by  which  he  propels  and  steers  his  little  body 
with  such  velocity  through  the  water. 

The  structure  is  remarkable,  the  femur  and  tibia  are 
somewhat  triangular,  the  latter  fringed  with  short  spines, 
and  long  flattened  filaments ;  in  the  middle  pair  of  legs 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  97 

these  filaments  are  on  both  margins,  on  the  hindmost  only 
on  the  outer  margin. 

The  tarsi  are  five-jointed,  but  the  three  upper  ones  are 
most  curiously  fashioned  into  long  leaf-like  lobes,  fringed 
with  spines,  the  fourth  joint  is  about  the  same  size  and 
semi-circular,  and  the  fifth  very  short-armed,  with  two 
claws,  as  indeed  is  each  tarsal  joint. 

Circulating  currents  may  be  seen  in  the  hind-legs.  Also, 
if  you  catch  one,  examine  its  very  curious  eyes  divided  into 
two  parts,  the  upper  group  for  viewing  objects  in  the  air, 
and  the  lower  those  in  the  water.  The  antenna?  are  remark- 
able, not  only  in  shape,  but  in  being  retractile  and  having 
each  an  ear-like  joint  fringed  with  colourless  flat  hairs,  which 
shuts  it  into  the  cavity  in  front  of  the  eyes. 

LEG   OF   BRACHINUS. 

(Bomladier  Beetle.) 

A  small  red  and  black  Beetle,  common  near  London, 
which  has  the  power  of  defending  itself  by  letting  off  smoke 
with  the  noise  of  a  pop-gun.  It  is  furnished  with  an  internal 
bladder  capable  of  firing  off  twenty  shots  in  succession.  If 
this  smoke  gets  into  the  eyes  it  makes  them  smart  as  if 
they  had  been  bathed  with  brandy.  This  little  fellow  has  a 
bitter  enemy  in  the  Calamosa,  a  larger  beetle,  which  hunts  it 
without  mercy.  As  it  finds  it  impossible  to  escape  by  speed 
of  foot,  it  stops  short  and  awaits  its  pursuer ;  but  just  as 
he  is  about  to  seize  it,  he  is  saluted  by  a  discharge,  and 
while  he  is  for  a  moment  stupefied  with  surprise,  the 
bombadier  endeavours  to  gain  a  hiding  place. — (See  '  Insect 
Miscellanies';  also  Bouche  de  Brachinus,  in  Baker's  col- 
lection.) 

LEG   OF   AXCHOMESUS, 

a  small  green  Beetle,  nearly  allied  to  Brachinus,  as  the 
leg  will  show ;  both  of  them  have  that  very  curious  curve 
in  the  tibia  which  is  peculiar  to  the  Carabici.  These  are 
swift-running  beetles,  and  many  of  them  have  no  wings 
under  their  elytra :  they  belong  to  the  Pentamera,  having 
jive  tarsi  or  ankle-joints. — (See  also  Bouche  et  Palpes,  in 
Baker's  collection.) 


98  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 


LEG   OF   CALATHUS   CASTELLOIDES. 

A  very  abundant  and  pretty  Beetle  about  half  an  inch 
long,  black  or  brown,  with  black,  or  sometimes  red  legs. 
Found  under  stones  near  London.  It  has  five  joints  in 
the  tarsi,  therefore  belongs  to  the  first  order  of  Coleoptera, 
the  Pentamera.  The  claws  are  toothed  like  a  comb, 
and  the  male  has  three  joints  of  the  anterior  tarsi  dilated. 
(See  also  Bouche  et  Palpes  de  Calathus,  in  Baker's  col- 
lection.) 

STING   OF   WASP   AND   BEE. 

The  weapon  of  defence  given  to  these  insects  consists  of 
a  barbed  dart  and  a  bag  of  subtle  poison.  The  dart  itself 
is  composed  of  two  blades,  with  serrated  edges,  enclosed  in 
a  sheath,  and  attached  by  strong  muscles  to  the  side  of  the 
abdomen ;  near  the  slit  by  which  it  protrudes  are  two  hairy 
appendages,  which  act  as  brushes  and  keep  it  clean,  and  at 
a  short  distance  within  a  slender  canal  leads  to  the  bag  of 
poison,  which,  pressed  by  the  muscles  in  the  act  of  stinging, 
gives  out  the  acrid  drop  which  irritates  the  wound  to  such 
painful  swelling. 

STING   OF   GNAT. 

See  Head  of  Gnat. 

STING   OF   TABANUS. 

See  Head  of  Tabanus. 


EGG   OF   BOT-FLY,    OR   CESTRUS. 

There  is  not  a  more  curious  and  interesting  object  than 
this.  Those  little  spots  which  cover  the  fore-legs  of  horses 
from  the  latter  end  of  July  to  the  end  of  September,  are 
eggs  like  this,  deposited  by  a  fly  called  (Estrus,  or  Gad-fly. 
The  longest  period  of  this  fly's  life  is  passed  in  the  intes- 
tines of  the  horse,  and  all  the  winter  every  horse  exposed 
by  field  work  or  pasture  feeding  to  the  attacks  of  the 
(Estrus  is  full  of  the  larva?  which  hatch  from  this  egg. 

The  fly  itself  appears  only  in  July,  and  is  properly  called 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  99 

Gasterophilus,  or  Stomach-lover.  A  tawny  body  very  hairy, 
wings  dingy  white,  and  with  a  transverse  gray  band ;  with- 
out any  proboscis,  for  it  lives  but  a  very  short  time — only 
to  lay  its  eggs  and  die.  The  abdomen  is  bent  inwards,  the 
female  having  a  retractile  tube  consisting  of  four  pieces, 
and  terminating  in  five  points,  within  which  she  holds  the 
egg,  and  hovers  over  the  horse,  lightly  darting  at  him, 
and  depositing  each  egg  upon  a  hair.  This  egg  is  firmly 
attached  by  some  glutinous  substance,  and  is,  as  you  may 
observe,  finely  striated  and  furnished  with  an  operculum  or 
lid,  hinged  and  fitted  on  that  oblique  top.  When  the  larva 
is  fully  formed,  the  egg,  which  is  always  placed  where  the 
horse  most  frequently  licks  itself,  opens  under  the  warm 
moisture  of  the  tongue,  and  the  larva,  which  is  provided 
with  hooks  for  the  purpose,  clings  to  the  tongue,  and  is 
swallowed  with  the  saliva  or  the  food.  By  two  long  sharp 
hooks  you  may  see  folded  downwards  on  the  larva  it  attaches 
itself  to  the  inner  coat  of  the  horse's  stomach,  nourished 
by  the  warmth  and  the  mucus  until  the  spring,  when  it  has 
grown  nearly  an  inch  long ;  it  then  unhooks  itself,  mingles 
with  the  food,  and  passes  out  as  what  grooms  call  bots. 
The  next  change  is  that  it  wriggles  into  the  earth,  and 
becomes  a  pupa,  lies  there  a  few  weeks,  and  comes  forth  as 
a  perfect  fly,  to  rise  up  and  seek  its  mate,  who  dies  imme- 
diately after  their  union,  and  the  female  lingers  but  a  few 
days  longer,  to  deposit  a  hundred  eggs,  or  more,  as  her 
appointed  task  on  earth. 


100  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 


CHAPTER  III. 

INSECTS  MOUNTED  WHOLE. 
COLEOPTERA,    HEMIPT.    HYMEN  OPT.,    as    C.    iv.    DIPTERA. 

HITHERTO  we  have  only  examined  parts  of  various 
insects,  and  whilst  they  have  surprised  and  delighted  us  by 
their  curious  or  beautiful  forms,  and  shown  us  how  perfectly 
they  are  adapted  to  the  wants  of  each  insect ;  yet  we  have 
but  a  very  imperfect  idea  of  the  anatomy  of  any  single 
insect  without  one  of  these  beautiful  preparations. 

They  cost  years  of  thought  and  experience  to  bring  to 
this  perfection.  To  preserve  the  delicate  body  entire,  yet 
make  it  perfectly  transparent,  so  as  to  display  every  joint, 
and  in  many  cases  its  internal  muscular"  structure ;  to  fix 
it  in  its  natural  position,  and  embalm  it,  as  it  were,  in  the 
clear  preservative  medium,  Canada  balsam  ;  to  draw  out 
the  beautiful  tongue,  or  the  wonderful  ovipositor,  and  show 
the  varied  and  fragile  antennae,  or  lay  out  the  fine  tissue 
of  the  wings,  was  the  work  of  many  a  day  before  this  art 
was  attained. 

And  these  slides  are  so  valuable  to  the  young  student  of 
natural  history  that  no  microscope  box  should  be  without 
one  or  two  illustrations  of  each  of  these  orders — Coleoptera, 
Hemiptera,  Hymenoptera,  and  Diptera. 

No  engraving  can  teach  the  lesson  upon  insect  anatomy 
so  well  as  that  which  is  learnt  at  the  microscope  with  one 
of  these  slides  upon  the  stage. 

Take,  for  instance,  one  of  the  Coleoptera — 

THE   TELEPHORUS,    OR    SOLDIER-BEETLE. 

We  find  this  little  creature  abundantly  in  our  gardens,  on 
hedges,  and  on  the  long  grass  of  a  sunny  June  morning ; 
but  especially  on  the  flowers  of  all  Umbelliferse,  such  as 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  101 

the  wild  Parsnip,  Carrot,  and  Parsley.  They  have  orange- 
coloured  elytra,  or  green  or  buff,  tipped  with  red.  Chil- 
dren call  them  "  soldiers"  and  "  sailors."  Carnivorous  in 
their  tastes,  they  haunt  flowers  for  the  smaller  insects  they 
feed  upon,  and  seize  them  fiercely  in  their  strong  pointed 
mandibles.  When  we  touch  them  they  depress  their  heads, 
become  motionless,  and  counterfeit  death. 

They  lay  their  eggs  in  damp  shady  places  in  the  earth, 
where  the  larvae  hatch  and  live.  These  are  velvety,  black, 
long,  soft-bodied  maggots,  with  strong  mandibles  on  their 
heads,  and  a  curious  fleshy  tubercle  beneath  the  last  segment 
of  the  body,  which  they  use  in  walking. 

Use  your  lowest  power  in  examining  these  preparations 
for  a  general  view  of  the  insect,  and  then  change  the  object 
glass  progressively  upward  to  the  highest  power  for  such 
parts  as  require  particular  attention — the  tongue,  the 
eye,  &c. 

The  first  part  to  look  at  in  a  slide  of  Coleoptera  is  the 
foot,  because  the  number  of  joints  immediately  above 
the  claw,  which  are  called  tarsi,  determines  its  position  in 
the  family  group.  All  the  Beetle  tribe  are  divided  into 
families  according  to  the  number  of  joints  of  their  tarsi. 
There  are  four  sections — 

The  Pentamera     .     or  five-jointed. 
The  Heteromera  .     or  five-jointed   anterior,  and   four- 
jointed  posterior  tarsi. 

The  Tetramera     .     or  four  joints  to  all  the  tarsi. 
The  Trimera    .     .     or  three-jointed  tarsi. 

The  foot  of  Telephorus,  having  five  joints,  belongs  to 
the  first  section.  Observe  how  deeply  the  penultimate  joint 
is  bilobed — that  the  tibia  or  joint  above  the  tarsi  has  two 
small  spurs — that  the  femur  or  thigh  is  stout,  and  attached 
to  the  thorax  by  two  other  joints  called  the  coxa  and  the 
troclianter. 

Next  observe  the  antennae ;  for  after  deciding  this  little 
beetle  to  belong  to  the  section  of  the  Pentamera,  you  will 
know  that  it  is  also  one  of  the  Serricornes,  or  third  family 


102  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

of  the  Pentamera,  by  its  long  slender  eleven-jointed  antennae 
of  the  same  thickness  throughout. 

Next  examine  the  curious  hatchet-shaped  joint  at  the 
end  of  the  palpi — small  feelers  attached  to  the  jaws, 
and  which  are  very  important  points  for  observation,  as 
their  number  and  shape  determine  the  species  of  many 
beetles. 

We  now  see  the  various  parts  of  the  mouth — the  labruin 
or  lip  notched  in  front ;  the  two  hairy  maxillae  formed  of 
five  pieces  delicately  fringed,  and  used  for  cleansing  the 
food  ;  two  strong  mandibles  or  jaws  for  seizing  their  prey. 

Two  compound  eyes  which,  in  the  male,  occupy  nearly 
the  whole  of  the  head. 

The  thorax,  or  body,  to  which  are  attached  the  three 
pairs  of  legs,  and  the  wings  and  wing-cases. 

This  thorax  is  a  wonderful  piece  of  mechanism.  It 
cannot  be  so  well  seen  in  this  slide,  because  the  elytra  or 
wing-cases  partly  cover  it ;  but  it  should  be  carefully  studied 
in  various  specimens.  There  are  three  chief  parts — 

The  pro-thorax ;  the  segment  nearest  the  heart,  and 
supporting  the  first  pair  of  legs. 

The  meso-thorax  :  bearing  the  elytra,  or  wing-cases,  and 
the  middle  pair  of  legs. 

The  meta-thorax;  bearing  the  wings  and  the  last  pair  of 
legs. 

But  these  are  again  composed  of  no  less  than  twenty- 
two  smaller  pieces,  equally  distinct  and  present  in  the  thorax 
of  the  tiniest  beetle  ;  and  if  we  consider  the  complicated 
machinery  necessary  for  the  direction  and  control  of  all  the 
muscles  required  for  insect  locomotion,  the  care  bestowed 
upon  the  formation  of  the  thorax  will  be  at  once  accounted 
for.  The  movement  of  the  legs  in  running,  creeping, 
climbing,  swimming,  fighting,  seizing  their  prey,  cleansing 
their  bodies,  and  the  varied  motions  of  the  wings  and 
wing-cases — these  all  demand  distinct  muscles  and  points 
of  attachment.  The  whole  cavity  of  the  thorax  is  occupied 
by  the  wing  and  leg  muscles,  and  the  great  ganglion  of 
nerve  which  directs  them  as  a  viceregent  from  the  seat  of 
sensation,  the  head. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  103 

And  whilst  looking  at  the  thorax  of  this  little  Beetle,  as 
hereafter  we  may  look  at  that  of  a  Fly,  it  will  not  lessen 
our  pleasure  to  be  reminded  of  the  many  kinds  of  muscles 
that  worked  unerringly  the  will  of  this  small  creature.  It 
had  its  levator  muscles  for  raising  its  limbs;  depressors, 
antagonistic  to  these,  for  depressing  them ;  flexors  for  bend- 
ing the  joints  ;  extensors  for  unbending  or  extending  them  ; 
abductors  for  drawing  an  organ  backward,  and  abductors 
for  drawing  it  forward ;  constrictors  that  contract  a  body  or 
an  opening  as  in  breathing ;  laxators  that  relax  it.  All 
these  are  in  quick  action  in  the  little  insect  that  runs  over 
your  hand  or  escapes  from  your  eye  ;  all  these  have  been 
planned  and  attached,  and  the  numbers  so  accurately  inter- 
woven, that  they  work  without  hindrance  or  confusion  by 
the  creative  word  of  the  Most  High. 

As  the  head  for  sensation,  with  its  ganglion  and  branch- 
ing nerves,  and  the  thorax  for  locomotion,  so  the  abdomen, 
usually  in  nine  segments,  is  appointed  as  the  digester  of 
food  and  the  organ  of  generation. 

The  internal  parts  of  an  insect  cannot  be  seen  in  these 
preparations.  We  must  therefore  confine  our  attention 
to  the  external  anatomy,  and,  before  this  slide  is  put  away, 
examine  the  wing. 

The  wing  of  a  Beetle  should  be  compared  with  that  of  a 
Fly,  in  order  to  appreciate  its  peculiar  structure.  The 
substance  is  membranous,  double  and  joined  together  by 
canals  or  nervures,  through  which  the  blood  circulates — a 
tracheal  vessel  runs,  and  a  nerve,  branching  from  the 
thoracic  ganglion,  and  giving  off  innumerable  fibres  to 
groups  of  vesicles  situated  immediately  beneath  the  costal 
nerve.  This  is  only  seen  with  very  high  powers  and  good 
glasses ;  also  requiring  a  particular  preparation  of  the  wing. 
It  must  simply  be  soaked  in  turpentine  for  a  week  or  more, 
and  mounted  in  balsam  warmed  just  enough  to  receive  the 
wing,  when  the  tracheal  vessel,  the  nerve,  and  the  vesicles, 
may  be  distinctly  seen  with  a  good  J-in.  or  J-in.  object 
glass. 

That  strong  nerve  on  the  forepart  of  the  wing  is  the 
costal  nerve.  As  the  Beetle's  wing  is  folded  under  the 


104  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

elytron  when  in  repose,  the  costal  nerve  ends  abruptly,  as 
we  see,  at  about  half  the  length  of  the  wing,  and  turning 
backward  into  the  post-costal  nervure,  forms  a  kind  of 
hook,  strengthens  the  base,  and  allows  of  the  easy  folding 
up  of  the  tip  of  the  wing. 

There  is  a  particular  provision  made  for  the  regulation 
of  the  specific  weight  of  the  beetle's  wing  by  means  of  a 
long  pocket  just  under  the  costal  and  mediastinal  nervures, 
called  the  Phialum,  into  which  a  liquid  is  introduced  at  the 
will  of  the  insect,  which  augments  its  powers  of  resistance 
in  flight. 

The  veins,  or  nervures,  are  so  placed  throughout  this 
wing  as  to  strengthen  and  stretch  every  part :  at  the  same 
time  to  admit  of  its  being  closely  and  easily  folded  under 
the  protecting  elytron  ;  a  most  necessary  arrangement  for 
creatures  who  live  in  the  earth  or  tinder  stones,  or  in  the 
water,  where  the  delicate  texture  of  the  wing  would  be  in 
constant  danger  of  destruction. 

Having  thus  examined  one  specimen  of  the  Beetle  tribe, 
we  shall  be  able  with  increased  interest  to  look  at  another, 
one  of  the  small  Water-beetles. 

HELOPHOKUS    GRANULARIS. 

This  is  an  abundant  little  creature  in  our  ponds  and 
ditches,  feeding  on  decayed  or  vegetable  matter,  and,  being 
easily  procured,  is  selected  as  an  example  of  a  Pentamerous 
Coleoptera,  but  of  the  family  of  the  Palpicornes,  the 
antennse  being  very  different  from  those  of  the  Telephorus. 
These  are  clubbed,  composed  of  nine  joints,  and  carried 
backwards. 

It  is  a  bad  swimmer,  and  the  legs  are  scarcely,  if  at  all, 
feathered  ;  the  striped  pro-thorax  and  the  beautifully 
dotted  elytra  make  it  a  favourite  and  valuable  object. 

The  sculpture  of  the  elytra  of  Beetles  is  most  remark- 
able ;  the  ridges  strengthen,  the  furrows  lighten,  the  dots 
give  air  to  the  spiracles  beneath.  In  the  Helophorus 
alternate  rowrs  of  large  and  small  dots  answer  both  pur- 
poses, and  usefulness  as  well  as  beauty  write  the  wisdom  of 
God  upon  the  wing-case  of  this  little  creature. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  105 


CATHERETES   URTICLE. 

This  is  a  lovely  little  Beetle  ;  as  we  see  by  its  tarsi,  it 
is  one  of  the  Pentamera,  though  at  first  sight  easily  mis- 
taken for  one  of  the  four-jointed  Coleoptera,  as  the  fifth 
joint  is  very  small,  and  only  visible  from  beneath.  The 
antenna  show  that  it  belongs  to  the  Clavicorne  family,  for 
they  are  clubbed.  This  particular  little  Beetle  is  one  of  a 
fiovver-loving  group  called  Nitidididat,  always  easily  recog- 
nised by  having  eleven  joints  in  the  antennae,  and  the  last 
three  in  a  club,  or  strung  like  beads,  with  an  interval 
between  each.  The  spotted  elytra  are  beautiful.  The 
facetted  eyes  and  the  delicate  mouth  will  require  a  higher 
power  rightly  to  examine  them.  And  this  exquisite  insect 
is  one  we  may  see  in  swarms  upon  nettles  revelling  in  the 
pendent  blossoms  any  sunny  summer's  day — very  small 
black  creeping  things  we  pass  unheeded  by. 

COCCINELLA,    OR   LADY-BIRD. 

This  familiar  little  visitor  is  not  only  a  beautiful  object 
for  the  microscope,,  but  a  real  friend  to  the  florist,  who  is 
apt  to  be  disappointed  and  angered  by  what  is  called 
the  "green  blight"  upon  the  roses,  and  is  not  perhaps 
aware  that  two  or  three  Lady-birds  would  clear  it  all 
away  much  better  than  the  usual  means  applied  by 
gardeners. 

The  Lady-bird  is  particularly  fond  of  Aphides,  and,  in 
its  larva  state,  pupa  state,  and  perfect  form,  will  greedily 
devour  them,  darting  at  an  Aphis,  and  seizing  it  in  those 
strong  little  jaws,  shaking  it  as  a  terrier  does  a  rat,  and 
sucking  its  life  away  ;  then  dropping  the  empty  body,  and 
springing  upon  another  and  another.  The  little  Coccinella 
has  frequently  saved  our  fir  plantations  from  the  host  of 
destroying  Aphis  in  the  spring  ;  and  our  bean-fields,  when 
attacked  by  the  black  blight  (Aphis  faboa),  are  often 
cleared  again  in  an  incredibly  short  time  by  the  avenger 
God  has  given  us  in  this  lovely  little  Beetle. 

It  is  one  of  the  Trimera,  three  joints  only  in  the  tarsi. 


106  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

The  antennae  eleven-jointed,  and  terminated  by  a  reversed 
conical  club. 

I  must  not  describe  so  fully  any  more  of  these  beautiful 
slides ;  but  recommend  you,  if  possible,  to  obtain  the 
following  whole  mounted  Coleoptera : 

Lcecophilus   Minutas,  remarkable  for  its  feathered  legs. 

Hattwdj  or  Turnip-fly,  „  „  thick  muscular 

thighs  for  leaping. 

Thy  anus,  or  Grass-flea,  also  with  muscular  thighs  and 
sculptured  elytra. 

Dimonia  cynoglossi .  one  of  the  Tetramera,  with  thick- 
ened thighs  and  beautiful  head. 

Haliplus  confirms  .  one  of  the  Hydrocantheri,  or 
Swimmers,  with  beautifully  fringed 
legs  for  swimming. 

Hyphidius  ovatus  .  one  of  the  Water-beetles,  with 
fringed  legs  for  swimming,  and  a 
curious  spine  at  the  tip  of  each 
elytron. 

Oyrinus  natator  .  a  Water-beetle.  (This  is  described 
in  leg  of  Gyrinus.) 


HEMIPTEEA. 

These  are  sucking  insects.  Their  mouth  has  a  long 
retractile  tube,  and  several  tine  lancets,  forming  a  long  pro- 
boscis, which  is  laid  along  the  breast  during  repose,  and 
maybe  seen  in  all  the  Field-bugs  (Cimex)  and  the  Aphides, 
which  belong  to  this  order.  The  wings  are  membranous, 
and  covered  with  semi-transparent  cases  analogous  to  the 
elytra  of  Beetles.  The  tarsi  are  always  three-jointed.  A 
few  of  them  inhabit  the  water,  and  of  these  the  Velia  rivn- 
lorum  and  Notonecta  are  mounted  whole. 

VELIA   KIVULOKUM. 

Most  people  have  observed  groups  of  water  insects 
sporting  on  the  surface  of  small  ponds,  or  swimming 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  107 

against  small  streams,  walking  lightly  on  the  still  water, 
and  resting  on  the  stems  of  grass  or  water  weeds  around. 
One  species  (Gerris)  has  a  long  thin  black  body  and  very 
long  legs  ;  but  Velia  may  be  known  by  its  scarlet  spots  on 
each  side  of  its  body.  The  two-jointed  sucker  and  the 
wing-cases  should  be  carefully  examined. 

NOTONECTA,    OR   THE   WATER-BOATMAN, 

is  a  beautiful  preparation,  exhibiting  the  retractile  sucker, 
which  is  a  formidable  weapon,  and  pricks  sharply;  the 
eyes  very  large  ;  the  hind-legs  fringed  with  long  hairs  and 
in  the  form  of  oars,  which  it  uses  with  great  rapidity, 
rowing  or  swimming  always  on  the  back,  and  looking  like 
a  canoe  propelled  by  a  clever  boatman.  The  eggs  of  this 
insect  are  found  abundantly  on  the  other  side  of  Water- 
lily  leaves,  or  of  Potomageton  ;  small  flask-like  eggs 
through  which,  in  an  advanced  state,  the  red  eyes  of  the 
little  Notonecta  may  be  seen,  and  when  it  comes  forth,  it 
only  resembles  its  parent  in  its  feathered  legs  and  quick 
movements,  having  no  wings  until  it  has  moulted  several 
times,  and  changed  from  the  larva  to  the  pupa  state,  in 
which,  however,  it  is  by  no  means  inactive,  for  the  pupa 
of  Hemiptera  feeds  as  heartily  as  the  perfect  insect.  This 
Notonecta  is  a  fierce  and  powerful  enemy  to  all  smaller 
aquatic  insects,  transfixing  them  with  his  sharp  proboscis, 
and  sucking  their  life  away. 

BEDUYIUS,    OR   BED-BUG, 

is  one  of  this  order,  and  the  sucker,  though  short,  is  very 
strong,  and  capable  of  producing  much  pain. 

CIMEX,    OR   FIELD-BUG. 

These  are  beautiful  objects  when  mounted.  The  head  is 
prolonged  like  a  snout,  more  or  less  triangular ;  and  the 
sheath  of  the  sucker  is  composed  of  four  distinct  joints ; 
they  prey  upon  other  insects ;  the  body  is  often  brightly 
coloured  and  spotted.  We  find  them  abundantly  on  long 
grass  or  field  flowers  in  the  hot  days  of  summer,  and  one 


108  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

species,  Pentatoma  griseus,  is  interesting  from  the  care  which 
the  female  takes  of  her  young,  not  only  in  brooding  over 
her  eggs,  but  in  leading  her  little  family  about  as  a  hen 
does  her  chickens. 

APHIS. 

A  specimen  of  the  green  or  black  blight  will  be  very 
interesting  to  the  florist,  although  the  Aphis  of  the  elder 
or  the  box  are  prettier  in  having  variegated  bodies.  There 
are  no  less  than  160  known  species,  and  few  insects  have  a 
more  curious  and  interesting  biography.  'Kirby  and 
Spence's  Entomology/  and  THistoire  des  Hemipteres,  de 
MM.  Serville  and  Amyot,'  will  give  abundant  information 
to  the  student  of  natural  history. 

I  can  only  draw  attention  to  the  external  form,  and  point 
out  the  remarkable  long  antennae  thrown  backwards ;  the 
proboscis,  fine  and  sharp,  with  which  it  pierces  the  young 
shoots  of  our  rose-trees,  or  the  fibres  on  the  under  side  of 
our  currant-trees  and  vines,  causing  them  to  curl  up  and 
turn  red.  Those  two  horns  on  the  back  are  tubes  from 
which  exude  small  drops  of  saccharine  matter  or  honey- 
dew,  of  which  the  ants  are  so  fond  that,  wherever  these 
Aphides  abound,  there  the  Garden  Ant  will  follow,  and 
may  be  seen  sucking  it  from  them. 

These  Ants  take  absolute  possession  of  some  species. 

The  Aphis  radicum,  which  feed  on  the  roots  of  plants,  are 
kept  by  the  Yellow  Ants  in  their  formicaries  under-ground, 
and  milked  as  cows  are  by  us.  This  may  be  watched  on 
rose-trees  or  oak-trees,  the  little  Ants  following  an  Aphis, 
tapping  them,  and  pressing  their  sides  to  make  them  jerk 
out  the  sweet  fluid. 

The  tarsi  are  only  two-jointed,  the  eyes  compound. 
They  are  both  winged  and  wingless,  and  the  Aphis  wings 
are  always  carried  with  the  fan  edges  upward,  and  have 
either  a  row  of  booklets  or  a  tuft  of  seven  or  eight  hooks, 
which  attach  the  wing-case  and  wing  together,  like  the 
hamuli  of  the  Hymenoptera. 

The  rapid  increase  of  these  insects  is  astonishing :  a 
single  Aphis  may  in  one  season  become  the  parent  of  as 


Scales  of  Moths  and  Butterflies. 


Plate  6. 


10 


1.  Wing  of  Herald  Moth.        2.  Spot  on  Herald  Moth's  wing,  magnified  60  diameters. 
3.  Eye-like  spot  on  wing  of  Emperor  Moth.  4.  Part  of  eye-like  spot,  magd.  60  diams. 

5.  Scales  of  Underwing  Moth,  magnified  80  diameters. 

7.  Brimstone  Butterfly.        8.  Scales  of  Brimstone  Butterfly,  magnified  150  diameters. 
9.  Scales  of  Red  Admiral  Butterfly,  magnified  100  diameters.         10.  Scale,  magd.  150  diams. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  109 

many  as  5,904,900,000  descendants.  The  fact  that  these 
are  produced  by  females  without  more  than  one  impregna- 
tion throughout  nine  generations  long  perplexed  our  natu- 
ralists. Bonnet  isolated  females  most  carefully,  and  obtained 
nine  generations  in  three  mouths.  It  is  now  ascertained 
that  certain  females  couple  and  lay  eggs  only  in  the 
autumn,  and  that  throughout  spring  and  summer  the  young 
ones  are  produced  alive  by  a  process  of  gemmation  from 
what  are  called  Nurses. 

All  through  the  winter  one  solitary  female  Aphis,  which 
I  had  placed  in  my  bedroom  window  on  the  leaf  of  a  tulip, 
continued  to  present  me  with  pretty  little  pink-eyed  stag- 
gering things,  until  the  whole  plant  was  covered  with  them  ; 
and  very  curious  it  was  to  see  the  small  Aphis  keep  close 
to  its  mother's  side  for  some  hours,  whilst  she  seemed 
tenderly  to  caress  it  with  her  long  antennae,  until  another 
required  her  care,  and  this  one  was  able  to  join  the  group 
of  sisters  at  a  little  distance,  whose  tiny  suckers  were 
plunged  into  the  juices  of  my  Van  Tromp. 

For  an  account  of  their  enemies  and  our  avengers,  see 
Hynienoptera,  Aphidius  avena. 

APHROPHORA,    OR   CUCKOO-SPIT. 

I  suppose  all  florists  will  like  to  have  this  slide,  because 
they  so  well  know  a  certain  frothy  substance  which  abounds 
on  their  Carnation  plants,  Lychnis,  Rose-trees,  and  Willows, 
in  which  sits  a  little  green  creature  with  red  eyes ;  a  soft, 
frightened,  innocent-looking  little  larva,  which  I  never  could 
help  covering  again  with  the  white  froth  if  I  had  blown  it 
aside  for  a  moment.  And  this  was  the  defence  of  the  young 
Aphrophora  we  are  now  looking  at :  it  passed  from  that 
larva  into  a  pupa,  and  then  into  this  perfect  state  with  wings 
and  wing-cases,  with  a  long  sucking  tube,  which  pierced  the 
stems  of  our  flowers  and  dried  up  the  plant  by  abstracting 
the  sweet  fluids  needful  to  its  growth.  Observe  the  mottled 
wing-case,  all  of  uniform  texture,  which  shows  it  to  belong 
to  the  second  division  of  Hemiptera,  called  Homoptera ;  the 
wing  with  longitudinal  nerves  forked  at  the  tip.  The  legs, 
which  leap  wonderfully  high,  are  remarkably  circled  at  each 


110  Objects  for  the  Microscope.  • 

tibia  by  a  crown  of  spines.     The  mouth  is  better  displayed 
in  a  specimen  of  Cimex. 

THRIPS. 

This  is  not  now  one  of  the  Hemiptera,  but  belongs  to  a 
very  small  order  called  Thysanoptera.  We  find  these  very 
minute  insects  swarming  in  our  flowers,  especially  in  the 
Carnations  and  Lilies.  They  are  long,  black,  active  little 
creatures,  looking  like  small  beetles,  and  turn  up  their  tails 
in  a  quick  impatient  way  that  reminds  us  of  the  Staphy- 
linus,  so  fragile  that  we  cannot  handle  them,  except  when 
mounted  thus. 

The  short  antennae  we  see  have  eight  joints,  the  terminal 
joints  armed  with  a  seta.  There  are  four  wings  of  equal 
size  deeply  fringed  with  hairs  on  all  sides,  and  usually  un- 
noticed, because  they  lie  horizontally  upon  the  back,  and  we 
seldom  see  them  in  use.  The  tarsi  are  short,  and  terminated 
by  a  vesicle  instead  of  a  claw.  The  mouth  has  mandibles 
and  palpi,  as  well  as  a  rostrum,  or  beak,  with  which  it 
pierces  the  delicate  young  leaves  of  our  Cucumbers,  Melons, 
Vines,  and  fruit-trees,  causing  them  to  shrivel  up.  They 
also  feed  upon  the  pollen  and  pistil  of  the  blossom,  and  often 
cause  the  failure  of  our  fruit,  and  of  the  wheat  crop,  by 
creeping  in  between  the  valves  of  the  green  ear.  Earwigs 
avenge  us  by  preying  upon  them,  which  florists  would  do 
well  to  remember  when  they  accuse  the  earwig  of  the 
destruction  of  their  Carnations. 

HYMENOPTEKA. 
TENTHREDO,    OR    SAW-FLY. 

Sometimes  we  find  "  the  saws "  only  of  this  curious  fly 
mounted  for  the  microscope  ;  but  at  Baker's,  and  Smith  and 
Beck's,  you  will  doubtless  obtain  the  whole  insect  beauti- 
fully prepared,  and  it  is  worth  any  money  in  the  naturalist's 
collection,  both  as  an  example  of  the  Hymenoptera  wing  and 
head,  and  also  for  its  complicated  and  wonderful  ovipositor. 
Few  of  the  Hymenoptera  can  be  mounted  whole,  for  the 
order  comprises  all  our  Bees,  Wasps,  Ants,  Saw-flies, 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  Ill 

Ichneumon-flies,  and  Gall-flies.  It  .is  a  most  interesting 
group  in  the  insect  world,  extremely  intelligent,  and  com- 
missioned by  its  Creator  to  minister  to  our  comfort  and  to 
defend  us  from  injury  in  a  way  that  is  little  known  beyond 
the  labours  of  the  Honey-bee. 

The  Hymenoptera  are  distinguished  from  all  those  which 
are  called  flies,  by  having  four  wings  instead  of  two, 
wholly  membranous,  veined,  and  divided  into  cells,  but  not 
assuming  the  appearance  of  network,  as  do  those  of  the 
Dragon-fly,  the  Hemerobitis,  the  Ephemera,  or  May-fly  ; 
neither  are  they  veined  at  all  like  the  wings  of  the  real 
fly  (Diptera), — yet  the  plan  is  perfect,  both  to  distinguish 
the  group,  and  in  that  group  the  species  from  each  other,  as 
we  shall  presently  prove.  The  eyes  are  large  and  compound 
in  all  the  Hymenoptera  ;  they  have  generally  three  simple 
eyes,  or  ocelli,  on  the  crown  of  the  head  ;  the  jaws  are 
strong  ;  the  tongue  of  varied  structure  (see  Tongue  of  Bee 
and  Wasp),  because  the  mouth  organs  are  used  not  only 
for  food,  but  also  for  labour  in  the  structure  of  nests,  and 
in  providing  for  their  young.  The  feet  are  somewhat  like 
those  of  the  Diptera,  but  are  sometimes  terminated  by 
toothed  claws  (see  Foot  of  Ophion) ;  the  tibia  are  often 
armed  with  spines,  or  very  curious  spur-like  appendages, 
especially  in  these  Saw-flies,  and  the  tarsi  are  five-jointed. 
As  a  rule  they  all  feed  upon  flowers,  but  I  have  found  them 
very  voraciously  attacking  insects  in  the  hot  sunshine  of  a 
June  morning. 

Their  metamorphosis  is  complete ;  that  is,  they  lay  eggs, 
become  larvae  with  six-hooked  feet,  spin  a  cocoon,  and 
change  to  pupa ;  then  rise  up  and  go  forth  winged  and 
perfect. 

The  wing  of  the  Hymenoptera  is  the  most  important 
part  in  ascertaining  the  genera,  for  all  the  antennae  are 
long,  varying  from  thirteen  joints  to  as  many  as  sixty  or 
seventy.  They  vibrate  with  singular  sensitiveness,  but  are 
not  like  those  of  the  Diptera,  where  the  antennae  alone  will 
often  decide  a  fly,  and  the  minute  differences  of  their  struc- 
ture is  in  itself  a  study. 

Here  the  index  to  God's  order  is  in  the  wing,  and  if  the 


112  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

wings  of  your  specimen  are  crumpled,  as  often  happens 
when  the  chief  anxiety  is  to  show  the  saws  of  the  fe- 
male, then  you  had  better  get  a  male  Saw-fly  (Cypheus 
pigmcBus),  where  I  doubt  not  they  will  be  expanded  and 
perfect. 

The  first  great  rule  is  this :  look  at  the  costal  nerve  which 
bounds  the  fore  part  of  every  wing,  and  is  the  main  support. 
Observe  in  all  the  Saw-flies  and  Ichneumons  there  is  a  dark 
horny  spot  called  the  stigma ;  from  that  a  nerve  or  vein  runs 
to  the  front  tip  of  the  wing,  dividing  the  enclosure  into 
one  or  two  cells,  called  the  marginal  or  radial  cells.  There 
is  but  one  in  Cypheus — a  large  oblong  one.  Behind  this 
cell,  and  running  nearly  parallel  at  a  little  distance,  is  a 
nerve  which  ends  at  the  tip  of  the  wing,  and  the  inter- 
mediate space  is  divided  into  from  one  to  four  cells,  called 
the  submarginal  or  sub-cubital  cells,  others  in  the  centre  are 
called  discoidal  cells,  and  others,  long  and  narrow  towards 
the  base,  are  basal  cells  ;  but  the  two  former  are  those  upon 
which  the  genera  are  founded.  Is  it  not  wonderful — this 
invariable  order  exhibited  by  the  presences  absence  of  one 
tiny  nerve  ? — always  present  in  every  individual  of  a  given 
species  throughout  the  world ;  varied  perhaps  slightly,  yet 
unerringly  in  the  adjacent  species ;  and  the  progress  of 
neuration  designates  the  rank  of  the  species  more  easily 
in  this  than  in  any  other  tribe  of  insects.  The  little  Platy- 
gaster,  a  very  small  Ichneumon-fly,  which  is  noticed  pre- 
sently, has  only  the  costal  nerve  and  stigma — no  cells  at  all. 
The  pretty  Chrysides,  those  scarlet  and  green  or  blue  flies, 
which  rush  about  restlessly  on  windows  and  walls  in  the 
hot  sun,  and  are  called  the  'Humming-birds  of  insects,  have 
only  the  front  wings  veined,  and  those  with  but  a  single 
cubital  cell,  and  that  not  closed,  and  very  imperfect  sub- 
marginal  ones.  And  then  in  other  genera  they  go  regu- 
larly increasing,  until  the  wing  is  perfected  in  the  Saw- 
flies  and  Bees.  It  makes  our  microscope  so  much  more 
valuable  when  it  helps  us  thus  to  a  personal  acquaintance 
with  the  "  winged  things "  around  us — when  the  eye 
becomes  educated  to  discern  the  letters  of  creation's  alpha- 
bet ;  for  we  are  but  children  in  the  '  First  Reading-book/ 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  113 

and  I  doubt  not  there  are  volumes,  countless  and  full  of 
eternal  wisdom,  laid  up  in  store  for  those  who  delight  in 
the  study  of  God's  works. 

We  can  now  return  to  the  slide  before  us.  The  colour 
of  the  Saw-fly  is  necessarily  lost  in  preparing  it  transpa- 
rently for  our  examination  ;  but  it  was  a  bright  and  beau- 
tiful fly,  yellow,  or  scarlet,  or  light  green  dotted  with  black. 
They  provide  for  their  young  thus.  I  had  the  pleasure  of 
watching  the  motherly  care  of  the  Saw-fly  of  the  rose  (Ten- 
thredo  roses)  last  summer. 

A  busy  little  fly  with  black  thorax  and  yellow  abdomen 
was  at  work  upon  a  rose-tree  so  intently  that  she  did  not 
stir  when  I  drew  near  to  see  what  she  was  about.  She  bent 
her  abdomen  as  you  see  here,  and  had  protruded  a  pair  of 
cutters  such  as  these.  They  are,  in  fact,  finely-toothed  saws 
with  about  eighteen  teeth  each,  and  run  backwards  and 
forwards  in  a  grooved  back-piece,  which  fits  on  each  like  a 
carpenter's  tennon  saw.  They  worked  alternately,  and  pre- 
sently she  changed  her  position  :  she  had  been  cutting  down 
deep,"uow  she  wanted  to  make  a  long  groove,  and  straight- 
ened her  body,  sawing  quite  fast  and  steadily,  making  a 
furrow  about  half  an  inch  long.  Then  she  paused,  and  a 
little  greenish  egg  was  laid  on  one  side,  another  on  the 
opposite  side,  all  along  until  a  double  row  had  been  depo- 
sited of  about  twenty  eggs ;  she  then  gave  out  a  frothy  glue 
which  seemed  to  fix  and  protect  them,  drew  in  her  ovipositor, 
and  flew  off  to  a  neighbouring  tree,  where  I  took  her  for 
examination  of  the  saws.  The  little  eggs  I  looked  at  with 
a  pocket  lens,  and  found  they  were  separated  up  the  middle 
of  the  groove  by  a  fibre  left  on  purpose.  From  day  to  day 
I  watched  them,  and  they  increased  in  size,  which  is  differ- 
ent from  all  other  eggs ;  the  edges  of  the  furrow  became 
black  and  swollen,  but  did  not  close,  and  about  ten  days 
after  I  found  all  the  little  eggs  empty,  and  several  tiny  green 
and  black-dotted  caterpillars  wandering  about,  very  like 
true  caterpillars,  which  they  are  not,  as  may  always  be 
known  by  counting  their  feet,  eighteen  or  twenty,  whereas 
the  larvse  of  butterflies  and  moths,  which  are  real  cater- 
pillars, have  only  from  ten  to  sixteen,  and  never  more. 


114  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

Frequently  our  gooseberry  trees  are  stripped  bare  by 
hosts  of  these  young  Saw-flies  in  larvse ;  they  spin  cocoons, 
and  remain  coiled  up  in  them  all  through  the  winter,  re- 
maining but  a  few  days  in  the  pupa  state,  and  emerging  in 
May  and  June. 

CYPHEUS   PYGM,fiUS, 

another  Saw-fly.  It  will  be  most  interesting  to  the  farmer, 
because  its  larva  is  very  troublesome  in  the  wheat  and  rye- 
fields,  especially  in  France,  where  it  often  destroys  a  great 
part  of  the  crop.  The  fly  itself  is  black  and  yellow ;  the 
male,  as  usual,  differs  from  the  female  in  colour  and  size  ; 
that  is,  he  is  of  a  brighter  yellow,  and  the  wings  clearer 
and  more  iridescent ;  hers  are  clouded,  and  the  yellow  of 
her  body  and  legs  more  ochreous.  The  larva  is  singular  in 
having  no  legs  at  all,  but  a  kind  of  tube  at  the  end  of  its  body 
with  a  telescope  movement  by  which  it  progresses  along  its 
tunnel,  for  it  feeds  in  the  stem  of  wheat  or  rye  ;  and  its 
history  is  interesting.  The  female  Saw-fly  may  be  seen  in 
a  warm  April  day  sawing  a  hole  just  beneath  a  knot  in  the 
tender  stem  of  the  young  wheat,  and  depositing  one  egg  in 
each  straw.  This  is  soon  hatched,  and  forthwith  the  larva 
begins  to  gnaw,  with  some  exceeding  strong  though  tiny 
mandibles,  the  juicy  inside  cells  of  the  stem,  which  of  course 
disturbs  the  economy  of  the  plant,  and  prevents  the  upward 
flow  of  all  the  nourishment  which  is  needful  for  the  growing 
ear.  As  soon  as  it  can  it  proceeds  to  grind  away  the  in- 
terior of  the  knot  also  and  ascend  the  stem.  As  it  grows 
and  thrives,  the  plant  withers  ;  but  in  the  month  of  July 
begins  to  descend  toward  the  earth,  and  a  few  days  before 
harvest-time  it  settles  itself  near  the  root  of  the  wheat,  cuts 
the  straw  regularly  round  inside,  so  that  it  breaks  off  under 
the  first  puff  of  wind,  and  the  little  creature  spins  a  warm 
cocoon  and  lays  itself  up  for  the  winter,  fat  and  happy,  un- 
less a  certain  little  cousin,  one  of  the  Ichneumon-flies,  has 
found  it  out,  when  his  life  will  not  have  reached  this  period, 
or  its  mischief  have  been  so  fatal 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  115 

ICHNEUMON-FLY. 

(Pachymerus  calcitrator.) 

Always  have  several  of  these  in  your  collection  ;  they  are 
beautiful  and  most  interesting ;  they  have  been  appointed 
to  do  a  certain  work,  they  have  been  gifted  with  wonderful 
instinct,  and  provided  with  fit  instruments  to  perform  it, 
and  they  are  one  of  our  many  examples  of  obedience  to  the 
order  of  God,  which  we  would  do  well  to  pause  and  con- 
sider. This  little  unheeded  fly, — watch  for  it  and  learn  its 
habits  ;  examine  it  here  as  it  is  prepared  for  you. 

It  was  black  and  reddish,  with  brown  edging,  and  white 
lines  across  the  segments  of  the  abdomen.  This  we  cannot 
see  here  ;  but  we  can  see  the  antenna,  its  first  needful  in- 
strument for  work,  with  twenty-two  joints,  each  with  a 
bristle  inside,  the  wings  large,  transparent,  and  iridescent, 
the  stigma  yellowish-brown,  the  one  marginal  cell  elongated. 
(Compare  it  with  the  wing  of  Cypheus,  which  has  two 
marginal  and  four  sub-marginal  cells)  and  one  sub-marginal 
large  cell,  with  a  little  nerve  running  into  it.  The  thighs 
are  thick,  and  the  tibia3  spurred. 

They  abound  often  on  Umbelliferse. 

And  this  is  its  use  in  the  world  :  to  find  out  the  larvae 
of  Cypheus  pygmcEus,  wherever  it  may  be,  and  destroy  it  by 
laying  one  of  its  own  eggs  inside  its  body,  which,  when 
hatched,  will  feed  upon  the  fat  of  the  destroying  insect, 
and  finally  kill  it,  by  preventing  its  further  development. 
Now,  considering  that  the  Saw-fly  maggot  is  carefully  con- 
cealed in  the  wheat-stalk,  the  work  is  not  so  easy ;  for  the 
stem  must  be  pierced  at  precisely  the  spot  where  it  lies,  and 
the  Ichneumon  must  ascertain  that  no  other  fly  has  pre- 
ceded her,  or  the  life  of  her  own  offspring  will  fail. 

The  antenna  ascertain  this  for  her ;  they  vibrate  inces- 
santly as  she  runs  rapidly  up  and  down  every  stem,  and 
whether  they  hear  the  gnawing  of  the  little  maggot  within, 
or  feel  the  consequent  vibration,  or  smell  the  larva  through 
the  pores  of  the  stomata  I  cannot  tell ;  but  it  may  be 
that  it  by  all  these  finds  out  the  precise  spot,  and  then  with 
its  long  ovipositor,  which  is  barbed  and  works  like  an  auger, 


116  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

a  hole  is  pierced  and  the  egg  laid  just  where  it  ought  to  be. 
The  great  and  unaccountable  marvel  is,  how  it  knows  whe- 
ther the  larva  has  been  touched  before  or  not.  But  so  it 
is,  and  thus  it  avenges  us  of  our  tiny  enemy. 

MICROGASTER   GLOMERATUS. 

These  you  will  always  find  mounted  at  Baker's,  Smith  and 
Beck's,  and  Ladd's.  They  are  exquisite  little  creatures  and 
some  of  our  best  friends.  Observe  its  large  eyes,  its  beau- 
tiful antennae,  the  last  joint  sculptured  so  delicately  that  it 
can  only  be  well  seen  with  a  J-inch  lens.  The  ovipositor 
is  partly  drawn  out,  and  if  the  insect  is  well  prepared,  you 
may  see  the  mechanism  by  which  it  acts, — two  powerful 
elastic  springs,  braced  across  by  three  loops  or  tendons  on 
each  side,  which  keep  the  instrument  in  place  during  its 
rapid  action.  This  fly  is  metallic  green  and  gold  ;  the  wings 
have  but  two  cubital  cells,  and,  owing  to  their  want  of 
nerves,  can  seldom  be  properly  displayed.  So  they  should 
be  examined  on  the  unprepared  insect,  which  is  abundant 
on  our  windows  and  in  our  gardens. 

The  first  time  I  saw  the  transformation  of  this  Ichneumon 
was  a  great  surprise, — a  child's  wonder  never  forgotten. 
I  had  kept  some  Cabbage  Caterpillars  in  a  box,  feeding 
them  duly,  and  expecting  the  white  butterflies  whose  pretty 
eggs  I  had  read  of  and  longed  to  see ;  when,  one  day  as  I 
was  considering  my  largest  caterpillar,  now  full-grown  and 
ceasing  to  eat,  instead  of  commencing  as  usual  to  prepare 
itself  for  transformation,  I  saw  in  one  moment  that  it  was 
dying,  and  a  host  of  tiny  worms  suddenly  pierced  from  its 
inside  in  all  directions,  wriggled  out,  and  began  to  spin 
so  fast  that  in  about  ten  minutes  nothing  could  I  see  but  a 
heap  of  small  yellow  silk  cocoons,  and  the  skin  only  of  my 
poor  fat  caterpillar.  What  it  meant  I  could  not  tell,  nor 
had  I  then  read  the  account  of  it  in  Kirby  and  Spence  ; 
but  I  took  the  cocoons,  put  them  in  a  glass  covered  with 
muslin,  and  in  about  a  fortnight  from  that  time  the  cocoons 
were  pierced  and  empty,  and  twenty  of  these  pretty  green 
and  gold  flies  were  out.  I  learnt  their  name  afterwards, 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  117 

and  that  they  are  our  appointed  avengers  to  check  the 
depredations  of  the  Cabbage  Caterpillar, — the  Microgaster 
GLomeratus. 

APHIDIUS    AVEN^l, EPHEDRUS    PLAGIATOE, — CERAPHRON 

CARPENTERII. 

These  Ichneumon-flies  defend  us  in  the  same  way  from 
the  Aphides  which  disfigure  our  rose-trees.  The  first  two 
lay  an  egg  in  the  body  of  the  Aphis,  which  is  inwardly 
devoured  by  the  larva  and  dies ;  we  may  see  it  turned 
brown  and  still  adhering  to  the  leaves.  If  the  fly  has 
escaped,  there  will  be  a  small  round  hole  in  the  side  of  the 
Aphis,  and  a  little  circular  door  attached  by  an  uncut  por- 
tion of  the  skin.  The  Ceraphron,  a  most  lovely  little  fly, 
destroys,  not  the  Aphis,  but  the  larva  of  the  Ephedrus 
inside  the  Aphis.  It  is  able  to  find  out,  even  in  an  appa- 
rently healthy  Aphis,  that  an  egg  has  been  deposited  by  its 
sister  Ichneumon,  and  that  the  larva  is  hatched,  when  it 
immediately  pierces  the  already  smitten  insect,  and  provides 
for  its  own  offspring  in  laying  its  egg  inside  the  internal 
parasite.  Thus,  in  preparing  many  of  the  brown  and  black 
dead  bodies  of  Aphides,  we  may  obtain  specimens  of  each 
of  these  beautiful  Ichneumons. 


CHELTMORPHA    PHTLLOPHORA,    OR    THE    TURTLE-SHAPED 
LEAF-BEARER. 

This  most  curious  insect  is  the  pupa  of  Chelymorpha,  an 
insect  discovered  by  the  Rev.  J.  Thornton,  on  the  leaves 
of  the  Maple  (Acer  campestris)  ;  it  is  intermediate  between 
the  Aphis  and  the  Coccus.  The  singular  leaf-like  appen- 
dages round  the  body  and  attached  to  the  legs  require  a 
half-inch  object  glass. 


118  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 


CHAPTER  IV. 

DIPTERA. 

0  happy  living  things  !  no  tongue 

Your  beauty  may  declare ; 
A  spring  of  love  gushed  from  my  heart, 

And  I  blessed  you  unaware." 

Ancient  Mariner. 


OF  all  the  insect  tribes  in  that  world  which  lies  about  us, 
and  of  which  we  know  so  little,  with  all  our  learning  and 
research,  there  is  none  which  has  been  more  neglected  than 
the  numerous  and  interesting  one  of  the  Diptera,  or  two- 
winged  flies.  Most  strange  that  it  should  be  so  ;  for  they 
are  the  least  harmful  and  the  most  truly  beneficial  to  man  of 
any  small  creatures ;  few  of  them  assault  us,  and  as  a  body 
they  are  so  important  that  the  world  could  almost  as  easily 
do  without  flowers  or  sunlight  as  without  Flies  ! 

They  are  beautiful.  Who  has  not  unconsciously  paused 
to  admire  the  metallic  lustre  of  an  unknown  Beris  or  Doli- 
chopus,  as  it  rested  on  the  laurel-leaf  by  his  side ;  or  the 
golden  Leptis  sitting  on  the  gray  bark  of  some  old  tree ; 
or  the  variegated  Syrphus  and  the  pretty  Empis  thronging 
the  umbelliferous  plants  by  the  wayside  ?  Who  has  not, 
in  the  listless  heat  of  a  summer's  day,  watched  the  merry 
dance  of  the  little  House-fly,  and  wondered  if  there  was 
not  more  intelligence  in  that  world  of  flies  than  he  had 
dreamed  of?  They  are  useful;  for  the  Diptera  in  their 
larval  state  feed  upon  the  dung  of  animals  and  decaying 
substances,  and  we  should  perish  from  the  noxious  vapours 
or  gases  which  arise  from  dead  matter  without  these  little 
scavengers. 

We  are  indeed  in  a  world  visible  yet  unknown,  the 
perfection  and  order  of  which  no  human  eye  had  ever  seen 
without  this  help  from  God,  whose  directing  providence 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  119 

gave  man  the  microscope.  His  world  it  is ;  His  creatures 
these,  and  of  all  the  countless  host  of  "  creeping  things," 
the  Diptera  seem  to  come  most  nearly  and  constantly 
within  our  reach.  Other  insects  we  must  seek  abroad  in 
woods  and  meadows  and  by  the  river-side,  and  only  at 
some  seasons  of  the  year  do  we  meet  with  them ;  but  the 
Diptera  are  ever  within  reach — our  little  home  friends.  The 
invalid  may  sit  all  the  year  round  within  the  shelter  of  his 
room,  yet  seldom  fail  of  finding  a  few  of  these  to  watch 
and  to  admire.  The  little  Phora  lingers  through  the  winter 
on  our  window-panes,  and  the  pretty  Midge  hops  to  and 
fro  in  December  days ;  whilst  with  the  earliest  sun  of 
February  the  quiet  heavy-looking  Musca  rudis  appears  in 
numbers  long  before  the  active  merry  little  Musca  domeslica, 
or  House-fly,  awakes  from  its  long  nap  in  some  snug 
unsuspected  hiding-place. 

Those  who  have  not  learnt  to  know  and  love  the  living 
things  around  us,  walk  to  and  fro  amidst  many  untasted 
pleasures.  I  often  think  the  difference  between  such  igno- 
rance and  the  knowledge  we  might  easily  attain  resembles 
that  which  we  feel  when  walking  alone  and  friendless  in  the 
crowded  streets  of  London  with  a  stream  of  fellow-creatures 
hurrying  past,  of  whose  life-history  we  know  nothing,  and 
for  whom  we  care  nothing ;  and  the  same  walk  taken  in 
our  native  village  or  island  home,  where  every  one  we  meet 
is  an  acquaintance,  relative,  or  friend,  or  friend's  friend, 
striking  unconsciously  the  electric  chain  of  sympathy. 
Even  if  we  know  but  a  name,  it  is  something  that  is  akin 
to  brotherhood.  Thus  also  before  we  know  the  structure, 
habits,  and  names  of  insects,  what  are  they  to  us  ?  Every 
worm  is  a  worm  ;  a  beetle  is  a  beetle  ;  every  fly  is  a  fly- 
nothing  more. 

But  take  the  trouble  to  examine  one  little  insect — the 
humblest,  the  commonest — learn  how  wonderfully  it  is 
fashioned,  how  gifted  with  happy  instincts,  and  how 
obedient  in  its  work — learn  its  name,  and  give  it  a  kindly 
look  just  once,  and  a  little  friend  is  gained  for  life  ;  you  will 
never  again  catch  a  sight  of  that  small  insect  without  a 
feeling  akin  to  brotherhood — you  know  it,  and  it  may  be 


120  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

association  of  place  and  time  will  enhance  the  pleasure 
ten-fold. 

There  is  not  any  small  work  that  I  know  of  on  the 
classification  of  the  Diptera :  the  best  manual  of  British 
Flies  is  that  of  the  '  Insecta  Britannica/  in  three  volumes- 
too  expensive  and  too  scientific  for  popular  use.*  There- 
fore these  slides  of  whole-mounted  Diptera,  with  the  brief 
descriptions  of  this  catalogue,  will  be  the  more  valuable,  as 
giving  the  young  student  his  first  introduction  to  a  family 
he  will  become  better  acquainted  with  hereafter. 

Very  briefly  let  me  preface  the  examination  of  the  first 
slide  with  a  list  of  the  principal  families  into  which  natu- 
ralists have  divided  the  Diptera.  As  the  Coleoptera  are 
known  by  the  joints  of  their  tarsi  and  structure  of  their 
antennae,  so  the  Diptera  are  classed  according  to  the  form 
of  the  antenna?  and  the  veining  of  the  wings. 

There  are  two  great  groups,  Nemocera  and  BracJu/ura. 
The  Nemocera  comprises  all  the  TipulaB,  Gnats,  Midges, 
&c.,  which  have  long  antenna?,  from  six  to  ten-jointed,  and 
inserted  in  front  of  the  head  between  two  large  compound 
facetted  eyes.  The  slides  of  head  of  Tipula  and  head  of 
Gnat  will  illustrate  this  better  than  any  description,  and 
enable  us  at  once  to  recognise  one  of  the  Nemocera.  A 
slide  of  a  whole  Gnat  and  of  a  Ptychoptera  will  give 
a  better  lesson  on  their  general  structure,  if  carefully 
examined,  than  any  book. 

CULEX  PIPIENS. 

The  common  Gnat,  both  male  and  female,  should  be 
mounted,  as  the  former  only  has  the  beautiful  plumed 
antennae,  and  the  latter  only  the  apparatus  called  the  sting, 
of  the  Gnat,  and  described  under  "  Head  of  Gnat/'  Its 
wing  is  often  mounted  as  a  separate  object,  to  show  the 
scales,  and  has  therefore  been  noticed  with  the  wings  of 
other  insects  (page  89).  But  as  this  little  fly  is  one  of  our 
most  common  acquaintance,  though  not  a  very  pleasant 
one,  a  slight  sketch  of  its  habits  will  be  interesting. 

*  Insecta  Britannica :  Diptera,  by  Walker.  Histoire  Naturelle  des 
Insectes  :  Dipteres,  by  Macquart. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  121 

The  female  Gnat  is  that  blood-thirsty  little  creature 
whose  shrill  clarion  sounds  an  attack  upon  man  and  beast 
throughout  the  warm  summer's  day  and  night.  She  flies 
silently  in  the  spring,  and  seldom  thirsts  for  blood  until  she 
begins  laying  eggs ;  of  these  she  produces  about  300  in  one 
season  in  stagnant  water,  and  their  transformations  occupy 
about  a  month ;  so  there  are  several  generations  in  one 
year,  which  accounts  for  the  swarms  which  occasionally 
trouble  us. 

A  few  of  the  Iarva3  of  the  Gnat  are  amusing  in  the 
aquarium,  and  being,  when  young,  very  transparent,  give 
excellent  observation  of  the  circulation  of  blood  and  of  the 
tracheal  organs. 

The  little  Gnat  lays  her  eggs  in  the  form  of  a  boat,  which 
floats  upon  our  waterbutts  or  ponds  for  about  a  week,  when 
it  sinks  down  to  the  bottom,  and  the  young  larva  escapes 
from  each  egg.  This  rises  to  the  surface  for  air,  which 
it  breathes  through  a  most  curious  organ  placed  at  the 
extremity  of  its  body,  and  it  hangs,  therefore,  head  down- 
wards whilst  breathing.  This  organ  is  a  tube  which 
springs  from  the  last  segment  but  one  of  its  abdomen,  and 
terminates  in  five  points  like  a  star.  In  the  interior  of 
this  tube  a  tracheal  vessel  runs  which  supplies  the  body 
with  air,  and  carries  down  a  little  bright  globule  when  the 
larva  descends  to  the  bottom  of  the  water  ;  this  renders  it 
so  buoyant  that  its  greatest  effort  is  required  to  descend, 
and  when  the  insect  wishes  to  rise  again,  it  has  only  to 
unclose  its  tube,  and  it  ascends  without  any  exertion  to 
the  surface,  remains  suspended  there,  drinking  in  the  sur- 
rounding element,  and  swallowing  shoals  of  little  "  living 
things,"  invisible  except  under  the  microscope.  A  tumbler 
of  stagnant  water  will  not  only  show  the  merry  evolutions 
of  these  larvae,  but  an  abundant  variety  of  the  Infusoria, 
upon  which  they  feed,  Monads,  Paramecium,  Rotifers, 
together  with  the  Desmidiacese,  which  abound  in  such 
water. 

In  the  next  change  the  Gnat  larva  becomes  a  pupa,  with 
quite  a  different  appearance  and  respiratory  organ  ;  for  now 
it  has  two  horn-like  appendages  on  the  upper  side  of  the 


122  Objects  for  the 

thorax,  and  it  rises  with  its  head  upwards  to  breathe 
through  them.  As  soon  as  the  last  change  is  at  hand,  the 
pupa  raises  its  thorax  out  of  the  water  entirely,  and 
slightly  turns  up  its  tail,  floating  like  a  boat ;  presently 
the  skin  bursts,  and  the  head  of  the  enclosed  perfect 
insect  emerges,  the  long  antennae  wave  to  and  fro,  and  the 
frail  bark  rocks  from  side  to  side  in  some  peril,  for  the 
lightest  breath  of  air  would  overset  it.  Then  one  by  one 
the  legs  are  drawn  forth  and  stretched  forward  to  some 
floating  leaf  or  stick  whereby  to  steady  itself ;  slowly  the 
rest  of  the  body  follows  ;  the  wings,  hitherto  pressed  to 
its  side,  crumpled  and  damp,  are  dried  by  the  warm  atmo- 
sphere, and  the  quick  breathing  of  the  little  Gnat  sends  a 
rush  of  air  through  the  delicate  veins  ;  they  are  gently 
waved  for  a  few  seconds,  then  up  and  away  flies  the 
rejoicing  creature  into  its  new  and  happy  life. 

Such  is  the  history  of  the  pretty  microscopic  object  on 
the  slide  before  us. 

Of  its  structure  it  is  necessary  to  know  that  all  the 
Diptera  are  distinguished  from  other  orders  of  insects  by 
having  only  two  wings,  and  a  pair  of  stout  organs,  called 
halteres,  which  are  supposed  to  represent  the  posterior 
wings  of  the  four- winged  tribes,  and  respecting  which  ento- 
mologists are  much  divided.  They  have  been  specially 
noticed  at  page  142.  The  Diptera  have  mouths  variously 
constructed  for  their  necessities.  Their  food  is  essentially 
fluid ;  the  juices  of  plants  or  of  insect  bodies,  and  of 
decomposing  matter,  forming  their  nourishment  ;  and, 
therefore,  instead  of  the  strong  horny  mandibles  of  a 
Beetle,  we  find  in  such  flies  as  Tabanus  a  pair  of  lancet- 
like  organs  for  plunging  into  the  skin  of  the  animal  whose 
blood  it  delights  in,  and  beneath  these  another  pair,  to 
which  are  attached  large  palpi,  exactly  corresponding  to 
the  maxillas  and  maxillary  palpi  of  the  Coleoptera;  a 
labium  or  lower  lip,  which  in  all  flower-haunting  and 
honey-loving  flies  is  very  long  and  beautiful,  as  in  Rhingia, 
Syrphus,  Conops,  and  many  of  the  Muscidse  ;  a  labrum  or 
horny  borer  prolonged  in  the  predaceous  flies,  and  very 
remarkable  in  the  Empidse  and  Asilidse,  which  have  also 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  123 

a  beautiful  lower  lip  or  labrum,  used  first  for  steadying  the 
lancets  in  their  descent  through  the  skin,  and  then  for 
sucking  up  the  fluid.  This  may  be  watched  by  any  one 
who  will  permit  this  little  Gnat  quietly  to  take  a  meal  on 
the  hand ;  and  once  fixed  she  is  not  easily  alarmed,  but 
will  allow  the  approach  of  a  pocket  lens,  and  observation 
of  her  proceedings. 

The  Diptera  have  also  a  tongue  (lingua) ;  it  is  not  the 
organ  usually  so  called,  but  a  lancet,  which  with  four 
others  lie  concealed  within  the  horny  lip  or  labrum  of 
Tabanus.  The  part  we  so  much  admire  in  the  proboscis 
of  the  Blow-fly,  Tipulae,  and  others,  is  the  lower  lip  or 
labium,  with  its  lobes  striated  by  radiating  tracheae. 

The  head  of  a  fly  is  attached  to  the  thorax  by  a  very 
slender  neck,  and  appears  to  move  upon  a  pivot,  having 
the  power  of  turning  quite  round. 

The  thorax  is  compact,  and  gives  support  to  the  wings, 
halteres,  and  three  pairs  of  legs. 

The  abdomen  is  composed  of  from  five  to  nine  segments, 
and  females  are  provided  with  ovipositors,  sometimes  of 
great  length,  and  consisting  of  a  series  of  little  tubes 
sliding  one  into  another  like  a  telescope. 

The  legs  have  always  five  tarsi,  two  claws,  and  two  or 
three  membranous  lobes,  or  pulvilli.  Of  the  internal  ana- 
tomy of  flies  I  must  not  allow  myself  to  say  much ;  but  it 
may  interest  many  to  know  that  they  possess  the  dorsal 
vessel  or  heart  which  ensures  the  circulation  of  blood,  an 
alimentary  canal  for  the  digestion  of  food,  provided  with 
salivary  vessels,  biliary  tubes,  and  a  chylific  stomach  which 
seems  to  supply  the  whole  intestinal  canal  with  a  power  of 
digesting  food  when  necessary.  Flies  have  a  crop  or  gizzard, 
situated  just  above  the  stomach,  and  appended  by  a  long, 
narrow  neck  to  the  throat  or  oesophagus ;  but  it  is  used 
chiefly  as  a  reservoir  for  food,  when  the  insect  takes  more 
than  is  needful  for  its  immediate  wants.  This  was  proved 
by  that  great  anatomist,  Hunter,  who  kept  a  fly  twelve 
hours  without  food,  and  then  gave  it  milk  and  killed  it ;  he 
found  no  milk  in  the  crop,  but  it  had  got  through  almost 
the  whole  tract  of  intestines ;  the  animal  had  immediate 


124  Objects  for  the  Microscope, 

occasion  for  food,  and  therefore  the  milk  was  not  detained 
in  the  crop,  the  intestines  having  the  power  of  digesting  it. 
Another  time  Hunter  allowed  some  flies  to  feed  plentifully, 
and  then  found  the  crop  quite  full,  as  well  as  the  intestines. 
Insects  have  no  absorbents ;  the  chyle,  which  is  a  clear, 
greenish  fluid,  with  round  oval  corpuscles,  is  supposed  to 
transude  through  the  coats  of  the  intestine  into  the  abdo- 
men, where  it  meets  with  the  blood  in  the  ill-defined  veins 
that  permeate  the  body.  (See  'Owen's  Lectures  on  Comp. 
Anat.')* 

The  tracheal  vessels  or  breathing  organs  have  been  noticed 
in  the  chapter  on  spiracles  and  tracheae. 

The  nervous  system  is  similar  to  that  of  other  insects, 
consisting  of  two  spinal  cords  or  threads,  exhibiting  a  series 
of  knots  or  ganglions.  The  Fly  has  one  in  the  head,  a  very 
large  one  in  the  thorax,  and  one,  or  sometimes  two,  in 
the  abdomen  ;  these  give  out  nerve-branches  to  the  wings, 
halteres,  and  legs. 

In  looking  at  a  slide  of  Culex  observe  the  length  of  the 
coxa,  and  the  small  joint  called  troclianter~  between  the  coxa 
and  femur. 

If  possible,  obtain  the  male  of  Culex  annulata  with  its 
magnificent  antennae  and  feathered  palpi,  and  the  female 
of  Culex  pipiens  for  the  display  of  the  suctorial  mouth. 


PTYCHOPTEKA. 

This  is  one  of  the  family  of  Tipulse,  Crane-flies,  or 
Daddy-long-legs,  which  abound  in  the  neighbourhood  of 
water,  and  are  recognised  by  their  black  and  yellow  bodies 
and  spotted  wings.  The  larva  is  an  aquatic  worm,  and 
the  pupa  has  a  curious,  long,  thread-like  appendage, 
through  which  it  breathes.  We  find  it  in  shallow  water 
at  the  brink  of  muddy  ponds. 

The  wing  is  a  good  study  after  that  of  the  Gnat,  as 
an  example  of  wings  without  scales,  and  of  the  peculiar 

*  The  stomach  of  the  Fly,  mounted  in  balsam,  is  an  interesting  object, 
and  kept  in  most  collections  for  sale. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  125 

veining  of  the  Nemocera.  The  costal  vein  is  the  one  which 
borders  the  fore-part  of  the  wing,  ending  at  the  tip.  The 
next  to  that  is  the  sub-costal,  which  here  is  prolonged  to 
five-sixths  of  the  length  of  the  wing,  and  connected  with 
the  radial  by  a  very  short  veinlet  close  to  the  tip ;  the 
-radial  and  cubital  spring  from  a  common  petiole,  which 
is  about  one-sixth  of  their  length,  and  proceeds  from  the 
sub-costal  at  half  the  length  of  the  wing ;  it  is  connected 
with  the  externo-medial  by  a  transverse  veinlet  at  a  little 
before  its  fork ;  the  cubital  is  forked  at  half  its  length  ; 
the  externo-medial  also  forked.  These  two  veins  being 
distinguished  thus,  help  the  eye  in  determining  the  others. 
Observe  also  that  faint  streak  or  spurious  vein  between  the 
forked  veins.  This  wing  has  no  discal  areolets,  such  as 
are  always  found  in  the  true  Tipulse,  or  Daddy-long-legs. 
These  numerous  parallel  veins  in  a  solitary  wing  would 
enable  us  to  ascertain  the  division  to  which  the  fly  belonged, 
even  if  the  long  antennae  and  peculiar  palpi  were  unseen. 
A  collection  of  wings  alone  from  this  group  would  be 
highly  interesting  for  comparison,  and  for  their  beautiful 
delicate  forms. 

The  halteres  also  should  be  carefully  mounted,  and  the 
clusters  of  nerve-vesicles  observed,  especially  those  of  Tipula 
aj  T.  Oleracea,  Limnobia,  and  Bibio. 


SCATOPHAGA. 

This  brings  us  to  the  second  great  group  of  the  Diptera, 
in  which  the  common  House-fly,  the  Blow-fly,  the  Horse- 
fly, and  others  well  known,  are  found. 

THE  FAMILY  OF  THE  BRACHYCERA, 

in  which  the  antennae  are  short,  never  exceeding  ten  joints, 
more  frequently  having  only  from  three  to  six.  The  wings 
also  have  branched  veins,  and  are  fewer  in  number  than 
those  of  the  Nemocera.  Their  bodies  are  stouter,  and  the 
palpi  short,  projecting  above  the  proboscis,  or  lying  on  it. 
These  are  the  flies  which  throng  our  flowers,  haunt  the 


126  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

woods,  the  meadows,  the  leaves  of  trees,  or  act  as  scaven- 
gers to  remove  the  noxious  substances  in  the  field  or  by  the 
wayside. 

There  are  twenty-eight  families,  each  containing  many 
genera  and  species,  which  can  only  be  learnt  by  long  and 
careful  study,  with  the  help  of  such  works  as  '  Walker's 
British  Diptera' ;  but  we  can  very  easily  become  familiar 
with  those  which  are  thus  mounted,  and,  through  them,  with 
others  which  flit  as  yet  unheeded  around  us.  Nor  will  it 
be  long,  I  hope,  before  some  small  manual  of  the  Diptera  is 
published,  more  attainable  to  the  young  student  than  the 
one  already  mentioned. 

THE   SCATOPIIAGA, 

(Ster  cor  aria,} 

is  the  common  Dung-fly,  seen  all  the  year  round,  but 
especially  in  summer,  resting  upon  cow-dung  and  deposit- 
ing its  eggs  therein.  It  is  also  often  on  the  window- 
panes.  The  male  has  a  round  hairy  abdomen,  the  female 
a  naked  pointed  one.  They  are  yellowish  or  olive-green 
flies,  the  head  yellow  between  the  eyes,  and  with  black 
drooping  antennae;  thorax  brownish  above  with  four  darker 
stripes  ;  the  wings  are  grayish,  with  a  tawny  tinge  along 
the  veins. 

This  preparation  is  very  valuable,  as  showing  the 
antennae  well.  We  perceive  the  very  different  structure 
from  those  of  the  Gnat  or  Tipula.  There  are  only  five 
joints  visible,  although  six  are  reckoned  by  naturalists. 
The  third  joint  (reckoning  from  the  base)  is  twice  as  long 
as  the  second,  the  fourth  obsolete,  fifth  and  sixth  seated 
upon  the  third  like  a  bristle,  and  called  the  arista.  The 
head  of  Scatophaga  is  very  bristly,  as  you  see  ;  and  so  also 
are  the  legs,  which  we  may  next  observe.  The  eye  and 
tongue  of  a  fly  are  fully  described  under  the  slide  of  Head  of 
Rhingia,  or  Syrphus.  The  joint  of  the  leg  nearest  to  the 
body  is  the  coxa,  the  next  to  that  the  femur,  or  thigh,  then 
the  tibia,  or  shank,  and  then  the  tarsi,  or  small  joints 
immediately  above  the  foot.  To  see  the  foot  well  requires 
a  higher  power,  that  the  delicately  fringed  pulvillus  may  be 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  127 

seen  edged  with  glandular  hairs,  open  at  the  point,  and 
secreting  a  glutinous  substance,  which  enables  the  fly  to 
attach  itself  firmly  to  glass  or  ceiling,  whilst  those  two 
strong  hooks  are  used  to  detach  it  from  the  surface  to  which 
it  clings. 

The  wing  is  next  to  be  observed.  It  is  the  most  im- 
portant to  the  naturalist.  Those  small  winglets  at  the  base 
are  called  the  alulae;  they  distinguish  some  families,  and 
generally  cover  and  protect  two  small  organs,  the  halteres, 
supposed  to  be  the  seat  of  smell,  described  at  page  142. 
The  wing  itself  consists  of  a  double  membrane,  more  or  less 
transparent,  attached  to  nervures  or  veins,  which  are  hollow 
tubes  containing  spiral  air-vessels,  communicating  with  the 
spiracles  or  lungs  in  the  trunk.  This  construction  is  won- 
derful for  lightness  and  for  strength  ;  the  larger  and  heavier 
the  body  is,  the  more  of  these  strengthening  veins  the  wing 
has.  And  as  by  breathing  only  these  vessels  are  filled 
with  air,  or  some  subtle  fluid,  the  very  act  of  flying  may  be 
but  the  palpitating  of  a  joyous  little  heart.  We  know  that 
the  tracheae  are  filled  with  air,  and  that  the  dorsal  vessel  is 
in  truth  the  heart,  sending  forth  streams  of  the  life-blood 
throughout  the  body  and  into  the  wings,  as  may  be  dis- 
tinctly seen  in  the  transparent  veins  of  a  newly-hatched  fly. 

But  to  learn  the  names  of  the  nervures  or  veins  of  a  fly, — 
a  most  useful  lesson, — no  wing  is  better  than  this  simple 
one  of  the  Dung-fly.  That  strong  vein  bordered  with  hairs 
on  the  foreside  is  the  costal  vein  ;  it  runs  round  the  tip  of 
the  wing,  and  ends  where  it  meets  the  cubital  vein.  The 
sub-costal  is  a  pale  short  vein  nearest  to  the  fore-border, 
and  ending  at  one-third  of  its  length.  . 

The  mediastinal  is  the  next  and  a  stouter  vein,  ending  at 
beyond  half  the  length  of  the  wing. 

The  radial  forks  at  its  base,  and  the  farthest  branch  is 
the  cubital  vein,  joined  to  the  prcebrachml  vein  by  a  clouded 
transverse  vein. 

The  upper  transverse  vein,  which  unites  the  prcebracltial 
to  the  pobrachial,  is  called  the  discal  transverse. 

The  membrane  itself  is  exquisitely  dotted  with  fine  hairs, 
and  fringed  all  round  with  longer  ones. 


128  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

The  Scatophagae  feed  on  smaller  Diptera,  and  deposit 
their  eggs  in  dung,  and  these  eggs  are  so  shaped  that 
whilst  they  are  warmed  and  nourished  in  the  soft  excre- 
ment, they  cannot  sink,  two  little  horns  on  either  side 
supporting  them  in  it,  which  enable  the  young  larva  safely 
to  escape. 

LONCHOPTEKA. 

Small  flies,  very  active  and  abundant  in  marshy  woods 
and  grassy  spots. 

You  can  observe  a  difference  here  in  the  antennae ;  the 
roundness  of  the  fifth  joint  and  long  arista ;  the  first  three 
joints  are  scarcely  seen  in  this  specimen.  The  wings  will 
give  a  good  example  of  a  simple  veining,  no  transverse 
vein  at  all,  and  the  praebrachial  forked ;  each  vein  is  fringed 
with  delicate  hairs.  This  is  a  male  fly,  and  has  two  hairy 
lamellae  at  the  base  of  the  abdomen. 

BIBEO. 

(One  of  the  Gnat  tribe.) 

Look  at  the  very  different  antennae  -projecting  fiercely 
forward,  with  nine  joints ;  the  palpi  on  each  side  of  the 
tongue  with  five  joints.  The  wings,  how  different  from 
the  true  Fly  or  Musca  !  It  has  many  veins,  and  thirteen 
areolets,  but  so  faint  that  we  cannot  see  them  all  in  this 
preparation  ;  only  the  costal,  sub-costal,  and  mediastinal  being 
distinctly  marked.  The  legs  are  worthy  of  observation. 

The  fore-tibia,  with  a  circle  of  spines  at  the  joint ;  the 
fore-femur,  very  stout,  and  the  coxa  and  trochanter  are  dis- 
tinctly seen  in  this  specimen.  The  larva  of  Bibeo  lives  in 
the  earth,  feeding  on  decayed  vegetable  matter  ;  it  has  rows 
of  short  hairs  which  it  uses  for  locomotion,  and  twenty 
spiracles  for  breathing.  The  pupa  is  found  naked  in  an 
oval  cell  with  a  very  gibbous  or  horny  thorax.  There  are 
twelve  species  of  Bibeo. 

DOLICHOPTJS. 

A  very  curious  fly,  and  one  of  our  common  garden  friends, 
in  the  neighbourhood  of  Oxford  or  anywhere  near  ponds 
and  rivers ;  for  it  is  a  water-loving  insect,  though  we  find 
it  on  our  window-panes,  and  basking  in  the  hot  sun  at 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  129 

noonday  on  rose-trees  and  other  shrubs.  It  is  quickly 
noticed  from  its  long  legs  and  metallic  round-backed  body, 
carrying  its  head  low,  and  sometimes  found  with  another 
fly  in  its  mouth,  being  very  predaceous. 

There  are  fourteen  genera  of  the  Dolichopidae,  each  con- 
taining many  species  ;  and  some  parts  of  their  internal 
anatomy  present  peculiarities  so  great  that  much  has  been 
written  about  them  by  LatreiUe,  Harris,  Dufour,  and  others. 
Their  habit  is  to  run  along  the  surface  of  still  water  like 
the  Velia  rivulorum  (see  Velia),  and  they  catch  smaller  flies, 
aquatic  worms,  and  even  small  gasteropods,  the  little  Physa, 
and  smaller  Planorbis ;  there  is  a  gaping  orifice  at  the  end 
of  the  proboscis,  which  admits  and  holds  the  prey  until  the 
iuices  are  sucked  out. 

We  know  not  where  they  lay  their  eggs,  but  the  larvae 
are  found  as  white  slender  worms  of  twelve  segments  in 
May,  underground  in  damp  earth,  and  in  June  they  change 
to  pupae,  casting  their  skin.  The  head  of  the  pupa  is  armed 
with  several  points,  the  ends  of  the  legs  in  their  sheaths, 
somewhat  detached  from  the  body,  and  a  process  resembling 
an  S  is  on  each  side  of  the  thorax  probably  for  respiration. 
The  Dolichopus  emerges  from  the  pupa  in  about  three 
weeks'  time.  Now  let  us  examine  the  slide. 

The  head  is  broad ;  the  eyes  large,  and  in  life  were  very 
brilliant.  The  antennae  stand  fiercely  out  and  require 
examination  with  the  J-inch ;  they  are  quite  unlike  any  we 
have  yet  seen.  Observe  three  distinct  joints  besides  the 
arista  or  spine,  which  points  forward ;  the  second  joint, 
the  shortest,  fringed  with  spines  and  intromitting  a  slender 
tube  obliquely  into  the  base  of  the  third ;  you  can  see  a 
kind  of  loop  or  dark  spot  where  it  is  inserted ;  the  third  is 
so  remarkable  that  whenever  you  see  this  compressed  and 
peculiar  shape  you  need  not  doubt  that  you  have  a  Doli- 
chopus. The  arista  is  two-jointed,  and  in  some  species  it 
is  ciliated. 

The  proboscis  is  short,  directed  downwards ;  the  head 
itself  is  armed  with  long  bristles.  The  abdomen  has  five 
segments,  and  on  each  of  them  you  see  a  double  row  of 
white  spots,  which  are  the  spiracles;  the  end  of  the 


130  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

abdomen  bends  suddenly  inwards,  and  these  last  two 
segments  are  called  the  hypopygium,  which  has  an  outer 
pair  of  appendages  like  fringed  plates ;  they  seem  to  be 
concave  and  join  together  to  protect  a  number  of  internal 
organs  of  varied  shape  which  we  see  projecting  beneath, 
and  the  use  of  which  has  been  largely  considered  by 
Dufour.  ('  Annales  des  Sciences  Naturelles/  3me  serie, 
tome  i.) 

The  wings  furnish  us  with  a  good  lesson,  and  an  easy 
one,  for  becoming  familiar  with  the  nerves  or  veins. 

The  costal  vein  is  fringed  and  strong,  ending  where  the 
prsebrachial  meets  it. 

The  sub-costal  is  very  short  and  stout. 

The  radial  and  cubital  spring  together  from  a  dot  at  the 
base  of  the  wing,  and  the  prcebrachial,  after  passing  the 
transverse  vein,  make  a  slight  curve  toward  the  cubital. 
Now,  that  very  slight  curve  is  of  the  utmost  importance, 
both  as  to  position  and  shape ;  it  serves  to  assure  you  of 
this  being  a  true  Dolichopus  ;  it  is  never  wanting  in  the 
species — never  altered — no,  not  even  by  a  microscopic  line. 
But  in  one  of  the  same  family,  a  cousin,  called  Psilopus, 
there  will  be  a  little  branch  at  the  angle  of  the  curve,  and 
in  another  relation,  Dolichopus  diadema,  the  curve  is  rec- 
tangular, with  a  little  branch.  This  Fly  is  common  on 
pools  overgrown  with  plants. 

So  is  Dolichopus  nobilitatus,  which  is  a  gilded  green  fly, 
easily  known  by  its  white-tipped  wings,  and  when  examined 
with  a  lens  you  will  observe  that  the  arista  is  long  and 
very  hairy ;  the  wing  very  narrow,  and  sloping  away 
without  any  lobe,  or  even  angle,  the  anterior  lines  being 
waved  within  the  dark  patch. 

No  Dolichopus  ever  has  an  axillary  lobe  to  the  wing. 

That  vein  beyond  the  probrachial  is  the  pobrachial ;  but 
the  base  of  the  wing  offers  the  particular  marks  of  the 
group,  and  ought  to  be  examined  in  a  separated  wing.  I 
dwell  upon  this,  because  the  careful  study  of  one  wing  is  a 
most  valuable  lesson :  the  eye  learns  tvhat  to  look  for  ;  it 
learns  accuracy  of  observation  ;  it  learns  what  it  never 
forgets — the  vast  importance  of  little  things;  and  what 


Objects  /or  the  Microscope.  131 

the  eye  sees  often  the  heart  feels.  Find  out,  therefore,  a 
very  short  and  oblique  vein,  between  the  cubital  and  the 
prcebrachial,  down  close  to  the  dot  of  the  radial,  and  the 
space  thus  bounded  at  the  base  is  called  the  prcebrachial 
areolet,  and  its  minute  size  and  position  in  every  one  of  the 
genera  is  decisive  of  the  family. 

Pass  on  now  to  the  legs,  and  remark  the  spines  on  the 
femora  and  metatarsus ;  they  will  also  serve  to  show  the 
species,  for  in  some  Dolichopus  there  is  invariably  but 
one  spine,  in  others  four  or  two,  and  in  some  there  is  a 
double  row. 

THE   OPOMYZA 

is  one  of  a  family  group  called  Geomizides  ;  they  frequent 
recent  or  decaying  vegetable  substances,  also  our  windows, 
and  are  very  present  little  unknown  friends.  We  may 
know  these  by  their  spotted  wings,  by  the  tawny  body, 
yellow  head,  thorax  striped  with  three  pale  lines;  the 
abdomen  has  a  dark  dorsal  stripe  or  dark  bands;  they 
abound  in  herbage.  Now  examine  the  head  and  wings. 

The  head  is  broad  and  eyes  large ;  the  antennse,  like 
those  of  a  true  Musca,  three  joints  drooping,  the  third 
round  and  large ;  the  arista  long,  slender,  hairy,  and  with 
a  small  joint  you  will  hardly  see  unless  the  head  is  in 
profile. 

The  thorax  is  bristly  ;  the  abdomen  has  seven  segments 
— a  little  hairy  ;  and  then  pause  to  look  at  the  wings,  and 
compare  them  with  those  of  Dolichopus. 

You  will  first  observe  two  transverse  veins  slightly 
clouded ;  the  prcebrachial  straight ;  the  discal  transverse 
hindermost,  and  joining  the  pobrachial  vein  to  the  prce- 
brachial ;  the  cubital  and  radial  veins  are  quite  straight. 

CHLOROPS. 

A  mischievous  little  Fly ;  and  the  farmer  will  be  inter- 
ested in  seeing  the  parent  of  that  larvae  which  sometimes 
commit  such  havoc  in  his  wheat-field.  In  England  there  is 
a  disease  known  as  the  gout,  from  the  swelling  it  occasions 


132  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

in  the  stems  of  wheat  and  barley,  but  which  is  called  the 
frit  in  Sweden,  where  it  occasions  enormous  loss — as  much 
as  one  hundred  thousand  pounds  sterling  annually.  This  is 
caused  by  the  little  innocent-looking  Chlorops  on  the  slide. 
It  effects  this  by  simply  depositing  its  eggs  early  in  June  on 
the  stem  of  the  young  wheat,  which  being  as  yet  low  in  the 
sheath,  the  little  maggot  hatches  and  feeds  in  the  shelter  of 
a  leaf,  mines  into  the  stem,  but  does  not  enter  the  hollow 
part.  It  is  well  that  it  does  not  do  so  ;  for  we  know  that  if 
the  cells  of  a  plant  are  destroyed  in  the  channel  of  its  life, 
which  is  the  stem,  of  course  it  presently  withers,  or  brings 
forth  but  imperfect  fruit. 

More  harm  would  this  insect  do  if  its  propagation  was 
not  checked  by  a  good  little  Ichneumon-fly  (C&linius), 
which  is  commissioned  to  destroy  its  larvaB  by  laying  its  own 
egg  inside  the  maggot  of  Chlorops,  just  as  the  Microgaster 
does  in  the  caterpillar  of  the  Cabbage  Butterfly,  and  thus 
defends  us  from  our  tiny  foe. 

These  Chlorops  frequent  our  windows,  often  in  swarms — 
known  by  their  large  green  eyes  ;  their  yellow  and  black 
bodies  and  beautiful  wings  lying  along  the  body  and  ex- 
tending beyond  it.  You  can  rarely  mistake  it ;  and  then  if 
you  have  this  mounted  specimen  you  will  observe  its  pecu- 
liar antennse,  the  third  joint  knobbed,  the  arista  seated  side- 
ways upon  it,  and  like  a  fine  long  bristle.  The  thorax 
striped ;  three  broad  stripes  and  one  slender  line  on  each : 
outside  of  these  a  black  dot  on  the  side  of  the  breast.  The 
scutellum  was  yellow ;  the  abdomen  short,  broad,  with  dark 
bands,  and  itself  pale  greenish-black. 

Observe,  in  the  wings,  how  the  sub-costal .  and  medias- 
tinal  are  joined  in  one  strong  vein,  which  meets  the  costal  at 
nearly  half  its  length ;  the  cubital  ending  at  the  tip  of  the 
costal;  the  radial  ending  at  three-fourths  of  its  length ;  the 
prcebrachial  ending  on  the  hind  border,  near  the  tip ;  the 
pobmchial  ending  at  beyond  half  the  length.  There  are  two 
transverse  veins. 

This  slide  will  help  us  to  recognise  both  our  enemy, 
Chlorops  teniopa,  and  our  little  window-friend,  Chlorops 
lineata.  The  abdomen  of  the  latter  has  a  yellow  tip  and 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  133 

base,  also  three  black  spots  on  the  pectus,  or  fore  part  of 
the  thorax. 

PHORA. 

All  the  year  round  the  little  Phora  is  upon  our  windows 
and  in  our  stables,  when  no  other  flies  are  to  be  seen,  but 
perhaps  some  eccentric  little  Midges,  hopping  diagonally 
here  and  there — scarcely  a  living  thing  to  study ;  yet  \ve 
shall  always  find  a  Phora  running  restlessly  but  happily  to 
and  fro,  with  a  bent  body  and  depressed  head ;  the  antenna 
very  short,  but  with  a  long  slender  arista  carried  back- 
Avar  ds,  the  third  joint  quite  round,  the  first  and  second  very 
small. 

The  wing  has  no  transverse  veins  at  all ;  it  is  of  the  sim- 
plest form,  strengthened  at  the  base  by  the  stout  costal  vein, 
which  ends  however  before  half  the  length  of  the  wing,  and 
is  ciliated  ;  the  mediastinal  vein,  also  stout,  ends  at  two 
thirds  the  length  of  the  costal ;  the  cubital  vein  and  radial 
vein  in  one,  and  forked  at  the  end  of  the  costal,  all  the 
other  veins  represented  by  four  veinlets,  often  indistinct. 
Now  compare  this  with  the  Leptis  wing. 

LEPTIS. 

(Tringaria.) 

A  splendid  preparation  of  a  fly  that  is  easily  found  and 
captured  by  any  rambler  in  woods,  because  it  has  a  quiet 
habit  of  sitting  upon  trunks  of  trees  with  its  head  down- 
wards, and  will  allow  a  wine-glass  to  be  capped  over  it  with- 
out any  alarm.  It  may  be  useful  to  mention  here  that  most 
flies  may  be  caught  by  a  small  tumbler,  or  stemless  wine- 
glass, and  a  handkerchief,  or  piece  of  card-board.  I  prefer 
the  handkerchief.  The  Leptis  may  thus  be  recognised :  it  is 
a  large  fly  with  long  pointed  abdomen,  tawny  coloured,  and 
having  three  rows  of  black  spots.  The  wings  are  spotted. 
The  thorax  is  that  part  which  supports  the  wings  and  legs, 
and  in  the  Leptis  it  has  three  fawn-coloured  stripes.  The 
legs  are  tawny  and  clothed  with  short  black  hairs. 

This  fly  appears  in  the  early  part  of  the  summer,  and 
haunts  meadows  and  hedges  as  well  as  woods.  It  feeds  on 


134  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

smaller  insects,  having  a  stout  short  labrum  and  slender  sharp 
maxillae,  with  which  to  kill,  as  well  as  a  thick  broad  labium 
(called  the  tongue),  to  suck  the  food.  The  larva  lives  in  the 
earth,  in  sand  or  manure,  or  decayed  wood.  The  pupa  is 
brown,  bare,  with  eleven  segments,  of  which  the  five  poste- 
rior are  furnished  with  a  series  of  little  teeth. 

As  it  is  quite  impossible  to  prepare  insects  so  as  equally 
to  display  all  parts,  we  may  find  some  difference  in  the 
slides,  even  of  the  same  insect.  The  Leptis  I  am  now  look- 
ing at  shows  the  beautiful  eye  and  tongue,  but  not  the 
antennae,  and  yet  they  are  to  be  observed  as  indicative  of  its 
individuality,  for  the  veining  of  the  wing  is,  at  first  sight, 
so  like  that  of  another  family  (the  Stratiomidse)  that  we 
might  mistake  it  if  we  did  not  read  its  name  in  the  antennas. 
They  are  small,  and  seated  side  by  side  in  the  middle  of  the 
face,  four-jointed,  the  first  short  and  cylindrical,  second 
transverse,  third  cyathiform,  or  cup-shaped,  and  a  long  fine 
bristle  makes  the  fourth  joint. 

Here  we  cannot  but  admire  the  delicate  network  of  its 
compound  eye :  in  life  it  was  of  a  bright  green,  and  the 
facets  numerous  and  small.  The  labium,  or  under-lip,  fur- 
rowed in  the  centre,  and  beautifully  marked  with  tracheal 
vessels,  acts  also  in  contracting  and  dilating  the  tongue  in 
the  act  of  drinking.  The  palpi,  or  feelers  and  tasters,  are 
remarkably  large  and  hairy,  projecting  on  each  side  of  the 
tongue. 

The  wings  are  to  be  the  chief  lesson ;  comparing  them 
with  the  simply  veined  wings  of  the  Phora,  as  an  indication 
of  farthest  remove  in  relationship,  whilst  they  also  show  us 
that  the  Leptis  is  a  near  cousin  to  the  Tabanus,  or  Horse- 
fly, and  to  all  flies  whose  wing-veins  are  crowded  together 
near  the  fore-border ;  the  costal  vein  ending  at  the  tip  of  the 
wing,  the  cubital  vein  deeply  forked,  and  the  fore-branch 
having  a  small  areolet.  There  is  a  discal  areolet,  large,  and 
emitting  three  veins  to  the  border,  and  the  anal  areolet  is 
open.  Eight  families,  comprising  many  genera  and  nume- 
rous species,  have  wings  upon  this  plan,  and  are  known  by 
the  variation  in  the  joints  of  their  antennee.  (See  head  of 
Tabanus  and  slide  of  Pachygaster  and  of  Beris.) 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  135 

No  better  example  can  we  have  of  the  leg  and  foot  of 
the  fly  than  this  slide  presents  ;  for  we  see  very  distinctly 
the  coxa,  or  hip-joint ;  the  trochanter,  a  small  joint  by 
which  the  thigh  or  femur  fits  into  the  coxa ;  the  tibia, 
or  shank-joint,  which  here  is  armed  with  two  spines,  and 
the  tarsi,  or  ankle-bones,  as  some  think  analogous  to  our 
instep-bones,  having  two  claws  and  pulvilli,  or  cushions, 
set  with  glandular  hairs.  (See  foot  of  fly  in  Scatophaga.) 
Here  observe  the  Leptis  has  three  instead  of  two  lobes. 

ASILUS. 

These  are  the  most  powerful  and  ferocious  of  the 
Diptera,  destroying  Beetles  and  Ichneumon-flies,  and  may 
be  seen  on  the  sunny  side  of  woods,  silently  darting  about, 
or  resting  with  a  huge  meal  in  their  mouth,  and  then  they 
are  pretty  easily  caught.  They  are  bright,  tawny-coloured 
flies,  very  hairy;  the  antenna  erect  and  long,  curved 
upwards,  and  the  proboscis  standing  forward. 

This  is  an  example  of  relationship  with  Leptis  as  to  the 
wing-veins,  and  yet  with  a  difference.  You  see  the  cubital 
vein  is  forked,  but  simply  so ;  the  discal  areolet  gives  out 
but  two  veinlets,  and  is  joined  to  the  cubital  by  a  short 
transverse  vein.  The  foot  also  observe — two  deep  lobes 
with  a  spine  between  them.  Then  look  carefully  at  the 
antennae,  and  compare  them  writh  those  of  Leptis;  you  see 
they  are  slender  and  styliform,  and  indicate  an  approach  to 
the  tribe  of  Empis-flies,  which,  as  they  abound  in  our 
gardens  and  may  easily  be  procured,  should  have  a  place 
in  our  object-box. 

EMPIS. 

(Snipe-fly.) 

Either  the  black  Empis  litida  we  see  so  often  on  our 
laurels  or  flowers  in  the  months  of  May  or  June ;  or  the 
Empis  stercorea,  which  swarms  on  the  umbelliferous  plants 
by  the  wayside ;  or  the  pretty  little  Hilara  that  plays  over 
the  water-meadows  or  great  ponds  : — any  of  these  will  give 
a  remarkable  proboscis  and  a  very  pretty  wing. 


136  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 


EMPIS    STERCOBEA. 


A  small,  shining,  yellowish  fly,  clothed  with  a  few  black 
hairs  or  bristles ;  the  thorax  with  a  black  linear  stripe  ; 
abdomen  with  three  black  stripes ;  legs  long,  slender,  and 
yellow  ;  tarsi  of  a  darker  hue.  The  Empidae  are  a  large 
and  very  distinct  family,  containing  twenty-three  genera, 
and  are  inhabitants  of  woods,  hedges,  fields,  and  gardens, 
where  they  find  their  prey — smaller  Diptera,  and  all  kinds 
of  lesser  insects.  They  are  fierce  and  voracious,  transfixing 
their  prey  with  their  long  proboscis,  and  sucking  out  the 
juices  with  their  beautiful  up-curved  tongue.  The  eyes  of 
a  male  Empis  touch  one  another ;  those  of  the  female  are 
parted  by  a  narrow  front,  a  distinguishing  mark  of  the 
sexes  in  most  flies.  The  antennae  of  the  Empis  always 
stand  forward,  and  observe  how  diiferent  they  are  from 
those  of  either  Dolichopus  or  Scatophaga.  It  is  only  by 
thus  comparing  one  slide  with  another  that  we  learn  our 
lesson  well. 

The  antennae  are  five-jointed,  close  to  each  other  at  the 
base,  porrect,  that  is,  standing  out ;  the  first  and  second 
joints  bristly  :  first  cylindrical;  second  cyathiform,  or  cup- 
shaped,  about  half  the  length  of  the  first ;  third,  subulate 
compressed ;  the  fourth  very  minute  ;  the  fifth  like  a  style, 
pointed  sharply.  The  thorax  has  a  broad,  black  stripe ; 
abdomen  three  black  stripes,  and  every  segment  is  punc- 
tured with  a  double  row  of  light  dots.  The  legs  are  long  ; 
the  coxa  shorter  than  the  femur,  the  trochanter  very 
distinct ;  the  third  joint  of  the  leg,  femur,  or  humerus,  is 
usually  the  largest  and  most  conspicuous ;  generally 
speaking,  the  anterior  pair  are  shorter  and  smaller  than 
the  posterior  pair.  If  the  insect  leaps,  the  thighs  of  the 
hind-legs  are  very  much  thickened  for  the  development 
and  action  of  its  muscles.  This  is  particularly  seen  in  the 
legs  of  the  small  beetle  called  Turnip-flea  (Haltica),  in  the 
flies  Ascia  podagrica,  one  of  the  Syrphida3,  and  also  in 
Syritta  pipiens,  which  should  be  mounted  as  examples  of 
the  thickened  and  toothed  femur,  and  of  a  curved  tibia 
joint.  The  Ascia  is  very  common  in  the  month  of  June, 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  137 

hovering  over  the  long  grass,  and  may  be  recognised  by 
its  black  and  yellow  body,  and  peculiar  darting  to  and  fro 
from  flower  to  flower.  The  fore-tarsi  are  often  dilated  in 
the  male  Empidae,  but  those  of  E.  stercorea  are  not  so. 

THE  WING. — The  wing  of  Empis  stercorea  will  give  an 
excellent  example  of  the  veining  peculiar  to  the  family. 
They  are  distinguished  by  these  three  variations : — • 

1. — The  costal  vein  vanishes  suddenly  at  the  tip  of  the 
wing,  just  where  it  meets  the  cubital  vein. 

2. — The  cubital  vein  is  forked. 

3. — The  discoidal  areolet  emits  three  veins  to  the  interior 
border. 

The  wings  of  Leptis  and  of  Asilus  have  also  a  forked 
cubital  vein,  and  three  branches  from  the  discal  areolet ; 
but  they  have  other  veins  crowded  together,  which  are 
wanting  in  the  Empis  wing,  and  as  the  antennae  are  quite 
as  important  to  the  entomologist  in  determining  a  genus 
as  the  veining  of  the  wing,  by  comparing  those  of  a  Leptis 
with  those  of  the  Empis,  a  striking  illustration  will  be 
obtained  of  the  progressive  order  and  variety  of  likeness, 
and  yet  of  distinct  difference,  between  the  families. 

HILARA. 

By  the  wing  and  the  antennae  we  recognise  one  of  the 
Empis-flies,  but  a  variation  in  the  form  of  the  third  joint 
and  the  shortness  of  the  first  two  joints  is  the  first  remove 
from  the  true  Empis.  Observe  also  the  stout,  short  pro- 
boscis, and  if  it  is  a  male  Hilara  the  fore  meta-tarsi  are 
much  dilated,  forming  quite  a  disc  on  that  part  of  the  leg. 

How  beautifully  the  wing  is  ciliated,  the  cubital  vein 
forked,  the  discoidal  areolet  emitting  three  veins,  and  a  spot 
upon  the  costal  vein  called  the  stigma,  which  in  this  wing 
is  marked  by  a  broad  brown  shade. 

These  Hilarae  feed  upon  smaller  insects,  and  also  on  the 
nectar  of  flowers.  They  assemble  in  swarms,  and  dance 
together  over  a  rivulet  or  river,  on  fine,  warm  summer 
evenings.  We  have  often  seen  them  rejoicing  in  merry 
play,  rising  and  falling  in  graceful  evolutions,  sometimes 
by  one  common  impulse  sweeping  off  down  the  stream,  as 

9 


138  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

if  a  breeze  had  suddenly  wafted  them  away,  or  invisible 
beings  had  chased  them;  then  slowly  and  prettily  they 
re-flitted  back  again  to  commence  their  gambols. 

SYKPHTJS   PTEASTEI. 

Many  of  the  Syrphidse  are  mounted  whole  ;  they  offer  a 
great  variety  in  the  structure  of  the  antennae,  the  mouth 
and  the  legs.  Some  are  so  large  that  the  head  only  is 
mounted,  to  show  the  beautiful  eyes  and  labium,  as  Rhingia, 
Helophilus,  Eristalis,  &c. 

They  are  our  prettiest  and  commonest  flies ;  honey-loving, 
flower-haunting,  harmless  little  creatures.  Most  of  them 
are  striped  or  banded  black  and  yellow,  and  love  to  hover 
in  the  air,  over  one  spot,  their  wings  almost  invisible  with 
rapid  vibration,  accompanied  by  a  shrill  hum  ;  if  alarmed, 
they  dart  away  with  astonishing  velocity,  and  are  somewhat 
difficult  to  catch.  The  family  contains  thirty-one  genera ; 
some  of  them  so  unlike  the  others  as  to  require  microscopic 
observation  and  comparison ;  the  Eristalis,  for  instance,  is 
often  mistaken  for  a  Bee  ;  the  Helophilus  also,  and  Rhingia, 
—the  two  former  abound  in  the  autumn  on  the  Michaelmas 
Daisy,  and  the  latter  frequents  the  woods  and  hedges,  dart- 
ing like  a  Wild  Bee  into  the  flower-bells,  with  a  long  pro- 
boscis, looking  to  the  unassisted  eye  like  a  Bee's  tongue. 

The  two  distinguishing  characters  of  this  large  family 
are  these  : — the  coalescence  of  the  palpi  with  the  maxillae, 
and  the  spurious  veins  of  the  wing,  one  before  the  prcvbrachial 
the  other  behind  the  pobrachial.  The  wing  alone  will 
decide  a  Syrphus  for  a  young  entomologist ;  therefore,  in 
examining  this  slide,  let  the  chief  attention  be  given  to  its 
veining,  also  collect  a  few  varieties,  comparing  the  wing  of 
the  common  Helophilus  with  this  one  of  Syrphus  pyrastri, 
the  type  of  the  family. 

The  costal  vein  ends  at  the  tip  of  the  wing,  where  it 
receives  the  cubital. 

Mediastinal  vein  distinct,  ending  about  the  middle  of  the 
costa. 

Sub-costal,  continued  nearer  to  the  tip,  and  ending 
separately  in  the  margin. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  139 

Prcebrachial  vein  connected  with  the  cubital  by  a  trans- 
verse vein  near  the  margin,  and  between  the  two  is  a  faint 
streak  or  spurious  vein  crossing  a  second  transverse  vein 
nearer  the  base. 

The  mediastinal  areolet  is  coloured  in  this  wing,  and 
appears  like  a  narrow  stigma  between  the  sub-costal  and 
mediastinal  veins. 

Areolets  are  enclosures  formed  by  the  branching  and 
crossing  veins  ;  they  are  important  in  the  wings  of  the 
Syrphidse,  and  must  be  observed. 

All  the  Syrphidse  have  alulae,  which  are  membranous  scales 
at  the  base  of  the  wings,  protecting  and  sometimes  quite 
covering  the  halteres.  They  are  particularly  beautiful  in 
Rliingia  and  Eristalis,  and  deserve  to  be  mounted  separately. 

In  the  wing  of  Helophilus  the  cubital  vein  curves  sud- 
denly inwards,  forming  a  loop  in  the  centre  of  the  areolet. 

The  feet  of  Syrphus  are  beautiful,  and  from  the  trans- 
parency of  the  preparation  we  see  the  articulation  of  the 
tarsal  joints  distinctly,  the  spine  at  each  tarsus,  and  the 
strong  hooks  and  delicate  pulvillus  of  the  foot. 

Some  of  the  Syrphidee  have  their  abdomen  nearly  filled 
with  air,  and  partly  diaphanous  or  transparent,  when  by 
careful  management  the  circulation  of  their  blood  may  be 
seen,  and  the  pulsations  of  the  dorsal  vessel  or  heart  may 
be  counted.  Place  the  fly  in  a  live  box  with  just  sufficient 
pressure  to  keep  it  still,  and  between  the  segments  the 
fluid  may  be  seen.  The  following  extract  from  '  Walker's 
British  Diptera'  (vol.  i.  page  285)  will  be  interesting  to  the 
student : — 

"  The  dorsal  vessel  of  this  fly  (S.  pyrastri),  instead  of  the 
usual  form  which  it  had  in  the  larvae,  assumes  the  shape  of 
a  flask,  having  its  long  end  directed  towards  the  thorax  ; 
the  pulsation  and  transmission  of  the  fluid  in  it  is  manifest. 
This  vessel  extends  in  length  from  the  junction  of  the  trunk 
with  the  abdomen  to  about  the  termination  of  the  second 
segment.  The  included  fluid  is  propelled  at  intervals  by 
drops,  first  from  the  wide  end  towards  the  trunk,  and  then 
in  the  contrary  direction.  It  is  conjectured  that  the  neck 
of  this  vessel  is  composed  of  two  or  more  approximated 


140  Objects  for  the  Microscope, 

tubes,  and  that  the  blood  is  conveyed  forward  by  the  out- 
ward ones,  and  backward  by  the  intermediate  one ;  also 
that  there  is  a  secondary  heart,  at  the  extremity  next  the 
thorax,  for  the  purpose  of  causing  the  reflux." 

BORBORUS   EQUINUS. 

These  are  very  abundant  everywhere  in  rank  grass,  and 
near  decaying  vegetable  matter,  upon  which  the  larvse  feed. 
They  are  small  black  flies,  remarkable  for  their  thick  fleshy 
labium,  and  a  broad  bellying  sheath  below,  which  should 
be  seen  in  profile.  Antenna?  rather  distant,  short,  and  turn 
outwards  with  a  long  slender  arista  ;  the  first  joint  so  small 
as  to  be  scarcely  perceptible,  the  second  nearly  as  large 
as  the  third,  which  is  obliquely  compressed  and  ciliated. 
The  legs  are  long,  and  fore-femora  thickened ;  there  is  a 
curious  spine  at  the  end  of  the  hind  tibia,  and  the  tarsi 
are  short  and  broad.  The  wing,  being  very  simply  veined, 
is  an  easy  study ;  the  chief  mark  of  this  family  being  in 
two  small  areolets  near  the  base  of  the  wing,  close  to  the 
hind  border,  which  are  called  anal  areolets,  and  in  this 
wing  they  are  complete.  The  discal  transverse  vein  is  also 
near  the  border  ;  it  joins  the  praebrachial  and  pobrachial 
together,  the  latter  does  not  continue  beyond  it.  The  radial 
and  cubital  are  branches  from  one  common  vein  at  the  base. 

There  is  a  full  account  of  this  species  and  its  larvse  in 
the  *  Entomological  Magazine '  (vol.  iii.  p.  323). 

SEPEDON. 

A  most  beautiful  specimen  for  the  shape  of  the  antennae 
and  the  structure  of  the  tongue.  The  wing  closely  resem- 
bles that  of  Borborus, — the  same  transverse  veins  and  anal 
areolets ;  but  the  antennae  separate  the  genera  entirely. 
Instead  of  the  short  second  joint  in  Borborus,  that  of 
Sepedon  is  very  long  and  spiny,  with  a  conical  and  convex 
tldrd  joint,  from  which  springs  the  three-jointed  arista. 

The  labium  is  set  round  with  double  hooks  and  curiously 
dotted, — a  most  interesting  variety  in  the  proboscis  of  flies. 

The  legs  are  rather  long,  hind  femora  thickened,  and 
armed  with  a  double  row  of  spines. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  141 

These  flies  are  found  amongst  water-plants ;  they  are 
black,  shining,  slightly  metallic,  with  bright  red  legs ;  the 
halteres,  also  red,  with  a  whitish  band.  Thorax  with  four 
black  stripes  ;  wings  gray,  with  a  lurid  tinge  in  front. 

SEPSIS. 

The  pretty  little  fly  which  we  find  upon  our  laurels, 
walking  about  with  raised  and  quivering  wings.  The  larva? 
feed  on  decaying  matter. 

The  antennae  are  drooping  and  short,  with  the  third  joint 
oval  and  larger  than  the  first  or  second  ;  the  arista  bare. 

Proboscis  broad  and  large ;  the  wings  simply  veined, 
but  very  delicate  and  beautiful,  and  with  a  black  spot  at 
the  tip,  without  alulae.  The  legs  are  remarkable  for  the 
large  spines  in  the  fore-femora  of  the  male,  and  for  the 
spiny  meta-tarsi. 

In  all  flies,  as  a  rule,  the  fewer  the  veins  the  smaller  the 
body,  and  the  more  sluggish  the  flight ;  the  comparison 
between  the  veins  of  Leptis,  Tabanus,  and  Phora,  or 
Sepsis,  will  prove  this. 

The  Sepsis  wing  has  a  costal  vein  running  quite  round 
the  tip  of  the  wing,  and  ending  on  the  hind  border  ;  sub- 
costal ending  before  one-third  of  the  length ;  mediastinal 
ending  before  half  the  length ;  radial  ending  near  the  tip 
of  the  wing ;  cubital  ending  quite  at  the  tip.  There  are 
two  transverse  veins. 

This  list  of  the  Diptera,  though  by  no  means  complete, 
is  sufficient  to  show  how  very  instructive  and  interesting 
these  preparations  are,  and  to  encourage  the  young  ento- 
mologist to  mount  insects  in  this  way  for  himself.  The 
method  is  easy,  but  requires  patience  and  experience. 

Soak  the  insects  in  liquor  potassi  for  a  longer  or  shorter 
period,  impossible  to  fix,  because  it  varies  necessarily  with 
the  size  and  texture  of  the  insect.  A  beetle  may  require 
months,  a  fly  but  a  few  weeks  or  days,  to  render  it  trans- 
parent, by  dissolving  its  inward  parts,  and  giving  flexi- 
bility to  its  integument.  It  is  then  washed  in  cold  water, 
and  laid  out  upon  a  glass  slide  in  the  desired  position. 
When  perfectly  dry  it  should  be  soaked  in  oil  of  turpentine, 


142  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

which  may  be  applied  with  a  camel-hair  pencil,  and  after- 
wards mounted  in  balsam.  In  this  last  and  most  difficult 
part  let  the  balsam  be  very  fluid,  and  the  warmth  gentle, 
that  the  air  may  be  quietly  dispersed,  and  the  bubbles 
removed  before  the  final  covering  with  thin  glass. 

I  recommend  the  Borborus  and  Empis  stercorea  as  the 
easiest  specimens  to  begin  with.  When  caught,  if  immersed 
in  hollands  or  spirits  of  wine,  they  will  keep  any  length  of 
time  until  wanted  for  mounting. 


THE   HALTERES,    OR   POISERS,    OF   DIPTERA. 

These  small  organs,  which  are  very  apparent  as  little 
knobs  on  a  stalk,  like  drumsticks,  just  behind  the  wings  of 
Blow-flies  and  the  Tipulse  (especially  the  Tipula  olacea, 
which  flutter  against  our  window-panes),  are  rudimentary 
wings.  We  only  find  them  in  the  Diptera,  which  all 
possess  these  much-disputed  organs. 

They  are  called  poisers,  or  balances,  because  it  was 
formerly  supposed  that  the  insect  used  them  as  the  rope- 
dancer  does  his  pole,  to  steady  itself  in  the  air.  Some 
naturalists  fancied  that  they  produced  the  humming  noise 
in  flight  by  beating  against  two  little  scales  at  the  base  of 
the  wing,  called  alulae ;  but  that  can  hardly  be  the  case, 
seeing  how  many  insects  buzz  who  have  no  halteres,  such 
as  Bees,  Cockchafers,  Dung-beetles,  &c.,  and  that  so  many 
flies  who  do  possess  them  fly  silently.  They  certainly  do 
move  very  rapidly,  quivering  as  the  insect  flies,  and  even 
when  at  rest  I  have  seen  the  vibration.  They  are  placed 
immediately  on  the  margin  of  the  great  thoracic  spiracle, 
and  the  late  discoveries  of  certain  organs  inside  these 
halteres  lead  us  to  suppose  they  are  organs  of  smell,  as  the 
antennae  may  be  of  hearing. 

HALTERES   OF   BLOW-FLY. 

These,  if  mounted  carefully  in  balsam,  have  become 
transparent ;  we  see  that  they  consist  of  three  parts,  the 
base,  shaft,  and  head.  The  organs  in  question  are  at  the 
base,  two  distinct  groups  of  vesicles,  which  look  like  dots 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  143 

arranged  in  rows.  The  upper  group  is  in  spiral  lines,  the 
lower  is  on  a  broad  flat  surface,  and  only  on  one  side. 
Each  vesicle  is  a  small  sac,  filled  with  fluid,  and  over- 
arched by  a  protecting  hair,  and  when  a  good  side  view  is 
obtained  they  are  seen  to  be  quite  spherical. 

The  two  naturalists,  Dr.  Hicks  and  Mr.  Purkiss,  who 
have  noticed  these  organs,  suppose  them  to  be  olfactory 
vesicles.  There  is  a  very  large  nerve  given  off  from  the 
great  thoracic  ganglion  into  the  halteres,  larger  even  than 
those  branches  which  pass  into  the  wings  and  legs  of  flies, 
which  makes  it  very  likely  that  in  these  very  small  appen- 
dages lies  a  great  sensitiveness  of  some  kind.  No  less  than 
360  of  these  vesicles  are  found  in  the  halteres  of  Rhingia ; 
and  for  what  purpose  ? 

Dr.  Hicks  justly  remarks,  that  it  is  scarcely  for  hearing, 
as  they  are  so  near  the  buzz  of  the  wings,  and  them- 
selves in  constant  motion,  so  that  other  sounds  would  be 
drowned  ;  but  that  the  current  of  air  produced  by  this  very 
fluttering,  and  also  the  position  of  the  halteres  near  the 
largest  thoracic  spiracle,  make  it  extremely  probable  that 
they  receive  the  floating  odours  in  the  air,  and  communicate 
them  to  the  brain,  or  cephalic  ganglion,  directing  thus  the 
Blow-fly  to  the  carrion,  the  Rhingia  to  the  flowers. 

HALTERES   OF   TABANUS. 

"  These  are  very  similar  to  those  of  the  Rhingia,  with 
the  addition  of  seven  vesicles  on  the  shaft  of  the  halteres 
to  the  upper  part  of  the  facet  of  the  ridge,  and  another 
group  of  eight  or  nine  beneath  the  ridge  opposite  the 
boarder  facet."* 

The  shaft  of  the  halteres  is  tubular,  and  is  the  channel 
for  the  branch  of  the  nerve  which  passes  up  and  expands 
in  the  head. 

The  head  of  the  halteres  contains  cellular  substance ; 
there  is  also  a  groove  on  one  side  lined  with  a  very  delicate 
membrane,  and  beneath  which  there  is  a  group  of  hairs. 

*  See  '  Journal  of  the  Proceedings  of  the  Linnsean  Society  of  London,' 
November,  1856. 

' 


144  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 


CHAPTER    V. 

PARASITES. 

A  GREAT  many  objects  are  sold  for  those  who  are  curious 
in  learning  the  forms  of  those  "  living  creatures  "  which 
are  nourished  on  the  bodies  of  higher  animals. 

Every  animal,  from  man  downwards,  is  a  pasture  land 
for  many  fellow- creatures.  So  surely  we  may  call  them, 
formed  as  they  are  by  the  Almighty  hand  which  fashioned 
our  own  wonderful  body. 

However  repugnant  it  may  be  to  our  refined  tastes  to 
examine  a  flea  or  a  louse,  this  arises  from  no  inherent 
ugliness  of  these  creatures,  but  rather  from  our  association 
with  them  in  scenes  of  dirt  and  misery,  of  personal  discom- 
fort also.  Very  probably  they  are  the  avengers  of  our  evil 
habits,  the  consequences  of  our  fallen  state,  and  yet  merci- 
fully ordered  to  do  us  good  rather  than  harm,  by  com- 
pelling the  careless  and  the  poor  to  that  watchfulness  and 
cleanliness  which  might  otherwise  be  neglected. 


THE     FLEA, 

man's  great  annoyance,  is  nevertheless  a  beautifully-formed 
creature. 

It  has  to  be  prepared  by  long  soaking  in  turpentine,  and 
mounted  in  balsam,  before  we  can  see  its  various  parts. 

The  flea  belongs  to  the  order  of  the  SuctoridaB.  The 
head  bears  antennae  four-jointed;  eyes  small,  round,  and 
simple  ;  the  proboscis  is  composed  of  two  long  mandibles 
with  serrated  edges ;  two  long  narrow  plates  with  fine  teeth 
and  longitudinal  ribs,  these  are  the  lancets ;  two  leaf-like 
plates,  nearly  triangular,  which  are  the  maxillae  ;  two  labial 
palpi,  two  maxillary  palpi,  one  slender  suctorial  organ 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  145 

called  labrum.  The  thorax  is  composed  of  three  segments, 
and  the  abdomen  of  seven  segments  ;  the  female  has  nine  ; 
and  both  sexes  on  the  last  segment  have  that  beautiful 
breathing  apparatus  called 

THE   PYGIDIUM   OF   A   FLEA. 

This  must  be  mounted  separately  to  be  seen  well,  and 
it  forms  an  excellent  test  object.  Topping  mounts  it 
beautifully. 

There  are  twenty-five  disc-like  areolaB ;  in  the  centre  of 
each  of  these  is  a  long  hair,  and  round  them  a  ring  of 
rectangular  rays.  It  must  be  seen  rather  than  described. 

The  legs  of  the  Elea  are  long  and  many-jointed,  the 
hind  pair  having  thick  muscular  thighs,  formed  for  extra- 
ordinary leaps,  and  terminated  by  five  tarsi,  and  two  curved 
and  toothed  claws.  Every  part  is  worthy  of  observation. 

The  coxa,  or  first  joint,  is  very  thick ;  the  trochanter  is 
very  small,  the  femur  long  and  thick,  the  tibiae  hairy. 

There  are  many  species  of  fleas,  each  of  them  parasitic, 
on  various  animals,  with  some  difference  in  structure.  The 
most  curious  are  the 

Pulex  talpce,  or  Mole-flea,  with  its  rows  of  spines  on  the 
neck. 

Pulex  Gallina,  or  Fowl's  flea,  which  does  not  leap,  but 
runs  swiftly,  and  has  a  most  tormenting  bite,  driving  hens 
from  their  nests,  and  compelling  their  masters  to  keep  the 
hen-house  clean. 

Pulex  Columba,  or  Pigeon's  flea,  very  curious.  The 
antennas  should  be  particularly  noticed ;  the  male  carries  his 
erect,  and  the  female  has  hers  partly  concealed  in  a  furrow 
near  her  eyes.  The  form  is  beautiful, — eight  cup-like  joints 
set  one  within  another,  and  surrounded  by  a  circle  of  stout 
bristles. 

Pulex  vespertiliojiis,  or  Bat's  flea,  has  a  row  of  dark 
spines  just  over  its  proboscis,  called  its  cephalic  setae,  and 
a  collar  of  spines,  called  its  proto-thoracic  setae. 

Pulex  felis,  the  Cat's  flea,  which  has  a  prettily  spotted 
head,  and  in  which  we  can  see  the  spiracles  on  every 
segment  of  the  abdomen,  and  also  the  pygidium,  is  one  of 


146  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

the  best  to  mount  for  observation.  The  dots  on  the  head, 
and  the  femora  being  without  hairs,  distinguish  it  from  the 
human  Flea. 

The  eggs  of  fleas  are  white,  long,  and  viscid  or  sticky  ; 
the  larvae  vermiform,  with  thirteen  segments  ;  the  pupa  is 
enclosed  in  a  silken  cocoon. 


PEDICULUS,    OR   LOUSE, 

a  genus  of  anoplurous  insects. 

Man  is  infested  by  three  kinds  of  Louse  ;  but  the  com- 
mon head  louse  is  the  one  usually  mounted  for  observation. 
It  has  a  flat  and  nearly  transparent  body,  three  pairs  of 
legs,  terminated  by  a  claw  or  hook,  and  a  head  which  has 
two  simple  eyes,  and  a  long  sucker  concealed  in  a  little 
fleshy  tubercle  or  snout.  They  multiply  prodigiously,  two 
females  producing  no  less  than  10,000  eggs  in  eight  weeks. 
Leuwenhoek  described  them  minutely,  and  seems  to  have 
watched  their  manner  of  feeding  and  propagating  with 
great  interest.  Certainly  their  eggs  are  curiously  formed, 
with  a  little  moveable  lid  on  a  hinge,  which  opens  for  the 
escape  of  the  young  larvae,  and  the  egg  of  the  Pheasant- 
louse  is  beautifully  striated  and  dotted,  giving  it  the  ap- 
pearance of  worked  net.  Some  parts  of  the  internal 
organization  of  a  Louse  are  well  worthy  of  attention  and 
dissection  ;  being  naturally  transparent,  a  little  soaking  in 
oil  of  turpentine  will  dissolve  the  fat  and  render  many  of 
the  organs  apparent. 

The  nerves  of  a  Louse  are  remarkable,  as  forming  a  thick 
spinal  cord  without  breaks  or  intervals,  after  the  ganglia  of 
the  head,  and  from  the  end  of  which  several  rays  or  nerves 
are  given  out  to  lower  parts  of  the  body,  a  slight  constric- 
tion only  marking  the  united  ganglia.  These  are  visible 
when  the  insect  is  properly  prepared.  The  ovaries  also  are  in 
ten  branches  of  bead-like  threads.  All  the  internal  apparatus 
is  as  perfect  as  in  more  beautiful  insects,  so  little  reason 
is  there  for  shrinking  from  or  thinking  meanly  of  even  a 
loathsome  louse. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  147 

Birds  have  many  varieties. 
The  Pheasant-louse ; 

The  Parasite  of  the  Rook  and  Chaffinch,  called  Riciniis 
pavonis,  are  interesting  objects. 


THE   ACARI,    OR   TICKS,    MITES. 

These  parasites  are  found  on  animals,  birds,  and  insects. 
They  belong  to  the  lowest  order  of  Arachnida,  the  Spider 
tribe,  and  many  of  them  are  beautiful  microscopic  objects. 

The  Acarus  scabid,  or  itch  insect,  is  a  very  valuable  pre- 
paration. It  is  the  occasion  of  that  disgusting  disease  the 
Itch,  and  is  exceedingly  difficult  to  obtain.  It  lodges  in  a 
burrow  near  the  pustule ;  but,  being  scarcely  visible  to  the 
naked  eye,  is  rarely  extracted  in  a  perfect  state.  When 
examined  under  the  microscope  it  is  found  to  have  an  oval 
body,  a  mouth  of  conical  form,  and  eight  feet  terminated  by 
bristles.  The  head  has  five  strong  mandibles,  with  which 
it  cuts  out  a  little  nest  under  the  skin  ;  it  lays  many  eggs, 
and  is  most  difficult  to  eradicate. 

ACARUS   DOMESTICUS,    OR   COMMON   CHEESE-MITES. 

The  dust  of  decayed  cheese  is  composed  entirely  of  these 
mites, — their  eggs  and  their  excrement.  Mounted  properly, 
we  should  see  their  oval  body,  with  a  head  from  which 
extends  two  large  mandibles,  somewhat  resembling  the 
claws  of  a  lobster.  When  the  insect  is  in  repose  it  crosses 
these  mandibles  over  its  head,  forming  a  kind  of  roof  over 
the  mouth.  The  legs  are  reddish,  and  inserted  in  two 
different  groups,  the  anterior  pair  considerably  larger  in 
the  male. 

These  Acari  are  both  viviparous  and  oviparous. 

ACARUS   PASSULARUM, 

found  abundantly  in  dried  figs,  is  like  the  cheese-mite,  but 
has  very  long  bristles  at  the  sides  of  the  mouth. 


148  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

ACAKUS   PASSEKINUS. 

Found  on  all  young  birds. 

IXODES,    OR   DOG-TICK, 

a  curious  parasite,  which  has  no  perceptible  eyes.  It  has 
a  toothed  beak,  which  it  fixes  in  the  skin  of  the  dog  and  of 
the  hedgehog,  and  it  holds  so  tightly  that  it  can  scarcely 
be  detached  alive.  It  deposits  a  prodigious  number  of 
eggs,  and  are  so  voracious  as  to  cause  the  death  of  some 
animals  from  exhaustion. 

MELOPHAGUS. 

(Sheep-tick.) 

This  parasite  belongs  to  the  Diptera,  though  it  is  wing- 
less. They  abound  on  sheep,  are  easily  taken  and  prepared. 
Let  them  soak  in  potash  for  at  least  a  month,  then  press 
them  and  wash  them  well ;  when  dry,  soak  in  turpentine 
before  mounting  in  balsam,  and  their  structure  will  be 
well  seen.  They  are  very  brilliant  objects  when  viewed 
with  polarized  light. 

The  Melophagus  is  one  of  the  family  Hippoboscida,  of 
which  there  are  six  genera,  all  of  them  parasites  of  mam<- 
malia  and  birds,  feeding  on  the  substance  at  the  roots  of 
the  hairs  and  feathers.  The  species  pass  their  egg  and 
larva  state  in  the  body  of  the  mother,  who  produces  only  a 
single  egg  at  a  time,  which  is  in  reality  a  pupa.  This 
pupa  egg  is  nearly  as  large  as  its  parent,  and  has  a  slight 
motion,  with  spiracles,  or  rather  spiraculiform  points, 
down  each  side,  and  in  a  short  time  it  changes  to  a  perfect 
Ely. 

The  Melophagus  has  no  wings,  but  six  stout  bristly  legs 
with  very  long  curved  and  toothed  claws,  which  they  fix  in 
the  wool  of  the  sheep.  The  head  is  very  large,  broader 
than  the  thorax ;  the  antennae  are  mere  tubercles  ;  the  eyes 
small,  oblong,  and  bare.  The  mouth  consists  of  a  pair  of 
short  hairy  valves,  in  which  a  long  sucking-tube  is  con- 
cealed;  it  usually  uncoils  in  mounting,  and  is  well  seen  as 
a  very  fine  hair,  protruding  from  between  the  valves. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  149 

STENOPTERYX. 

This  should  be  looked  for  on  swallows :  you  may  find  them 
abundantly  in  nests  of  the  young  birds.  They  run  very 
quickly,  but  do  not  attempt  to  fly,  although  they  have 
wings,  and  are  good  examples  of  another  genus  of  the  Hip- 
poboscidse. 

Here  we  find  a  difference  in  the  male  and  female ;  the 
former  having  long  narrow  wings,  ciliated  in  front,  the 
costal  vein  more  than  two-thirds  the  length  of  the  wing,  and 
longitudinal  veins  crowded  close  to  the  costal.  The  female 
has  short  triangular  wings  ;  the  rest  of  the  body  very  like 
that  of  Melophagus. 

ORNITHOMYIA. 

(Parasite  of  Birds.) 

A  green  and  tawny  fly,  more  perfectly  winged  than  the 
preceding  genera,  but  seldom,  if  ever,  using  the  wings,  and 
running  with  great  swiftness  amongst  the  feathers  of  all  birds. 

NTCTERIBIA. 

This  is  a  rare  parasite,  but  quite  worth  seeking,  upon 
bats.  The  head  is  thrown  back  in  an  extraordinary  manner ; 
the  mouth  has  a  large  bulb-like  organ,  from  which  proceeds 
a  horny  style.  It  has  no  wings;  the  claws  are  strong, 
dilated  beneath  ;  and  the  abdomen  is  terminated  by  two 
styles.  There  are  specimens  of  this  in  the  British  Museum. 

CHELIFEE. 

This  parasite  attacks  flies.  I  have  seen  a  common  fly 
run  wildly  about  the  window-pane,  shaking  itself  violently, 
and  apparently  in  great  distress.  Upon  catching  it,  I 
found  a  small  scorpion -like  creature  fixed  upon  one  of  its 
thighs,  by  a  pair  of  tremendous  claws, — hardly  could  it 
be  detached  for  examination,  and  then  it  ran  quickly  like  a 
crab,  sideways.  The  Chelifer  belongs  to  the  Tracliean 
Arachnida,  that  is,  they  breathe  by  means  of  trachea  and 
spiracles,  and  not,  as  the  higher  order  of  spiders,  by  lungs, 
or  internal  gills.  They  have  eight  legs,  two  long  palpi 
armed  with  claws ;  the  eyes  are  at  the  side  of  the  thorax, 
and  the  flat  abdomen  is  jointed. 


150  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

ACARFS   GAMASUS, 

found  abundantly  on  the  Dung-beetle,  which  it  infests. 
This  has  a  trifid  labium,  mandibles  cheliform,  denticulate, 
the  tarsi  terminated  by  two  claws,  and  an  elegant  pulvillus, 
which  make  it  worth  mounting. 

Scottish  peasants  have  a  habit  of  examining  the  Dung- 
beetles  in  the  spring,  and  observing  the  position  of  the 
acari  on  their  bodies :  if  the  parasites  are  clustered  near  the 
head,  there  will  be  a  fine  harvest,  if  towards  the  end  of 
the  abdomen,  a  late  one. 

TROMBIDIUM   PHALANGII. 

A  pretty  little  parasite,  which  attaches  itself  to  the 
Phalangium,  or  Harvest-spider.  These  spiders  have  small 
oval  bodies  and  very  long  legs,  with  two  eyes  on  their  backs, 
and  always  run  upon  the  ground ;  we  find  these  little  scarlet 
mites  attached  to  their  legs  and  bodies. 

TROMBIDIUM   AUTUMNALE. 

(Harvest-bit  jr.) 

This  troublesome  little  parasite  is  found  in  corn-fields  in 
August,  and  burrows  in  the  skin,  causing  much  painful 
irritation.  The  best  way  of  catching  it  is  to  tie  pocket- 
handkerchiefs  round  the  legs,  and  walk  through  a  stubble- 
field,  when  we  are  nearly  certain  of  finding  specimens 
enough  in  the  folds  of  the  handkerchief.  They  are  mounted 
in  balsam. 

In  all  the  Trombidia,  observe  the  form  of  the  chelicerse, 
with  their  moveable  claw,  and  the  palpi,  which  have  a  sin- 
gular appendage  or  finger  beneath  each  extremity,  which 
distinguishes  them  from  the  common  Acari,  and  show  their 
relationship  to  the  pretty  scarlet  Water-mites,  theHydrachna. 

WATER-MITES. 

(Hydrachnidce.) 

The  beautiful  Hydrachna  and  Limnochares  are  parasites 
upon  the  Water-beetle  (Dytiscus),  and  Water-scorpion 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  151 

(Nepa),  and  worthy  of  attention  in  their  metamorphosis, 
also  when  mounted  thus  as  objects  for  the  microscope. 

There  are  several  species;  some  bright  scarlet (Hydrachna), 
others  dotted  with  black,  having  blue  legs  (Atax),  some 
parti-coloured  black  and  scarlet  (Diplodontus),  one,  bright 
green  (Arrenus) ;  all  of  them  to  be  found  in  rivers  and  ponds 
merrily  swimming  about,  and  laying  millions  of  small  red 
eggs  on  leaf  and  stem  of  water  plants.  They  seize  on  small 
crustaceans,  such  as  the  Cyclops  andDaphnia,  and  suck  them. 

The  metamorphosis  is  as  follows  : — The  eggs  are  laid  in 
great  abundance  throughout  May  and  June,  six  weeks  after 
a  curious  larva  comes  out,  having  a  long  blue  snout  and 
two  large  round  eyes.  We  do  not  know  how  long  it 
remains  free  in  the  water,  but  towards  the  end  of  the 
summer  we  find  it  change  into  a  scarlet  oblong  pupa, 
fixed  by  a  strong  hook  to  the  tail  of  the  Water-scorpion,  or 
under  the  elytra  of  Dytiscus.  These  pupa3  were  once  mis- 
taken for  eggs ;  but  the  French  naturalist  Duges  watched 
them  well,  and  saw  every  stage  of  the  metamorphosis. 
From  the  pupa  emerges  a  six-legged  mite,  which  moults 
and  becomes  perfect,  with  eight  ciliated  legs  for  swimming. 

The  claws  and  palpi  should  be  particularly  noticed,  and 
the  epidermis  of  the  green  mite  Arrenus,  mounted  for  its 
dotted  appearance. 

ENTOZOA. 

These  are  parasites  attached  to  the  internal  parts  of  the 
animal  body,  and  consist  of  intestinal  worms,  some 
extremely  minute,  burrowing  in  the  skin,  others  of  larger 
size  infesting  the  viscera.  No  part  of  the  human  body  is 
free  from  their  attacks,  the  liver,  the  kidneys,  the  intestines, 
and  the  brain,  are  their  food  and  abiding-place.  There  is 
scarcely  one  animal,  especially  of  the  vertebrate  classes, 
which  is  not  infested  by  several  species.  The  human  body 
has  eighteen  internal  parasites,  and  those  which  inhabit 
one  animal  are  rarely  found  in  one  of  another  genus. 
Those  who  desire  further  knowledge  of  these  parasites,  had 
better  read  l  Owen's  Hunterian  Lectures/  vols.  iv.,  v.,  vi. 


152  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

CHAPTER  VI. 

MICEOSCOPIC  MOTHS. 

"  Small  fowl  that  sun  their  wings  on  the  petals  of  wild  flowers." 

Proverbial  Philosophy , 


A  NEW  class  of  objects,  especially  adapted  for  the 
binocular  microscope  and  a  three-inch  object  glass,  will 
give  the  young  student  both  surprise  and  delight,  when 
from  his  own  researches  he  obtains  these  common  and  yet 
little  known  Lepidoptera.  Their  history  has  been  written 
most  ably  by  Stainton,  in  seven  unattainable  volumes,  and 
the  '  Insecta  Britannica'  has  an  extinct  volume  on  the 
Tiniena — at  least  it  is  out  of  print,  and  to  be  found  only  in 
museums  and  the  libraries  of  the  subscribers,  so  that  what 
I  now  give  is  chiefly  the  result  of  my  own  observations  and 
collecting.  I  purpose  a  much  more  detailed  account,  with 
illustrations,  for  "  the  Intellectual  Observer/'  at  the  proper 
time. 

One  of  the  wonders  of  my  childhood  was  the  variety  and 
strangeness  of  the  hieroglyphics  I  found  on  bramble-leaves 
and  rose-leaves,  the  white  winding  stream  with  a  dark  line 
waving  through  it ;  and  after  picking  open  several,  and 
finding  within  the  small  green  caterpillars,  and  after  often 
gathering,  and  keeping  them  only  to  find  the  leaves  wither 
and  the  larvaB  die,  I  made  small  muslin  bags,  and  covering 
the  mined  and  rolled  leaves,  I  was  rewarded  by  the  perfect 
insects,  of  such  exceeding  beauty  as  led  me  to  renewed 
attention  and  patient  watching. 

Every  folded  leaf,  in  truth,  is  the  habitation  of  a  micro- 
scopic moth  in  its  larval  state,  and  beneath  the  leaf  a  blotch, 
a  pucker,  or  a  tiny  tent,  will,  if  watched,  give  one  of  these 
beautiful  objects.  They  may  be  caught  with  a  net,  swept 
off  the  bushes  they  frequent  at  certain  times  ;  but  they  are 
so  very  delicate  and  tender,  that  it  is  scarcely  possible  to  do 
this  without  ruffling  the  beautiful  plumage ;  and  I  prefer 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  153 

breeding  them  or  collecting  the  grubs,  and  keeping  them 
under  muslin  shades,  to  ensure  a  perfect  specimen. 

I  must,  however,  forewarn  my  young  friends  that  every 
leaf  miner  is  not  the  larva  of  a  moth ;  for  the  primrose, 
ranunculus,  and  several  other  plants,  are  mined  by  the 
larva  of  flies,  the  Phy tomyzides  and  Agromyzides. 

The  following  list  of  the  prettiest  specimens  will  direct 
the  collector : — 

NEPTICULA   AURELLA. 

This  is  the  bramble-leaf  miner.  The  parent  lays  an  egg 
on  the  under  surface  of  the  leaf,  and  as  soon  as  hatched, 
the  larva,  which  is  a  very  small  caterpillar,  with  very 
undeveloped  legs,  and  no  coronet  of  hooks  on  its  fore-legs, 
begins  to  bore  through  the  cuticle  and  feed  on  the  paren- 
chyma, between  the  upper  and  under  skin.  As  it  feeds  and 
grows,  the  wavy  line  widens  visibly,  and  along  the  centre  is 
a  string  of  excrement,  black  and  wavy  also.  When  full 
fed,  it  emerges  and  falls  to  the  ground,  spins  a  cocoon,  and 
changes  to  a  pupa  ;  at  the  end  of  three  weeks  it  rises  as  the 
perfect  insect,  and  flits  over  the  brambles  in  calm,  sunny 
weather  ;  or  we  may  find  them  in  windy  weather  resting  on 
the  sheltered  side  of  a  paling. 

To  the  unassisted  eye,  this  tiny  moth  is  a  mere  brown 
speck,  a  very  dot  of  life.  Placed  under  the  microscope,  we 
see  two  upper  wings  of  rich  brown  passing  into  deep 
purple,  and  then  a  violet  spot  and  band  of  brightest  gold. 
Two  under  wings  of  soft  gray,  deeply  fringed  with  silvery 
scales,  and  these  scales  are  all  remarkably  large  for  the 
size  of  this  minute  insect,  which  does  not  exceed  three  lines 
in  length. 

NEPTICULA   MALYELLA, 

is  the  moth  of  a  small  leaf  miner  on  apple  trees,  in  July  and 
October,  for  all  these  little  creatures  have  double  broods ; 
and  its  dark-brown  upper  wings  are  streaked  with  a  single 
bright  pale  band. 

NEPTICULA   PRUNETORI. 

Mines  the  sloe  leaf,  and  has  a  beautiful  dark]  wing,  with 
a  well-defined  black  line  preceding  a  silvery  band. 

10 


154  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

NEPTICULA   TRIMACULATA, 

the  three-spotted  moth  of  the  poplar-mining  caterpillar, 
which  deposits  its  egg  on  the  upper,  and  not  on  the  usual 
lower  side  of  the  leaf,  and  makes  a  long  gallery  running 
close  to  one  of  the  ribs,  then  suddenly  eats  out  a  blotch. 
The  larvse  are  found  in  July  and  October ;  the  moth  in 
May  and  August,  easily  recognised  by  the  broad,  whitish 
streak,  taking  up  half  the  breadth  of  the  wing,  with  two 
triangular  whitish  spots  beyond  the  middle. 

But  the  microscopist  need  not  go  further  than  the  common 
laburnum  for  one  of  the  prettiest— nay,  it  is  a  lovely  little 
creature,  that  glistening,  white-winged 

CERIOSTOMA. 

Those  unsightly  blotches  on  the  leaves  are  the  abode  of 
its  larva  ;  and  we  lament  over  the  spoiled  and  crumpled 
laburnum  leaves  until  we  have  learnt  the  life  of  that  most 
beautiful  little  moth.  The  upper  wings  are  pure  white, 
with  a  pale  yellow  spot  on  the  costa  beyond  the  middle,  and 
a  second  spot  with  parallel  lines  ;  then,  near  the  tip,  a  large 
black  spot  with  violet  pupil,  and  three  radiating  brown 
streaks  in  the  cilia.  No  large  butterfly  is  so  beautiful. 

There  is  another  Ceriostoma,  so  like  the  first  as  scarcely 
to  be  distinguished,  and  yet  it  has  a  variation,  and  is  one 
of  the  manifestations  of  design  and  order  that  I  cannot  but 
draw  attention  to.  It  mines  the  broom  plant,  and  is 
easily  taken  from  the  middle  of  June  to  the  end  of  July. 
The  upper  wing  is  like  that  of  the  laburnum  miner,  except 
that  the  second  dot  has  always  converging,  and  not  parallel 
lines — that  is  all ;  it  is  but  the  bending  of  a  narrow  line, 
invisible  to  the  naked  human  eye,  yet  there  it  ever  is,  drawn 
by  the  Hand  whose  lightest  touch  hath  purpose  and  per- 
fection of  design. 

Another  species,  perhaps  lovelier  still, 

CERIOSTOMA    SCITELLA, 

mining  the  hawthorn,  the  apple,  the  pear,  blotching  the 
leaves  and  making  our  hedge-rows  wither  before  their  time. 
How  exquisite  is  the  soft  gray  wing  of  this  species,  mottled, 
fretted,  banded,  and  streaked,  with  a  golden  tinge  around 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  155 

the  large  violet  eye,  like  a  microscopic  Peacock  Butterfly, 
but  far  more  beautiful.  This  well  deserves  careful  mounting. 

But  as  my  space  is  limited,  I  must  not  enumerate  many 
more  of  these  moths,  for  it  is  only  to  give  an  impulse  to 
the  study  of  them  that  I  write  so  much,  and  to  suggest 
them  as  new  and  interesting  objects  for  the  microscope. 

There  are  no  less  than  seventy  species  of  Lithocolletis, 
whose  brilliant  gilded  or  silvered  wings  have  given  them 
the  appellation  of  the  Humming  Birds  of  the  Lepidoptera, 
and  it  will  well  repay  any  trouble  to  obtain  the  following 
species : — 

LITHOCOLLETIS   STLVELLA. 

Abundant  on  the  maple,  and  found  near  London,  Ten- 
terden,  Guildford,  Oxford,  Bristol  and  Shrewsbury.  The 
pure  white  wings  have  ochreous  fans,  bent  into  angles,  and 
edged  with  jet-black  scales. 

LITHOCOLLETIS   SCH  HEBE  BELLA. 

The  larva  puckers  the  under  side  of  elm  leaves,  and  the 
perfect  insect  flits  to  and  fro,  with  bright-reddish,  orange- 
coloured  wings,  striped  with  silver  glittering  bars,  and  with 
a  pair  of  silver  dots.  These  are  very  abundant  near  London 
and  Oxford  in  May  and  in  August. 

LITHOCOLLETIS   TRIFASCIELLA. 

Whoever  cares  to  find  this,  need  but  observe  the  lower 
leaves  of  the  honeysuckle  shoots  in  April,  all  puckered 
aslant,  and  the  under  side  mined.  Three  broods  in  the 
year  does  this  honeysuckle  feed,  and  around  it  will  flit  the 
moth  with  reddish-yellow  wings  and  white  bands,  deeply 
bordered  with  black  scales.  This  also  is  common  near 
London. 

LITHOCOLLETIS    HORTELLA.— L.    ROBORIS.— L.    AMYOTELLA. 

These  all  mine  oak  leaves,  and  have  very  pretty  variegated 
wings,  white  or  yellow,  and  with  golden-brown  bands  and 
dots,  and  delicate  gray  under  wings,  with  white  cilia. 

The  collector  must  also  seek  the  leaf  rollers  as  well  as 
the  leaf  miners. 


156  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

GRACILLARIA   SWEDERELLA, 

common  on  the  oaks  in  May,  June,  and  August.  The 
upper  wings  bright-reddish,  with  a  violet  gloss,  pale-yellow 
streaks,  and  triangle,  and  under  wings  of  shining  gray. 
This  pretty  little  creature  sits  upon  its  tail  when  at  rest, 
with  a  smooth  head  and  its  long  antennae  folded  back ;  not 
difficult  to  catch. 

GRACILLARIA   SYRINGELLA. 

Abundant  in  gardens  where  lilac  trees  sufferfrom  the 
rolling  up  of  the  leaves,  and  the  little  chocolate-variegated 
moth  comes  forth  to  give  another  brood  to  the  already 
disfigured  trees. 

COLEOPHORA   GRYPHIPENNELLA. 

There  are  about  forty-one  species  of  these  moths  whose 
larvae  make  tents  in  the  most  ingenious  manner,  eating  away 
the  parenchymas  of  a  leaf  until  enough  is  hollowed  out  for 
a  convenient  habitation,  and  then  joining  with  silken  threads 
the  upper  and  lower  cuticle,  they  cut  it  quite  out  and  walk 
off  with  it.  These  are  found  commonly  on  rose  trees  in 
May,  and  the  little  moth  in  June.  Other  species  on 
Stellaria,  Sallows,  Hawthorn,  Ground  Ivy,  the  Pear,  the 
Plum,  and  the  Cherry  in  May,  when  the  pupa  cases  may 
be  collected  and  the  moths  taken. 

ORNIX   GUTTEA. 

A  pretty  spotted  moth  whose  larva  folds  down  the  edge 
of  apple  leaves  and  feeds  there. 

LITHOCOLLETIS   SCABIOSELLA. 

In  the  herbage  near  scabious  plants  this  pretty  species 
will  be  found  and  easily  taken. 

It  is  reddish-saffron  coloured,  the  upper  wings  with  three 
pure  bright  white  stripes,  edged  on  the  inner  side  with 
black  scales,  and  there  is  a  double  spot  at  the  apex  of  the 
wing,  white  also,  but  with  a  stream  of  black  scales,  spreading 
fan-like  towards  the  edge.  The  larva  of  this  Lithocolletis 
crumples  up  the  root  leaves  of  the  scabious  by  mining  the 
under  surface  of  the  leaf,  and  in  the  shelter  of  its  excavation 


Objects  for  the  Microscope*  157 

spins  a  slight  cocoon  where  it  undergoes  its  transformation. 
This  moth  is  plentiful  in  the  neighbourhood  of  Croydon. 

GLYPHIPTERYX    THRASONELLA. 

Several  of  these  are  the  prettiest  little  green  moths  flitting 
in  open  meadows,  and  one  species,  haunting  the  rushes  in 
damp  places,  has,  upon  the  dark-bronzy,  green  ground,  five 
bluish  silvery  streaks,  and  above  the  anal  angle  a  black 
blotch,  enclosing  three  silvery  violet  spots.  The  wing  is  deeply 
edged  with  bronzed  cilia,  and  the  under  wings  are  gray. 

Another  extremely  pretty  species  is  found  in  June  and 
July  flying  over  the  flowers  of  Stonecrop — this  is  Glyphip- 
teryx  equitella. 

Enough,  perhaps,  are  now  described,  yet  I  would  draw 
attention  also  to  the  form  of  the  heads,  the  feathered 
antenna?,  and  the  tufts  of  scales  on  the  heads  and  palpi  of 
many  of  these  moths.  For  instance — 


THE    HEAD    OF    OCHSENHEIMERIA 


feathered  in  a  marvellous  bird-like  manner,  the  antennae 
thickened  with  scales,  labial  palpi  very  hairy,  and  the 
head  alone  making  an  excellent  object.  The  moth  is  gray, 
and  very  abundant  in  some  meadows  towards  the  end  of 
July.  They  are  rarely  seen,  however,  except  between  the 
hours  of  twelve  and  two,  in  the  heat  of  the  sun,  and  then 
they  are  hopping  about  the  grass  stems,  and  depositing 

on  the  stems  of  Dactylus  glomeratus. 
"he  heads  of  the  following  are  remarkable,  and  worth 
mounting : — 

HEAD    OF   PLUTELLA, 

with  tufted  labial  palpi. 

The  moth  is  spotted  gray,  and  is  often  very  abundant 
among  cabbages  and  cruciferous  plants. 

HEAD    OF   CORSICIUM. 

This  should  show  the  front  of  the  head,  and  the  curved 
labial  palpi,  with  long  pendent  scales.  The  moth  is  grayish- 
brown,  and  hovers  about  oak  trees  in  June,  August,  and 
September. 


158  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 


CHAPTER  VII. 

PALATES. 


PALATE   OF   HELIX   POMATIA. 

Helix  pomatia  is  that  very  large  snail  found  in  woods 
and  hedges  on  chalky  soil  and  oolite  formations  in  the 
Southern  and  Midland  Counties  of  England.  The  shell  is 
often  two  inches  high,  of  pale  tawny  colour.  These  snails 
were  highly  esteemed  in  the  olden  time  by  the  imperial 
gourmands  of  Rome,  who  preferred  them  fried  in  oil  of 
almonds,  and  then  delicately  grilled  on  a  silver  gridiron. 
When  previously  fattened  upon  bran  and-wine,  they  grew  to 
an  enormous  size ;  three  snails,  two  eggs,  and  a  lettuce,  being 
a  favourite  supper  of  Pliny  the  younger.  At  one  period  in 
England  we  feasted  upon  them  ourselves,  boiled  in  spring- 
water,  and  seasoned  with  oil,  salt,  and  pepper ;  and  highly 
relished  them  as  a  foreign  luxury,  introduced  for  that  pur- 
pose about  the  middle  of  the  sixteenth  century,  and  first 
cultivated  in  Surrey,  afterwards  in  Buckinghamshire  and 
Northamptonshire.  Of  later  years  they  have  been  used 
medicinally  in  cases  of  consumption,  as  also  the  common 
garden  snail,  Helix  aspersa,  which  is  exported  from  England 
yearly  for  this  very  purpose,  and  sent  to  America  packed 
in  old  casks.  The  glassmen  at  Newcastle  have  still  a  snail- 
feast  yearly,  and  generally  collect  the  snails  themselves  on 
the  Sunday  previous  to  the  feast. 

We  may  also  care  to  know  that  this  edible  snail,  which 
abounds  in  the  neighbourhood  of  Mount  Sinai,  has  been 
thought  to  have  supplied  the  Israelites  with  food  in  that 
part  of  their  journey  towards  the  land  of  Canaan ;  for  the 
whole  sides  of  that  valley  between  Mount  Deouchi  and 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  159 

Mount  Torah  are  covered  with  shrubs  of  tamarisk  broom, 
and  with  clover  and  saintfoin  ;  and  the  herbage  beneath  is 
so  thronged  with  these  snails  that  travellers  say  it  is  diffi- 
cult to  walk  without  crushing  them. 

So  much  for  the  general  interest  of  the  snail ;  but  the 
palate  chiefly  relates  to  its  depredations,  and  shows  us  the 
cause  of  its  mischief-making  in  our  gardens. 

HELIX   ASPERSA. 

The  mouth  of  the  snail  is  armed  with  two  horny  lips, 
sufficiently  powerful  to  bite  the  tender  stalks  of  lettuce  and 
other  young  vegetables  ;  and  is  further  provided  with  this 
palate,  which  is  not  in  the  mouth,  but  lying*  far  back  in  a 
kind  of  pouch  which  opens  in  front,  and  is  capable  of  pro- 
jection forward  and  backward,  as  may  be  well  observed  in 
the  water-snails  kept  in  aquariums.  We  can  there  see  the 
opening  lips  and  the  palate  thrown  forward,  rasping  away 
the  conferva  spores  on  the  surface  of  the  glass.  The 
palate  of  Helix  aspersa  is  broad  and  short,  set  with  about 
150  rows  of  stout  serrated  teeth — altogether  no  less  than 
21,000  in  this  single  palate. 

LIMAX, 

(Black-slug,) 

is  nearly  the  same,  but  contains  yet  more  teeth.  A  full- 
sized  and  aged  slug  has  26,000  teeth,  which  accounts  for 
its  power  of  destruction  in  our  gardens. 

HELTX   HORTENSIS. 

Helix  Hortensis  is  a  variety  of  the  common  garden  snail, 
reddish,  yellowish,  or  pale  gray. 

HELIX    NE^IORALIS. 

Helix  nemoralis  is  the  pretty  banded  black  and  yellow 
snail,  which,  if  long  lying  in  the  warm  sun,  often  turns 
rose-coloured  or  fine  pink,  to  the  great  admiration  of  little 
shell  collectors. 


160  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 


HELIX    RUFESCENS. 


Helix  rufescens,  a  reddish-brown  snail,  flattish,  and  in 
the  middle  of  the  largest  whorl  it  has  a  narrow  white  line 
or  band,  which  distinguishes  it. 

HELIX   VIRGATA. 

These  pretty  small  brown  and  white  banded  snails  are 
most  abundant  on  our  sandy  sea-coasts,  quite  covering  the 
marine  planits  there  ;  also  they  are  often  in  great  numbers 
on  sandy  commons  on  the  wayside  turf. 

The  palates  of  all  these  terrestrial  gasteropods  are  upon 
the  same  plan — broad,  short,  and  with  long  rows  of  teeth  ; 
the  prettiest  variety  is  found  in  the  palate  of 

ZONITES,    OR   HELIX   NITIDA. 

This  small  snail  is  a  species  passing  out  of  the  genus 
HelicidaB ;  it  is  small,  transparent,  pale  yellow,  or  light 
brown,  with  five  whorls,  and  the  under  side  clouded  with 
white  ;  found  under  stones,  and  in  violet  beds  at  the  roots 
of  the  plants,  also  in  cellars  and  yards  in  cities.  The  side 
teeth  slope  towards  the  centre,  which  is  occupied  by  what 
maybe  called  double  teeth,  or  teeth  with  several  projections. 
There  are  few  prettier  palates  than  this  of  the  common  little 
Zonites,  or  Cellar-snail. 

PALATE   OF   WHELK. 

(Buccinum  undatum.) 

Compare  this  with  the  palate  of  any  of  the  terrestrial 
gasteropods — snails  or  slugs — and  the  difference  of  struc- 
ture will  be  apparent :  instead  of  that  broad  short  mem- 
brane thickly  set  with  rows  of  nearly  uniform  teeth,  we  have 
here  a  ribbon-like  tongue,  having  strong  serrated  teeth  at 
the  edges,  and  rows  of  small  finer  ones  between  them,  better 
observed  by  polarized  light,  which  makes  it  a  splendid 
object.  This  tongue  is  contained  in  a  long  fleshy  proboscis, 
with  which  the  Whelk  bores  through  the  shell  of  those 
molluscs  which  serve  it  for  food,  and  the  muscles  by  which 
it  moves  this  tongue  are  immensely  strong,  not  only  drawing 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  161 

it  backwards  and  forwards,  but  raising  or  depressing  the 
teeth. 

The  whelk  is  largely  consumed  in  London ;  it  is  dredged 
off  every  part  of  the  British  coast.  Dr.  Johnson  tells  us 
that  at  the  enthronisation  feast  of  William  Warrham, 
archbishop  of  Canterbury,  in  1504,  8,000  Whelks  were 
dressed  as  side  dishes  for  the  lordly  epicures  of  those 
days. 

PALATE    OF   PURPUREA. 

The  Purpurea,  or  Dog-whelk,  is  a  small  species  of  Buc- 
cinum  very  abundant  on  our  rocks ;  it  has  a  white  shell, 
and  is  often  found  with  a  little  semi-transparent  flask  beside 
it,  or  a  cluster  of  them  filled  with  eggs,  which  are  most  in- 
teresting microscopic  objects,  as  the  development  of  the 
little  mollusc  is  easily  watched.  The  palate  is  pretty  and 
resembles  that  of  the  larger  Buccinum.  It  was  from  this 
shell-fish  that  the  Tyrians  procured  their  famous  purple  dye, 
making  a  bath  of  the  liquid  in  the  proportion  of  two  pounds 
of  Buccinum  liquor  to  one  pound  of  the  purpurea.  The 
process  being  tedious,  and  the  needful  quantity  of  these 
little  creatures  very  great,  the  price  of  the  wool  so  dyed 
was  enormously  high — no  less  than  1,000  Roman  denarii, 
or  thirty-six  pounds  sterling,  per  pound. 

NASSA. 

A  smaller  species  of  Buccinum. 

PALATE    OF   TROCHUS   ZIZIPHINUS. 

This  is  the  palate  of  that  very  pretty  variegated  spiral 
shell  called  "  Tops,"  which  we  delight  to  find  on  the  rocks 
at  low  water  under  the  thick  hanging  masses  of  sea-weed. 
No  palate  is  so  beautiful,  or  requires  such  careful  exami- 
nation ;  for  when  we  have  had  a  general  view,  we  should 
always  use  a  higher  power,  and  explore  further  the  won- 
derful workmanship  displayed  in  this  tiny  tongue.  Not 
only  are  there  triple  rows  of  finely  notched  teeth  arching 
over  towards  the  centre,  but  the  intermediate  space  is 
thronged  with  delicate  leaf-like  teeth,  curved  downwards 


162  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

with  minutely  serrated  edges — making  a  powerful  instru- 
ment for  rasping  the  surface  of  the  sea-weed  upon  which 
the  Trochus  feeds. 

The  mouth  (of  the  Trochus)  has  no  upper  horny  plate, 
and  therefore  probably  needed  this  elaborately  toothed 
tongue. 

PALATE  OF  TROCHUS  CRASSUS. 

Trochus  Crassus  is  a  variety  of  the  same  family,  having 
a  large  gray  shell,  and  the  tongue  less  beautiful. 

PALATE   OF   TROCHUS   UMBILICATUS. 

Trochus  umbilicatus ;  a  smaller  and  more  abundant  shell, 
also  of  gray  colour. 

PALATE    OF   PERIWINKLE. 

(Littorina.} 

The  Periwinkle  is  too  well  known  to  need  description, 
and  the  palate  is  very  like  that  of  the  Irochus  Crassus. 

PALATE    OF   HALIOTIS,  OR   AUMER. 

The  Haliotis  is  that  beautiful  univalve  mollusc  found  in 
the  Channel  Islands,  under  stones  at  low  tide ;  the  fleshy 
foot  is  sold  in  the  market  there,  and  highly  esteemed  as  an 
article  of  food,  either  stewed  or  fried  in  batter.  The  shell 
is  brought  to  England,  and  sold  to  manufacturers  of  works 
inlaid  with  so-called  mother-of-pearl,  which  is  really  the 
beautiful  interior  of  this  shell.  The  palate  is  one  of  the 
finest  prepared  for  the  miscroscope,  and  yet  more  compli- 
cated than  that  of  Trochus  ziziphinus,  which  it  resembles. 
The  central  band  here  has  rows  of  teeth,  having  nearly 
straight  edges  instead  of  points  ;  there  is  on  each  side  a 
lateral  band  consisting  of  large  teeth,  shaped  like  those  of 
a  shark  ;  and  beyond  this,  again,  another  lateral  band  on 
either  side,  composed  of  several  rows  of  smaller  teeth.  (See 
1  Carpenter  on  the  Microscope/  p.  605.) 

The  Haliotes  are  carnivorous  as  well  as  vegetarian,  often 
found  feeding  on  dead  bodies. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  163 


PALATE   OF   PLEUEOBRANCH. 

The  Pleurobranch  is  a  lemon-coloured,  oval-shaped  mol- 
lusc, found  under  stones  in  tide-pools,  and  breathing  by  a 
beautiful  branchial  plume,  which  is  thrown  out  on  the  right 
side,  as  it  glides  along,  and  protected,  when  at  rest,  by  a 
thin  shell  inside  the  mantle.  This  palate  is  quite  unlike 
any  of  the  others,  more  resembling  a  tesselated  pavement, 
with  a  single  tooth  in  each  lozenge-shaped  division. 

PALATE   OF   APLYSIA. 

Aplysia  is  a  sea-slug,  found  in  deep  rock-pools  gliding 
about  with  a  thick  hump-backed  body,  olive-brown,  and 
tentacles  like  ears,  causing  it  to  resemble  a  hare.  If 
handled  or  frightened,  it  jerks  forth  a  deep  purple  liquid, 
which  stains  the  hand  or  discolours  the  water.  This  is 
evidently  its  defence,  and  conceals  it  from  the  pursuit  of 
ravenous  crustaceans.  It  belongs  to  the  family  of  the 
Pleurobranchs,  which  have  their  breathing  organs  con- 
cealed within  the  mantle,  but  always  on  the  right  side,  and 
the  palate  is  broad  and  short,  resembling  that  of  the  garden 
snail,  only  very  much  larger. 

PALATE   OF   DOEIS. 

(Tuberculata.) 

Another  variety  of  sea-slug,  much  more  beautiful,  and 
the  palate  curiously  set  with  strong  hooked  teeth  like  a 
harrow;  it  has  forty-four  rows,  each  with  140  of  these 
curved  teeth,  used  for  rasping  sea-weed.  There  are  many 
species  of  Doris  usually  found  under  stones  at  low  tide,  or 
beneath  tufts  of  sea-weed ;  they  are  orange-coloured,  or 
pale-yellow,  and  vary  in  size  from  our  largest  garden  slug 
to  a  very  small  one ;  on  their  backs  they  carry  a  plume  of 
branchial  organs,  and  are  therefore  called  Nudibranchs,  or 
naked-gilled  animals. 

PALATE   OF   LIMPET. 

Who  does  not  know  the  Limpet,  clinging  to  the  wave- 
beaten  rock,  and  seemingly  as  motionless  as  its  native  cliff? 


164  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

— who  has  not  jerked  it  off  for  bait  or  for  the  variety  of 
colour  in  its  pretty  shell,  and  in  so  doing  noticed  a  long 
slender  thread  attached  to  its  head,  and  many  times  longer 
than  its  body  ?  That  was  the  tongue  we  are  looking  at. 
It  has,  we  see,  alternate  rows  of  four  hooked  teeth,  and 
two  notched  large  teeth  all  the  whole  length  of  that  thread- 
like palate,  which  lies  coiled  up  loosely  inside  its  body,  and 
is  thrown  forward  like  a  scythe  to  mow  down  the  lichen 
upon  which  it  feeds.  When  the  front  row  of  teeth  wears 
away,  a  second  is  brought  forward,  and  so  the  length  of  the 
tongue  only  provides  for  the  little  creature's  necessities  and 
duration  of  life. 

PALATE   OF   CHITON. 

Not  so  abundant,  and  very  different  in  formation,  is  the 
Chiton,  which  we  find  hidden  in  crevices  of  the  same  rock 
to  which  the  Limpet  clings.  The  Chiton  is  the  only  mol- 
lusc which  has  many  shells  in  one.  This  little  creature  has 
eight  plates  or  shells  overlapping  each  other,  round  the 
external  edges  of  which  the  breathing  organs  lie, — a  row  of 
triangular  leaflets  vibrating  in  the  water,  and  resembling 
gills  in  structure.  The  palate  we  see  is  long  and  ribbon- 
like,  with  dark-brown  teeth  on  either  side,  and  smaller  in 
the  centre  ;  they  are  set  in  a  kind  of  double  arch,  jointed, 
and  capable  of  elevation  or  depression,  and  used,  like  those 
of  the  Limpet,  for  vegetable  food. 

PALATE  OF  YELLOW  NERITE 

is  very  pretty,  and  somewhat  like  the  Periwinkle.  The 
Nerite  is  that  bright-yellow  shell  so  common  on  our  sandy 
coasts.  Children  call  them  "  yellow  tops." 

PALATE    OF   NEBITINA   FLUVIATILIS 

is  a  fresh-water  mollusc,  found  in  slow  rivers  adhering  to 
stones,  the  shell  very  prettily  chequered  with  spots  or  bands 
of  white,  brown,  purple,  or  pink. 

PALATE   OF   LYMNJEA   STAGNALIS. 

The  three  following  palates  belong  to  fresh-water 
molluscs. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  165 

Lymnsea  is  a  large  snail,  whose  shell,  making  six  or 
seven  whorls,  terminating  in  a  fine  point,  is  found  in  all 
ponds  and  stagnant  water,  floating  or  gliding  foot  upwards, 
and  feeding  voraciously  on  all  kinds  of  vegetable  matter. 
The  palate  resembles  that  of  the  garden  snail. 

PALATE  OF  PLANORBIS  CORNEA. 

Planorbis  is  a  flat  snail  with  a  shell  in  horizontal  coils, 
the  size  of  a  shilling,  other  species  being  smaller.  The 
tongue  is  oblong,  and  set  with  many  rows  of  fine  teeth. 

PALATE    OF    PALUDINA. 

Paludina  is  a  remarkable  fresh- water  shell,  more  resem- 
bling a  large  Periwinkle,  but  banded  black  and  yellow, 
with  a  strong  operculum.  It  brings  forth  its  young  alive, 
and  they  may  be  found  in  all  stages  of  life  in  the  space 
between  the  mantle  and  the  shell.  The  tongue  of  the  Palu- 
dina differs  much  from  those  of  Lymnaea  and  Planorbis, 
being  long  and  slender,  and  the  teeth  like  horny  plates 
laid  over  one  another — more  like  those  of  the  land-snail, 
Cyclastoma,  and  showing  that  it  is,  in  truth,  as  La  Mark 
conjectured,  the  family  which  links  the  two  great  divisions 
of  land  and  water  molluscs.  Here  then  we  have  a  very 
interesting  palate,  and  proof  of  the  usefulness  of  microscopic 
observation  ;.  for  nowhere  but  in  the  palate  do  we  find  the 
very  marked  distinction  between  the  Paludina  and  Lymnsea, 
both  inhabitants  of  the  same  stream,  and  at  the  same  time 
the  close  relationship  to  the  little  Cyclastoma,  which  lives 
high  and  dry  upon  the  chalky  hills,  and  under  the  hedge- 
rows of  a  limestone  district. 

PALATE   OF   CYCLASTOMA. 

The  Cyclastoma  elegans  has  a  white  and  finely  striated 
shell ;  its  palate  should  be  mounted  in  fluid,  as  indeed  all 
these  are.  Simple  salt  and  water  well  preserves  them. 


166  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 


CHAPTER  VIII. 

SLIDES   OF   ZOOPHYTES. 

"  0  Lord,  how  manifold  are  thy  works  !  in  wisdom  hast  thou  made 
them  all :  the  earth  is  full  of  thy  riches.  So  is  the  great  and  wide  sea, 
wherein  are  things  creeping  innumerable." 

Psalm  civ.  24,  25. 

"  Look  who  list  thy  gazeful  eyes  to  feed 
Wit  h  sight  of  that  is  fair  :  look  on  the  frame 
Of  t  his  wide  universe,  and  therein  read 
The  endless  kinds  of  creatures  which  by  name 
Tho  u  canst  not  count,  much  less  their  natures  aim  ; 
All  which  are  made  with  wondrous  wise  respect, 
And  all  with  admirable  beauty  deckt." 

Spenser. 


AN  explanation  of  these  useful  slides  to  every  sea-side 
student  seems  necessary,  from  the  fact  that  many  persons 
inquire,  "  What  is  a  Zoophyte  ?"  and  if  shown  one  of  these 
under  the  microscope,  will  presently  declare  that  it  cer- 
tainly may  be  an  animal,  for  it  moves.  This  has  happened 
to  myself  more  than  once,  and  an  explanation  required  to 
prove  the  fact  is  a  post-mortem  examination,  and  then  we 
only  see  the  body,  or  rather  the  framework,  which  sup- 
ported the  once  living  polype. 

These  are  the  skeletons  of  Zoophytes  mounted  to  show 
the  beauty  of  their  structure,  and  the  variations  of  form 
which  determine  the  species. 

If  we  would  see  them  alive,  we  must  gather  them  at  the 
sea-side  fresh  from  their  native  element,  on  the  sea-weed 
or  the  rock,  and  by  placing  them  in  a  watchglassful  of  water 
under  the  microscope,  the  question  "  What  is  a  Zoophyte  ?" 
will  be  answered  far  better  than  any  tongue  can  tell  or  pen 
describe.  Nevertheless,  to  appreciate  these  slides  we  must 
explain  that  Zoophytes  are,  with  one  exception,  marine 
animals,  varying  in  size  from  the  little  microscopic  creatures 
mounted  here,  to  the  large  tree-like  Gorgonias,  and  the 
huge  Madrepores  and  Corals  of  the  tropical  seas.  They 
are  plant-like  animals,  often  mistaken  for  sea-weeds, 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  167 

requiring  minute  attention  and  microscopic  study  to  un- 
derstand ;  but  even  the  careful  observation  of  those  speci- 
mens on  our  lists  will  open  a  wide  field  of  interest,  and  help 
the  young  student  considerably  in  his  first  researches. 

The  number  of  British  Zoophytes  amounts  to  about 
35  genera,  and  240  species.  These  are  divided  into  two 
great  divisions,  and  hold  very  different  ranks  in  the  scale 
of  creation  ;  for  the  Zoophytes  called  Polyzoa,  being  much 
more  highly  organized  than  those  called  Anthozoa,  they 
are  placed  with  the  Tunicate  Molluscs  (Ascidians,  &c.  &c.), 
and  above  the  Radiata  (Starfish  and  Echini)  ;  whereas  the 
Anthozoa  are  only  just  above  the  Infusoria,  or  lowest  form 
of  animal  life. 

These  slides  contain  specimens  of  both  these  orders, 
which  will  be  further  explained  when  under  the  microscope. 
Those  of  the  Anthozoa  are — 


Sertularia. 

Plumularia. 

Laomedea  Campanularia. 

Tubularia. 


Coryne. 
Halecium. 
Thuiaria. 
Antennularia. 


Their  bodies  are  globular,  contractile  in  every  part, 
symmetrical,  mouth  and  vent  one,  gemmiparous  and 
oviparous.  The  Polyzoa  are — 


Gemellaria. 

Cellularia. 

Crisea. 


Mustra. 

Pustulipora. 

Lepralia. 


If  we  describe  the  Sertularia  as  an  example  of  Anthozoa, 
and  Gemellaria  as  one  of  the  Polyzoa,  the  student  will 
understand  each  of  the  others,  and  when  at  the  sea-side 
will  have  <  Harvey's  Sea-side  Companion/  or  '  Landes- 
borough  on  Zoophytes,'  to  teach  the  variety  of  the  species, 
and  direct  to  their  particular  habitat. 


ANTHOZOA. 
SERTULARIA   PUMILA. 


This  little  branch  of  zigzag  cells  was  once  creeping 
along  the  Fucus,  or  common  sea-weed,  on  rocks  at  low- 
water  mark,  often  so  thickly  crowded  together  as  to  cover 
the  alga.  The  cells  are  opposite  each  other,  and  at  inter- 


168  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

vals  large  capsules  or  ovarian  vesicles  rise  from  the  base  of 
a  smaller  cell.  In  life  this  horny  skeleton  was  filled  with 
a  living  pulp,  and  each  tiny  tube  right  and  left  was  the 
abode  of  a  beautiful  white  creature  called  a  Polype,  which 
rose  up  and  threw  out  eight  or  ten  fine  tentacula,  or 
feelers,  drawing  food  into  a  mouth  placed  in  the  centre  of 
these  tentacles.  From  the  mouth  there  was  a  digestive 
sac,  or  stomach,  communicating  with  the  stem,  and  a  cir- 
culation of  fluid  went  on  throughout  the  polypidom,  that 
is  to  say,  the  branch  of  cells  we  have  described,  though 
each  Polype  had  an  independent  life. 

It  has  been  observed,  that  at  the  base  of  the  Zoophyte 
stomach  there  is  an  orifice  closed  by  a  contracting  and 
dilating  sphincter  muscle,  and  through  this  the  digestive 
food  is  propelled  to  the  stem,  after  enough  has  been  appro- 
priated by  that  Polype,  besides  which  a  spiral  movement 
of  particles  is  seen  in  the  stem,  somewhat  resembling  the 
rotation  in  Chara. 

The  manner  of  propagation  and  of  growth  is  very 
remarkable.  Those  ovarian  pear-shaped  vesicles  you  may 
see  here  and  there  on  the  branches  contain  buds,  or 
gemmse,  which,  when  mature,  escape  and  swim  freely  in 
the  great  ocean.  Their  form  is  most  unlike  that  of  their 
parent ;  they  are  called  Medusyides,  and  in  turn  produce 
fertilised  ova ;  these  being  edged  with  cilise  move  for 
several  hours  in  the  water,  and  then,  fixing  on  sea-weed, 
rock,  or  stone,  develop  into  a  polypidom  like  this  spray 
of  Sertularia.  When  the  ovule  fixes,  minute  fibres  are 
observed  to  proceed  from  the  under  side,  and  the  pulp 
dilates  and  ascends,  covered  by  the  horny  substance,  inside 
which  the  dark  pulp  runs  like  a  thread.  At  a  certain  fore- 
ordained point  it  stops,  becomes  bulbous,  a  tube  or  cup 
(according  to  the  species)  forms  gradually,  whilst  the  pulp 
is  fashioned  into  the  Polype  with  little  knobs  lengthening 
into  tentaculse,  which  no  sooner  are  complete  than  they  are 
thrown  forth  for  food  ;  and  the  nourishment,  instead  of 
increasing  the  size  of  the  Polype,  is  passed  to  the  stem, 
and  a  second  cell  buds  forth  on  the  opposite  side,  or  the 
stem  is  prolonged  a  little,  according  to  the  plan  of  the 
species.  Look  at  the  next  slide — 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  169 

SERTULARIA   POLYZONIAS. 

You  see  here  that  the  Polype  cells  are  not  opposite  each 
other,  but  alternate  and  far  apart.  There  are  two  varieties 
of  this  Zoophyte,  the  one  upright,  the  other  spreading 
and  branching ;  it  is  found  on  shells  and  sea- weed,  especially 
on  branches  of  Halidrys. 

These  little  creatures  are  very  phosphorescent  in  the 
dark;  if  we  shake  or  strike  the  sea-weed  upon  which  it 
rests,  a  shower  of  diamond  sparks  seem  to  be  scattered  over 
the  frond  ;  each  cell  on  the  delicate  spray  is  a  fairy  lamp,  a 
moment  seen  and  gone,  or  sometimes  shining  on  with  a 
faint,  gentle  light,  showing  where  the  little  Zoophyte  is 
dwelling.  Often  when,  having  gathered  a  quantity  of  Ser- 
tularia  pumila  during  the  day,  I  have  handled  it  at  night, 
the  flashing  out  of  a  thousand  tiny  stars  has  astonished  me. 
What  must  it  be  if  the  tossing  wave  shakes  glory  thus  from 
the  dark  weed  in  the  stormy  night,  and  the  ocean  depths 
are  illuminated  by  their  living  lamps  ? 

SERTULARIA   OPERCULATA, 

or  Sea-hair  Coralline,  shows  the  sharp  tooth-like  cells 
peculiar  to  this  species,  and  the  vesicles  with  a  rounded 
operculum  on  the  top.  This  zoophyte  is  abundant  on  the 
coast,  often  thrown  up  on  the  beach  in  tufts  as  much  as 
six  or  eight  inches  long,  especially  after  a  storm. 

SERTULARIA   ROSACEA, 

called  the  Lily  or  Pomegranate  Coralline,  will  give  you  a 
good  specimen  of  varieties  in  species,  and  show  you  what  to 
observe  ;  for  the  cells  are  not  so  unlike  those  of  the  common 
Sertularia  pumila  (the  upper  part  of  the  cells  bent  out- 
wards and  downwards  slightly),  but  the  vesicles  are  most 
unlike.  You  see  they  are  pear-shaped,  wrinkled,  cleft  at 
the  top,  and  more  silvery  in  hue.  This  coralline  grows  on 
shells  in  deep  water,  and  is  parasitic  on  other  zoophytes, 
small  white  clusters  being  often  found  on  Plumulariafalcata 
and  Sertularia  argentea. 

LAOMEDEA   GENICULATA, 

the  Knotted-thread  Coralline — a  very  common  and  beau- 

11 


170  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

tiful  zoophyte,  one  of  the  family  of  Campanularidse,  and 
worthy  of  minute  examination.  In  this  species  we  are 
successful  in  preserving  the  polypes  themselves  inside  those 
tiny  cups.  The  fibres  are  twisted  in  a  network  on  the  sea- 
weed— usually  a  frond  of  Laminaria  or  Fucus,  and  slender 
threads  bristle  thickly  from  the  stem — a  zigzag  line,  on 
each  side  of  which  rise  winged  stalks  bearing  the  polype 
cell ;  here  and  there  are  large  vesicles  containing  Medu- 
soides.  The  peculiar  interest  of  these  Laomedea  is  the 
wonderful  adaptation  of  their  structure  to  the  element  in 
which  they  live.  How  would  this  fragile  cup  and  slender 
stem  resist  the  wild  storms  of  the  ocean  if  it  had  not  been 
provided  with  that  jointed  pedicle,  which  bends  to  and  fro 
on  every  side  in  ease  and  safety,  whilst  the  little  inhabitant 
stretches  forth  its  single  row  of  tentacles,  and  draws  food 
into  its  probosciform  mouth  ?  The  vesicles  also,  though 
apparently  sessile,  are  fixed  upon  a  footstalk  like  a  screw, 
which  enables  them  to  resist  the  shocks  of  a  stormy  sea. 

LAOMEDEA   DICHOTOMA. 

Laomedea  dicliotoma,  or  Sea-thread  Coralline,  is  found  in 
long,  filiform,  zigzag  branches,  on  old  shells  or  stones,  or 
sea-weed,  within  tide-mark. 

PLUMULARIA   CRISTATA. 

Observe  this  both  with  reflected  and  transmitted  light. 
It  is  the  Feather  Coralline  picked  up  as  sea-weed  by  chil- 
dren on  the  sea-coast,  after  a  gale  of  wind  has  cast  up 
treasures  of  the  deep  within  our  reach.  It  belongs  to  a  family 
(Plumularia)  which  has  several  species,  but  none  so  beautiful 
as  this.  We  find  it  twined  round  the  stems  and  pods  ot 
Halidrys  siliquosa ;  sometimes  a  mussel-shell  will  have  a 
feathery  plume  upon  its  rich  blue  surface,  and  tens  of  thou- 
sands of  tiny  creatures  spring  forth  from  those  sessile  cups, 
ranged  all  along  the  pinnae  ;  they  are  shaped  somewhat  like 
lilies  of  the  valley,  with  a  projecting  spine  beneath  each,  and 
the  vesicles  are  oblong,  pod-like,  and  banded  with  cristated 
ribs ;  the  more  of  these,  the  better  the  specimen  ;  but  it 
should  be  examined  when  fresh,  and  is  more  easily  found, 
perhaps,  than  any  other  zoophyte. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  171 

PLUMULARIA    FALCATA 

is  another  species,  in  which  you  may  observe  the  polype 
cells  seated  in  close  array  along  the  pinnse  of  the  branches ; 
these,  when  dry,  bend  inwards  like  a  sickle,  and  give  the 
name  of  Sickle  Coralline  to  this  zoophyte.  It  is  dredged 
in  deep  water,  and  common  on  oyster  beds.  A  wavy  branch 
of  it  will  not  tmfrequently  be  found  on  the  back  of  some  old 
crab,  which  has  served  as  its  perambulator,  and  carried  it 
into  rich  stores  of  Diatoms  and  Infusoria,  such  as  it 
delights  in. 


POLTZOA. 

GEMICELLARIA. 

This  is  one  of  the  Polyzoa,  more  highly  organized  than 
Sertularia,  &c.,  and  therefore  ranking  considerably  higher 
in  the  scale  of  creation.  The  difference  in  the  skeleton 
here  prepared  is,  that  we  have  a  calcareous  cell  instead  of  a 
horny  one.  Almost  ah1  the  Polyzoa  have  calcareous  sheaths, 
or  polyzoaries,  as  this  skeleton  is  called,  instead  of  poly- 
pidom,  which  belongs  to  the  lower  class  of  zoophytes.  The 
difference  between  the  two  is  this  :  a  polypidom  is  a  sepa- 
rate horny  case,  which  is  formed  before  the  indwelling  and 
connected  polype,  and  the  polype  itself  is  part  of  a  common 
central  mass,  having  a  simple  stomach,  thread-like  tenta- 
culse,  which  seize  food  and  draw  it  to  the  mouth,  and 
which  multiply  by  ovarian  vesicles  containing  medusoides. 
The  polyzoary  is  a  case  or  tunic  investing  the  body  of  a 
distinct  and  separate  polype,  which  is  either  horny  or  cal- 
careous, sometimes  forming  a  dense  hard  crust  on  stones 
and  shells. 

The  polype  within  is  quite  different  from  that  of  the 
Anthozoa.  It  has  ciliated  tentacles.  The  Polyzoa  is  a 
part  of  the  polype  itself,  investing  it  as  a  tunic  or  case, 
which  is  sometimes  horny,  but  most  frequently  calcareous, 
even  forming  dense  crusts  upon  shells,  stones,  or  sea- weeds. 
Though  always  found  in  a  mass,  the  Polyzoa  are  strictly 
solitary  individuals,  without  inward  connection,  each  polype 


172  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

being  perfect  in  itself,  and  distinguished  from  the  Anthozoa 
by  that  of  its  ciliated  tentacles,  which  do  not  seize  the  prey, 
but  create  currents  in  the  water  whereby  food  is  carried 
into  the  mouth. 

This  is  a  great  distinction,  and  must  be  observed,  of 
course,  in  the  living  animal ;  a  very  curious  sight  it  is  to 
watch  the  shoals  of  little  golden  fish-like  naviculse  whirled 
into  the  vortex  of  a  hungry  polype,  the  currents  running 
along  the  cilia  or  delicate  fringe  which  edges  each  tentacle. 
Some  polypes  have  two  stomachs,  one  a  kind  of  gizzard, 
triturating  the  food,  and  the  other  digesting  and  discharging 
the  refuse.  There  is  even  a  rudimentary  liver — a  valve  at 
the  pyloric  opening  ;  the  stomach  itself  is  lined  with  cilia  ; 
in  short,  the  living  polype  you  are  now  looking  at  in 
its  dead  state  was  a  wonderfully  organized  little  creature, 
though  scarcely  visible  to  the  naked  eye.  Instead  of  the 
ovarian  vesicles  of  the  Anthozoa  we  find,  especially  on 
Flustra  and  Lepralia,  little  pearly  cells,  which  are  gemmae, 
or  buds,  thrown  forth  from  the  body  of  the  polype.  They 
have  two  methods  of  propagation,  one  by  gemmation,  the 
other  by  a  true  sexual  generation.  (See  '  Carpenter  on  the 
Microscope,'  p.  575.) 

MEMBRANIPORA   PILOSA. 

An  abundant  and  beautiful  zoophyte  for  examination  in 
the  living  state,  as  the  fearless  little  polypes  rise  up  in 
crowds  from  the  shelter  of  their  pearly  homes,  and  fling  forth 
their  white  ciliated  tentacles,, waving,  curling,  contracting, 
and  expanding,  in  very  ecstasy  of  life,  drawing  in  the  food 
they  require  by  means  of  the  currents  these  tentacles  make. 

In  this  living  state  the  Membranipora  is  only  a  brown, 
thick  crust  on  rock  or  sea-weed  ;  but  when  the  zoophyte  is 
dead,  we  find  it  on  the  brown  fucus  or  the  crimson  Deles- 
seria,  or  sheathing  the  stem  of  Chondrus  crispus,  like  a 
delicate  net,  pure  white,  or  pale  fawn  colour;  when  mounted 
dry  it  is  perfectly  lovely.  We  now  see  the  oval  horizontal 
membranous  cells,  sharply  toothed  and  granulated,  whilst 
behind  the  mouth  of  each  is  a  long  jointed  bristle,  which 
in  life  lashed  the  water  to  and  fro,  keeping  the  Polypidoin 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  173 

free  from  obnoxious  particles.  If,  however,  the  observer  is 
at  the  sea-side,  whilst  examining  a  living  Membranipora,  he 
may  look  for  the  singular  organ  described  by  Dr.  Farre  and 
by  the  Rev.  T.  Hincks.  It  is  oblong,  placed  between  the 
base  of  two  of  the  arms,  and  attached  to  the  tentacular 
ring.  Round  the  opening  at  top  is  a  play  of  cilia,  and  it  is 
lined  with  cilia.  These  gentlemen  observed  numbers  of 
filamentous  bodies  wriggling  up  from  the  visceral  cavity,  and 
as  they  reached  the  base  of  this  organ,  they  were  drawn  into, 
carried  upward  through  the  ciliated  channel,  and  ejected, 
being  then  whirled  away  by  the  tentacular  currents.  These 
are  supposed  to  be  spermatozoic  bodies  called  cercariee,  and 
subservient  in  some  way  to  the  function  of  generation. 

Besides  Mebranipora,  I  would  direct  attention  to  various 
species  of  Lepralia.  Scarcely  a  stone  or  a  shell  from  the 
great  deep  but  yields  most  varied  forms  of  these  zoophytes, 
in  the  Channel  Islands,  Jersey,  by  Mrs.  Gatty,  of  Eccles- 
iield,  Guernsey,  on  Phylophora  rubens,  and  also  at  Sidmouth, 
the  loveliest  species  called 

LEPRALIA   GATTY.E, 

may  be  found  in  winter  thrown  up  after  a  storm,  exceeding 
small — a  little  branching  speck,  once  seen  never  forgotten, 
differing  from  all  other  Lepralia  in  having  a  rich  pattern 
carved  upon  the  centre  of  each  cell.  A  raised  knob  and 
a  circlet  of  dots,  then  rays  or  raised  lines,  between  each  of 
which  is  to  be  found  a  dot  or  puncture  larger  in  size  than 
those  of  the  other  circle ;  again,  the  termination  of  each 
cell  is  delicately  fluted,  that  is,  if  not  overcrowded  with  cells 
or  ovarian  capsules.  In  all  Lepralia  we  find  round,  pearly, 
smaller  cells,  dotted  over  the  surface,  sometimes  almost 
hiding  the  parent  cells ;  these  are  most  abundant  on  the 
pretty 

LEPRALIA   HTALIXA, 

common  on  mussel-shells. 

LEPRALIA   NITIDA 

is  like  a  miniature  human  thorax,  ribbed  and  with  a  broad 
band  representing  the  sternum  ;  a  lip  armed  with  five  long 


174  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

spines,  and  having  a  metallic  glow  over  all  the  pure  white 
fabric. 

The  observation  of  a  few  specimens  will  lead  to  a  large 
collection ;  not  a  speck  upon  sea-weed,  stone,  or  shell,  should 
be  overlooked,  and  for  a  pleasant,  easy  guide,  take  '  Dr. 
Landesborough  on  Zoophytes.' 

ALECTO    GRANULATE. 

This  is  found  creeping  on  stones  and  shells  and  weed 
dredged  from  the  deep  ;  cells  tubular  and  creeping,  four  or 
five  abreast,  with  long  spines,  and  granulated  texture  and 
erect  circular  aperture.  Alecto  major  has  no  granular 
markings.  This  zoophyte,  amongst  others,  is  sold  by 
Baker,  and  a  collection  would  be  found  most  useful  pre- 
paratory to  further  researches  at  the  sea-side. 

GEMMELLAEIA   LORICULATA. 

This  Gemmellaria  loriculata  is  an  example  of  the  branched, 
half-horny,  half-calcareous  polyzoary;  it  is  a  splendid 
object  with  polarized  light,  if  mounted  in  balsam,  the 
cells  pale  pink,  with  a  framework  of  carbonate  of  lime, 
giving  a  fine  orange  tint. 

We  find  Gemmellaria  abundantly  on  the  south-western 
coast,  or  thrown  up  on  the  beach,  after  a  gale,  in  bunches, 
easily  distinguished  by  the  position  of  the  cells  back  to 
back  in  pairs. 

GEMECELARIA,    OR   NOTOMIA   BURSARIA, 

a  rare  but  lovely  zoophyte,  always  to  be  looked  at  as 
opaque,  and  the  singular  appendages  to  its  lid  observed. 
The  triangular  cells  are  in  pairs,  each  capped  by  an  organ 
resembling  a  tobacco-pipe,  or,  some  say,  a  bird's  head.  It 
is  also  called  the  Shepherd's  Purse  Coralline,  from  its 
resemblance  to  the  seed-capsules  of  that  plant.  We  only 
find  it  in  very  small  tufts,  parasitic  on  other  zoophytes  ;  but, 
minute  as  it  is,  the  tiny  creature  has  the  same  highly 
organized  body  as  the  rest  of  the  Polyzoa. 

CELLULARIA   AYICULAEIA 

is  the  true  Bird's-head  Coralline  found  on  stones  in  deep 
water  or  at  very  low  tides,  growing  in  spiral  fan-like  tufts 
about  an  inch  high.  This  is  a  calcareous  polyzoary :  the 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  175 

cells  have  a  spine  at  each  upper  angle,  and  an  appendage 
called  the  bird's  head.  With  a  little  management  of  light, 
you  will  see  the  muscular  lines  by  which  the  neck  opens 
and  shuts  ;  when  alive  it  snaps  in  all  directions,  seizes  any 
passing  animal,  and  holds  it  fast  until  death.  Now,  as  they 
have  no  inward  connection  with  the  stomach  of  the  polype, 
neither  give  the  food  to  the  tentacles,  it  is  doubtless  for 
protection  that  they  are  placed  over  the  otherwise  defence- 
less zoophyte — a  sensitive  and  ever-ready  police  to  keep 
the  cities  of  the  great  deep.  Cities  they  are  indeed ;  for 
examine  a  piece  of  Flustra — 

FLUSTRA   TRUNCATA. 

On  one  specimen  you  may  count  18,000  inhabitants,  all 
rejoicing  in  the  life  bestowed  upon  them,  and  all  in  obedi- 
ence and  harmony  performing  their  task  in  the  ocean  world. 
Yes,  they  all  have  an  appointed  work — they  had  it  long 
ago  in  the  ages  beyond  our  own  existence — before  the 
green  earth  had  risen  from  the  chaos  of  waters,  or  even 
before  the  Saurian  age  of  reptiles,  in  the  calm  clear  ocean 
of  the  earliest  formations,  the  little  polyzoaries  of  these 
zoophytes  existed,  and  their  fossil  forms  are  found  with 
those  of  the  lonely  Trilobite. 

It  is  possible  to  mount  these  zoophytes  with'  the  polypes 
displayed,  and  a  more  beautiful  object  is  rarely  seen.  The 
way  to  manage  it  is  thus :  Watch  the  living  creature  placed 
in  a  shallow  dish  of  its  native  element,  and  whilst  they  are 
"  out"  dash  in  a  tumbler  of  cold  spring  water,  which 
paralyses  the  Polypes,  and  they  may  be  mounted  in  fluid 
permanently.  Another  way  I  have  heard,  but  not  tried,  is 
to  pour  gently  some  spirit  into  the  water,  which  irritates 
the  zoophyte,  and  it  comes  forth  to  drink  of  the  intoxicating 
fluid,  and  falls  a  victim  to  its  poisonous  influence. 

PUSTULIPORA   FOSSIL, 

of  which  the  present  species  are  Pustulipora,  Deflexa,  and 
Proboscidia ;  calcareous,  erect  Polyzoas,  with  tubes  half 
immersed  ;  found  on  shells  in  deep  water  off  Plymouth  and 
Zetland  ;  whilst  the  fossil  slides  sold  by  Tennant  are  from 
the  chalk  of  Kent  and  Wilts. 


176  Objects  for  the   Microscope. 

FLTJSTRA   CHARTACEA 

abounds  at  Hastings ;  thin,  glistening,  and  scarcely  two 
inches  high,  of  a  light  straw  colour  ;  the  cells  are  an  oblong 
figure,  protected  by  a  helmet-like  operculum.  Called  also 
the  Paper  Seamat. 

The  name  Flustra  is  from  a  Saxon  word  flustrian,  to 
weave  ;  and  wonderful,  truly,  is  the  living  web  which  the 
Almighty  hand  has  woven  in  the  deep  sea ! 

CELLULARIA    REPTANS. 

(Creeping  Cellularia .) 

The  Cellularia  polyzoa  has  a  mixture  of  horny  and  cal- 
careous matter ;  the  cells  have  an  oblique  opening,  each 
with  four  or  five  short  spines :  it  is  a  very  common  species 
on  fucus,  in  circular  branched  tufts. 

CELLULARIA   CILIATA. 

A  delicate  little  pearly-white  coralline,  often  found  amidst 
the  bunches  of  red  sea-weed — the  Ptilota  sericea  espe- 
cially. The  cells  are  at  the  tips  of  the  branches,  and  armed 
with  five  very  long  calcareous  spines,  which  are  so  brittle 
that  you  seldom  get  them  mounted  perfectly ;  and  over 
the  mouth  a  most  exquisite  little  operculum,  transparent 
yet  firm,  closes  the  door  against  intrusion,  and  falls  back 
when  the  twelve  or  sixteen  ciliated  tentacles  come  forth 
for  food. 

CRISEA   EBURNEA. 

The  Ivory-tufted  Coralline,  common  on  such  sea- weeds 
as  Delesseria  and  Dasya,  also  on  the  roots  of  the  Lami- 
naria  which  has  been  thrown  by  a  rough  sea  upon  the 
beach.  Finely  granulated  pear-shaped  vesicles  are  often 
scattered  over  its  branches  ;  it  is  strongly  calcareous  ;  the 
cells  tubular,  with  circular  apertures  looking  towards  oppo- 
site sides. 

CRISEA   CORNUTA. 

The  Goat's-horn  Coralline,  more  rare,  and  parasitical  on 
other  zoophytes.  This  is  a  very  minute  species,  with  long 
tubular  cells,  shaped  like  goat's  horns,  and  placed  one  over 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  177 

the  other.  A  fine  hair-like  bristle  projects  from  the  side  of 
each  cell,  and  speckled  oval-shaped  gemmae  are  often  found 
on  the  branches. 

SERIALARIA    LENDIGERA. 

The  Nit  Coralline.  Large  tangled  masses  of  Serialaria 
often  lie  upon  the  sea-sand  after  a  storm,  or  come  ashore 
clinging  to  the  up-torn  branches  of  Halidrys.  It  looks  to 
the  naked  eye  but  as  some  knotted  thread  ;  yet  even  with  a 
pocket  lens  we  find  each  knot  to  be  a  little  pan  pipe,  with 
from  eight  to  twelve  polype  cells  seated  side  by  side  on  the 
fine  silken  thread  which  runs  on  a  little  space,  and  again  a 
small  pan  pipe  or  family  group  makes  what  is  called  the 
Nit  on  the  coralline. 

FRESH-WATER  ZOOPHYTES. 


POLTZOA. 

THESE  objects,  accessible  wherever  there  is  a  quiet,  sha- 
dow}7 pond,  or  a  sluggish  canal,  or  a  ditch  semi-covered  by 
the  road-side,  are  worthy  of  close  attention  ;  indeed,  the 
development  of  the  Statoblast  or  Gemmae  of  fresh-water 
Polyzoa  is  too  great  a  pleasure  to  pass  unnoticed. 

STATOBLASTS. 

Small  oval  bodies,  found  floating  on  the  water  of  ponds 
and  ditches  all  through  the  winter  ;  they  may  be  mounted 
dry,  and  are  useful  thus,  enabling  the  young  student  to 
recognise  them  in  the  water.  They  have  an  oval  brown 
centre,  and  a  lighter  brown  reticulated  border,  more  or  less 
wide,  according  to  the  species.  One  variety  is  exceeding 
beautiful — the  Statoblast  of  Ciistatello  mucedo — which  has 
a  scalloped  edge  and  hooked  spines  of  crystal,  proceeding 
in  rays  from  the  border,  giving  it  a  sun-like  appearance. 
These  bodies  are  formed  in  the  interior  of  the  parent 
zoophyte,  growing  like  buds  from  the  funiculus  or  small 
cord  which  attaches  the  stomach  to  the  endocyst  or  internal 
coat  of  the  tunic.  They  are  not  true  eggs,  yet  they  produce 
perfect  polypes,  and  are  not  expelled  from  the  Polypidom, 


178  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

but  may  be  seen1  in  long  files  within  the  horny  tube  of 
PLumatella  repens  (the  most  abundant  species),  both  during 
the  life  and  long  after  the  death  of  the  parent  polype. 
Probably  the  shelter  is  a  needful  protection  against  the 
hungry  minnows  or  sticklebats ;  but  when  the  Polypidom 
decays  the  Statoblasts  float  freely  on  the  surface  of  the 
water,  attach  themselves  to  Lemna  and  Anacharis,  or  even 
to  stones  and  sticks,  until  the  warmth  of  a  spring  morning 
quickens  them  into  life. 

If  kept  in  a  room  they  develop  sooner.  As  I  write  in 
this  month  of  February,  there  are  several  Statoblasts  in  my 
aquarium  with  a  young  Plumatella  fully  formed,  sheltered 
beneath  the  open  valves,  and  waving  a  circlet  of  white 
tentacles,  feeding  almost  incessantly,  and  with  body  so 
transparent  that  every  part  of  its  internal  economy  is  visible. 
The  lophophore,  or  membrane,  which  bears  the  tentacles, 
can  be  seen  drawn  in  like  the  retracted  finger  of  a  glove, 
the  open  oesophagus  and  striated  stomach,  its  muscular 
bands  across,  and  longitudinal,  the  pyloric  cavity,  the 
cardial  cavity,  and  the  movement  of  the  intestine,  as  it 
ejects  the  rejectamenta. 

In  a  further  state  we  should  see  the  ovary  and  developing 
Statoblasts. 

THE    PLUMATELLA    REPENS, 

so  called  from  the  Latin  word  signifying  plumed  and  repens, 
or  creeping,  because  of  its  habit  of  lengthening  the  small 
brown  tubes  along  stones  or  leaves,  or  twining  round 
Lemna.  It  looks  merely  like  a  dead  spray  of  horny  sub- 
stance when  taken  out  of  the  water;  but  replace  it  in  a 
tumbler  of  its  own  soft  element,  and  from  every  spray  will 
peer  forth  a  multitude  of  ciliated  polypes,  like  Membrani- 
pora,  except — and  observe  this — the  tentacula,  ranging  from 
twenty  to  fifty  in  number,  are  not  in  a  starry  ray,  but  in  the 
form  of  a  double  horseshoe,  the  outer  one  fan-shaped,  and 
the  inner  one  likewise,  but  more  compact,  only  it  sometimes 
arches  over,  and  the  plumed  tentacles  seem  like  a  feathery 
tent  protecting  the  indweller ;  or,  as  was  really  the  case, 
enclosing  hopelessly  the  caught  infusoria  whirled  by  the 
outer  current  into  the  hungry  mouth  beneath.  When, 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  179 

however,  a  larger  species  of  prey  is  taken  in  the  net  the 
result  is  sometimes  inconvenient.  A  Notommata  heedlessly 
sailing  along  I  once  saw  drawn  into  the  horseshoe  snare, 
and  though  with  strong  bounds  he  dodged  the  encircling 
arms,  and  evidently  went  down  against  his  will,  yet  down 
he  went,  when  presently  I  observed  that  he  recovered  heart 
within  that  prison,  and  began  feeding  on  the  smaller  fry 
that  had  been  swallowed  with  himself.  The  next  day  the 
poor  Plumatella  looked  weak,  and  was  evidently  ill  at  ease 
with  that  rampant  Notommata  within  still  jerking  about 
and  feeding.  The  ne^xt  day  the  polype  was  dead.  Out  of 
the  perishing  body  sprang  the  triumphant  infusoria. 

Let  me  urge  every  one  who  can  do  so  to  obtain  either 
the  Plumatella  itself  or  Statoblasts,  and  for  all  such  supplies 
of  vegetable  or  animal  life  the  student  had  better  go  to 
King's,  190,  Great  Portland  Road. 

PALUDICELLA 

is  found  in  still  or  slowly  running  water,  attached  to  stones 
in  dark  corners,  the  cells  very  much  resembling  those  of 
the  marine  Eucratia  cliellata. 

LOPHOPUS 

has  a  transparent  gelatinous  tunic,  enclosing  several  polypes, 
and  attaches  itself  to  the  stems  of  Lemna  Polyrhiza  in  dark 
ponds  or  ditches. 

ALCYONELLA 

may  be  found  in  sluggish  water  in  dense  masses,  after 
encrusting  the  branches  of  trees  which  dip  into  the  water. 

CRISTATELLA   MUCEDO. 

The  large  light-loving,  beautiful  creature,  flinging  its 
broad  polypidom  over  stems  of  the  water-lily,  and  they 
come  forth  in  a  watch-glass  under  the  microscope,  neither 
shrinking  from  the  light,  nor  frightened  at  a  jog  of  the 
table,  a  whole  army  of  tented  tentacles  waving  to  and  fro. 
Sometimes  this  polypidom  looks  like  a  little  bit  of  greenish 
sponge  floating  on  the  water.  The  Statoblasts  are  spined 
and  crystalline ;  they  very  soon  develop  a  polype  which 
immediately  in  a  new  process  of  generation  multiplies  by 
gemmation. 


180  Objects  for  the  Microscopt 


CHAPTER  IX. 

SEA-WEEDS—MARINE  ALGJ2. 

"  The  gentleness  of  Heaven  is  on  the  sea. 
Listen !  the  mighty  Being  is  awake, 
And  doth  with  his  eternal  motion  make 
A  sound  like  thunder — everlastingly." 

Wordsworth. 
The  water  is  calm  and  still  below, 

For  the  winds  and  waves  are  absent  there, 
And  the  sands  are  bright  as  the  stars  that  glow 

In  the  motionless  fields  of  upper  air  ; 
There,  with  its  waving  blade  of  green, 

The  Sea-weed  streams  through  the  silent  water, 
And  the  crimson  leaf  of  the  Dulse  is  seen 
To  blush  like  a  banner  bathed  in  slaughter." 

Percival. 


THESE  slides  of  sea-weeds  will  surely  be  very  popular 
objects ;  the  student  at  the  sea-side  will  refer  to  them  again 
and  again  for  the  verification  of  his  own  specimens,  and  for 
instruction  in  the  varied  tissues  and  parts  of  fructification. 
The  student  at  home  and  far  inland  will  bend  over  them  in 
delight  until  he  hears  the  booming  wave,  and  feels  the  spray 
of  an  up-rushing  tide — until,  on  the  wide,  wild  coast,  after 
a  storm,  he  seems  to  see  the  tangled  treasures  of  these 
beautiful  plants  cast  up  to  perish.  Or,  as  slide  after  slide 
is  examined  and  learned,  the  strong  yearning  will  come  for 
a  wandering  by  the  sea-side — a  rest  beside  a  rock-pool.  If 
the  sea-side  has  ever  been  a  Home — if  our  childhood's  joy 
has  been  to  patter  on  the  sands  with  naked  feet,  and  chase 
the  scrambling  crab  into  its  cranny — or,  later,  with  eager 
hand  to  gather  Zoophyte  and  Weed,  with  an  understanding 
heart  and  loving  eye  for  the  great  works  of  the  Almighty, 
then  these  beautiful  specimens  will  come  with  the  power 
of  association  and  memory,  as  well  as  with  their  scientific 
value. 

A  slide  of  that  exquisite  Ptilota  plumosa  sent  my  spirit 
far  away  from  the  quiet  country  home.  A  sound  of  a 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  181 

gushing  tide  was  in  mine  ears,  the  vast  expanse  of  a  sunlit 
sea  before  mine  eyes — my  feet  were  slipping  and  bounding 
from  rock  to  rock,  down  to  the  edge  of  a  retreating  wave, 
a  long  way  from  the  shadow  of  the  Serk  cliffs.  Suddenly, 
as  in  a  dream,  a  deep  rock-pool  lay  before  me,  on  the  outer 
side  of  which  a  forest  of  Laminaria  and  Cliorda-filum  was 
streaming  out  into  the  sea ;  all  round  the  interior  margin 
were  thick  clusters  of  olive  sea-weeds,  and  the  dense  foliage 
of  Lichinia,  Cystoseira,  and  Furcellaria.  Here  and  there 
beautiful  tufts  of  the  jointed  Catanella,  the  delicate  Cera- 
mium,  Laurentia,  Plocamium,  and  in  one  dark  corner  some 
fronds  of  the  crimson  Rhodipnenia^  whilst  in  the  deepest 
shadow  grew  the  purple  Chondrus  crispus  turning  green  and 
olive  in  the  sunny  side  of  the  pool.  The  water  was  clear 
and  untroubled,  when  with  little  splash  a  Cabot*  darted 
across  from  crevice  to  cranny  beneath  a  boulder  in  the 
pool ;  a  Prawn,  gracefully  poised,  and  waving  its  long 
feelers,  was  lurking  under  the  weeds,  and  a  green,  greedy 
Crab,  was  watching  a  purple,  passive  Mussel  gaping  in  the 
warmth  and  quietude :  myriads  of  living  creatures,  tiny 
Molluscs  and  Cytheridse,  were  rejoicing  in  that  little  world 
—one  single  tide-pool. 

Not  to  dream  on,  but  to  explore  deeper  still  into  the 
mysteries  and  beauties  of  the  sea-flowers — as  they  should 
be  called — not  weeds. 

"  Call  us  not  weeds — we  are  flowers  of  the  sea ; 
For  lovely,  and  bright,  and  gay-tinted  are  we, 
And  quite  independent  of  culture  or  showers ; 
Then  call  us  not  weeds — we  are  ocean's  fair  flowers." 

La  ndesborougli . 

We  must  consider  steadily  their  microscopic  parts,  and 
learn  their  place  in  creation. 

MARINE   ALG^, 

or  Sea-weeds,  are  in  the  ranks  of  the  lower  Cryptogamia  : 
yet  the  range  is  very  wide,  from  the  fructification  of  the 
simple  Ulva  to  the  highly  organized  antheridia  and  anthe- 
rozoides  of  the  Fucus  platycarpus. 

*  The  Guernsey  name  for  the  Blennius,  or  Blenny. 


182  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

The  greatest  interest  of  the  Sea-weed  slides  will  be  lost 
unless  we  are  acquainted  with  their  fructification ;  for  no 
slide  is  of  much  value  unless  it  displays  either  the  Tetra- 
spores, or  Favellce,  or  Ceramidium,  or  Sori,  or  Nematliecia, 
or  Antheridia  of  the  various  plants. 

It  is  best  to  look  at  these  preparations  first  with  the 
lowest  power,  a  two-inch  object  glass,  which  gives  a  large 
clear  field,  and  displays  the  general  form  to  the  greatest 
advantage.  Then  raise  the  power  successively  to  examine 
the  fructification,  in  doing  which  we  may  find  some  beau- 
tiful specimens  of  Diatomacese  attached  to  the  Algse.  In 
looking  over  a  slide  of  Ptilota  I  observed  a  chain  of  the 
frustules  of  Grammatophora  depending-  from  one  of  the 
pinnae,  and  two  or  three  beautiful  Isthmia  obliqua  entangled 
in  another  part  of  the  frond  ;  some  Licmophora  were  at-, 
tached  to  the  stem,  and  this  single  slide  gave  long  and 
delightful  study,  with  the  use  of  all  the  powers  of  the 
microscope. 

The  fructification  of  Sea-weed,  which  is  the  most  im- 
portant part,  can  only  be  understood  by-having  a  collection 
of  about  twelve  slides,  of  the  following  varieties  : 

Two  slides  of  Ptilota,  which  will  show  either  an  involucre, 
containing  three  spores,  or  a  lacinia,  or  little  leaf,  bearing 
numerous  tetraspores,  that  is,  cases  containing  FOUK  spores 
or  seeds. 

Two  of  Plocamium,  which  give  branches  bearing 
tubercles  containing  tetraspores,  or  stichidia  containing 
spores. 

One  of  Polysiphonia  gives  an  example  of  a  Ceramidium, 
an  elegant  urn-shaped  capsule,  open  at  the  top,  and  con- 
taining a  group  of  crimson  pear-shaped  spores. 

Two  of  Odonthalia,  which  has  two  kinds  of  fructification  ; 
and  on  the  slide  should  be  either  capsular  fruit,  somewhat 
like  that  of  Polysiphonia  ;  or  stichidia,  long,  delicate  pod- 
like  receptacles,  enclosing  crimson  spores  in  separate  cham- 
bers or  cells. 

Two  of  Callithamnion,  which  has  capsules  seated  along 
its  pinnae,  or  branchlets  with  bi-lobed  FavelloB. 

Phyllophora  shows  quite  a  different  kind  of  fructification, 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  183 

called  nemathecia,  or  warts,  concealed  under  leafy  processes 
composed  of  delicate  mpniliform  or  bead-like  filaments. 

Rhodymenia  gives  an  example  of  embedded  tubercles 
containing  spores  called  coccidia. 

Nitophylmm  is  spotted  with  son',  each  of  which  contains 
a  number  of  tetraspores. 

Polysiphonia  fastigiata  abounds  with  antheridia  at  the 
tip  of  its  filaments  amongst  spiral  fibres. 

The  fructification  of  the  highest  order  is  that  of  Fucus 
serratus  and  platycarpus,  which  should  be  examined  fresh 
from  the  plant,  and  is  seen  in  perfection  between  the 
months  of  December  and  April.  It  has  a  truly  sexual  cha- 
racter, and  as  the  receptacles  of  this  Fucus  contain  both 
the  "  sperm-cells  "  and  the  "  germ-cells,"  it  is  considered 
an  hermaphrodite  plant. 

In  the  common  Fucus  vesiculosus  (Bladder-wrack)  the 
receptacles  containing  antheridia  are  found  on  one  plant, 
and  those  containing  sporangia  on  a  separate  individual ; 
it  is  best,  therefore,  to  obtain  the  F.  platycarpus  or  serratus, 
which  latter  is  found  abundantly  at  half-tide,  and  easily 
recognised  by  the  toothed  edges  of  its  frond,  when  both 
organs  are  observable  in  the  same  plant. 

Choose  a  mature  receptacle,  which  maybe  known  by  its 
discharging  little  gelatinous  masses  adhering  round  its 
orifice.  Make  a  section  through  it,  and  you  will  see  a 
globular  cavity  lined  with  filaments,  some  of  which  project 
through  the  pore.  These  filaments  are  jointed,  or  rather 
are  composed  of  cells  containing  what  are  called  anthero- 
zoides ;  these  are  yellow  dots  with  two  long  thread-like 
appendages,  which,  when  liberated  by  the  breaking  of  the 
cell,  have  a  spontaneous  and  rapid  motion,  and  they  imme- 
diately swarm  around  the  sporangia,  and  fecundate  them. 
The  sporangia  are  pear-shaped  bodies  lying  amongst  these 
filaments  near  the  walls  of  the  cavity,  and  they  are  the 
parent  cells  of  the  germ  cells,  which  produce  the  spores  or 
seeds.  Each  of  these  sporangia  gives  forth  a  cluster  of 
eight  cells,  and  are  therefore  also  called  octospores. 

In  the  hermaphrodite  fuci  the  spores  do  not  leave  the 
receptacle  until  after  their  fecundation  ;  but  in  Fucus  vesi- 


184  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

culosus,  which  is  a  dioecious  plant,  the  antherozoides  meet 
the  spores  in  the  water  directly  after  they  issue  from  the 
receptacle. 

To  observe  this,  take  an  olive-green  receptacle,  which  is 
the  female,  and  set  free  a  few  pores  in  a  drop  of  sea-water 
in  a  shallow  cell ;  then  liberate  a  few  ripe  filaments  from 
an  orange-yellow  receptacle,  which  will  contain  the  anthe- 
rozoides, and  the  whole  process  of  fertilisation  may  be 
watched  with  a  power  of  250  diameters. 

Then,  if  you  further  wish  to  prove  the  subsequent  pro- 
cess of  germination,  a  little  care  and  patience  will  enable 
these  very  spores  to  grow  from  the  cell  of  what  is  called  a 
"growing  slide,'7  or  even  in  a  tumbler  of  water,  taking 
precautions  to  keep  the  water  fresh  and  still,  by  drawing  it 
off  with  a  siphon,  and  renewing  it  daily  in  the  same  gentle 
way. 

The  fructification  of  the  Rhodospermese,  or  red  sea- 
weeds, has  not  yet  been  so  thoroughly  investigated,  and 
the  varied  forms  of  the  spore-cases  will  be  the  chief  beauty 
as  well  as  value  of  the  following  preparations. 

CALLITHAMNION. 

There  are  twenty-five  species  of  this  plant,  and  most  of 
them  are  common  on  the  shores  of  Great  Britain  ;  its  name 
is  derived  from  two  Greek  words,  signifying  "  beautiful 
little  shrub,"  and  it  is  very  beautiful,  with  a  rosy  or  brown- 
ish-red frond,  or  rather  filament,  jointed  and  branching, 
bearing  two  kinds  of  fructification  : 

1.  External  tetraspores  seated  upon  the  branches. 

2.  Roundish   or    lobed    berry-like    receptacles,    called 
favellaB,  seated  on  the  main  branches,  and  containing  many 
spores. 

Callithamnion  delights  in  mud-covered  rocks.  C.  rosewn 
is  found  at  Torquay;  also  C.  gracillimum  growing  along 
the  mud-covered  base  of  the  harbour.  In  fact,  the  collector 
must  often  content  himself  with  a  handful  of  mud,  showing 
merely  a  few  red  filaments,  and  then  on  washing  these 
carefully  he  will  find  not  only  one,  but  perhaps  many 
species  of  this  lovely  Sea-weed. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  185 


CERAMIUM. 

Fourteen  species  are  on  the  list  of  British  Algae. 

The  filaments  are  of  varied  colour,  from  red  and  purple 
to  white,  jointed  and  dichotomous,  which  means  regularly 
and  repeatedly  cleft;  it  has  two  kinds  of  fructification — 

1.  Capsules,  with  a  membranous  pericarp  or  outer  skin, 
containing  numerous  angular  seeds. 

2.  Oblong  granules  partly  imbedded  in  the  joints  of  the 
filaments  called  favellce. 

The  name  is  from  a  Greek  word  signifying  "  little 
pitcher"  which  the  capsules  nevertheless  do  not  resemble. 

Ceramium  botrycarpum  is  found  in  fruit  from  August  to 
November,  with  clusters  of  favellse  on  all  the  branches- 
most  beautiful.  Its  chief  habitat  is  Torquay  and  Bristol. 

Ceramium  rubrum  is  common  everywhere  in  tide-pools 
between  water-mark. 

PTILOTA   PLUMOSA. 

This  lovely  little  plant,  rightly  named  Ptiiota,  from  a 
Greek  word  signifying  "  pinnated,"  from  its  innumerable 
small  branches  or  pinnce,  is  one  of  our  best  preparations ; 
for,  even  without  the  fruit,  its  cellular  tissue  being  very 
transparent,  the  cells  containing  the  crimson  endochrome 
are  distinctly  seen,  and  lender  it  a  favourite  object.  The 
stem  is  closely  branched  right  and  left  with  branchlets  called 
pinnce,  and  these  again  cut  into  exceedingly  fine  divisions 
called  pinnulce ;  at  the  tip  of  the  latter  we  find  the  fructi- 
fication. This  consists  of  two  or  three  minute  capsules 
called  favellce,  each  of  which  contains  three  or  four  oval 
seeds,  and  they  are  themselves  surrounded  and  apparently 
protected  by  several  linear  segments  bending  over  them. 

When  fresh  gathered  for  observation,  these  favellce  are 
of  a  rich  crimson  with  a  pellucid  border,  and,  seated  in  their 
little  cage  of  crimson  pinnulse,  are  really  beautiful. 

Another  kind  of  fructification  is  found  on  Ptilotse,  but 
on  distinct  individuals ;  the  pinnulse  are  broader  at  the  tips, 
and  covered  with  oval  bodies  called  tetra  spores,  from  their 
containing  four  seeds. 

12 


186  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

Ptilota  is  a  perennial  plant  found  in  summer  and  autumn 
frequently  growing  on  the  stems  of  Laminaria  digitata,  and 
therefore  our  best  specimens  may  be  gathered  on  the  beach 
after  the  autumnal  equinoctial  gales.  At  Torquay  it  is 
found  on  rocks,  but  Ptilota  sericea  is  often  mistaken  for  it ; 
this  is  very  abundant  on  the  rocks  at  Moulin  Huet  in 
Guernsey,  hanging  in  rich  silky  masses  on  the  sheltered 
side  of  the  rocks,  and  thronged  with  that  minute  but  lovely 
zoophyte  Eucratia  chelata. 

PLOCAMIUM   VULGARE,    OR   COCCINEUM. 

Plocamium  coccinewn  it  is  called  from  its  fine  crimson 
colour,  and  the  word  Plocamium  means,  in  Greek,  "  braided 
hair,"  which  the  fine  divisions  of  the  frond  resemble. 

A  small  branch  of  this  lovely  weed  has  been  thus  hap- 
pily described  in  a  French  botanical  work,  and  will  direct 
the  eye  in  examining  this  slide.  I  shall  therefore  tran- 
scribe it : — 

"  Sa  tige  est  tres-rameuse,  et  toujours  dans  le  meme 
plan  ;  Pordre  des  ramifications  est  tres-remarquable  ;  chaque 
rameau  est  legerement  flexueux,  et  n'emet  de  ramifications 
que  du  cote  convexe :  la  premiere  est  un  filet  simple  et 
pointu  ;  la  deuxieme  est  tin  filet  qui  a  trois  dents  du  cote 
anterieur ;  la  troisieme  est  un  filet  qui  a  deux  dents,  et  qui 
au  lieu  de  la  troisieme  dent  pousse  un  filet  muni  d'une  dent 
en  dehors  ;  la  quatrieme  est  un  filet  qui  n'a  qu'une  dent,  la 
deuxieme  dent  est  devenue  tine  filet  a  une  dent,  et  la 
troisieme  un  filet  rameux. 

"  Apres  ces  quatre  ramifications  il  y  a  une  espace  vide, 
et  la  tige  emet  des  rameux  semblables  du  cote  oppose." 

The  fructification  is  of  two  kinds  : — 

1.  The  stichidia,  or  oblong  vesicles  containing  spores  in 
separate  divisions  or  cells — very  beautiful. 

2.  Spherical  capsules,  seated  upon  the  branches,  contain- 
ing a  cluster  of  spores. 

This  is  a  common  Sea-weed  everywhere  in  summer  and 
autumn. 

POLYSIPHONIA. 

There  are  twenty-four  species  of  this  Sea-weed,  some  of 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  187 

them  inhabitants  of  the  rock-pool,  some  of  the  wide  wild 
ocean,  growing  on  the  stems  of  Laminaria,  and  therefore 
often  found  upon  the  beach  after  a  storm,  or  obtained  by 
dredging  on  all  the  British  coasts.  It  also  loves  to  grow 
upon  Melobesia  on  the  steep  sides  of  rock-pools. 

Of  all  these  the  P.  urceolata  and  P.  elonyella  are  the 
best  for  microscopic  observation.  The  former  has  a  beau- 
tiful fructification  ;  an  urn-shaped  capsule  called  a  cerami- 
dium,  furnished  with  a  pore  or  opening  like  the  mouth  of  a 
vase,  and  containing  a  tuft  of  pear-shaped  spores. 

A  second  form  of  fruit  is  met  with  on  the  same  plant — 
the  tip  of  a  branch  expands,  and  a  row  of  tetraspores  is 
imbedded  in  it;  also  on  Polydphonia  fastigmta  such  an 
abundance  of  antheridia  is  found  as  to  give  a  yellow  colour 
to  the  plant,  quite  visible  to  the  naked  eye,  and  deserving 
particular  microscopic  observation. 

SPHEROCOCCUS. 

A  common  plant,  often  cast  ashore  after  a  gale,  and 
found  all  along  the  coast  of  Cornwall  and  Devonshire,  Isle 
of  Wight,  and  the  Channel  Islands. 

It  is  difficult  to  obtain  perfect  specimens  of  the  beautiful 
fructification,  they  are  so  often  destroyed  by  the  violence  of 
the  waves ;  but  a  careful  dissection  of  it  freshly  gathered 
would  be  both  delightful  and  instructive. 

We  find  minute  spherical  capsules  supported  on  slender 
stalks  and  mucronate,  that  is,  having  a  little  spine  obliquely 
projecting  from  their  apex ;  upon  opening  this,  by  making 
a  section  through  it,  we  see  a  cluster  of  crimson  seeds,  also 
stalked.  The  structure  of  the  branches  should  be  noticed  ; 
they  are  obscurely  but  perfectly  veined,  a  faint  narrow 
mid-rib  and  lateral  parallel  veins  may  be  distinctly  seen. 

GRIFFITHSIA, 

so  named  in  honour  of  Mrs.  Griffiths  of  Torquay,  found  on 
the  coast  of  Devonshire,  and  other  parts  of  the  southern 
coast  of  England.  The  frond  is  rose-red,  filamentous,  and 
jointed.  The  fructification  is  of  two  kinds: — 

1.  Tetraspores  affixed  to  whorled  involucral  ramuli  or 
small  branches. 


188  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

2.  FavellaB,  or  gelatinous  receptacles,  surrounded  by  an 
involucre,  and  containing  a  mass  of  minute  angular  spores. 

There  is  a  beautiful  species,  called  Griffithsia  coralince, 
the  filaments  of  which  resemble  a  string  of  fine  glossy 
crimson  beads,  found  on  rocks  at  low-water  mark,  or  in 
deep  [pools  during  summer.  This  should  be  mounted,  if 
possible,  with  its  tetraspores. 

GKACILLAEIA, 

one  of  the  SphaBrococcoida?,  named   from   a  Latin  word 
signifying  "  slender." 

Gracillaria  erecta  is  found  on  sand-covered  rocks,  at 
Sidmouth  and  Torquay ;  it  fruits  in  winter,*  when  it  should 
be  gathered  and  mounted ;  for  both  kinds  of  fructification 
are  beautiful,  especially  the  coccidia,  of  which  sections 
should  be  made  to  show  the  spores  imbedded  in  the  outer 
skin,  and  the  delicate  hexagonal  cells  of  the  interior. 

The  coccidia  are  pod-like  receptacles  at  the  tips  of  the 
filaments,  and,  when  magnified,  appear  to  be  dotted  with 
crimson  spots.  Make  a  transverse  section  to  observe  the 
position  of  the  spores.  The  other  kind  of  fructification  is 
a  frond  covered  with  sessile  capsules,  about  the  size  of  a 
poppy-seed,  containing  a  cluster  of  oblong  red  seeds. 

Gracillaria  compressa  is  sometimes  cast  ashore  attached 
to  coral  and  algse  at  Sidmouth,  where  it  was  found  by 
Mrs.  Griffiths,  and  also  in  the  Channel  Islands  by  other 
collectors.  It  is  not  generally  known  that  the  Island  of 
Aklerney  is  famous  for  its  rare  and  beautiful  Sea- weeds, 
many  of  them  made  known  by  Mrs.  Gaudion,  wife  of  the 
late  judge  of  Aklerney,  an  indefatigable  collector  and 
admirable  preserver  of  Sea-weeds,  to  whom  I  am  greatly 
obliged  for  some  excellent  specimens. 

LAURENSIA. 

There  are  several  species  of  this  abundant  and  pretty 
Sea- weed.  It  varies  much  in  colour  and  size  ;  some  species, 
L.  pmnatifida,  being  of  a  dark  purple  and  even  olive  colour, 
whilst  the  Laurentia  obtusa  has  a  fine  pink  colour :  though 

*  February  and  March. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  189 

in  rock-pools  much  exposed  to  the  sun  it  hangs  in  dirty 
yellow  bunches,  and  for  that  reason  is  often  unrecognised. 
The  rare  Laurentia  tenuissinia  is  found  plentifully  in  the 
Channel  Islands. 

The  fructification  of  Laurentia  .is  both  various  and 
remarkable,  requiring  microscopic  investigation. 

1.  It  has  broadly  ovate  capsules,  about  the  size  of  a 
poppy-seed,  containing  red  pear-shaped  seeds,  supported 
upon  narrow  stalks.     A  section  must  be  made  through  the 
capsule  to  show  them  well. 

2.  Ternate  granules  imbedded  in  the  ramuli,  or  tips  of 
the  short  .branches.     Simply  magnified  they  appear  to  be 
dotted.     A  transverse  section  should  be  made. 

Then,  again,  on  some  specimens  of  the  same  plant  may 
frequently  be  found  swollen  tips,  forming  large  spurious 
capsules,  and  these  are  very  curious.  Some  of  them  have 
only  a  minute  pore ;  others  are  spread  out  more  like  the 
shield  of  a  Lichen,  and  edged  with  pink.  On  making  a 
section  through  these,  numerous  transparent  linear  bodies 
are  seen  pressed  closely  together ;  they  are  composed  of 
minute  filaments  surrounding  a  slight  column,  and  termi- 
nate in  several  round  pellucid  lobes.  In  the  round  capsules 
they  are  also  present,  and  by  a  gentle  pressure  under  the 
microscope  are  seen  to  issue  in  numbers  from  the  pore. 

Laurentia  is  found  in  perfection  from  June  to  September. 

ODONTHALIA. 

This  is  only  found  on  the  Northern  coasts  of  England, 
Yorkshire,  and  Scotland.  It  comes  on  shore  from  the  deep 
sea  finely  dotted  with  fruit  in  the  month  of  November. 
The  beautiful  stichidia,  reddish  purple,  and  the  ceramidium 
—both  kinds  are  on  this  plant. 

BONNEMAISONNIA, 

named  after  Bonnemaison,  a  celebrated  French  Algologist. 
Nothing  can  be  more  graceful  and  beautiful  than  this  ex- 
quisite little  plant ;  the  fronds  so  delicately  ciliated,  of  a 
bright  rose  colour,  and  dotted  all  along  with  tiny  capsules 
— the  true  ceramidium ;  each  urn-like  vase  containing  a 


190  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

group  of  stalked  spore-cases,  in  which  are  numerous  seeds. 
The  texture  of  the  plant  also  is  a  beautiful  microscopic 
object.  It  is  found  from  June  to  September  all  round  the 
English  and  Scottish  coast. 

'  DELESSERIA 

is  only  microscopic  in  its  fructification,  and  as  an  example 
of  Sori.  It  has  two  kinds  of  fructification  : — 

1.  Capsules,   containing  spores,   and  these  are   always 
found  upon  the  mid-rib  and  stem  of  the  plant. 

2.  Sori,  or  masses  of  granules  collected  into  little  spots 
or  lines  in  the  substance  of  the  frond,  or  in  little  leaflets  or 
distinct  pod-like  leafy  processes,  which  form  a  sort  of  fringe 
on  the  mid-rib  and  margin  of  the  plant.     We  never  find 
more  than  one  kind  of  fruit  on  any  individual. 

Delesseria  is  a  well-known  and  abundant  Sea-weed,  a 
favourite  in  all  collections,  from  its  beautiful  colour  and 
broad  fronds. 

Delesseria  limosa  is  found  after  storms  attached  to  the 
stems  ofLaminaria  digitata.  Specimens  "have  been  gathered 
in  which  the  frond  measured  four  inches  across. 

There  is  one  species,  Delesseria  ruscifolia,  which  deserves 
microscopic  attention  from  its  substance  between  the  mid-rib 
and  margin  being  transversed  by  white  pellucid  branched 
veins  composed  of  a  single  row  of  elongate  cellules.  The 
colour  is  a  fine  rose-pink  ;  it  is  found  from  May  to  Septem- 
ber at  Yarmouth,  Torquay,  Bognor,  Ilfracombe,  &c. 

RHODOMELA. 

This  is  a  large,  bushy  plant,  beautifully  tufted  in  the 
spring,  and  bearing  feathery  tufts  of  ramuli  of  light  brown- 
purplish  colour.  In  early  summer,  about  June,  the  fruit  is 
found,  and  is  of  two  kinds : — 

1.  Nearly  globular  capsules,  full  of  free,    pear-shaped 
seeds. 

2.  Stichidia,  pod-like  receptacles,  with  termite  granules 
imbedded  in  the  substance. 

Sections  of  a  ripe  pod  and  of  the  stem  are  beautiful  under 
the  microscope.  The  external  appearance  is  as  if  it  were 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  191 

ribbed  or  jointed  ;  but  upon  examination  we  find  a  tissue  of 
hexagonal  cells,  each  with  a  red  dot  in  the  centre,  and  if  we 
make  a  longitudinal  section  we  find  oblong  cells,  through 
which  runs  a  red  filament.  It  is  found  upon  the  drifted 
stems  of  Laminaria  and  upon  rocks  in  the  sea.  There  are 
several  species,  of  which  Rhodomela  pynastroides  is  the  most 
common. 

SPTRIDIA   FILAMENTOSA. 

This  is  rare  in  England,  but  found  on  the  coast  of  Devon- 
shire, the  Isle  of  Wight,  and  the  Channel  Islands.  The 
name  is  derived  from  a  Greek  word  signifying  "  basket" 
which  the  receptacles  resemble  ;  for  the  stalked  gelatinous 
receptacles  have  a  membranous  pericarp  often  surrounded 
by  an  involucre  of  short  ramuli,  containing  two  or  three 
masses  of  roundish  granules;  it  is  these  which  look  like 
baskets. 

CHAETOSPORA  WIGGII 

is  very  beautiful,  but  rarely  obtained  in  fruit,  and  has  not 
yet  been  thoroughly  investigated  ;  therefore  it  is  mentioned 
rather  to  induce  observation  when  the  plant  is  found  in 
perfection.  It  is  gathered  on  the  coast  of  Normandy  and 
in  the  Channel  Islands  ;  Sidmouth,  Brighton,  and  Yarmouth 
also  yield  it  occasionally.  It  is  of  a  fine  rose  colour,  and 
has  very  delicate  filiform  fronds. 

HALYMENIA 

has  a  compressed  frond,  pinky  red,  consisting  of  a  very- 
delicate  membrane,  which  when  in  fruit  is  dotted  with  Sori, 
and  a  transverse  section  should  be  made,  which  will  show 
the  spores,  called  in  this  plant  "  favellidia,"  attached  to  the 
inner  surface  of  the  membrane.  It  is  found  abundantly  on 
the  coast  on  rocks  and  stones,  in  the  sea  during  summer. 

DASYA. 

There  are  four  species  of  this  lovely  Sea-weed.  The 
name  is  taken  from  a  Greek  word  signifying  hairy.  The 
commonest  of  them,  Dasya  coccinea,  is  often  mistaken  for 


192  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

Ptilota  plumosa,  being  found  in  long  crimson  feathery 
sprays  on  the  coast  after  storms,  or  dredged  in  deep  water. 
It  is  a  great  favourite  with  collectors  of  sea-weed  for  orna- 
mental purposes,  and  is  equally  valuable  for  the  microscope, 
yielding  two  kinds  of  fructification  ;  the  Ceramidium,  con- 
taining pear-shaped  spores,  and  the  Stichidia,  containing 
tetraspores,  ranged  in  transverse  bands. 

A  delicate  section  of  the  lower  part  of  the  stem  will  show 
the  internal  structure,  which  is  of  numerous  parallel  tubes 
surrounding  a  central  cavity,  and  edged  with  a  circle  of  the 
short  stout  hairs  which  clothe  the  stem. 

Sections  of  the  fruit  and  of  the  stem  are  often  indispen- 
sable for  determining  the  species,  and  give  innumerable 
varieties  of  beautiful  objects. 

DASYA   ARBUSCULA. 

A  delicate  plant  not  uncommon  at  the  verge  of  low-water- 
mark in  many  parts  of  Scotland  and  in  the  Channel  Islands ; 
remarkable  for  its  beautiful  and  abundant  stichidia,  clustered 
amidst  the  fine  ramuli,  which  cover  the-  frond  densely,  and 
are  forked  at  the  tip,  jointed,  and  of  a  clear  crimson-lake 
colour,  sometimes  more  or  less  brown,  and  always  discharg- 
ing its  fine  colour  if  left  in  fresh  water. 

DASYA   OCCELLATA 

is  of  a  purple  colour,  and  the  dense  tufts  of  ramuli  at  the 
tips  of  the  branches  give  it  a  dotted  appearance,  like  an 
eyelet  on  each  delicate  feathery  stem.  The  stichidia  are 
very  long  slender  pods,  full  of  tetraspores. 

DASYA  VENUSTA. 

A  most  beautiful  and  rare  little  plant,  found  in  the 
Channel  Islands  in  summer  and  autumn.  The  shape  of 
the  stichidia,  which  have  long  acute  points,  and  the  re- 
peatedly forked  ramuli,  distinguish  it  from  Dasi/a  arbuscula, 
which  it  otherwise  much  resembles. 


These  marine  Algae  are  prepared  in  Paris,  by  Bourgogne, 
and  sold  by  Baker,  of  High  Holborn.     A  collection  of  even 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  193 

a  few  would  be  most  useful  to  a  young  student,  who  thus 
might  learn  what  to  mount  for  himself  at  the  sea-side. 

As  to  the  method  ;  when  the  form  only  of  the  plant  is 
desired  I  find  Canada  balsam  a  good  medium.  The  Sea- 
weed being  perfectly  dry,  it  only  requires  placing  in  warm, 
not  hot,  balsam,  and  covering  with  a  previously  warmed 
thin  glass  cover.  But  for  the  display  and  preservation  of 
the  fructification  the  following  liquid  is  preferable  :— 

GOADBY'S  SOLUTION  FOR  MARINE  AIXLE. 

Four  oz.  bay-salt,  two  oz.  alum,  four  grains  corrosive 
sublimate,  two  quarts  of  boiling  water. 

A  cell  is  to  be  made  on  the  revolving  table  with  Bruns- 
wick black,  and  thoroughly  dried.  The  specimen  then  laid 
in  the  cell  with  enough  of  the  solution  to  fill  the  cell,  and 
the  glass  cover  carefully  laid  on.  Let  it  stand  for  a  few 
minutes,  and  dry  the  surrounding  glass  with  blotting  paper 
before  the  varnish  is  applied,  which  hermetically  seals  it. 
The  Sea-weed  must  be  mounted  fresh  from  the  sea. 


194  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 


CHAPTER  X. 

FOBAMINATED  SHELLS. 

I  BELIEVE  that  every  one  is  surprised  and  delighted  with 
these  lovely  little  shells ;  so  minute  that  they  resemble 
grains  of  the  finest  sand ;  and  so  perfect  in  structure  that 
they  seem  to  be  the  habitation  of  a  more  highly  organized 
animal  than  they  really  are. 

There  are  two  kinds  of  foraminated  shells,  calcareous 
and  siliceous.  The  calcareous  shells  are  found  alive  in 
marine  deposit,  and  on  sea-weed ;  the  siliceous  are  also 
dredged  up  from  the  depths  of  the  sea,  and  found  in  strata 
formed  of  fossil  deposits. 

The  animals  which  dwell  in  these  beautiful  little  shells 
are  of  the  lowest  order  in  the  scale  of  animal  creation,  not 
yet  perfectly  understood,  and  are  variously  placed  by 
scientific  men.  Formerly  they  were  considered  as  belong- 
ing to  the  family  of  Cephalopods,  or  Cuttle-fish.  Ehren- 
berg,  a  great  naturalist,  regarded  them  as  polypes,  and 
placed  them  amongst  the  Bryozoa,  or  Zoophytes.  Du 
Jardin,  a  French  naturalist,  and  most  modern  authors,  agree 
in  the  relationship  of  foraminifera  to  those  very  curious 
animals,  Amoeba  and  Actinophrys  sol,  which  are  found  in 
fresh  water,  and  may  be  studied  from  our  aquariums. 

Their  internal  organization  is  a  simple  body  of  what  is 
called  sarcode,  a  kind  of  pulp  which  has  the  power  of 
assimilating  and  digesting  food  in  all  its  parts.  The  body 
has  no  particular  mouth,  stomach,  or  intestine,  neither  has 
it  eyes  or  other  senses,  except  feeling ;  but  it  can  put- 
forth  long  feelers  through  the  perforations  in  the  shell, 
and  can  entangle  and  draw  in  its  appointed  food,  which, 
whenever  it  enters,  is  presently  digested,  and  the  residue 
ejected,  not  always  out  of  the  shell,  for  the  cavities  are 
sometimes  choked  up  by  these  undigested  atoms. 

Now  in  some  of  the  Eoraminifera  the  body  is  single  and 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  195 

jointed,  in  others  the  chambers  of  the  cells  are  so  distinct 
that  the  sarcode  body  may  be  considered  as  compound,  and 
one  tiny  shell  to  contain  a  family,  the  members  of  which 
have  been  produced  as  gemmae  or  buds,  one  from  the  other. 

The  subject  is  still  under  investigation  by  scientific  men, 
therefore  I  shall  not  enter  further  into  it,  but  recommend 
the  student,  if  desirous  of  further  information,  to  read 
'  Weaver's  Abstract  of  Foraminifera '  in  '  Annals  of  Nat. 
Hist./  1841  ;  '  Williamson  Trans.  Micros.  Soc.,'  vol.  ii., 
and  l  Micr.  Journal/  vol.  i. ;  also  *  Carpenter  on  the  Micro- 
scope,' chap.  x. 

The  structure  of  the  shell  itself  is  various,  some  being 
single-chambered  (Lagena,  Miliolina,  and  Gromia) ;  the 
greater  number  are  compound  shells,  with  cells  arranged 
lengthwise,  or  circular,  or  spiral,  all  of  them  dotted  with 
numerous  foramina,  or  holes,  from  whence  they  are  named 
foraminated  shells. 

We  should  have  at  least  three  slides  of  these  in  our 
collection :  one  of  the  mixed  specimens,  one  of  the  beau- 
tiful Oistellarea,  or  Operculina,  and  one  of  the  siliceous 
Foraminifera  from  the  Barbadoes  deposit. 

THE   OPERCULINA 

is  the  best  example  of  a  compound  shell,  to  show  the  divi- 
sion into  chambers;  it  is  like  a  tiny  nautilus,  and  if  we 
saw  the  interior  we  should  find  each  chamber  separated 
from  the  other  by  double  walls,  or  septa,  containing  tubes, 
and  which  give  off  lateral  branches,  and  a  network  of  minute 
veins  for  circulation  of  fluid.  A  large  syphon  or  tube 
forms  the  margin  of  the  shell,  and  is  the  medium  of  com- 
munication between  the  cells. 

The  shells  of  this  Foraminifer  being  calcareous,  are  easily 
dissolved  by  muriatic  acid ;  and  a  recent  specimen  may  be 
examined  by  placing  it  in  a  watchglassful  of  water  with  one 
drop  of  strong  acid,  when,  in  a  very  short  time,  the  shell 
will  dissolve,  leaving  the  animal  naked  and  perfect  with 
every  mark  of  its  habitation  left  upon  its  plastic  body. 

On  examining  a  mixed  slide  you  will  find  that  some  are 
starlike  (Astoma),  some  in  complex  whorls  (Cassidulina), 


196  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

some  straight  and  yet  chambered  (Verneucilina) — the 
variety  is  immense.  They  are  dredged  from  the  depths  of 
the  Mediterranean,  the  Adriatic,  and  JEgean  Seas,  and  on 
our  own  coast  they  are  found  also  plentifully  in  the  white 
drifted  sand,  or  amongst  the  corallines  in  rock-pools.  The 
Cassidulina  and  Rosalina  are  the  most  common  in  the 
Channel  Islands.  The  ouze  of  oyster-beds  also  abound 
with  some  species. 

FOSSIL  FOKAMINATED  SHELLS  FROM  BARBADOES. 

These  are  of  a  different  kind ;  the  shells  are  siliceous ; 
the  variety  even  on  this  one  slide  is  probably  amazing,  and 
the  delicacy  of  form  and  workmanship  truly  worth  a  long 
and  careful  examination.  They  were  first  discovered  by 
Professor  Ehrenberg,  at  Cuxhaven,  on  the  North  Sea,  after- 
wards found  by  him  in  collections  made  in  the  Antarctic 
Seas.  Fancy  these  fragile  and  lovely  little  creatures  having 
been  brought  up  by  the  sounding-lead  at  the  depth  of  2,000 
fathoms !  Such  are  the  beautiful  forms  which  the  hand 
of  God  has  fashioned  in  His  wisdom,  where  human  eye 
never  sees  and  foot  of  man  never  treads,  and  which,  but 
for  our  microscope,  had  remained  unknown  to  us  as  they 
have  been  for  the  ages  past. 

Nothing  do  we  examine  thus  but  it  reveals  such  perfect 
finish,  such  loving  design  of  adaptation  to  the  creature's 
necessities,  that  we  have  deeper  thoughts  than  our  tongue 
can  utter,  and  learn  lessons  that  philosophy  has  never 
taught.  Nothing  is  done  carelessly  ;  nothing  is  isolated  or 
loose  in  the  scale  of  creation ;  the  plan  is  seen  ever  wider, 
deeper,  higher,  but  complete  and  in  perfect  order,  whatever 
part  is  presented  to  our  finite  mind.  We  see  very  little, 
we  know  very  little ;  but  we  gaze  on,  and  our  hearts  are 
directed  upward  even  by  a  slide  of  microscopic  shells  sculp- 
tured with  hieroglyphics  of  the  Creator. 

The  Barbadoes  deposit  alone  furnishes  2S2  varieties  ;  and 
when  we  consider  that  in  a  single  ounce  of  sand  6,000  of 
these  shells  were  picked  out,  and  in  another  ounce  from 
the  shores  of  the  Antilles  no  less  than  3,840,000  were  dis- 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  197 

covered ;  when  we  learn  that  these  little  shells  are  increasing 
so  fast  as  to  block  up  navigable  channels,  obstruct  gulfs, 
and  fill  up  harbours,  we  feel  how  little  we  can  know  of  that 
Infinite  Mind  who  has  so  ordered  the  multiplicity,  and  so 
elaborately  worked  these  foraminated  shells. 

ORBITOLITES 

are  circular  fossil  shells,  varying  in  size  from  a  sixpence  to 
very  minute  species,  found  in  all  foraminiferous  sand.  It 
is  the  habitation  of  a  composite  animal,  often  found  alive 
on  sea-weed,  but  more  abundant  in  the  fossil  state.  The 
chambers  or  cells  are  arranged  in  circles — the  shell  not 
sculptured.  The  animal  is  of  a  less  high  order  than  the 
true  Foraminifera.  Perforations  in  the  shell  are  doubtless 
for  the  Pseudopia  ;  their  habits  and  mode  of  propagation 
are  not  known. 

NUMMULITES. 

These  are  a  species  of  Foraminifera,  but  only  in  the  fossil 
state ;  they  are  much  larger,  too,  varying  in  size  from  a 
fourpenny-piece  to  half-a-crown  ;  they  are  the  habitations 
of  a  composite  animal,  and  the  structure  of  the  shell  is  very 
complicate  ;  the  chambers  are  arranged  in  spirals  round  the 
centre  in  great  numbers.  They  abound  in  the  United 
States,  where  a  mountain  300  feet  high  seems  to  be  entirely 
formed  of  these  shells.  The  crystalline  marble  of  the 
Pyrenees  and  the  limestone  ranges  of  the  Adriatic  Sea  are 
wholly  composed  of  small  Nummulites.  The  Great  Pyramid 
of  Egypt  is  built  upon  blocks  of  limestone  consisting  of 
these  foraminated  shells — habitations  of  beings  who  lived 
long  before.the  age  of  man,  and  were,  amongst  others,  God's 
instruments  for  preparing  the  earth  for  the  perfection  of 
his  creation. 


198  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 


CHAPTER  XL 

SPICULES    OF    SPONGES. 


SPICULES  OF   SPONGE. 

THESE  slides,  although  useful,  and  to  a  certain  extent 
interesting,  are  very  far  from  what  is  wanted  to  illustrate 
the  nature  of  a  sponge.  They  are  isolated  siliceous  spicula 
of  the  horny  skeleton  of  the  sponge;  very  various  in  form, 
but  all  for  the  same  purpose  of  strengthening  the  framework 
of  the  animal. 

Sponges  in  their  living  state  are  by  no  means  like  the 
dried  specimens  sold  for  domestic  purposes ;  these  are  but 
the  dead  form,  the  mere  skeleton  of  what  was  once  a  living 
creature.  When  alive  it  possesses  a  firm,  fleshy  substance, 
composed  of  cells  about  1 -7000th  of  an  inch  in  diameter ; 
the  horny  skeleton  is  developed  in  the  inter-cellular  sub- 
stance, and  within  cells  of  horny  matter  these  spicula  are 
secreted. 

Sponges  present  a  great  variety  in  their  external  ap- 
pearance ;  some  being  soft  as  jelly,  whilst  others  are  as 
hard  as  flint;  some  very  large,  and  others  exceedingly 
minute.  The  nature  of  the  body  closely  resembles  that  of 
the  Foraminifera  and  Amcebse,  having  no  distinct  organs, 
and  capable  of  assimilating  food  in  all  its  parts.  There  is 
a  current  flowing  in  and  out  through  the  whole  sponge, 
entering  the  small  apertures  or  oscuia,  and  being  expelled 
by  the  animal  through  the  large  apertures  or  oscuia.  The 
channels  through  which  the  currents  are  drawn  and  expelled 
are  furnished  with  ciliated  cells,  which  promote  the  circula- 
tion of  the  water  from  whence  the  sponge  derives  its  needful 
supply  of  oxygen  and  food  for  the  maintenance  of  its  life. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  199 

This  action  may  be  observed  by  the  seaside  student  on 
carefully  removing  Grantia  ciliata,  or  Halicliondria  panicece 
from  its  native  rock,  and  placing  it  in  a  basin  of  fresh  sea- 
water,  when  they  will  presently  pour  forth  streams  of  the 
fluid  from  their  oscula,  and  give  full  evidence  of  life. 

Their  propagation  is  by  gemmation,  or  by  winter-ova, 
for  a  full  description  of  which  we  must  refer  to  Mr.  Bower- 
bank's  papers  in  '  Trans.  Micro.  Soc./  1840,  and  '  Johnson 
on  British  Sponges/ 

What  we  particularly  want  for  an  educational  box  is  a 
good  section  of  sponge,  showing  the  spicula  in  situ.  The 
following  slides  are,  however,  very  useful,  because  after 
examining  the  tri-radiate  spicula  of  Grantia,  the  stellate 
pin-shaped  spicula  of  Tethea,  the  anchor-headed  spicula  of 
Pachymatisma,  and  the  peculiar  bi-rotulate  spicula  of  the 
fresh- water  sponge,  Spongilla  fluviatilis,  we  are  able  to 
understand  many  of  the  miscellaneous  contents  of  fossil  earth 
or  recent  sand,  and  discern  not  only  the  remains  of  a  sponge, 
but  to  what  particular  family  an  isolated  spiculum  belongs. 

GEMMULES   OF   PACHYMATISMA. 

These  are  young  sponges  or  gemmules  ;  they  grow  from 
the  sarcode  body,  and  occur  in  great  numbers  towards  the 
base  or  root  of  the  sponge ;  at  first  they  appear  as  little  knobs, 
arising  from  the  cellular  tissue,  their  stem  lengthens,  they 
become  detached,  ciliated,  and  soon  escape  from  the  parent 
sponge  to  whirl  for  some  time  in  the  water,  and  finally  fix 
upon  their  appointed  habitat  and  grow  into  a  sponge. 

SPICULES   OF   GRANTIA   NIYEA. 

These  are  tri-radiate  spicula  of  carbonate  of  lime.  With- 
out sections  of  the  sponge  itself,  or  engravings,  it  is  not 
possible  to  explain  or  understand  the  beautiful  arrange- 
ment of  these  spicula  for  support  and  for  defence ;  many  of 
them  project  into  the  cavities  of  the  sponge  to  prevent  the 
entrance  of  foreign  bodies,  which  would  assuredly  injure 
the  delicate  fibres  of  its  frame. 

Grantia  compressa  is  an  abundant  animal  in  the  caves  at 
Tenby,  and  the  Gouliot  Caves  in  Serk.  Grantia  ciliata  is 


200  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

found  in  rocky  pools  hanging  like  a  little  bottle  with  a 
circle  of  silvery  spiculse  round  its  mouth. 

Spicules  of  Pachymatisma  (crutches). 
Halichondria  incrustans. 
„  Griffithsia. 

Dysidea  fragilis. 
Tethese. 

Spongila3  fluviatilis. 
Geodia. 
Sponge  Spicules,  Thames. 

„  „          Serk. 

„  „          Pin-shaped. 

„  ,,          Parallel-spined. 

„  „          Anchor-shaped. 

„  „          Truncated. 

„  ,,          Clubs. 

„  „          Stars. 

Sponges  from  the  Phillippine  Islands. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  201 

CHAPTER  XII. 

SECTIONS     OF    BONE. 

THESE  are  favourite  objects  for  the  polariscope,  and  are 
usually  selected  from  their  brilliancy  under  polarized  light ; 
but  the  structure  of  bone  is  a  most  interesting  study 
as  connected  with  comparative  anatomy  and  geological 
researches,  opening  a  wide  field  of  observation. 

Bone  is  formed,  like  all  other  parts  of  the  body,  by  the 
development  of  cells,  in  which  secondary  deposits  of  earthy 
or  inorganic  matter  consolidate  the  tissue  and  form  the 
substance.  Chemically,  bone  consists  of  gelatine,  with 
phosphate  of  lime,  carbonate  of  magnesia,  fluoride  of  cal- 
cium, small  quantities  of  carbonate  of  lime,  and  a  little 
oxide  of  iron. 

The  marrow  or  medullary  tissue  of  bones  consists  of 
ordinary  fatty  tissue,  a  particular  liquid,  and  cells,  with 
vessels  and  nerves. 

The  structure  will  only  be  understood  by  the  examina- 
tion of  a  few  of  these  slides.  Take,  for  example,  a  section 
of  human  bone, 

MAN'S  METACARPAL. 

The  first  thing  we  notice  is  the  number  of  apertures 
surrounded  by  laminae  or  layers  of  substance  in  circles. 
These  are  the  Haversian  canals  which  serve  for  the  trans- 
mission of  blood-vessels  to  the  interior  of  the  bone.  The 
numerous  black  spots  with  radiating  fibres  are  called  lacunae, 
or  bone-cells,  and  the  fine  lines  are  little  tubes  called 
canaliculi,  or  calcigerous  canals.  They  are  dark,  because 
filled  with  air,  and  their  shape  and  size  are  most  important 
matters  to  the  naturalist,  who  thereby  can  determine  to 
what  class  of  Bird,  Beast,  Reptile,  or  Fish,  any  given  bone 
belongs. 

Not  only  so,  but  by  the  arrangement  of  the  Haversian 
canals  and  bone-cells,  differing  in  every  bone  of  the  body, 
from  the  bones  of  man  to  those  of  the  smallest  creature, 

13 


202  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

there  is  an  infinite  variety  of  structure  adapted  to  the 
necessities  of  the  animal,  more  or  less  of  strength,  or  of 
lightness,  or  of  flexibility. 

A  knowledge  of  this  has  enabled  Owen,  the  great  osteo- 
logist,  to  ascertain  the  order  and  exact  position  of  an  ante- 
diluvian reptile  from  a  mere  fragment  of  fossil  bone. 

By  microscopic  examination  of  bone  the  existence  of 
Keaper  reptiles  in  old  red  sandstone  has  been  determined, 
and  the  supposed  reptile  Saurocephalus  been  removed  into 
the  class  of  fishes.  It  is  marvellous  to  observe  in  the 
section  of  a  fossil  bone  which  belonged  to  an  animal  of 
extinct  race,  such  as  the  huge  Mastodon  and  Megatherium, 
the  very  same  structure  and  proportionate  size  of  bone-cells 
that  we  find  in  our  domestic  animals,  and  in  man  himself; 
to  compare  a  section  of  bone  from  the  colossal  Iguanodon 
with  one  from  the  timid  lizard,  and  find  them  modelled  after 
the  same  type,  and  by  the  peculiar  form  and  large  size  of 
the  lacunaB  and  canaliculi  to  recognise  the  reptile ;  or  to 
examine  a  section  from  the  fossil  bones  of  the  gigantic 
Dinornis,  whose  species  has  been  extinct  for  ages,  and  yet 
find  in  the  still  existing  Apteryx  a  continuance  of  the  race, 
and  the  unmistakable  small  lacunae  of  Birds. 

It  was  from  a  fossil  bone  of  the  Dinornis  and  micro- 
scopical examination  that  Professor  Owen  ascertained  that 
it  was  the  femur  or  thigh-bone  of  a  Bird — that  the  bird 
was  large,  heavy,  sluggish — of  the  ostrich  tribe,  and  there- 
fore probably  with  the  habits  of  that  bird.  Afterwards, 
when  a  few  more  bones  were  sent  to  the  naturalist,  he  not 
only  discovered  that  they  belonged  to  nine  different  species, 
but  was  able  to  determine  that  one  Dinornis  was  a  bird  ten 
feet  six  inches  high,  another  nine  feet,  another  five  feet,  and 
so  on. 

With  a  very  moderate  knowledge  of  the  structure  of 
bone,  and  a  habit  of  observation  and  comparison,  the  student 
of  geology  or  of  natural  history  may  be  able  to  ascertain 
to  which  class  of  vertebrate  animals  any  bone,  fossil  or 
recent,  belongs.  A  collection  of  the  jaws  and  small  bones 
of  Moles,  Rabbits,  Weasels,  and  Rats,  will  give  beautiful 
preparations.  Nor  are  they  difficult  to  mount ;  all  we  require 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  203 

is  a  small  web  saw,  a  good  hone,  and  patience.  Slice  a 
thin  bit  of  bone  with  the  saw,  and  rub  it  on  the  hone  with 
water  until  transparent.  Towards  the  end  of  the  operation 
fasten  the  section  with  balsam  to  a  glass  slide,  and  finish 
the  grinding  carefully,  when  it  may  be  dried  and  mounted 
like  any  other  object. 

The  whole  jaw  of  a  Mole  well  ground  down  is  very  beau- 
tiful, showing  the  Haversian  tubes  like  a  tree  branching 
out  between  the  fangs  of  the  molar  teeth. 

Longitudinal  sections  generally  show  the  structure  best. 

In  the  position  and  use  of  a  bone,  the  size  and  number 
of  the  lacunae  and  Haversian  canals  are  modified  to  give 
the  required  strength  or  lightness.  The  wing-bones  of 
Birds  abound  in  Haversian  canals  and  lacunae,  which  give 
both  elasticity  and  strength,  and  there  is  an  interesting 
paper  on  this  subject  by  the  Rev.  J.  B.  Dennis,  in  the 
'  Microscopical  Journal '  for  1843.  For  the  guidance  of 
the  student  who  may  wish  to  collect  specimens  and  prepare 
sections  of  bone,  the  following  table  of  the  relative  size  of 
bone-cells  in  Fishes,  Reptiles,  Birds,  and  Man,  will  be 
useful : — 

Measurement  of  bone-cells  in  parts  of  an  English  inch. 
(TRANSVERSE  SECTIONS.) 


,.  f  one  of  the  largest     ^ 

diameter  j  oue  of  the  sm*Uest  _i_ 


1440 

Human  bone  .  1  *  ^  vt  ^  °"«—  4"° 


Ostrich 


(  Long  diameter     one  °*  £e  larSf  *    « 
J  \oneofthesmallest 

(Short  diameter    one  of.  *e  ' 


X  one  of  the  smallest  -J- 


Reptile    .  .  .  .(Short  diameter  f  one  of  the  largest 

1  one  of  the  smallest 

*" 


f  Long  diameter  •!  c 
Conger  Eel.  J  I  one 

(Short  diameter  (one  °5  tjle  lar^est    ** 
l^one  of  the  smallest  _L 


1150 
4506 
5840 
550" 
1135 


204  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

See  '  Transactions  of  the  Microscopical  Society/  vol.  ii. 
part  ii.  p.  46. 

The  following  preparations  of  bone  may  be  obtained  at 
Baker's,  and  most  other  opticians  : — 


Femur  of  Poliocephah 

Edwardsi. 
Femur  of  Monkey. 
Femur  of  Eagle. 
Bone  of  Alligator. 


Rib  of  Python. 
Rib  of  Tortoise. 
Horn  of  Rhinoceros. 
Seal  bone. 
Bone  of  Antelope. 


Bone  of  Turtle. 

FIN-BONE    OF   LEPIDOSTEOS. 

A  genus  of  fishes  belonging  to  the  family  of  Clupeidse, 
natives  of  tropical  America.  They  are  remarkable  for  their 
long  rasp-like  teeth,  and  the  hard  scales  like  stone.  They 
are,  with  the  genus  Polypterus,  the  only  living  representa- 
tives of  the  vast  numbers  of  extinct  voracious  fishes  whose 
remains  are  found  in  various  secondary  formations. 

FEMUR   OF   TETRAO    UROGALLUS. 

Tetrao  urogallus.  one  of  the  Grouse  tribe,  an  English 
species  of  bird  called  Cock  of  the  Wood. 


SECTIONS     OF     TEETH. 

These  are  brilliant  polariscope  objects,  and  offer  the 
same  interesting  subjects  for  observation  and  comparison 
in  various  animals,  fish,  reptiles,  and  mammalia. 

The  teeth  of  Mammalia  consist  of  a  crown,  or  that  por- 
tion above  the  jaw-bone  and  gum  ;  and  a  neck,  or  narrower 
intermediate  portion. 

The  substance  of  human  teeth  consists  of  three  parts  : 
the  ivory,  or  dentine,  which  is  white,  and  of  a  silky  appear- 
ance, composed  of  numerous  tubes  or  canaliculi,  called 
ivory  tubes  ;  the  cement,  or  bony  portion,  which  forms  the 
outer  coating  of  the  fangs,  and  is  like  other  bone  with 
,  but  rarely  with  any  Haversian  canals ;  the  enamel, 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  205 

which  covers  the  ivory,  and  is  extremely  hard,  brittle,  and 
fibrous.  The  fibres  of  enamel,  separated  by  muriatic  acid, 
are  found  to  be  six-sided  prisms,  about  l-6000th  in  breadth, 
and  transversely  striped,  which  are  well  seen  under  the 
polariscope. 

SECTION   OF   HUMAN   TOOTF, 

(Perpendicular,) 

will  show  the  enamel  on  the  crown,  like  a  narrow  border 
running  round ;  the  ivory  in  a  broad  band  round  the  pulp- 
cavity  ;  and  the  cement  round  the  fang,  dotted  with  lacunae. 

SECTION   OF   HUMAN   TOOTH, 
(Transverse,) 

will  only  show  the  enamel  and  the  ivory. 


Tooth  of  Saw-fish. 
Sperm  Whale. 

Jaw  of  Myliobates,   or  Eagle 
Ray-fish. 


Wolf-fish. 
Elephant's  Tooth. 
Tusk  of  Sus  Indicus. 


206  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 


CHAPTER  XIII. 

HAIRS. 


HUMAN    HAIR. 

THE  interest  of  these  slides  is  greatly  increased  by  view- 
ing them  with  polarized  light,  as  they  give  beautiful  colours 
over  the  selenite  stage.  But,  besides  the  mere  play  of 
colour,  it  is  worthy  of  observation  that  the  hairs  of  animals 
and  insects  are  so  variously  fashioned  and  so  delicately 
finished,  that  each  species  has  in  some  cases  a  distinct  form, 
though  to  unassisted  eyes  they  are  perfectly  alike.  The 
structure  of  hair  is  cellular,  like  every  other  part  of  the 
body,  and  if  it  is  soaked  in  acetic  acid,  or  soda,  that  appa- 
rent tube  is  found  to  be  made  up  of  scales  outwardly,  pig- 
ment cells,  linear  cells,  and  nucleated  cells  within ;  growing 
from  the  skin  in  which  it  is  planted,  having  a  bulb-like 
root,  nourished  by  ducts  and  follicles,  or  small  pouches  on 
either  side  of  the  hair-bulb. 

When  a  human  hair  is  young  and  healthy,  it  has  abun- 
dant pigment  cells,  and  therefore  is  coloured;  but,  when 
old  or  diseased,  either  the  pigment  cells  become  empty,  or 
only  filled  with  air,  or  it  is  preyed  upon  by  fungi,  several 
species  of  which  infect  the  human  hair. 

HAIRS    OF   DORMOUSE   AND    COMMON   MOUSE 

show  a  beautiful  arrangement  of  air-cells,  and  if  soaked  in 
potash  these  become  more  visible,  with  the  medullary  cells 
in  two  rows. 

HAIR    OF   MOLE. 

The  cells  in  the  medulla  very  distinct. 

HAIRS    OF   BATS. 

These  are  very  remarkable,  that  of  the  Indian  Bat  pre- 
senting whorls  of  scales  at  regular  intervals  along  the  shaft ; 
others  give  variety  in  the  medullary  structure. 

HAIR   OF   ELEPHANT. 

This  is  a  transverse  section,  showing  groups  of  empty 
cells  here  and  there,  and  others  in  dense  clusters  contain- 
ing pigment.  Examine  with  polarized  light. 


Specimens  of  Hair,  magnified  20".'  oinmeters. 


-Vt 

\     V.  /    .      ;  /W" 

&&&&* 


-*&. 


^HWo^ 

/    \        X-v'-N-V       -4    Y t  \../\"t 


I.    Wool. 


2.  Hair  of  Horse 


>.   Human  Hair. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  207 

HAIR    OF    CAMEL. 

More  nearly  resembling  wool,  soft  and  flexible,  with  dis- 
tinct cortical  cells,  giving  it  the  appearance  of  being  jointed. 

HAIR    OF    REINDEER. 

In  the  Deer  there  are  few  cortical  cells,  but  the  medul- 
lary cells  are  so  developed,  that  they  resemble  the  cellular 
tissue  of  vegetables. 

HAIR   OF   ORNITHORHYNCHFS. 

A  whole  hair  of  this  curious  little  animal  presents  a  com- 
bination of  wool  and  of  hair.  The  base,  which  is  long  and 
slender,  being  quite  woolly,  and  the  upper  part  enlarged 
considerably,  and  showing  imbricated  scales  on  the  surface. 
The  Ornithorhynchus  is  a  most  singular  little  animal,  about 
one  foot  and  a  half  long,  with  a  head  somewhat  like  a 
duck ;  a  body  like  a  mole,  and  yet  so  unlike  any  other 
animal  that  it  was  at  first  disbelieved  such  a  genus  existed. 
It  is  a  native  of  New  South  Wales,  and  called  by  the 
colonists  the  Water-mole. 

HAIR    OF    LARVA    OF    DERMESTES. 

This  is  used  as  a  test  object,  and,  when  viewed  with  a 
good  clear  J-inch  object  glass,  should  show  the  shaft  thickly 
covered  with  minute  spines  or  scales,  placed  on  whorls  up 
to  the  tip,  where  the  last  whorl  is  composed  of  broader 
hairs  or  scales,  somewhat  resembling  the  petals  of  a  flower, 
and  each  scale  terminated  by  a  little  knob. 

The  Dermestes  lardarius  is  a  small  black  beetle,  very 
destructive  to  bacon  ;  it  has  a  broad  gray  band,  spotted 
black  at  the  base  of  the  elytra.  It  belongs  to  the  Penta- 
mera,  having  five  joints  in  the  tarsi,  and  to  the  Clavicornes, 
having  clubbed  antennae.  The  larvae  are  most  mischievous 
in  insect  collections.  So,  also,  another  of  the  family  An- 
threnus,  whose  hairs  are  mounted  as  test  objects. 

We  find  the  larvae  of  Anthrenus  under  the  bark  of  old 
elm  trees  in  February ;  of  light  brown  colour,  with  tufts 
of  long  hairs  on  the  three  lower  joints  of  the  abdomon. 
These  hairs  are  wonderfully  beautiful.  Soak  them  a  few 
minutes  in  turpentine,  and  mount  in  balsam. 


208  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 


CHAPTER  XIV. 

SPICULES    OF    HOLOTHURIJE. 

HOLOTHURLE  are  marine  animals  nearly  related  to  the 
Star-fish  and  Echini,  belonging  to  the  Radiata,  but  very 
unlike  them  in  appearance;  they  are  outwardly  like  a  simple 
tough  sac,  with  a  plume  of  delicate  feelers  or  tentacula  at 
its  head.  It  is  divided,  like  the  Sea-urchin,  into  five  parts, 
having  five  avenues  of  suckers,  and  the  plume,  though 
more  or  less  plumose,  is  always  a  multiple  of  Jive. 

They  glide  about  in  sunny  rock-pools,  or  lie  under  stones, 
and  have  a  curious  habit  of  ejecting  all  their  intestines  if 
irritated  or  alarmed,  yet  live  a  long  time  perfectly  empty, 
and  have  the  power  of  reproducing  their  very  complicated 
internal  parts.  They  possess,  though  outwardly  of  such  a 
simple  form,  heart,  liver,  intestines,  a  wondrous  system  of 
circulation,  and  are  so  prolific  that  an  individual  has  been 
known  to  lay  5,000  eggs  in  one  night. 

The  spicules  we  mount  for  the  microscope  form  a  kind 
of  skeleton,  being  deeply  imbedded  in  the  skin,  and  their 
form  varies  with  the  species. 

SPICULES   OF   SYNAPTA. 

A  species  of  Holothuria  found  in  the  Adriatic  Sea  ;  these 
calcareous  plates  are  imbedded  in  the  skin  and  perforated 
each  with  ten  or  fifteen  holes,  in  one  of  which  an  anchor- 
like  spine  is  fitted  with  a  hinge,  by  which  it  is  erected  or 
depressed  at  the  will  of  the  animal. 

These  are  best  observed  with  the  blackground  illumina- 
tion. 

SPICULES   OF   CHIRODOTA. 

Another  species  inhabiting  the  Mediterranean,  and  the 
plates  remarkable  for  their  delicate  wheel-like  markings. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  209 

CALCAREOUS   SPICULES   OF   DORIS. 

The  Doris  is  a  soft-bodied  animal,  often  called  a  sea- 
slug ;  it  is  one  of  the  Nudibranch  mollusca,  having  its 
breathing  organs  outside  its  body,  and  like  a  starry  plume 
on  its  back.  It  is  often  seen  gliding  about  in  sunny  rock- 
pools,  or  sheltered  under  loose  stones — feeding  on  sponges, 
and  also  on  dead  fish.  The  tongue  is  very  beautiful,  and 
has  been  noticed  amongst  the  palates. 

CALCAREOUS  SKELETON  OF  DORIS. 

The  skin  appears  to  be  strengthened  by  these  calcareous 
spicules  as  a  kind  of  skeleton,  and  their  position  is  better 
viewed  when  thus  mounted. 

The  shape  of  the  spicules  varies  a  little  with  the  species. 

SPICULES   OF  GORGONIA. 

These  slides  present  a  variety  of  calcareous  spicules, 
which,  when  examined  with  the  ^-inch  power  and  dark- 
ground  illumination,  or  simply  with  polarized  light,  show 
curious  shapes  and  beautiful  colours.  They  are  found  in 
the  skin  of  the  Gorgouia,  and  each  species  has  its  peculiar 
shape  and  colour. 

Gorgon ias  are  zoophytes  ;  when  drawn  up  from  the 
ocean,  as  they  live  at  a  great  depth,  they  look  like  a  shrub 
or  small  tree  of  bright  salmon  colour ;  the  branches  are 
spotted  with  little  depressions,  but  have  no  appearance  of 
life.  If,  however,  it  is  quickly  replaced  in  sea-water,  a 
lovely  sight  is  seen — from  every  dot,  on  every  branch, 
comes  forth  a  living  creature,  flower-like,  pearly  white,  and 
spreading  forth  a  circle  of  delicate  pinna?  or  filaments,  edging 
eight  petal-like  tentacula.  They  are  feeling  for  their  prey, 
and  drawing  in  shoals  of  marine  infusoria,  like  other 
zoophytes.  When  the  animals  die,  the  petals  shrink  in  and 
the  skin  hardens,  and  these  spicules  are  found  in  masses 
throughout.  Some — the  Gorgonia  cristata — have  spicules 
shaped  like  double  crosses  ;  some  are  of  a  rich  purple ; 
others  crimson  ;  others  again  of  golden  hue  even  by  natural 
transmitted  light  and  with  moderate  power. 


210  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

SPICULES   OF   ALCYONIUM   DIGITATUM. 

These  are  likewise  abundant  in  that  polype  so  common 
in  some  parts  of  our  coast,  the  caves  at  Tenby,  and  the 
Gouliot  Caves  in  Serk,  or  are  often  washed  up  on  the 
sea-shore  after  a  storm.  Fishermen  call  them  dead  men's 
fingers,  and  they  do  look  like  a  large  yellow  finger  or 
thumb,  tough  and  ugly,  until,  as  with  the  Gorgonia,  we 
replace  it  in  sea-water,  when  the  same  kind  of  beautiful 
zoophytes  appear  from  the  multitude  of  little  spots  which 
stud  the  surface.  These  spicules  give  firmness  to  the  skin, 
and  form  a  sort  of  skeleton. 


SECTION   OF   ECHINUS   SPINE. 

This  beautiful  purple  or  golden  star,  with  fretwork  and 
circles  in  many  varieties,  is  a  section  or  very  thin  slice  of 
one  of  the  spines  of  the  Echinus,  Sea-urchin,  or  Sea-hedge- 
hog, as  it  is  sometimes  called  at  the  sea-side  by  fishermen 
and  boys,  who  either  dredge  them  up  from  the  depths-  of 
the  ocean,  on  oyster-beds,  or  find  them  at  low- tide  in  the 
crannies  of  rocks.  There  are  many  species  ;  some  very 
large  and  bristled  over  with  small  spines  ;  some  exceeding 
small,  scarely  larger  than  a  marrowfat  pea  ;  others,  again, 
about  the  size  of  a  hen's  egg,  with  fewer  but  much 
longer  spines,  the  Cidaris.  The  common  Echinus  has  no 
less  than  four  thousand  spines  for  its  defence,  the 
structure  of  each  spine  presenting  these  beautiful  varia- 
tions. The  centre  is  usually  occupied  by  a  network, 
bounded  by  a  row  of  what  appear  to  be  transparent  spaces, 
but  are  really  sections  of  those  strengthening  pillars 
which  run  up  the  spine  and  form  the  exterior  of  every 
layer.  Sometimes  these  sections  of  Echinus  have  annular 
bands,  dividing  a  finely  reticulated  space,  and  some  have 
hollow  spaces.  They  should  be  seen  on  the  dark  illumi- 
nated ground  with  the  dotted  lens,  or  the  parabolic 
illuminator,  when  the  effect  is  quite  magical.  Also  using 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  211 

the  blue  selenite  the  structure  is  better  seen  by  polarized 
light. 

A  short  account  of  the  animal  to  which  this  spine 
belongs  may  be  interesting  to  those  who  cannot  read  its 
perfect  history  in  the  work  of  Forbes  on  the  Radiata.  It 
belongs  to  the  same  division  as  the  Star-fish,  the  Holo- 
thuriae,  the  Medusae,  or  Jelly-fish,  the  Entozoa,  Polypes, 
and  Infusoria,  in  all  of  which  the  external  or  internal  parts 
radiate  like  a  star,  and  which  are  therefore  called  the 
radiatae.  In  all  these,  but  especially  in  the  Star-fish  and 
Sea-urchin,  the  parts  are  divided  and  formed  by  the  number 
five  in  a  most  remarkable  manner,  and  few  things  would 
afford  a  pleasanter  study  than  one  of  these  sea-urchins, 
easily  procured  in  every  fish-market  in  London,  or  at  the 
sea-side.  The  animal  is  easily  killed  in  cold  fresh  water, 
and  then  the  spines  may  be  examined,  with  their  curious 
ball  and  socket  joint,  so  firmly  fixed,  yet  so  easily  bending 
on  every  side  at  the  will  of  the  Echinus,  who  uses  them, 
not  only  for  defence,  but  for  burrowing  in  the  sand. 
Between  the  spines  are  multitudes  of  minute  organs,  the 
uses  of  which  are  as  yet  unknown,  called  pedecilaria? ;  they 
are  of  three  kinds,  pearly  white  with  dotted  and  toothed 
beaks,  and  move  about  when  the  Echinus  is  alive,  opening 
and  shutting  their  trifid  beaks  as  if  each  had  an  independent 
life. 

They  are  beautiful  objects  mounted  in  balsam,  and  viewed 
with  a  low  power.  When  the  spines  have  been  examined 
they  are  easily  removed  by  dipping  the  shell  into  boiling 
water  and  brushing  them  off;  then  fresh  beauty  appears  in 
the  tesselated  wall  of  that  wonderful  house  built  up  by  the 
Almighty  for  the  Sea-urchin  according  to  a  certain  plan, 
and  with  such  contrivance  for  its  comfort  as  it  is  worth  while 
to  examine  quietly.  Eirst  we  notice  double  rows  of  very 
minute  holes,  dividing  the  shell  into  five  divisions ;  through 
each  hole  a  small  sucker  protruded  by  which  it  walked,  or 
attached  itself  to  rocks  or  stones ;  1,860  of  these  suckers 
occupying  each  two  of  these  pores.  The  plates  between 
each  double  row  of  pores  are  studded  with  the  balls  which 
fitted  into  the  socket  of  each  spine  ;  these  fine  plates  are 


Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

called  ambulacral  plates,  and  are  not  in  one  piece  ;  closely 
examined  each  plate  consists  of  many  smaller  ones,  no  less 
than  300  of  them  in  those  five  divisions,  and  again  in  the 
avenues  between  the  pores  there  are  300  more.  600  plates, 
besides  the  4,000  spines  and  countless  pedecilaria3  in  the 
outward  form  of  the  common  Sea-urchin  ! 

The  structure  of  the  mouth  is  one  which  has  long  been 
the  wonder  and  admiration  of  naturalists,  and  was  compared 
by  Aristotle  to  a  lantern  without  a  skin,  from  whence  it 
has  derived  the  name  of  Aristotle's  Lantern.  Again  we 
see  the  number  five,  in  five  jaws,  each  with  a  long  sharp 
tooth  converging  in  the  centre,  close  to  the  mouth,  and  the 
framework  of  these  jaws  consists  of  five  times  Jice  pieces, 
moved  by  six  times  jive  muscles,  working  with  great  power 
the  jaws  of  this  little  animal,  who  feeds  on  any  dead  fish 
or  flesh  it  can  attain,  eating  also  young  crabs  with  great 
greediness,  and  catching  them  with  the  suckers  which 
surround  the  mouth.  The  opposite  end  of  the  shell  is 
occupied  by  jive  ovarian  plates,  in  each  of  which  there  is 
an  aperture  by  which  the  eggs  are  excluded ;  they  are 
strengthened  by  transverse  bands  inside,  and  again  separated 
by  jive  smaller  plates  which  bear  each  a  little  red  eye. 
The  internal  anatomy  I  shall  not  enter  upon ;  enough  is 
written  here  to  give  much  interest  to  the  various  sections 
of  Echinus  spines  which  we  purchase  as  microscopic  objects, 
and  which  are  sometimes  glanced  at  as  very  pretty  crochet 
patterns. 


OBJECTS  FOR  THE  POLAEISCOPE. 
POLAEIZED    LIGHT. 

The  possession  of  a  polarizing  apparatus  with  a  good 
microscope  is  a  source  of  much  gratification  even  to  the 
unscientific,  inasmuch  as  common  substances  are  glorified 
thereby  in  a  marvellous  way.  My  parish  boys  declared 
they  had  no  notion  their  cows'  horn  was  so  beautiful,  and 
some  of  them  wished  audibly  for  a  waiscoat  like  the  elytra 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  213 

of  a  Dyticus.  However,  the  effect  of  polarized  light  is  not 
only  beautiful  to  the  eye,  but  of  real  use  to  the  investigator 
of  tissues,  and  in  the  researches  of  the  pathologist,  for  by 
it,  the  true  structure  of  organic  bodies  may  often  be  made 
clear,  when  the  ordinary  white  light  has  failed  to  develop  it. 

Hardly  in  a  concise  manner  can  the  question  be  answered, 
which  is  so  often  asked,  "Why  are  these  objects  so  coloured?" 
and,  What  is  polarized  light  ?  But  I  may  briefly  explain 
that  rays  of  light  reflected  from  a  body  under  special  con- 
ditions, or  transmitted  through  certain  transparent  crystals, 
undergo  such  change  in  their  properties,  that  they  are  no 
longer  subject  to  the  same  effects  of  reflection  and  refrac- 
tion as  before. 

The  common  ray  of  light  may  be  compared  to  a  glass 
rod  smooth  and  white,  uniform  in  texture,  whilst  the 
polarized  ray  is  smooth  on  one  side,  rough  and  dark  on 
the  other. 

How  it  becomes  so,  requires  too  long  a  dissertation  on 
the  laws  of  light  and  colour  ;  but  so  it  is.  And  when  this 
polarized  ray  is  either  thrown  upon  or  transmitted  through 
various  substances,  it  is  either  reflected,  or  absorbed  and 
extinguished  according  to  the  structure  of  the  object  pre- 
sented to  it.  The  most  brilliant  colours  are  developed  by 
this  process,  especially  in  crystals,  feathers,  sections  of  quill, 
bone,  hoof,  horn.  A  good  selection  of  these  objects  is  of 
value  to  the  microscopist. 

SELENITE, 

which  is  a  mineral  substance  consisting  of  crystallized 
hydrated  sulphate  of  lime,  when  split  into  thin  layers  or 
laminae,  are  very  beautiful  under  polarized  light,  and  discs 
of  blue  or  red  selenite  are  used  to  enhance  the  colour  of 
objects  for  the  polariscope.  There  are  many  crystals  and 
organic  substances  whose  thickness  is  not  suitable  for  the 
production  of  distinct  colour,  which,  when  a  plate  of  selenite 
is  placed  beneath  them,  exhibit  a  brilliant  array  of  the  most 
gorgeous  hues.  A  good  disc  mounted  in  brass  costs  five 
shillings,  but  smaller  ones  may  be  obtained  at  Baker's  for 
one  shilling,  and  answer  every  purpose. 


214  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 


RHINOCEROS    HORN. 

A  section  of  this  beautiful  and  familiar  object  is  a  good 
example  of  the  effect  of  polarized  light.  By  common  light 
we  see  a  pale  yellowish  substance  composed  of  horny  fibres 
interlacing  and  forming  cells  of  concentric  layers  round  a 
minute  central  point.  All  this  is  faintly  visible  ;  but  sub- 
jected to  the  action  of  polarized  light,  brilliant  bands  of 
gold  mark  out  the  compartments,  whilst  the  layers  of  blue, 
purple,  or  green,  circle  round  a  spot  which  probably  cor- 
responds to  the  papilla?  of  the  cutis. 

WHALEBONE. 

A  longitudinal  section  exhibits  the  lamina?  of  compressed 
cells  on  either  side  of  the  medullary  cells,  varied  and  beau- 
tiful in  colour.  The  transverse  section  shows  the  large 
concentric  cells  and  pigment  granules  yet  more  vividly 
bright. 

ELYTRA  OF   DYTICUS. 

This  exquisite  preparation  for  the  polariscope  requires 
considerable  time  and  care  to  give  it  the  necessary  trans- 
parency, for  the  exhibition  of  colour  entirely  depends  upon 
the  preparation. 

The  elytra  is  naturally  hard,  black,  ribbed,  and  dotted  ; 
the  structure  scarcely  visible.  It  must  be  soaked  in  potash 
for  a  month,  then  examined,  washed,  dried,  soaked  in  tur- 
pentine, and  finally  mounted  in  balsam  ;  when  nothing  but 
the  suckers  of  that  same  beetle  can  exceed  it  in  colour. 
The  richness  of  the  golden  ground,  the  blue  and  crimson 
spots  on  which  the  black  cross  of  polarized  light  is  seen, 
makes  it  a  truly  glorious  object. 

Hairs  from  the  leaf  of  a  fern  show  like  glittering  stars  in 
the  dark  blue,  midnight  sky. 

THE   CUTICLE    OF   DEUTZIA   LEAF 

shows  the  stellate  siliceous  hairs  of  all  colours  on  the  cel- 
lular tissue. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  215 

SECTIONS   OF   QUARTZ 

give  infinite  variety  and  arrangement  of  colour. 


The  following  list  of  objects  is  specially  for  the  polar- 
iscope,  and  may  be  obtained  at  Baker's  and  at  other  opti- 
cians : — 

Sections  of  bone. 
Hairs  of  animals. 
Hairs  from  plants. 
Fibres  of  Palm. 
Section  of  Vegetable  Ivory. 
Papyrus. 

Palates  of  Whelk. 
Sections  of  Marble. 
,,          Granite. 

Agate. 

Foot  of  Wasp. 
Elytra  of  Beetle. 
Section  of  Cuttle-fish  bone. 
Crystals  of  Borax. 
Salicine. 

Cellularia  (Zoophyte). 
Gemellaria  (Zoophyte). 
Sections  of  Infant  Skull. 
Section  of  Tooth. 

Crystals  of  lodo-disulphate  of  Quinine. 
Oxalate  of  Ammonia. 


216  Objects  JOT  the  Microscope. 


CHAPTER   XV. 

ANATOMICAL  INJECTED  PREPARATIONS. 

THESE  beautiful  and  instructive  preparations  will  he 
found  most  suitable  objects  for  examination  with  a  binocular 
microscope  ;  and  as  this  little  hand-book  is  intended  for  the 
non-medical  and  young  students  of  Natural  History,  a 
description  of  the  usual  preparations  shall  be  as  brief  and 
clear  as  possible. 

If  the  structure  of  a  Bee's  tongue,  or  of  a  Cricket's 
gizzard,  be  interesting  to  us,  and  the  spiracle  of  a  Beetle 
and  egg  of  a  Fly  be  worthy  of  a  place  in  our  cabinet,  much 
more  so  must  be  those  organs  of  our  own  life  upon  whicli 
our  health  of  body  or  of  mind  depends,  and  which  in  their 
elaborate  workmanship  and  forethought  prove  how  fearfully 
and  wonderfully  we  are  made.  It  is  not  a  merely  curious 
study,  for  if  we  did  understand  the  mechanism  of  our  body 
better  we  should  not  so  recklessly  peril  its  safety,  by  the 
careless  folly  of  fashion  or  the  unbridling  of  our  passions. 

INJECTED    PREPARATIONS 
Of  Human  Liver — Rabbit — Pig — Monkey,  &c. 

These  are  either  injected  with  chromate  of  lead,^ver- 
million,  or,  if  for  transparent  injections,  with  Prussian  blue 
and  carmine.  The  sections  give  the  lobular  and  inter- 
lobular  vessels,  sometimes  the  blood-vessels  only,  or  the 
interweaving  capillaries  and  hepatic  vessels  in  different 
colours. 

The  preparation  before  me  of  Sheep's  liver  is  one  of 
Topping's,  presenting  a  beautiful  series  of  radiating,  minute 
vessels,  in  a  mingled  network  of  blue  and  carmine  ;  the 
stereoscopic  effect  detaches  every  capillary,  and  we  look 
through  the  delicate  structure. 


Circulation  of  the  Blood,  in  Stickleback  and  Frog. 


Plate  8. 


1    Stickleback.        2.  Small  portion  of  Stickleback's  tail-fin,  magnified  35  diameters. 

3    Part  of  Frog's  foot.  4.  Minute  portion  of  the  web,  magnified  100  diameters. 

5.  Capillaries  in  web  of  Frog's  foot,    magnified  580  diameters. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  217 

To  appreciate  this  preparation  we  must  understand  the 
action  and  office  of  the  Liver. 

This  organ  is  employed  in  abstracting  from  the  blood 
that  secretion  called  Bile,  which  is  necessary  to  complete 
the  process  of  digestion,  though  its  precise  mode  of  acting 
is  still  unknown.  The  liver  is  situated  at  the  right  side  of 
the  stomach,  and  at  its  lower  end  a  large  vein,  called  the 
portal  vein,  enters,  charged  with  blood  that  it  has  received 
from  the  intestinal  veins,  returning  with  impure  blood  from 
various  parts  of  the  body.  This  portal  vein  is  injected  blue, 
and  has  spread  into  those  innumerable  capillaries  which 
distribute  the  blood  throughout  the  liver,  and  in  a  most 
unusual  way  reunite  and  coalesce  into  a  large  cavity  at  the 
upper  end  of  the  liver,  called  the  vena  cava.  Through 
this  channel  the  cleansed  blood  is  propelled  into  the  heart, 
to  be  afterwards  sent  through  the  lungs  for  further 
purification. 

The  substance  of  the  liver  itself  is  made  up  of  secreting 
cells  and  passages,  called  hepatic  ducts  (colour  injected 
with  carmine),  with  branches  terminating  in  enlargements, 
called  lobes,  round  which  the  capillaries  spread.  The  bile 
withdrawn  is  poured  forth  through  a  third  passage  into  the 
duodenum,  or  small  intestine  nearest  the  stomach.  Here  it 
mingles  with  the  food,  performs  the  office  assigned  to  it, 
and  the  superabundance  passes  on  and  away  from  the 
system  altogether. 

YILLI. 

Small  Intestines  of  Man— Monkey — Pig — Dog — Cat — Eabbit. 

Any  of  these  will  show  the  structure  which  absorbs  the 
nutritive  part  of  our  food  immediately  after  its  leaving  the 
stomach.  We  see  in  this  preparation  a  crowd  of  papillae, 
covered  with  a  network  of  vessels  injected  either  with  vermil- 
lion  or  chromate  of  lead.  These  are  the  villi,  or  minute  pro- 
cesses of  the  mucous  membrane  of  the  small  intestines ;  two 
or  more  arteries  are  distributed  to  each  villus,  and  from 
their  capillaries  proceed  one,  two,  or  more  veins,  which  pass 
out  at  the  base  of  each  villus.  Also  there  are  one  or  more 
lacteal  vessels  in  each  of  these  minute  villi,  spreading  in  a 

14 


218  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

network  over  the  surface,  interwoven  with  the  capillaries, 
and  absorbing  the  fatty  part  of  our  food,  whilst  the  blood- 
vessels absorb  the  dissolved  part  of  any  kind.  The  villi 
are  closely  crowded  in  the  small  intestines,  preventing  the 
too  quick  passage  of  the  food,  which  here  receives  the 
needful  bile  from  the  liver  and  pancreatic  fluid. 
A  transverse  section  of 

DUODENUM   OF   MOUSE 

gives  a  transparent  view  of  the  villi,  in  which  both  blood- 
vessels and  lacteals  are  distinctly  visible. 

THE   LUNG. 

Human — Monkey — Bear — Puppy — Pig — Cat — Sheep — Fowl — Goose — 
Turtle— Rattlesnake— Frog— Tortoise. 

The  usual  sections  of  lungs  of  animals  present  the  capil- 
laries of  the  veins  charged  with  impure  blood,  woven  in 
close  network  around  these  bronchial  tubes,  which  aerate 
the  life-blood,  and  send  it  back  pure  and  bright  into  the 
heart,  to  leap  forth  again  throughout  the  whole  living 
frame.  The  air  we  breathe  is  composed  in  every  one  hun- 
dred volumes  of  seventy-nine  volumes  of  oxygen.  It  is 
the  oxygen  that  gives  life  and  is  the  essential  agent,  the 
nitrogen  merely  modifies  its  too  energetic  action,  and  when 
this  gas  comes  into  contact  with  the  carbon  contained  in  the 
blood  of  these  fine  capillaries,  carbonic  acid,  deleterious 
and  noisome,  is  the  result,  and  we  breathe  it  forth  at  every 
expiration.  Then  the  sluggish  purple  blood  brightens,  and 
in  vermiUion  streams  flows  on  in  a  web  of  capillaries,  which, 
if  those  of  the  lungs  only  were  extended,  would  cover  a 
space  of  2,642  square  feet,  and  the  air-cells  themselves 
number  600,000,000.  This  lung  in  a  single  year  will  have 
contracted  and  dilated  9,000,000  times,  will  have  inhaled 
100,000  cubic  feet  of  air,  and  aerated  more  than  3,500  tons 
of  our  life-blood. 

If,  however,  we  are  looking  at  slides  of  other  than  human 
lungs — the  reptile,  or  the  bird — we  shall  see  modifications 
wisely  arranged  for  the  habits  of  the  creature.  In  the 
lung  of  the  Fowl  or  Pheasant,  an  immense  number  of 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  219 

capillaries  are  exposed  to  the  air  by  means  of  lobules  or 
lunglets,  each  of  which  has  its  own  bronchial  tube  and 
system  of  blood-vessels.  Each  lobule  has  a  central  cavity 
surrounded  by  a  solid  plexus  of  blood-vessels,  which  is.  not 
covered  by  any  limiting  membrane,  but  admits  the  air  freely 
between  the  meshes. 

In  the  lungs  of  Reptiles  the  respiratory  surface  is  formed 
by  the  walls  of  an  individual  internal  cavity,  with  thin 
membranous  wall,  and  simple,  smooth  expanse,  except  at 
the  upper  end,  where  the  tracheal  vessels  enter,  close 
covered  with  a  network  of  capillaries,  and  these  ramify  over 
the  surface,  depressing  it  into  sacculi  or  air-cells,  each  of 
which  has  a  capillary  network  of  its  own,  very  considerably 
increasing  the  surface  of  blood-vessels  exposed  thus  to  the  air. 

THE   GILL   OF   AN   EEL 

will  present  a  beautiful  object,  and  show  how  this  external 
lung  is  adapted  for  life  in  another  element  than  pure  air. 
The  lamina  are  divided  into  minute  leaflets,  over  each  of 
which  the  finest  possible  web  of  capillaries  is  traced,  and 
the  strength  of  the  muscular  apparatus  connected  with  each 
arch  of  laminae  renews  the  fluid  necessary  for  their  perfect 
aeration,  without  the  cilia,  which  is  needful  in  the  gills  of 
Oysters,  Mussels,  and  Molluscs,  also  in  the  temporary  gills 
of  the  young  Water-newt. 

THE  INJECTED  FIN  OF  A  TUKTLE 

is  an  exquisite  object,  showing  the  blood-vessels  like  coral- 
branches  gleaming  in  the  water  depths,  less  numerous,  and 
therefore  more  distinct  in  form,  than  in  most  circulatory 
preparations. 

THE   STOMACH   OF  A  MOUSE. 

This  is  the  best  object  for  examination  of  and  under- 
standing the  structure  of  the  stomach,  as  the  section  gives 
a  transparent  view  of  the  gastric  vessels,  and  also  of  the 
pyloric  opening. 

The  animal  stomach  is  a  strong  muscular  sac,  consisting 
of  three  separate  layers  or  sets  of  fibres,  which  give  it  the 
power  of  contraction  and  dilatation.  It  is  lined  with  a 
mucous  membrane,  smooth  and  velvety  when  distended, 


220  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

but  loose  and  plaited  when  contracted.  The  internal  sur- 
face is  somewhat  like  honeycomb,  with  shallow  cells,  at  the 
bottom  of  which  lie  the  minute  orifices  of  the  gastric  glands. 
We.  see  these  glands  looking  somewhat  like  villi  in  the 
injected  preparation,  but  they  are  essentially  different  both 
in  structure  and  office.  These  tubular  glands  produce  the 
cells  containing  the  gastric  juice  which  digests  our  food. 
When  the  stomach  is  empty  they  are  at  rest  and  the  orifice 
of  each  is  closed,  but  no  sooner  does  food  enter  the  stomach 
than  the  capillaries  surrounding  each  gland  become  excited, 
and  the  glands  commence  actively  secreting  an  acid  fluid, 
which  oozes  in  minute  drops  from  their  open  mouths  and 
mixes  with  the  contents  of  the  stomach. 

The  pyloric  opening  is  the  passage  into  the  duodenum  ; 
during  the  first  part  of  digestion  it  is  completely  closed, 
but  as  digestion  progresses  it  relaxes  more  and  more, 
suffering  even  undigested  portions  to  go  through  it. 

THE  SKIN. 

Injected  portions  of  the  skin  usually  show  the  fibro- 
cellular  tissue  called  the  corium,  elastic,  yet  dense  and 
tough,  beneath  which  lie  the  important  sweat-glands,  the 
hair-follicles,  and  the  papillae.  The  web  that  we  see  is  com- 
posed of  fat-cells,  blood-vessels,  absorbents,  and  unstriated 
muscular  fibre. 

SECTION    OF   PALM    OF   THE   HAND    OR   FOOT   OF    CAT — DOG — 
MONKEY. 

This  will  show  the  cutis  above  and  the  papillae  beneath, 
forked  or  trifid  with  loops  of  capillary  blood-vessels.  The 
papillae  are  not  all  furnished  writh  nerve-fibres;  many  of  them 
have  merely  blood-vessels  for  the  supply  of  the  epidermis, 
and  those  which  possess  nerve-fibres  are  usually  destitute 
of  blood-vessels.  The  sensory  papillaB  contain  a  peculiar 
"  axile  body,"  or  bundle  of  fibrous  tissue,  upon  which  the 
nerve-fibre  terminates. 

If  you  do  not  mind  snipping  a  papilla  from  your  own 
tongue  with  a  sharp  pair  of  curved  scissors  and  soaking  it 
in  a  solution  of  soda  for  a  few  minutes,  it  becomes  trans- 
parent, and  the  nerve-fibres  are  distinctly  seen.  In  some 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  221 

sections  of  the  skin,  hair-follicles  are  visible,  and  the 
foot  of  the  Cat  exhibits  these.  In  other  preparations  the 
sweat-glands  are  shown,  which  are  long  tubes  coiled  into  a 
knot  near  the  closed  end,  and  a  straight  or  spiral  duct 
piercing  the  skin  at  the  surface  between  the  papillae.  These 
glands  are  most  numerous  as  well  as  large  in  the  palm  of 
the  hand — there  are  2,736  in  each  superficial  square  inch  ; 
upwards  of  two  millions  in  the  whole  body,  carrying  off  car- 
bonic acid  and  water,  as  well  as  various  other  substances 
superabundant  in  the  system — chloride  of  sodium,  muriate 
of  ammonia,  phosphate  of  soda,  lactic  acid,  and  carbonate 
of  lime. 

The  lower  animals,  more  particularly  the  naked  Amphibia, 
as  Frogs  and  Toads,  exhale  carbonic  acid  gas  most  abundantly 
by  the  skin,  and  respire  also,  absorbing  water  as  well  as  air, 
by  means  of  the  sudoriparous  glands. 

THE   SKIN   OF   THE   TOAD 

is  very  interesting,  for  it  shows  not  only  the  network  of  the 
capillaries,  but  the  pigment-cells  beneath. 


CILIARY   PROCESSES. 
THE   EYE   OF    THE    OX. 

This  is  a  magnificent  object,  exhibiting  the  blood-vessels 
of  the  choroid  membrane  and  ciliary  processes. 

THE    EAR   OF  A   MOUSE. 

A  really  beautiful  preparation,  showing  the  cartilage-cells 
and  the  structure  of  the  mouse's  hair,  also  the  injected 
arteries  and  veins.  The  cartilage-cells  are  simple  in  this 
part  of  the  body,  resembling  the  parenchyma  of  vegetables, 
and  the  substance  is  without  blood-vessels,  being  nourished 
by  those  which  spread  over  them  in  the  enveloping  mem- 
brane of  the  ear. 

They  are  the  lowest  order  of  animal  cells,  like  the  Algse 
of  the  vegetable  kingdom,  without  vessels  of  any  kind,  and 
nourished  by  inhibition. 

THE   TOE   OF   THE   WHITE   MOUSE. 

A  very  popular  object,  and  worthily  so.     If  the  section 


222  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

is  thin,  transparent  and  perfect,  it  will  show  the  structure 
and  position  of  the  nail,  the  corium  and  papillae  beneath  ; 
the  joints  and  shaft  of  each  bone  of  the  toe,  with  its  attendant 
arteries  and  returning  veins ;  also  the  hairs,  with  bulb  and 
follicle  to  each.  In  these  hairs  the  outer  cortical  or  invest- 
ing membrane  is  distinctly  seen,  banded  or  crossed  in  the 
centre  with  a  double  row  of  medullary  cells.  When  these 
last  two  slides  have  been  looked  at  with  a  low  power, 
examine  further  with  a  half-inch. 


INJECTED    PREPARATIONS. 
THE    KIDNEY. 

The  Rabbit  or  the  Cat  gives  an  excellent  preparation  of 
this  organ. 

The  whole  substance  of  the  kidney  is  made  up  of  urinary 
tubules,  with  attendant  arteries  and  veins.  These  tubes  or 
passages  are  lined  with  cells  like  paving-stones,  called 
"  epithelial  cells,"  and  those  round  bodies  injected  blue  or 
crimson  are  the  Malpighian  tufts,  or  -terminations  of  a 
tubule,  into  which  an  artery  runs  and  twists  about,  forming 
a  plexus  of  minute  blood-vessels,  ultimately  uniting  to  a 
single  outgoing  or  efferent  vessel,  which  branches  off  again 
into  a  capillary  network,  situated  in  the  cortical  or  outer 
substance  of  the  kidney.  These  solitary  efferent  vessels  are 
like  the  portal-vein  system  of  the  liver,  both  serving  to 
convey  blood  between  two  capillary  systems.  The  inter- 
stices between  the  blood-vessels,  nerves,  and  tubules  of  the 
kidney  are  occupied  by  areolar  tissue. 

TONGUE. 
Human — Monkey — Dog —  Cat — Mouse. 

If  a  perpendicular  section  of  the  human  tongue  be 
obtained,  we  shall  see  that  it  consists  of  a  free  surface, 
covered  with  structures  analogous  to  those  of  the  skin,  a 
cutis  or  corium,  on  which  are  placed  papillce,  which  are 
more  developed  in  the  rough  tongue  of  the  Dog  and  the 
Cat  than  in  the  human  subject ;  consequently  an  injection 
of  the  dog's  tongue  is.  a  more  beautiful  object.  The  fungi- 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  223 

form  papillae  spread  out  in  looped  capillaries,  whilst  on  the 
surface  beneath  is  seen  an  intermediate  plexus  of  minute 
vessels.  The  artery  and  its  vein  are  distinctly  visible  in 
each  papilla,  with  the  attendant  nerve. 

THE   BRAIN.  ' 
Cat — Rabbit — Mouse,  &c.  &c. 

OR,    SECTIONS   OF   SPINAL   CORD   OR   GANGLIA. 

We  touch  any  slide  of  Brain  reverently,  for  we  stand 
here  upon  the  border-land  between  the  visible  and  the 
invisible,  the  known  and  the  unknown,  whether  it  be  of 
animal  instinct  or  human  reason,  whose  seat  lies  here. 

Beautiful  are  these  delicate  capillaries,  spreading  round 
and  over  each  convolution  of  the  brain  ;  strange  are  these 
stellate  forms  of  nerve  corpuscles  imbedded  in  a  dimly- 
shaded  or  granular  substance.  Nerve  fibres  ramify  and 
interlace — nerve  force  flies  along  each  fibre  with  immea- 
surable velocity.  We  know  that,  chained  within  this 
complex  nerve  system,  the  living  soul  goes  to  and  fro  in 
contact  with  the  outer  world,  upon  the  countless  paths 
which  issue  from  the  twelve  pair  of  cerebral  nerves  and 
thirty-one  spinal  nerves ;  each  of  these  has  a  double  fibre 
of  sensation  and  of  motion  ;  they  are  separate,  yet  sheathed 
together ;  if  we  cut  one  of  them  the  power  of  movement  is 
gone,  whilst  sensation  remains ;  if  we  cut  the  other,  then 
convulsive,  irregular  movement  stirs  a  limb  which  can  no 
longer  feel.  We  know  that,  flashing  from  the  invisible 
dweller  within  that  little  brain,  instinct  or  intelligence 
governs  the  whole  of  this  material  frame.  We  have  learned 
works  on  the  phenomena  of  motion  or  the  physiology  of  the 
nerves,  theories  plausible  and  wild  concerning  this  organ 
of  the  mind,  and  we  feel  keenly  how  very  slight  a  jar  may 
trouble  for  ever  the  right  action  of  the  intellect ;  but  we 
really  have  little  knowledge  beyond  the  mere  structure  of 
the  Brain,  and  we  gaze  wistfully,  it  may  be,  at  the  most 
difficult  of  all  preparations  to  prepare  satisfactorily. 

All  these  preparations  may  be  procured  at  Baker's,  from 
fifteen  pence  to  two  shillings  each. 


224s  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 


CHAPTER  XYI. 

SLIDES  OF  CRYSTALLIZATION. 

THESE  are  beautiful  polariscope  objects,  and  extremely 
useful  to  the  young  student  as  first  lessons  in  crystallo- 
graphy, and  incentives  to  experimental  knowledge  of  the 
various  forms  of  mineral  substances.  Crystals  are  con- 
stantly met  with  in  the  examination  of  both  animal  and 
vegetable  tissues ;  it  is  therefore  necessary  to  become 
acquainted  with  the  most  common  forms,  if  we  use  our 
microscope  understandingly. 

In  the  cuticle  of  onion  we  find  crystallized  oxalate  of 
lime ;  in  rhubarb  also,  but  varied  in  form,  as  it  is  combined 
with  tartaric,  citric,  or  malic  acid.  Every  crystallizable 
mineral  substance  has  a  definite  form  of  crystallization,  and 
often  many  accidental  or  secondary  forms.  Carbonate  of 
lime — a  substance  well  known  as  forming  chalk,  marble,  &c., 
and  abundant  in  animal  structure — is  found  in  hundreds  of 
secondary  forms  ;  in  groups  of  radiating  needles,  in  hexa- 
gons, in  rhombohedral  forms,  as  in  the  shell  of  the  Oyster ; 
thus  the  perfect  knowledge  of  the  laws  and  accidents  of 
crystallization  is  a  deep  study ;  in  fact,  it  is  to  mineralogy 
what  mathematics  is  to  common  arithmetic,  and  cannot  be 
entered  upon  in  a  mere  catalogue  of  slides. 

The  following  preparations  are  recommended  for  beauty 
and  utility,  when  examined  with  polarized  light ;  a  plate  of 
selenite  is  frequently  indispensable  for  the  display  of  colour 
and  accurate  observation  of  outline. 

SELENITE 

is  itself  a  form  of  crystallization ;  native  crystallized  hy- 
drated  sulphate  of  lime,  called  also  satin  gypsum  or  quarry- 
glass.  It  is  found  in  the  quarries  on  Shotover  Hill,  Oxford  ; 
but  the  finest  crystals  are  met  with  at  Montmartre,  near 
Paris. 

The  primary  form  is  that  of  an  oblique  rectangular 
prism,  with  ten  rhomboidal  faces,  two  of  which  are  larger 
than  the  rest. 


Objects  for  the  Microscope. 


225 


It  is  split  into  thin  laminae,  and  mounted  on  glass  slides 
for  the  polariscope,  and  upon  the  thickness  of  the  film 
depends  the  colour. 

The  following  list  of  crystals  may  direct  the  student  to 
many  interesting  specimens  : — * 


Acetate  of  Copper. 

Acetate  of  Manganese. 

Acetate  of  Soda. 

Acetate  of  Zinc. 

Acetate  of  Lead. 

Agate,  transparent  sections. 

Alum. 

Arseniate  of  Potass. 

Bicarbonate  of  Potassium. 

Bichromate  of  Potassium. 

Borax,  or  Birate  of  Soda. 

Boracic  Acid. 

Bismuth. 

Carbonate  of  Potass. 

Carbonate  of  Lime. 

Carbonate  of  Soda. 

Chlorate  of  Potass. 

Chloride  of  Barium. 

Chloride  of  Cobalt. 

Chloride  of  Sodium. 

Citric  Acid. 

Deut-iodide  of  Mercury. 

Granite,  transparent  sec- 
tions. 

Hydrochlorate  or  Muriate  of 
Ammonia. 

Iodide  of  Potassium. 


Iodide  of  Quinine. 
Nitrate  of  Ammonia. 
Nitrate  of  Baryta. 
Nitrate  of  Bismuth. 
Nitrate  of  Copper. 
Nitrate  of  Soda. 
Nitrate  of  Uranium. 
Oxalic  Acid. 
Oxalate  of  Lime. 
Oxalate  of  Ammonia. 
Oxalate  of  Potass. 
Oxalate  of  Soda. 
Phosphate  of  Ammonia. 
Phosphate  of  Soda. 
Salicine. 

Sulphate  of  Ammonia. 
Sulphate   of  Copper   (Blue 

Vitriol). 

Sulphate  of  Iron. 
Sulphate  of  Magnesia 

(Epsom  Salts). 
Sulphate  of  Soda. 
Sulphate  of  Zinc. 
Sulphate  of  Nickel. 
Sulphate  of  Cadmium. 
Tartaric  Acid. 
Uric  Acid. 


The  formation  of  Crystals  under  the  microscope  may  be 
watched  with  the  greatest  facility.  A  little  common  salt 
(chloride  of  sodium)  dissolved  in  water,  and  a  drop  of  the 
solution  placed  on  a  glass  slide  gently  heated  over  a  spirit 
lamp,  or  by  applying  the  corner  of  the  slide  to  the  candle, 

*  These  are  mounted  for  the  Polariscope  by  Mr.  Topping. 


226  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

will  show  the  formation  of  crystals  in  primitive  cubes,  ter- 
minated by  quadrangular  pyramids.  The  water  slowly 
evaporates,  and  the  atoms  held  in  solution  return  to  their 
natural  form. 

ACETATE   OF   COPPER 

is  made  by  dissolving  common  verdigris  in  excess  of  diluted 
acetic  acid,  and  when  crystallized  on  the  slide  will  exhibit 
the  phenomena  of  dichromism  or  double  colour,  deep  blue 
and  yellowish  green. 

SULPHATE   OF   COPPER. 

Blue  vitriol  dissolved  in  water,  and  likewise  treated  with 
a  gentle  heat,  will  show  the  formation  of  beautiful  blue 
crystals  in  oblique  rhomboidal  prisms. 

ALUM 

does  not  polarize,  but  gives  crystals  of  the  octohedral  form. 

OXALURATE   OF  AMMONIA. 

This  is  most  beautiful  in  the  formation  of  its  crystals ; 
they  appear  on  the  slide  as  circular  discs-or  very  flat  spheres, 
consisting  of  minute  needles  radiating  from  the  centre,  and 
sometimes  projecting  beyond  the  circumference  of  the  disc. 
Without  the  selenite  stage  these  discs  are  like  brilliant 
little  white  stars,  traversed  by  a  black  cross  ;  with  the 
selenite  they  are  splendid  objects,  the  colours  often  disposed 
in  concentric  rings. 

MUREXIDE    OR   PURPURATE    OF   AMMONIA 

is  an  artificial  product  of  the  decomposition  of  uric  acid. 
The  crystals  are  flattened,  short,  four-sided  prisms,  of  bright 
ruby  red  by  transmitted  common  light,  and  the  two  broad 
surfaces  are  emerald  green  by  reflected  light. 

HYDROCHLORATE   OR   MURIATE    OF   AMMONIA. 

This  salt  crystallizes  in  cubes,  octohedra,  and  trapezohedra. 
A  very  little  of  the  powdered  salt  dissolved  upon  a  slide 
and  heated  gives  a  beautiful  exhibition  of  feathery  crystals 
darting  across  the  field  of  sight,  and  breaking  into  stars 
and  crosses.  They  do  not  polarize. 


Objects  jor  the  Microscope.  227 


OXALATE   OF   AMMONIA. 

This  is  obtained  by  neutralizing  a  solution  of  oxalic  acid 
with  ammonia  or  its  carbonate,  and  evaporating,  which 
gives  long,  slender  needles  belonging  to  the  right  rhombic 
prismatic  system,  and  very  brilliant  crystals  under  polarized 
light, 

SALT   OF   BRUCIA. 

Using  a  solution  of  ammonia  with  certain  salts  will  give 
an  infinite  variety  of  beautiful  crystals;  for  instance,  a 
little  salt  of  brucia,  diluted  and  mixed  with  ammonia,  will 
produce  delicate  star-like  groups  of  crystals ;  and  if  a 
solution  of  sulphocyanide  of  potassium  is  used  instead  of 
ammonia,  the  crystals  are  more  feathery,  and  resemble 
sheaves  of  brilliant  little  lances. 

Solution  of  hydrochlorate  of  strychnine  with  ammonia 
gives  an  immediate  precipitate  of  minute  prismatic  crystals, 
well  defined. 

A  solution  of  quinine  with  ammonia  gives  a  perfectly 
amorphous  precipitate  ;  with  sulphocyanide  of  potassium  it 
gives  very  pretty,  irregular  groups  of  circular  crystals  ;  but 
it  is  well  to  allow  twenty-four  hours  for  the  formation  of 
these,  as  if  hurried  they  are  extremely  minute,  and  not  so 
perfect. 

IODO-DISULPHATE   OF  QUININE. 

This  is  sold  prepared  for  examination ;  the  crystals 
possess  a  more  intense  polarizing  power  than  any  other 
known  substance.  They  are  difficult  to  mount,  though  the 
formation  is  an  interesting  process,  and  may  be  attempted. 
The  salt  is  prepared  by  dissolving  disulphate  of  quinine  in 
strong  acetic  acid,  warming  the  solution,  and  dropping  into 
it  an  alcoholic  solution  of  iodine  in  small  quantities  at  a 
time,  and  placing  the  mixture  aside  for  crystallization. 
They  dissolve  in  hot  alcohol,  but  are  not  soluble  in  cold 
alcohol  or  ether. 

To  prepare  for  mounting,  a  little  of  the  liquid  containing- 
the  crystals  should  be  placed  on  the  slide,  and  the  liquid 


22S  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

removed  with  blotting  paper.  When  the  crystals  are  dry, 
the  Canada  balsam,  previously  made  thin  with  ether,  may 
be  applied  without  heat. 

BORAX,    OR   BI-BORATE    OF   SODA, 

is  soluble  in  twelve  times  its  weight  of  cold  and  twice  its 
weight  of  boiling  water,  and  crystallizes  in  very  perfect 
forms  of  oblique  octohedral  prisms.  Dissolved  in  alcohol, 
and  dropped  on  a  slide,  it  crystallizes  immediately. 

BORACIC  ACID 

is  the  acid  of  the  salt  borax,  and  is  prepared  by  mixing 
three  parts  of  borax  dissolved  in  twelve  parts  of  boiling 
water  with  one  part  of  sulphuric  acid. 

When  a  little  phosphoric  acid  is  added  to  the  boracic 
acid,  and  the  solution  dropped  upon  a  slide,  then  laid  upon 
a  warm  iron  plate,  most  beautiful  discs  are  obtained,  which 
exhibit  the  cross  and  coloured  rings  under  polarized  light. 

From  the  simple  solution  of  boracic  acid  we  obtain 
crystals  belonging  to  the  doubly  oblique  prismatic  system, 
having  two  optic  axes.  Sometimes,  when  rapidly  crystal- 
lized, the  boracic  acid  forms  arborescent  crystals  on  the  slide. 

SULPHATE   OF   MAGNESIA. 

(Epsom  Salts.) 

The  solution  will  deposit  crystals  belonging  to  the 
rhombic  system,  and  varying  in  form  according  to  the 
treatment  in  crystallizing.  They  polarize  brilliantly  with 
the  selenite  stage. 

,  AMMONIO-PHOSPHATE   OF   MAGNESIA 

is  a  salt  frequently  met  with  in  animal  secretions  which 
have  undergone  decomposition  ;  they  belong  to  the  rhombic 
system,  but  their  varieties  are  endless.  Stellate  and  pen- 
niform  crystals  are  frequently  found  in  urine. 

URIC   ACID,    OR   LITHIC   ACID. 

This  acid  abounds  in  animal  secretions,  in  the  excrement 
of  birds,  serpents,  &c.,  and  the  urine  of  mollusca  and 
carnivorous  mammalia.  The  crystals  belong  to  the  right 


Objects  for  the  Microscope.  229 

rhombic  prismatic  system,  but  are  various  in  form  and  size. 
They  polarize  light  splendidly. 

NITRATE    OF   POTASH,    NITRE,    OR   SALTPETRE. 

This  salt  is  dimorphous ;  it  crystallizes  in  various  forms, 
but  they  all  belong  to  the  right  rhombic  prismatic  system ; 
sometimes  six-sided  prisms  with  dihedral  summits  are  on 
the  slide,  and  sometimes  obtuse  rhombohedral  crystals, 
resembling  those  of  nitrate  of  soda ;  but  they  all  polarize, 
and  exhibit  the  phenomena  of  analytic  crystals. 

Analytic  crystals  are  those  which  possess  the  power  of 
analyzing  light,  like  the  tourmaline  used  in  the  ordinary 
polariscope. 

SALICINE, 

an  alkaloid  extracted  from  the  bark  of  the  willow  tree,  and 
crystallizing  in  beautiful  forms,  either  in  discs  exhibiting  the 
cross  and  concentric  circles  of  colour,  or  in  prismatic  crys- 
tals in  stellate  and  irregular  groups,  polarizing  admirably. 

NITRATE    OF    SILVER, 

crystallized  on  a  slide,  shoots  over  the  glass  in  most  bril- 
liant feathery  crystals,  and  is  also  a  splendid  object  viewed 
with  a  spotted  lens  or  parabolic  reflector. 


I    RECOMMEND     THE    FOLLOWING     OBJECTS    AS   THE     CONTENTS 

OF  A  GOOD  EDUCATIONAL  Box : 

Cuticles  of  Lily,  Candytuft,  and  one  or  two  others,  to 
show  cells  and  stomata. 

Cuticle  of  Indian  Corn,  or  Equisetum,  to  show  siliceous 
cuticle. 

Cuticle  of  Hyacinth,  to  show  raphides. 

Cells  of  spiral  fibre. 

Scalariform  vessels. 

Starch  grains. 

Hairs  of  Deutzia  leaf. 

Scales  on  leaf  of  Elaagnus  or  Tillandsia. 


230  Objects  for  the  Microscope. 

Pollen  of  Hollyhock  or  Mallow. 

Stamens. 

Sections  of  Wool,  Endogens  and  Exogens. 

A  capsule  of  Moss. 

Spore-cases  of  Fern. 

Elaters  of  Equisetum. 

Elaters  of  Jungermannia. 

Leaf  of  Moss  or  Jungermannia. 

Specimens  of  Fungi. 

Mould,  Arsyria,  Phragmidium,  or  Puccinea,  blight  of 
Wheat. 

Heads  of  Insects. — Bee,  Wasp,  Beetle,  Butterfly,  Hyme- 
noptera,  Blow-fly,  Panorpa,  Tipula,  to  show  the  tongues  and 
eyes,  and  study  them  comparatively. 

Antennae  of  Syrphus,  of  Cockchafer. 

Leg  of  Dytiscus,  Gyrinus,  a  Fly,  a  Beetle,  a  Saw-fly. 

Wing  of  Wasp,  for  hamuli ;  wing  of  Syrphus,  of  Hemip- 
tera,  of  Moth,  to  show  scales. 

Spiracles  of  Dytiscus  ;  Trachea  of  ditto,  or  Silkworm ; 
Aerating  leaflets  of  Libellulae,  or  Ephemera. 

Sting  of  Wasp  or  Bee,  of  Gnat,  of  Horse-fly. 

Elytra  of  Diamond-beetle,  of  Hemiptera. 

Saws  of  Saw-fly. 

Egg  of  Breeze-fly. 

Acarus  of  Sugar. 

Palate  of  Whelk  and  Helix,  Limpet,  Doris. 

Zoophytes. — Sertularia,  Laomeda,  Notamia,  Gemellaria, 
Cellularia,  Flustera,  Plumularia. 

Sections  of  Bone  and  Teeth. — Human  bone,  reptile  bone  ; 
one  of  fish,  of  bird,  of  quadruped. 

Hairs  of  Animals. — Elephant,  Mouse,  Bat. 

Spicules  of  a  Sponge. 

Spicules  of  Gorgonia  and  Holothuria. 

Section  of  Echinus  spine. 

Infusorial  Earths,  three  or  four  specimens,  especially 
Discs  from  Guano  and  jNaviculse. 

Sea- weeds,  Callithamnion. 

Ptilota  Polysiphonia. 


Crown  8vo,  elegantly  bound,  cloth  gilt.  Illustrated  with  8  beautifully  coloured  full-page 
plates  and" 90  Wood  Engravings,  price  3s.  6d.,  post  free  for  42  stamps. 

FIELD     FLOWERS, 

A  HANDY  BOOK 

FOR 

THE    RAMBLING    BOTANIST, 

SUGGESTING 

to  loofc  for  antt  tofcre  to  go  in  tfcc  outdoor  sttrtrj?  of 

BKITISH     PLANTS. 
BY  SHIRLEY  HIBBERD,  F.R.H.S. 


"  It  will  serve  as  an  excellent  introduction  to  the  practical  study  of  wild  flowers." — 
The  Q,ueen. 

"  We  cannot  praise  too  highly  the  illustrations  which  crowd  the  pages  of  this  hand- 
book ;  the  coloured  plates  are  especially  attractive,  and  serve"  to  bring  before  us  very 
distinctly  the  most  prominent  flowers  of  the  field,  the  heaths,  and  the  hedgerows."— 
Examiner. 

GROOMBRIDGE  &  SONS,  5,  Paternoster  Row,  London. 


Crown  8vo,  elegantly  bound,  cloth  gilt.  Illustrated  with  8  beautifully  coloured  full-page 
plates  and  numerous  Wood  Engravings,  price  3s.  6d.,  post  free  for  42  stamps. 

SEA-SIDE     WALKS 

<&t  a  flaturaltet 

WITH    HIS    CHILDREN. 

BY  THE  REV.  W.  HOUGHTON,  M.A.,  F.L.S. 

"The  wonders  of  the  sea-shore  are  detailed  in  an  easy,  pleasant,  and  lucid  style."— 
Examiner. 

"  The  book  is  very  attractive,  and  its  usefulness  is  enhanced  by  its  many  careful  illus- 
trations."—Dat/y  Telegraph. 

"  Families  visiting  the  sea-side  should  provide  themselves  with  this  convenient  and 
instructive  work."—  The  Queen. 

"  It  is  pleasingly  written,  and  the  scientific  information  is  correct  and  well  selected." 
— Athenceum. 

GROOMBRIDGE  &  SONS,  5,  Paternoster  Row,  London. 


Crown  8vo,  elegantly  bound,  cloth  gilt,  Illustrated  with  8  full-page  coloured  Plates  and 
numerous  Wood  Engravings,  price  3s.  6d.,  post  free  for  42  stamps. 

COUNTRY    WALKS 

<®f  a  flaturalfet 
WITH    HIS   CHILDREN. 

BY  THE  REV.  W.  HOUGHTON,  M.A.,  F.L.S. 

"  A  fresher,  pleasanter,  or  more  profitable  book  than  this  has  rarely  issued  from  the 
press." — Art  Journal. 

"  Contrives  to  furnish  a  large  amount  of  interestine  natural  history  in  brief  compass 
and  in  a  picturesque  and  engaging  manner." — Pall  Mall  Gazette. 

"  It  is  wonderful  what  a  very  large  amount  of  most  instructive  matter  connected  with 
the  animal  and  plant  world  the  writer  has  condensed  into  a  small  compass." — Land 
and  Water. 

"  This  pretty  little  volume  forms  one  of  the  best  little  books  on  popular  Natural 
History,  and  is  admirably  adapted  as  a  present  to  the  young."— Birmingham  Daily  Journal. 

GROOMBRIDGE  &  SONS,  5,  Paternoster  Row,  London. 


NEW  BOOK  BY  SHIRLEY  HIBBERD. 
Now  ready,  crown  8vo,  cloth  gilt,  price  3s.  6d.,  post  free  for  42  stamps. 

THE    FERN    GARDEN 

HOW    TO  MAKE,  KEEP,  AND  ENJOY  IT  : 

OR, 

FERN  CULTURE  MADE   EASY. 

BY    SHIRLEY    HIBBERD,    F.R.H.S. 

Illustrated  with  8  Coloured  Plates,  and  about  2fi  Wood  Engraving's. 


Ferns  in  General. 

Fern  Collecting. 

How  to  form  an  Outdoor  Fernery. 

Cultivation  of  Rock  Ferns. 

Cultivation  of  Marsh  Ferns. 

Ferns  in  Pots. 

The  Fern  House. 

The  Fernery  at  the  Fireside. 

GROOMBRIDGE  &  SONS, 


CONTENTS. 

Management  of  Fern  Cases. 

The  Art  of  Multiplying  Ferns. 

British  Ferns. 

Cultivation  of  Greenhouse  Stove  Ferns. 

Select  Greenhouse  Ferns. 

Select  Stove  Ferns. 

Tree  Ferns. 

Fern  Allies. 

Paternoster  Row,  London. 


Post  8vo,  cloth  gilt,  price  5s.,  post  free  for  60  stamps. 

THE     ROSE     BOOK; 

A  PRACTICAL   TREATISE   ON 
THE  CULTURE    OF  THE    ROSE; 

COMPRISING 

The  Formation  of  the  Rosarium,  the  Characters  of  Species  and  Varieties,    Modes  of 

Propagating,  Planting,  Pruning,  Training,  and  Preparing  for  Exhibition,  and 

the  Management  of  Roses  in  all  Seasons. 

BY    SHIRLEY    HIBBERD,     F.R.H.S. 


The  Families  of  Wild  Roses. 

The  Families  of  Cultivated  Roses. 

Summer  Roses. 

Forming  the  Rosarium. 

Culture  of  Roses  in  the  Open  Ground. 

Autumn  Planting. 

Spring  Planting. 

Pruning,    Disbudding,   and    Seasonal 

Management. 
Climbing  Roses. 


CONTENTS. 


Pillar  Roses: 

Yellow  Roses. 

Roses  in  Pots. 

Roses  in  Beds. 

Roses  in  Great  Towns. 

Tea  Roses  in  Towns. 

Various  Modes  of  Propagating. 

Select  Lists  of  Roses. 

Reminders   of    Monthly   Work    in    Rose 

Hints  to  Beginners.  [Garden. 


GROOMBRIDGE  &  SONS,  5,  Paternoster  Row,  London. 

Crown  8vo,  elegantly  bound,  gilt  edges,  Illustrated  with  12  beautifully  coloured 
Engravings,  price  3s.  6d.,  post  free  for  42  stamps. 

THE     CANARY; 

ITS    VARIETIES,      MANAGEMENT,    AND     BREEDING. 

WITH 

PORTRAITS    OF    THE    AUTHOR'S    OWN    BIRDS. 

BY    THE    REV.     FRANCIS     SMITH. 


A  Plea  for  the  Canary. 
Origin  of  our  own  Canaria. 
The  Wild  Canary. 
Our  Lizards. 

Our  Yorkshire  Spangles. 
Our  Norwich  Yellows. 
Our  London  Fancy  Birds. 
Our  Belgians. 
Our  Green  Birds. 


CONTENTS. 

Our  Cinnamons. 
Our  Turncrests,. 
The  Dominie  and  the  Germans. 
Preparations  for  Breeding. 
Nest  Boxes  and  Nests. 
Our  first  Birds. 
Our  Misfortunes. 
Our  Infirmary. 
|    On  Cages. 


GROOMBRIDGE  &  SONS,  6,  Paternoster  Row,  London. 


NEW     EDITION     OF      THE     WORKS 

OF 

GRACE     AGUILAR 


This  elegant  Edition,  large  crown  8vo,  is  printed  from  new  type,  on 
paper  made  especially  for  the  series,  handsomely  bound,  and  illustrated  by 
the  leading  Artists  of  the  day. 

HOME    INFLUENCE. 

A  Tale  for  Mothers  and  Daughters.    Crown  8vo,  Illustrated,  cloth  gilt,  5*. 

THE    MOTHER'S     RECOMPENSE. 

A  Sequel  to  Home  Influence.     With  Illustrations,  Crown  8vo,  cloth  gilt,  Gs. 

WOMAN'S    FRIENDSHIP. 

A  Story  of  Domestic  Life.     Crown  8vo,  Illustrated,  cloth  gilt,  5*. 

THE     VALE    OF    CEDARS;     OR,    THE    MARTYR. 

Crown  8ro,  Illustrated,  cloth  gilt,  5*. 

THE    DAYS     OF     BRUCE. 

A  Story  from  Scottish  History.    Crown  SYO,  Illustrated,  cloth  gilt,  6*. 

HOME    SCENES    AND    HEART    STUDIES. 

Crown  8vo,  Illustrated,  eloth  gilt,  5*. 

THE     WOMEN    OF    ISRAEL 

Characters  and  Sketches  from  the  Holy  Scriptures.     Illustrated. 
Crown  SYO,  cloth  gilt,  6a. 

CRITICISMS   ON    GRACE    AGUILAR'S    WORKS. 

HOME  INFLUENCE.—"  To  those  who  really  knew  Grace  Aguilar,  all  eulogium  fails 
short  of  her  deserts,  and  she  has  left  a  blank  in  her  particular  walk  of  literature, 
which  we  never  expect  to  see  filled  up." — Pilgrimaget  to  English  Shrines,  by  JLfr* 
5.  G.  Hall. 

MOTHER'S  RECOMPENSE.— " « The  Mother's  Recompense'  forms  a  flttinpr  close  to 
its  predecessor,  '  Home  Influence.'  The  results  of  maternal  care  are  fully  de- 
veloped, its  rich  rewards  are  set  forth,  and  its  lesson  and  its  moral  are  powerfully 
enforced." — Morning  Post. 

WOMAN'S  FRIENDSHIP.— "We  congratulate  Miss  Aguilar  on  the  spirit,  motive, 
and  composition  of'this  story.  Her  aims  are  eminently  moral,  and  her  cause  cornea 
recommended  by  the  most  beautiful  associations.  These,  connected  with  theskillhere 
evinced  in  their  development,  ensure  the  snccessof  her  labours."— Illustrated  Newt. 

VALE  OF  CEDARS.—"  The  Authoress  of  this  most  fascinating  volume  has  selected 
for  her  field  oceof  the  most  remarkable  eras  in  modern  history — the  reigns  of  Ferdi- 
nand and  Isabella It  is  marked  by  much  power  of  description,  and  by  a  woman's 

delicacy  of  touch,  and  it  will  add  to  its  writer's  well-earned  reputation." — Eclectic 
Bevietc. 

DAYS  OF  BRUCE.—"  The  tale  is  well  told,  the  interest  warmly  sustained  throughout, 
and  the  delineation  of  female  character  is  marked  by  a  delicate  sense  of  moral  beauty. 
It  is  a  work  that  may  be  confided  to  the  hands  of  a  daughter  by  her  parent."— 
Court  Journal. 

HOME  SCENES.—"  Grace  Aguilar  knew  the  female  heart  better  than  any  writer  of 
our  day,  and  in  every  fiction  from  her  pen  we  trace  the  same  masterly  analysis  and 
development  of  the  motives  and  feelings  of  woman's  nature."—  Critic. 

WOMEN  OF  ISRAEL.—"  A  work  that  is  sufficient  of  itself  to  create  and  crown  a 
reputation."— Mrt.  S.  C.  Hall. 

GKOOMBRIDGE  &  SONS,  5,  PATERNOSTER  EOW,  LONDON. 


BOOKS    FOR    YOUNG    NATURALISTS. 


Crown  8Vo,  elegantly  botrad,  gilt  edges,  Illustrated  with  16  beautifully 
coloured  Plates  and  numerous  Wood  Engravings,  price  5s. 

NESTS    AND    EGGS 

OP   PAMILIAE   BIBDS. 

Described  and  Illustrated  with  an  account  of  the  Haunts  and  Habits  of 
the  Feathered  Architects,  and  their  Times  and  Modes  of  Building. 

BY  H.  G.  ADAMS. 
GEOOMBRIDGE  &  SONS,  5,  Paternoster  Bow,  London. 

Crown  8vo,  elegantly  bound,  gilt  edges,  Illustrated  with   8  beautifully 
coloured  Plates  and  numerous  Wood  Engravings,  price   3s.  6d. 

BEAUTIFUL    BUTTERFLIES. 

DESCRIBED  AND  ILLUSTRATED 

With  an  Introductory  chapter,  containing  the  History  of  a  Butterfly 
through  all  its  Changes  and  Transformations.  A  Description  of  its  Struc- 
ture in  the  Larva,  Pupa,  and  Imago  states,  with  an  Explanation  of  the 
scientific  terms  used  by  Naturalists  in  reference  thereto,  with  observations 
upon- the  P6etical  and  other  association*  of  the  Insect. 

BY  H.  G.  ADAMS. 
GROOMBEIDGE  &  SONS,  5,  Paternoster  Row,  London. 

Crown    8vo,   elegantly  bound,  gilt  "edges,   Illustrated  with  8  beautifully 
coloured  Plntes  and  numerous  Wood   Engravings,  price   3s.   Gd. 

BEAUTIFUL    SHELLS 

THEIR     NATUEE,    STRUCTURE,    AND     USES 
FAMILIARLY  EXPLAINED. 

\\VK  Directions  for  Collecting,   Clearing  and  Arranging  them  in  the 

Cabinet. 

Descriptions  of  the  most  remarkable  Species,  and  of  the  creatures 
which  inhabit- them,  and  explanations  of  the  meaning  of  their  scientific 
naojegj  and  of  the'  terms  used  in  Conchology. 

BY  H.  G,  ADAMS. 
GiROOMBEIDGE  AND  SONS,  5,  Paternoster  Row,  London. 

Crown  8vo,  elegantly  bound,  gilt  edges,  Illustrated,  with  8  beautifully 
coloured  Plates  and  Wood  Engravings,  price  3s.  6d. 

HUMMING     BIRDS. 

DESCRIBED   AND    ILLUSTRATED. 

WITH  AS 

Introductory  Sketch  of  their  Structure,  Plumage,  Haunts,  Habits,  etc. 

BY  H.  G.  ADAMS. 
GROOMBEIDGE  &  SONS,  5,  Paternoster  Eow,  London. 


NEW    EDITION    OF    THE    WORKS 
OP 

.A.    I^f    IST    .A-          ZjISL 

This  elegant  edition,  large  crown  8ro,  is  hancteomely  bound  in  cloth,  gilt 

edges,  suitable  ibr  presentation,  and  Illustrated  by  the 

leading  artists  of  the  day. 


In  One  Volume,  large  crown  8vo,  Illustrated,  price  5s. 

SELF  AND  SELF-SACRIFICE 

OB, 
NELLY'S       STORY. 

BY  ANNA  LISLE. 

"A  very  beautifhl  story,  with  characters  well  drawn,  scenery  vividly  described,  and 
interest  admirably  sustained.  The  tendency  of  the  volume  is  not  only  unexceptionable, 
but  excellent  in  a  Christian  point  of  vrow.  Wa  have  seldom  seen  a  book  in  which  the 
best  and  highest  aim  is  so  manifest  without  the  attractiveness  of  the  tale  being  at  all 
lessened  by  the  embodiment  of  ro.i^ioua  principles."  —  Eclectic  Review. 

"  The  story  is  so  delightful,  and  \he  whole  spirit  of  the  book  so  pure,  that  it  compels 
our  admiration."  —  Daily  Netcg. 

"Since  '  Cnrrer  Bell'  we  have  read  nothing  more  genuine,  nor  more  touching. 
'Nelly's  Story  '  has  power  to  carry  the  reader  right  through  with  it,  and  can  hardly  fail 
to  impress  a  moral  of  inestimable  importance."  —  Carlitle  Journal. 

"  Admirably  written,  pervaded  throughout  by  fine,  correct,  and  wholesome  senti- 
ments."—  Utorning  Post. 

"  Its  excellent  moral  tone,  and  keen  observation,  are  sure  to  render  the  book  wid*ly 
popular."  —  Jokit  Bull. 

Netty's  Story'  is  a  good  one.    It  is  one  of  the  best  we  hare  read  for  a  long  time." 


"  Abounding-  ia  interest.  We  can  hardly  conceive  a  more  suitable  gift-book."— 
Lady's  Neiczpaper. 

"  Will  be  w*-lc«T*ed,  read,  and  talked  about."—  Gentleman'*  ZTapazine. 

"  '  JJeliy's'Story  '  iatoid  in.-8och.  a  good  aad  pleasant  way,  and  withal  is  so  useful  and 
world-like,  tfest  we  trust  it  may  bring  to  its  authoress  the  fame  that  she  is  well  able  to 
•upport."  —  Tait't  Magazine. 

'•  We  recognize  and  proclaim  in  the  authoress  of  this  thrilling  tale  a  quality  beyond 
mere  ability—  geuius  of  a  very  high  order.  We  claim  for  Anna  Lisle  a  place  amongst 
the  most  distinguished  writers  of  her  age.  The  story  is  a  brilliant  effort  of  refined  ^nd 
sanctified  imagination  throughout,  quite  as  fascinating  as  anything  in  the  way  of  story, 
whether  told  by  Scott,  Stowe,  Dicsens,  or  Currer  Bell."—  Sentinel. 


In  One  Volume,  large  crown  8vo,  Illustrated,  price  5s. 

QUICKSANDS 

A  TALE. 

BY  ANNA  LISLE, 

"  It  ia  a  thoroughly  woman's  book.  We  can  fairly  say  that  we  have  seldom  met  with 
a  graver  or  more  strikin?  warning  against  the  consequences  of  over  eagerness  about 
worldly  position  and  advantages,  more  forcibly  and,  at  the  same  time,  gracefully  con- 
yeyed." — Literary  Gazette. 

"Contains  a  great  deal  of  quiet  and  powerful  writing.  Marty,  the  maid  of  Mra. 
Grey,  might  pass  for  a  creation  of  Dickens.  The  moral  of '  Quicksands '  ia  at  onco  com- 
prehensive and  striking." —  Weekly  Mail. 

GKOOMBEIDGE  &  SONS,  5,  Paternoster  Bow,  London. 


Crown  8vo,  elegantly  bound,  cloth  gilt,  Illustrated  with  8  beautifully  coloured 
full-page  Plates  and  numerous  Wood  Engravings,  price  3s.  6d. 

THE    MICROSCOPE 

A  Popular  Description  of  some  of  the  most  Beautiful  and  Instructive 
Objects  for  Exhibition. 

With  Directions  for  the  Arrangement  of  the  Instruments  and  the  Collection 
and  Mounting  of  Objects. 

BY    THE    HON.    MRS.    WARD. 


"  This  elegant  book  deserves  at  our  hands  especial  commendation  for 
many  reasons.  There  is  no  book  that  we  know  of  that  we  would  more 
willingly  place  in  the  hands  of  a  beginner  to  create  an  interest  in  the  science 
of  Microscopy.  The  Illustrations  are  beautiful,  coloured  to  represent  nature, 
and  all  original.  To  our  readers  we  cannot  give  better  advice  than  to 
become  purchasers  of  the  book — they  will  not  regret  the  outlay."—  Elec- 
trician. 

GROOMBRIDGE  &  SONS,  5,  Paternoster  Row,  London. 


Crown  8vo,  elegantly  bound,  cloth  gilt,  Illustrated  with  12  beautifully 
coloured  full-page  Plates  and  numerous  Wood  Engravings,  price  3s?.  6d. 

THE    TELESCOPE 

A  FAMILIAR    SKETCH 

COMBINING  A  SPECIAL  NOTICE  OP  OBJECTS  COMING  WITHIN  THE  RANGE 
OF  A  SMALL  TELESCOPE 

With  a  Detail  of  the  most  Interesting  Discoveries  which  have  been  made 

with  the  assistance  of  powerful  Telescopes,  concerning  the  Phenomena 

of  the  Heavenly  Bodies. 

BY  THE  HON.   MBS.  WARD. 


"  It  is  with  pleasure  that  we  direct  the  reader's  attention  to  a  little  gem 
lately  published  by  the  Hon.  Mrs.  WAKD.  One  of  the  most  admirable  little 
works  on  one  of  the  most  sublime  subjects  that  has  been  given  to  the  world. 
The  main  design  of  the  book  is  to  show  how  much  may  be  done  in  astro- 
nomy with  ordinary  powers  and  instruments.  We  have  no  hesitation  in 
saying  that  we  never  saw  a  work  of  the  kind  that  is  so  perfect.  The  illus- 
trations are  admirable,  and  are  all  original." — Western  Daily  Press. 

GROOMBRIDGE  &  SONS,  5,  Paternoster  Row,  London. 


Crown  8vo,  elegantly  bound,  cloth  gilt,  Illustrated  with  8  beautifully  coloured  full-page 
plates  and  90  Wood  Engravings,  price  3s.  6d.,  post  free  for  42  stamps. 

FIELD     FLOWERS, 

A  HANDY  BOOK 

FOR 

THE    RAMBLING    BOTANIST, 

SUGGESTING 

to  look  for  antf  tofjm  to  go  in  tfte  outdoor  stiiUn  of 

BRITISH     PLANTS. 
BY  SHIRLEY  HIBBERD,  F.R.H.S. 


"  It  will  serve  as  an  excellent  introduction  to  the  practical  study  of  wild  flowers."— 
The  Queen. 

"  We  cannot  praise  too  highly  the  illustrations  which  crowd  the  pages  of  this  hand- 
book ;  the  coloured  plates  are  especially  attractive,  and  serve  to  bring  before  us  very 
distinctly  the  most  prominent  flowers  of  the  field,  the  heaths,  and  the  hedgerows." — 
Examiner. 

GEOOM BRIDGE  &  SONS,  5,  Paternoster  Row,  London. 


Crown  Svo,  elegantly  bound,  cloth  gilt.  Illustrated  with  8  beautifully  coloured  full-page 
plates  and  numerous  Wood  Engravings,  price  3s.  fid.,  post  free  for  42  stamps. 

SEA-SIDE     WALKS 

(£f  a  £aturaliat 
WITH    HIS    CHILDREN. 

BY  THE  REV.  W.  HOUGHTON,  M.A.,  F.L.S. 


"  The  wonders  of  the  sea-shore  are  detailed  in  an  easy,  pleasant,  and  lucid  style."— 
Examiner. 

"  The  book  is  very  attractive,  and  its  usefulness  is  enhanced  by  its  many  careful  illus- 
trations."— Daily  Telegraph. 

"  Families  visiting  the  sea-side  should  provide  themselves  with  this  convenient  and 
instructive  work."—  The  Queen.. 

"It  is  pleasingly  written,  and  the  scientific  information  is  correct  and  well  selected." 
— AthencBiim. 

GROOMBRIDGE  &  SONS,  5,  Paternoster  Row,  London. 


Crown  Svo,  elegantly  bound,  cloth  gilt,  Illustrated  with  8  full-page  coloured  Plates  and 
numerous  Wood  Engravings,  price  3s.  6d.,  post  free  for  42  stamps. 

COUNTRY    WALKS 

<&i  a  flaturalttft 
WITH    HIS   CHILDREN. 

BY  THE  REV.  AY.  HOUGHTON,  M.A.,  F.L.S. 

"  A  fresher,  pleasanter,  or  more  profitable  book  than  this  has  rarely  issued  from  the 
l>re»3." — Art  Journal. 

"  Contrives  to  furnish  a  large  amount  of  interesting  natural  history  in  brief  compass 
and  in  a  picturesque  and  engaging  manner." — Pall  Mall  Gazette. 

"  It  is  wonderful  what  a  very  large  amount  of  most  instructive  matter  connected  with 
the  animal  and  plant  world  the  writer  has  condensed  into  a  small  compass." — Land 
and  Water. 

"  This  pretty  little  volume  forms  one  of  the  best  little  books  on  popular  Natural 
History,  and  is  admirably  adapted  as  a  present  to  the  young." — Birmingham  Daily  Journal. 

GROOMBRIDGE  &  SONS,  5,  Paternoster  Row,  London. 


NEW  BOOK  BY  SHIRLEY  HIBBERD. 
Now  ready,  crown  8vo,  cloth,  gilt,  price  8s.  6d.,  post  free  for  42  stamps. 

THE    FERN    GARDEN 

HOW    TO  MAKE,  KEEP,  AND  ENJOY  IT  : 

OR, 

FERN  CULTURE  MADE   EASY. 

BY    SHIRLEY    HIBBERD,    F.R.H.S. 

Illustrated  ivith  $  Coloured  Plates,  and  about  Jfi  Wood  Engravings. 


Ferns  iu  General. 

Fern  Collecting. 

How  to  form  an  Outdoor  Fernery. 

Cultivation  of  Rock  Ferns. 

Cultivation  of  Marsh  Ferns. 

Ferns  in  Pots. 

The  Fern  House. 


CONTENTS. 

Management  of  Fern  Cases. 
The  Art  of  Multiplying  Ferns. 
British  Ferns. 

Cultivation  of  Greenhouse  Stove  Ferns. 
Select  Greenhouse  .Ferns. 
Select  Stove  Feras. 
Tree  Ferns. 
The  Fernery  at  the  Fireside.  I    Fern  Allies. 

GROOM  BRIDGE  &  SONS,  5,  Paternoster  Row,  London. 

Post  8vo,  cloth  gilt,  price  6s.,  post  free  for  60  stamps. 

THE     ROSE     BOOK; 

A  PRACTICAL   TREATISE   ON 

THE  CULTURE   OF  THE    ROSE; 

COMPRISING 

The  Formation  of  the  Rosarium,  the  Characters  of  Species  and  Varieties,    Modes  of 

Propagating,  Planting,  Pruning,  Training,  and  Preparing  for  Exhibition,  and 

the  Management  of  Roses  in  all  Seasons. 

BY    SHIRLEY    HIBBERD,     F.R.H.S. 


CONTENTS. 


The  Families  of  Wild  Roses. 

The  Families  of  Cultivated  Roses. 

Summer  Roses. 

Forming  the  Rosarium. 

Culture  of  Roses  in  the  Open  Ground. 

Autumn  Planting. 

Spring  Planting. 

Pruning,    Disbudding,    and   Seasonal 

Management. 
Climbing  Roses. 

GROOMBRIDGE  &  SONS,  5, 


Pillar  Roses. 

Yellow  Roses. 

Roses  in  Pots. 

Roses  in  Beds. 

Roses  in  Great  Towns. 

Tea  Roses  in  Towns. 

Various  Modes  of  Propagating. 

Select  Lists  of  Roses. 

Reminders   of    Monthly   Work    in   Rose 

Hints  to  Beginners.  [Garden. 

Paternoster  Row,  London. 


Crown  8vo,  elegantly  bound,  gilt  edges,  Illustrated  with  12  beautifully  coloured 
Engravings,  price  3s.  6d.,  post  free  for  42  stamps. 

THE     CANARY; 

ITS     VARIETIES,      MANAGEMENT,    AND     BREEDING. 

WITH 
PORTRAITS    OF    THE    AUTHOR'S    OWN    BIRDS. 

BY    THE    REV.     FRANCIS     SMITH. 


A  Pica  for  the  Canary. 
Origin  of  our  own  Canaria. 
The  Wild  Canary. 
Our  Lizards. 
Our  Yorkshire  Spangles. 
Our  Norwich  Yellows. 
Our  London  Fancy  Birds. 
Onr  Belgians. 
Our  Green  Birds. 

GROOMBRIDGE 


CONTENTS. 

Our  Cinnamons. 
Our  Turucrests. 
The  Dominie  and  the  Germans. 
Preparations  for  Breeding. 
Nest  Boxes  and  Nests. 
Our  first  Birds. 
Our  Misfortunes. 
Our  Inlirmary. 
|    On  Cages. 
SONS,  5,  Paternoster  Row,  London. 


THE  RAINBOW  STORIES. 

Price  4d.  each,  Illustrated. 

BY  THE  EDITORS  OF  "THE  MAGNET  STQRIBS/' 


No,  1,— PHIL  THOMDYKE'fl  ADYENTUEES,    By  Prances 
M,  Wilbraham, 

No.  2,— THE  BIPT  IN  THE  BOOK,    By  Mrs,  S.  C.  Hall. 

No,  3,— THE  BUEGOMASTBE'S  DAUGHTEE,      By  W.  H. 
G-,  Kingston. 

No,  4,— HEEBEBT  AROHEE,     By  Lady  Charles  Thyape. 
No,  5,— THE  MATADOE'S  EEVENGE.    By  E,  M.  Piper. 
No,  6,— BEAMPTON  AMONG  THE  E08ES,     By  T.  Miller. 
No,  7.— THE  SEASIDE  HOME.    By  Mrs.  Eussell  Gr&j. 
No.  8,— THE  NOETHOEOPT  LILIES.    By  M,  E.  Shi^ey. 
No,  9,— PEEILS  AMONG  PIEATES,    By  P.  M.  Wilbraham. 
No,  10,— HEADLESS  AND  HANDLESS,    By  P.  H.  Wood. 
No.  11.— PEITZ,    By  Gertrude  Crockford, 
No,  12,— THE  WANDEEEE,    By  Lady  Charles  Thyrme. 


The  above  stories  can  also  be  had,  elegantly  bound  with  illuminated 
title  and  gilt  edges,  in  two  volumes,  price  8s.  6d.  each ;  each  forming  a 
distinct  volume^  very  suitable  for  presentation. 

The  idea  of  giving  a  monthly  story  complete  in  itself  was-sweeestfuily 
earned  out  by  the  publishers  in  their  "Magnet"  series,  to  which  the 
present,  the  "  Rainbow,"  is  a  sequel.  "  Eecreative  reading,"  the  Editor 
affirms,  "  invigorates  the  intellect  j  and  stories  of  the  right  sort,  true  in 
fact  or  true  in  nature,  perform  a  good  work  in  education,  and  tend  to 
awaken  the  nobler  sentiments  of  the  heart."  "  The  Rainbow'Stories" 
are  of  this  character,  and  as  varied  as  the  beautiful  object  from  which 
they  take  their  name,  embracing  subjects  oT  Fact,  History,  Travel,  and 
Adventure.  Eminent  writers  contribute  to  the  series.  Each  story  is 
handsomely  done  up  in  illuminated  cover,  and  is  illustrated  by  two  well 
executed  wood  engravings.  The  price  is  within  the  means  of  most 
young  people's  pocket-money,  and  there  can  be  no  doubt  that  where 
the  young  folks  of  a  family  circle  make  the  acquaintance  of  the  Rainbow 
Series,  a  desire  will  be  created  that  the  acquaintanceship  should  bo 
continued  and  extended. 


GROOMBRIDGE  &  SCXNS,  5,  Paternoster  Row,  London. 


GIFT  BOOKS  AT  ONE  SHILLING  AND  SIXPENCE. 

These  well-written  and  beautiful  Stories  are  lively,  instructive,  and 
moral ;  their  endeavour  is  to  teach ;  to  entertain  while  they  improve 
— to  inform  the  mind  and  educate  the  heart.  Each  volume,  crown 
8vo,  is  printed  from  new  type,  on  paper  made  especially  for  the  series, 
handsomely  bound,  and  illustrated  by  the  leading  Artists  of  the  day. 
They  are  among  the  best  and  cheapest  books  published  for  young 
people. 

OSCAR :  A  TALE  OP  NORWAY. 

AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

CONTAINING 

OSCAB  :  a  Tale  of  Norway ;  HOME  AT  THE  HAVEN  ;  THE  FOUNDLING 
OF  THE  WBECK. 


THE  CHILDREN  AND  THE  SAGE. 

AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

CONTAINING 

THE  CHILDREN  AND  THE  SAGE  :  a  Story  of  Galileo  ;  THE  SEEKEB 
AND  THE  FINDEB  :  a  Story  of  Columbus  j  THE  STOBY  OF 
WELLINGTON. 

ALFRED    THE    GREAT. 

AND    OTHER    STORIES     FROM  "HISTORY. 

CONTAINING 
ALFEED   THE   GBEAT;   THE   KING  AND   THE   BONDMEN; 

THE  CEUSADEBS. 


ROUND    THE    WORLD. 

AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

CONTAINING 

BOUND   THE   WOIWLD  ;   THE   PEOPHET  AND   THE   LOST  CITY  ; 
THE  SHIP  AND  THE  ISLAND. 


MOFFAT,  THE  MISSIONARY. 

AND  OTHER  STORIES, 

CONTAINING 

MOFFAT,  THE   MISSIONAEY?    HALCYON  DAYS;    TIIE    REWABDS  OP 
INDUSTBY. 


LOUIS     D  U  V  AL. 

AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

CONTAINING 

Louis  DUVAL  :  a  Story  of  the  French  Revolution ;  THE  SEA 
THE  YOUNG  EMIGBANTS. 


GROOMBRIDGE  &  SONS,  5,  Paternoster  Row,  London. 


SHILLING    GIFT    BOOKS    FOR    YOUNG   PEOPLE. 

Each  Book  sent  Post  Free  for  12  Stamps. 

UNION  JACK;  AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

BY  MES.  S.  C.  HALL. 
Illustrated  with  15  Wood  Engravings.     Foolscap  8vo,  cloth  gilt,  Is. 

' '  Mrs.  Hall  has  written  a  charming  story.  The  scene  is  laid  in  Ireland.  The 
characters  are  for  the  moet  part  Irish,  and  the  name  of  the  tale  is  '  Union  Jack.' 
It  is  written  with  much  simplicity,  and  is  calculated  to  amuse  men  and  women  aa 
well  as  children,  for  whom  it  is  professedly  written." — Wettern  Daily  Mercin-y. 

THE  TOWN  OF  TOYS;  AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

BY  SAEA  WOOD. 

Illustrated  with  15  Wood  Engravings.     Foolscap  8vo,  cloth  gilt,  1*. 

"One  of  the  best  of  the  series;  the  narrative  is  clearly  and  concisely  written, 
the  subject  matter  is  good,  and  above  all  it  is  replete  with  that  sustained  interest, 
without  which  children's  stories  become  worse  than  useless." — Englith  Churchman. 

NO  MAN'S  LAND;  AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

BY  T.  MILLEK. 
Illustrated  with  15  Wood  Engravings.     Foolscap  8vo,  cloth  gilt,  Is. 

"  A  series  of  very  amusing  and  instructive  tales  for  children,  written  by  a 
talented  author." — Brighton  Gazette. 

THE    SEA    SPLEENWORT;   AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

BY  THE    AUTHOR    OF    "THE    HEIR   OF    REDCLYFFE." 
Illustrated  with  15  Wood  Engravings.     Foolscap  8vo,  cloth  gilt,  Is. 

"  A  capital  little  book  for  children,  both  amusing  and  instructive."— Liverpool 
Daily  Pott. 

LOTTIE'S  HALF-SOVEREIGN  ;  AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

BY  MRS.  RCSSELL   GRAY. 
Illustrated  with  15  Wood  Engravings.     Foolscap  8vo,  cloth  gilt,  1*. 

"The  story  before  us  is  a  most  delightful  one,  and  such  as  may  be  placed  in 
the  hands  of  any  child  with  the  utmost  confidence." — Hull  Advertiser. 

THE  SHEPHERD  LORD;  AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

BY  JULIA  CORNER. 

Illustrated  with  15  Wood  Engravings.     Foolscap  8vo,  cloth  gilt,  Is. 

"  We  cannot  imagine  a  better  book  for  children  educated  at  home ;  it  com. 
bines  the  fascination  of  romance  with  the  truth  of  history,  and  will  be  eagerly 
devoured  by  the  youth  of  both  sexes." — Somertet  County  Herald. 


GROOMBRIDGE  &  SONS,  5,  PATERNOSTER  ROW,  LONDON. 


SHILLING    GIFT    BOOKS    FOR    YOUNG    PEOPLE. 

Each.  Book  sent  Post  Free  for  12  Stamps. 


THE  CAPTIVE'S  DAUGHTER;  AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

BY  W.  HEAED  HILLYAED. 
Illustrated  with  15  Wood  Engravings.     Foolscap  8vo,  cloth  gilt,  Is. 

"  If  one  were  asked  to  select  a  series  of  stories  most  suitable  for  presents  to 
children,  and  affording  real  pleasure  in  their  perusal  to  'children  of  a  larger 
growth,'  very  few  would  hesitate  to  name  this  series  as  the  very  first  and  best  of 
the  class." — Coventry  Herald. 

THE  ORPHANS  OF  ELFHOLM  ;  AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

BY  FEANCES  BEOWNE. 
Illustrated  with  15  Wood  Engravings.     Foolscap  8vo,  cloth  gilt,  1*. 

"  A  book  to  be  prized  by  the  young,  for  its  several  tales  are  well  written  and 
full  of  touching  interest."— City  Frets. 

WHEN  WE  WERE  YOUNG ;  AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

BY   THE   AUTHOE   OF   "A   TEAP   TO   CATCH  A  SUNBEAM." 
Illustrated  with  15  Wood  Engravings.     Foolscap  8vo,  cloth  gilt,  Is. 

"The  precept  of  moral  courage  which  it  inculcates,  coupled  with  its  excellent 
tone  throughout,  stamps  it  at  once  as  being  of  the  right  sort." — English  Church  man. 

NOT  CLEVER ;  AND  OTHER  STORIES, 

BY  FEANCES  M.  WILBEAHAM. 

Illustrated  with  15  Wood  E-ngravings.      Foolscap  8vo,  cloth  gilt,  1*. 
«•  Pure  in  tone,  full  of  interest,  well  got  up,  and  cheap." — Hereford  Times. 

DEAR  CHARLOTTE'S  BOYS ; -AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

BY  EMILY  TAYLOE. 
Illustrated  with  15  Wood  Engravings.     Foolscap  8vo,  cloth  gilt,  Is. 

"  We  are  glad  to  receive  a  volume  of  these  pretty  stories.  There  is  something 
refreshing -in  them,  scarcely  to  be  found  in  any  other  publication." — City  Press. 

THE  STORY  OF  NELSON.;   AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

BY  W.  H.  a.  KINGSTON. 
Illustrated  with  15  Wood  Engravings.     Foolscap  8vo,  cloth  gilt,  1*. 

"  Mr.  Kingston,  with  great  skill,  brings  out  the  stirring  events  of  the  great 
Admiral's  life  from  the  lips  of  an  old  Greenwich  pensioner.  The  story  is  toldTV-ith 
all  the  enthusiasm  of  a  true  '  Salt,'  and  has  the  further  merit  of  capital  descrip. 
live  writing." — Plymouth  Journal. 


GEOOMBEIDGE  &  SONS,  5,  PATEENOSTEE  EOT7,  LONDON 


SHILLING    GIFT    BOOKS   FOR    YOUNG    PEOPLE, 

Each  Book  sent  Post  Free  for  12  Stamps. 


BLIND  URSULA;  AND  OTHER  STORIES, 

BY  MRS.  WEBB. 
Illustrated  with  15  "Wood  Engravings.     Foolscap  Sro,  cloth  gilt,  1*. 

"  A  domestic  tale  of  humble  life,  which  -will  well  repay  perusal.  There  is  an 
excellent  tone,  moral  and  religious,  throughout  the  narrative." — Lteds  Intelligencer. 

SEA-SHELL  ISLAND;  AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

BY  G.  E.  SARGENT. 

Illustrated  with  15  Wood  Engravings.     Foolscap  Svo,  doth  gilt,  1*. 
"  An  exceeding  pretty  story." — Somersetshire  County  Herald. 

WHICH  WAS  THE  BRAVEST?  AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

BY  L.  A.  FALL. 
Illustrated  with  15  Wood  Engravings.     Foolscap  Svo,  cloth  gilt,  Is. 

"A  tale  of  the  Christmas  holidays  en  *he' banks  of  the  Shannon,  intended  to 
show,  by  the  conduct  of  a  party  of  young  people,  that  rashness  and  disobedience 
are  no  proofs  of  courage.  It  should  be  widely  spread,  :for  tie  -spirit  of  the  little 
book  is  excellent.  The  engravings  are  appropriate;  and  pleasing." — Plymouth 
Journal. 

THE  CLOCKMAKER  OF  LYONS;  AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

BY  E.  M.  PIPEE. 
Illustrated  with  15  Wood  Engravings.     Foolscap  8vo,  cloth  gilt,  1*. 

"An  interesting  tale,  forming  one  of  Messrs.  Groombridge's  Series  of  Gift 
Books,  and  by  no  means  the  worst  of  the  series." — Ckeltexhem  Journal. 

THE   ANGEL   UNAWARES;  AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

BY  MARY  HOWITT. 
Illustrated  with  15  Wood  Engravings.     Foolscap  Svo,  cloth  gilt,  Is. 

"A  pretty  story  of  kindness  rewarded  by  success.  The  principal  actors  are 
children,  and  the  teaching  of  the  story,  while  it  is  full  of  point  for  older  learners, 
is  adapted  especially  to  the  capacity  of  youth." — Plymouth  and  Derowport  Journal. 


HISTORICAL  DRAMAS. 


BY  THE  AUTHOR  OF   "THE  HEIR  OF  REDCLYFFE." 
Illustrated  with  15  Wood  Engravings.     Foolscap  Svo,  cloth  gilt,  Is. 

"  Combines  amusement  with  instruction  in  a  way  that  must  please  the  rising 
generation." — Renfrewshire  Independent. 


GROOMBRIDGE  &  SONS,  5,  PATERNOSTER  ROW,  LONDON. 


SHILLING    GIFT    BOOKS    FOR    YOUNG    PEOPLE. 

Each  Book  sent  Post  Free  for  12  Stamps. 


LOST  IN  THE  WOOD;  AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

BY  MRS.  GILCHRIST. 
Illustrated  with  15  Wood  Engravings.     Foolscap  8vo,  cloth  gitt,  1*. 

"Perfectly  healthy  in  tone,  and   highly  interesting,    these  tales  are  indeed 
most  suitable  for  family  reading."— Gloucester  Mercury. 

RAINBOW'S   REST;  AND  OTHER  STORIES. 

BY  THOMAS  HOOD. 

Illustrated  with  15  Wood  Engravings.     Foolscap  8vo,  cloth  gilt,  1*. 

"  These  are  excellent  stories  for  children,  and  nicely  got  up  and  illustrated."— 
Paitley  Herald. 


*A  COMPLETE  SET  OF  THE  TWENTY  VOLUMES,  VIZ.:- 

UNION  JACK.    By  Mrs.  S.  C.  HALL. 

TOWN  OF  TOYS.    By  SABA  WOOD. 

NO  MAN'S  LAND.    By  T.  MILLEE. 

SEA  SPLEENWORT.    By  Author  of  "  The^Heir  of  Redelyffe." 

LOTTIE'S  HALF-SOVEREIGN.    By  Mrs.  RUSSELL  GEAY. 

THE  SHEPHERD  LORD.    By  JULIA  COBNEB. 

THE  CAPTIVE'S  DAUGHTER.    By  W.  HEABD  HILLYABD. 

THE  ORPHANS  OF  ELFHOLM.    By  FBANCES  BEOWNE. 

WHEN  WE  WERE  YOUNG.    By  Author  of  "A  Trap  to  Catch 

a  Sunbeam." 

NOT  CLEVER.    By  FBANCES  M.  WILBBAHAM. 
DEAR  CHARLOTTE'S  BOYS.    By  EMILY  TAYLOB. 
STORY  OF  NELSON.    By  W.  H.  G.  KINGSTON. 
BLIND  URSULA.    By  Mrs.  WEBB. 
SEA-SHELL  ISLAND.     By  G.  E.  SABGENT. 
WHICH  WAS  THE  BRAVEST?     By  L.  A.  HALL. 
THE  CLOCKMAKER  OF  LYONS.    By  E.  M.  PIPES. 
THE  ANGEL  UNAWARES.    By  MABY  HOWITT. 
HISTORICAL  DRAMAS.     By  Author  of  "  The  Heir  of  RedclyiTe." 
LOST  IN  THE  WOOD.    By  Mrs.  GILCHBIST. 
RAINBOW'S  REST.    By  THOMAS  HOOD. 

Enclosed  in  a  Box,  20s. 

"  "We  have  read  most  of  them  with  great  care,  for  we  are  very  watchful  over 
books  for  the  young,  and  can  assure  our  readers  they  are  well  worth  a  mother':* 
attention.  They  vary  in  interest  and  in  moral  value,  but  all  of  them  are  calcu- 
lated both  to  amuse  and  instruct.  Some  convey  valuable  historical  information, 
others  lessons  in  natural  history,  and  most  of  them  convey  a  healthy  moral  in- 
fluence. All  are  subservient  to  religion  as  well  as  morals,  but  they  are  not  tinc- 
tured with  any  ism,  nor  do  they  inculcate  any  peculiar  tenets." — British  Mothers' 
Journal. 


GROOMBRIDGE  &  SONS,  5,  PATERNOSTER  HOW,  LONDOX. 


GROOMBRIDGE'S 

8HILLIMQ  PRACTICAL   MANUALS. 

Each  Book  sent  post  free  for  12  stamps. 


1.  HOME-MADE  WINES.    Eow  to  Make  and  Keep 

them,  with  Remarks  on  preparing  the  Fruit,  fining, 
bottling,  and  storing.  By  G.  VINE.  Contains  Apple, 
Apricot,  Beer,  Bilberry,  Blackberry,  Cherry,  Clary, 
Cowslip,  Currant,  Damson,  Elderberry,  Gooseberry, 
Ginger,  Grape,  Greengage,  Lemon,  Malt,  Mixed  Fruit, 
Mulberry,  Orange,  Parsnip,  Raspberry,  Rhubarb,  Rai- 
sin, Sloe,  Strawberry,  Turnip,  Vine  Leaf,  and  Mead. 

2.  CARVING  MADE  EASY;  or,  Practical  Instruc- 

tions, whereby  a  Complete  and  Skilful  Knowledge  of 
the  Useful  Art  of  Carving  may  be  attained.  Illustrated 
with  Engravings  of  Fish,  Flesh,  and  Fowl,  together 
with  Suggestions  for  the  Decoration  of  the  Dinner 
Table.  By  A.  MERRYTHOUGHT. 

3.  COTTAGE  COOKERY.    Containing  Simple  In- 

structions upon  Money,  Time,  Management  of  Pro- 
visions, Firing,  Utensils,  Choice  of  Provisions,  Modes 
of  Cooking,  Stews,  Soups,  Broths,  Puddings,  Pies,  Fat, 
Pastry,  Vegetables,  Modes  of  Dressing  Meat,  Bread, 
Cakes,  Buns,  Salting  or  Curing  Meat,  Frugality  and 
Cheap  Cookery,  Charitable  Cookery,  Cookery  for  the 
Sick  and  Young  Children.  By  ESTHER  COPLEY. 

4.  COTTAGE  FARMING;  or,  How  to  Cultivate  from 

Two  to  Twenty  Acres,  including  the  Management  of 
Cows,  Pigs,  and  Poultry.  By  MARTIN  DOYLE.  Con- 
tains, On  Enclosing  a  Farm,  Land  Drainage,  Manures, 
Management  of  a  Two- Acre  Farm,  Cow  Keeping,  The 
Dairy,  Pig  Keeping,  Bees  and  Poultry,  Management 
of  a  Ten- Acre  Farm,  Flax  and  Rape,  Management  of  a 
Farm  of  Twenty  Acres,  Farm  Buildings,  etc. 

GEOOMBEIDGE  &  SO:N"S,  5,  Paternoster  Row,  London. 


GROQMBRIDGE'S 

SHILLING  PffAOTtGAL  MANUALS. 

Each  Boole  sent  post  free  for  12  stamps. 


5.  SINGING  MADE  EASIEB,  FOE  AMATEURS, 

explaining  the  pure  Italian  Method  of  Producing  and 
Cultivating  the  Voice  ;  the  Management  of  the  Breath; 
the  "best  way  of  Improving  the  Ear ;  with  much  other 
valuable  information  equally  valuable  to  Professional 
Singers  and  Amateurs. 

6.  MAEEET  GARDENING,  giving  in  detail  the 

various  methods  adopted  by  Gardeners  in  growing  the 
Strawberry,  Rhubarb,  Filberts,  Early  Potatoes,  Aspa- 
ragus, Sea  Kale,  Cabbages,  Cauliflowers,  Celery,  Beans, 
Peas,  Brussels  Sprouts,  Spinach,  Radishes,  Lettuce, 
Onions,  Carrots,  Turnips,  Water  Cress,  etc.  By  JAMES 
CUTHILL,  F.R.H.S. 

7.  CLERK'S   DICTIONARY   OF   COMMERCIAL 

TERMS  ;  containing  Explanations  of  upwards  of  Three 
Hundred  Terms  used  in  Business  and  Merchants'  Offi- 
ces. By  the  Author  of"  Common  Blunders  in  Speak- 
ing, and  Writing  Corrected." 

"  An  indispensable  book  for  all  young  men  entering 
a  counting-house  for  the  first  time." 

8.  THE  CAT,  its  History  and  Diseases,  with  Method 

of  Administering  Medicine.    By  the  Hon.  LADY  GUST. 

9.  ELOCUTION  MADE  EASY  for  Clergymen,  Pub- 

lic Speakers,  and  Readers,  Lecturers,  Actors,  Theatri- 
cal Amateurs,  and  all  who  wish  to  speak  well  and 
effectively  in  Public  or  Private.  By  CHARLES  HARTLEY. 
Contents  :  Cultivation  of  the  Speaking  Yoice,  Manage- 
ment of  the  Voice,  Pausing,  Taking  Breath,  Pitch,  Ar- 
ticulation, Pronunciation,  The  Aspirate,  The  Letter  R, 
Emphasis^  Tone,  Movement,  Feeling  and  Passion, 
Verse,  Scriptural  Reading,  Stammering  and  Stutter- 
ing, Action,  Acting.  Reciting,  etc. 


GROOMBRIDGKE  &  SONS,  5,  Paternoster  Eow,  London. 


GROOMBRIDGE'S 

SHILLING  PRACTICAL  MANUALS. 

'Each  Book  sent  post  free  for  12  stamps. 


10.  ORATORY  MADE  EASY,  A  Guide  to  the  Com- 

position  of  Speeches.  By  CHARLES  HARTLEY.  Con- 
tents :  Introduction,  Power  of  Art.,  Various  Kinds  of 
Oratory,  Prepared  Speech,  Constructing  a  Speech, 
Short  Speeches,  Command  of  Language,  Reading  and 
Thinking,  Style,  Hasty  Composition,  Forming  a 
Style,  Copiousness  and  Conciseness,  Diction  or  Lan- 
guage, Purity  and  Propriety,  Misapplied  Words, 
Monosyllables,  Specific  TJerms,  Variety  of  Language, 
Too  Great  Care  about  Words,  Epithets,  Precision, 
Synonymes,  Perspicuity,  Long  and  Short  Sentences, 
Tropes  and  Figures,  Metaphor,  Simile-,  &<?. 

11,  THE   GRAMMATICAL   REMEMBRANCER  ; 

or,  Aids  for  Correct  Speaking,  Writing,  and  Spelling, 
for  Adults.  By  CHARLES  HARTLEY.  Contents  :  Intro- 
duction, Xeglect  of  Bnglis-h  Grammar,  Divisions  of 
Grammar,  Parts  of  Speech,  The  Article,  The  Silent 
H,  Xouns,  Formation  of  the  Plural,  Genders  of  ISFouns, 
Cases  of  Xouns,  Comparison  of  Adjectives,  Personal 
Pronouns,  Eelative  Pronouns,  Demonstrative  Pro- 
nouns, Regular  and  Irregular  Verbs,  Shall  and  Will, 
The  Adverb,  Misapplication  of  Words,  Division  of 
Words,  Capital  Letters,  Rules  for  Spelling  Double  / 
,  A  Short  Syntax,  Punctuation,  <&c. 


12.  THE  CANARY:  Its  History,  Varieties^  Manage- 

ment,  and  Breeding,  with  Coloured  Frontispiece.  By 
RICHARD  Avis.  Contains,  History  of  the  Canary, 
Varieties  of  the  Canary,  Food  and  General  Manage- 
ment, Cages,  Breeding,  Education  of  the  Young, 
Mules,  Diseases,  &c. 

13.  BIRD  PRESERVING  and  Bird  Mounting,  and 

the  Preservation  of  Birds'  Eggs,  with  a  Chapter  on 
Bird  Catching.  By  RICHARD  Avis. 


GROOMB  RIDGE  &  SOISTS,  5,  Paternoster  Hew,  London. 


GROOMBRIDGE'S 

SHILLING   PRACTICAL  MANUALS. 

Each  Book  sent  post  free  for  12  stamps. 


14.  WINE  GUIDE ;  or,  Practical  Hints  on  the  Pur- 
chase and  Management  of  Foreign  Wines,  tlieir  His- 
tory, and  a  complete  catalogue  of  all  those  in  present 
use,  together   with  remarks  upon  the   treatment   of 
Spirits,  Bottled  Beer,  and  Cider.     To   which  is  ap- 
pended Instructions  for  the  Cellar,  and  other  informa- 
tion valuable  to  the  Consumer  as  well  as  the  Dealer. 
By  FEEDERICK  C.  MILLS. 

15.  PIGEONS :  their  Varieties,  Management,  Breed- 
ing, and  Diseases,  with  Coloured  Frontispiece.     By 
H.  PIPER.     Contains  full  instructions  upon  Lockers, 
Pole-houses,  Dovecotes,  Pigeon  Lofts,  Traps,  Nesting 
Places,  Choosing  Stock,  Mating,  Eggs  and  Hatching, 
Young  Ones,  Food,  Water,  Salt  Cat,  Parasites,  Dis- 
eases, Pigeon  Law,  Varieties  and  Origin,  The  English 
Carrier,  Messenger,  or  Homing  Pigeons,  The  Horse- 
man,  Pouting    Horseman,    Dragoon    and    Skinnum, 
The  Question  of  Instinct  in  Flight,  Training  Messen- 
ger Pigeons,  The  Pouter,  The  Old  English  Tumbler, 
The  German  Tumbler,  The  Common  Flying  Tumbler, 
The    Short-faced    Tumbler,    The    Almond    Tumbler, 
Training  Tumbler,  &c. 

16.  POULTRY.    A  Practical  Guide  to  the  Manage- 
ment of  Domestic  Poultry,   describing   the   different 
varieties   with   full  instructions    upon    Management, 
Breeding,  and  Diseases,  with   Coloured  Frontispiece. 
By  H.  PIPER      Contents  :  Houses  and  Runs,  Choosing 
Stock,  Feeding  and  Management,   Nests,   Eggs  and 
Hatching,  Chickens,  Rearing  and  Fattening,  Diseases 
and  Varieties,  Brahma  Pootras,  Cochin-chinas,  Malays, 
Spanish,  Dorking,  Game,   Hamburgh,   Polands,  Ban- 
tams, Aylesbury  and  Rouen  Ducks,  &c. 

17.  DOG  AED  GUN ;  or,  Hints  to  Young  Sportsmen. 

By    CAPTAIN  FELLOWES.     Illustrated  with  Wood  En- 
gravings- 

GROOMBBTDGE  &  SONS,  5,  Paternoster  Eow,  London.